Download 2.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task

Survey
yes no Was this document useful for you?
   Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Document related concepts

Multiprotocol Label Switching wikipedia , lookup

Network tap wikipedia , lookup

IEEE 1355 wikipedia , lookup

Computer network wikipedia , lookup

Wake-on-LAN wikipedia , lookup

Airborne Networking wikipedia , lookup

Parallel port wikipedia , lookup

Recursive InterNetwork Architecture (RINA) wikipedia , lookup

Spanning Tree Protocol wikipedia , lookup

Cracking of wireless networks wikipedia , lookup

Serial digital interface wikipedia , lookup

IEEE 802.1aq wikipedia , lookup

Routing in delay-tolerant networking wikipedia , lookup

Virtual LAN wikipedia , lookup

Zero-configuration networking wikipedia , lookup

Transcript
S9700 Core Routing Switch
V200R001C00
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Issue
01
Date
2012-03-15
HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2012. All rights reserved.
No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means without prior written
consent of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
Trademarks and Permissions
and other Huawei trademarks are trademarks of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
All other trademarks and trade names mentioned in this document are the property of their respective holders.
Notice
The purchased products, services and features are stipulated by the contract made between Huawei and the
customer. All or part of the products, services and features described in this document may not be within the
purchase scope or the usage scope. Unless otherwise specified in the contract, all statements, information,
and recommendations in this document are provided "AS IS" without warranties, guarantees or representations
of any kind, either express or implied.
The information in this document is subject to change without notice. Every effort has been made in the
preparation of this document to ensure accuracy of the contents, but all statements, information, and
recommendations in this document do not constitute the warranty of any kind, express or implied.
Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
Address:
Huawei Industrial Base
Bantian, Longgang
Shenzhen 518129
People's Republic of China
Website:
http://www.huawei.com
Email:
[email protected]
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
i
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
About This Document
About This Document
Intended Audience
This document describes the multicast service supported by the S9700, including basic
knowledge, protocol implementation, configuration procedures, and configuration examples.
This document guides you through the configuration of the multicast service of the S9700.
This document is intended for:
l
Data configuration engineer
l
Commissioning engineer
l
Network monitoring engineer
l
System maintenance engineer
Symbol Conventions
The symbols that may be found in this document are defined as follows.
Symbol
Description
DANGER
WARNING
CAUTION
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Indicates a hazard with a high level of risk, which if not
avoided, will result in death or serious injury.
Indicates a hazard with a medium or low level of risk, which
if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate injury.
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation, which if not
avoided, could result in equipment damage, data loss,
performance degradation, or unexpected results.
TIP
Indicates a tip that may help you solve a problem or save
time.
NOTE
Provides additional information to emphasize or supplement
important points of the main text.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
ii
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
About This Document
Command Conventions
The command conventions that may be found in this document are defined as follows.
Convention
Description
Boldface
The keywords of a command line are in boldface.
Italic
Command arguments are in italics.
[]
Items (keywords or arguments) in brackets [ ] are optional.
{ x | y | ... }
Optional items are grouped in braces and separated by
vertical bars. One item is selected.
[ x | y | ... ]
Optional items are grouped in brackets and separated by
vertical bars. One item is selected or no item is selected.
{ x | y | ... }*
Optional items are grouped in braces and separated by
vertical bars. A minimum of one item or a maximum of all
items can be selected.
[ x | y | ... ]*
Optional items are grouped in brackets and separated by
vertical bars. Several items or no item can be selected.
&<1-n>
The parameter before the & sign can be repeated 1 to n times.
#
A line starting with the # sign is comments.
Change History
Updates between document issues are cumulative. Therefore, the latest document issue contains
all updates made in previous issues.
Changes in Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Initial commercial release.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
iii
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
Contents
About This Document.....................................................................................................................ii
1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide.............................................................................................1
1.1 IP Multicast Overview........................................................................................................................................2
1.2 IP Multicast Features Supported by the S9700..................................................................................................2
1.3 IPv4 Multicast Configuration Guide..................................................................................................................2
1.3.1 IPv4 Multicast Addresses..........................................................................................................................2
1.3.2 IPv4 Multicast Protocols...........................................................................................................................3
1.3.3 Typical Configuration Solution.................................................................................................................4
1.3.4 Controlling Multicast Forwarding.............................................................................................................5
1.4 IPv6 Multicast Configuration Guide..................................................................................................................5
1.4.1 IPv6 Multicast Addresses..........................................................................................................................5
1.4.2 IPv6 Multicast Protocols...........................................................................................................................8
1.4.3 Typical Configuration Solution.................................................................................................................9
1.4.4 Controlling Multicast Forwarding.............................................................................................................9
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration................................................................................................10
2.1 IGMP Snooping Overview...............................................................................................................................11
2.2 IGMP Snooping Supported by the S9700........................................................................................................12
2.3 Configuring IGMP Snooping...........................................................................................................................13
2.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................13
2.3.2 Enabling IGMP Snooping.......................................................................................................................14
2.3.3 (Optional) Configuring a Static Router Interface....................................................................................15
2.3.4 (Optional) Configuring Multicast Group Member Interfaces.................................................................16
2.3.5 (Optional) Configuring IGMP Snooping Querier...................................................................................17
2.3.6 (Optional) Configuring IGMP Message Suppression.............................................................................19
2.3.7 (Optional) Disabling Users from Dynamically Joining Multicast Groups..............................................19
2.3.8 (Optional) Adjusting IGMP Snooping Parameters..................................................................................20
2.3.9 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................22
2.4 Configuring a Static Multicast MAC Address.................................................................................................24
2.5 Configuring the IGMP Snooping Proxy for the VLAN...................................................................................26
2.6 Configuring a Layer 2 Multicast Policy...........................................................................................................27
2.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................27
2.6.2 Configuring a Multicast Group Policy....................................................................................................28
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
iv
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
2.6.3 Configuring Prompt Leave for Interfaces................................................................................................29
2.6.4 Filtering Layer 2 Multicast Data on an Interface.....................................................................................30
2.6.5 Enabling the Discarding of Unknown Multicast Data Packets in a VLAN............................................30
2.6.6 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................31
2.7 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast CAC................................................................................................................31
2.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................32
2.7.2 Limiting the Number of Multicast Groups of a VLAN, a Layer 2 Interface, or an Interface in a VLAN
..........................................................................................................................................................................33
2.7.3 Limiting the Number of Multicast Groups in a Channel for a VLAN, an Interface, or an Interface in a
VLAN...............................................................................................................................................................34
2.7.4 Configuring Channels on a VLAN..........................................................................................................35
2.7.5 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................36
2.8 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast SSM Mapping.................................................................................................37
2.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................37
2.8.2 (Optional) Configuring an SSM Group Policy........................................................................................38
2.8.3 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast SSM Mapping........................................................................................38
2.8.4 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................39
2.9 Maintaining Layer 2 Multicast.........................................................................................................................40
2.9.1 Clearing Static Entries in a Multicast Forwarding Table........................................................................40
2.9.2 Clearing Multicast Forwarding Entries...................................................................................................41
2.9.3 Clearing the Statistics on IGMP Snooping..............................................................................................41
2.9.4 Debugging IGMP Snooping....................................................................................................................42
2.9.5 Debugging Layer 2 Multicast CAC.........................................................................................................42
2.10 Configuration examples..................................................................................................................................42
2.10.1 Example for Configuring IGMP Snooping...........................................................................................43
2.10.2 Example for Configuring Layer 2 Multicast CAC for a VLAN............................................................45
2.10.3 Example for Configuring IGMP Snooping SSM Mapping...................................................................49
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration..........................................................................53
3.1 Multicast VLAN Replication Overview...........................................................................................................54
3.2 Multicast VLAN Replication Supported by the S9700....................................................................................54
3.3 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs.................................................................56
3.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................56
3.3.2 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs........................................................57
3.3.3 Adding Interfaces to VLANs...................................................................................................................58
3.3.4 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................58
3.4 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on Interfaces.......................................................................59
3.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................59
3.4.2 Creating a Multicast VLAN....................................................................................................................60
3.4.3 Binding User VLANs to a Multicast VLAN on an Interface..................................................................60
3.4.4 Adding Interfaces to VLANs...................................................................................................................61
3.4.5 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................61
3.5 Configuration Examples...................................................................................................................................61
3.5.1 Example for Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs...................................62
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
v
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
3.5.2 Example for Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on Interfaces.........................................64
4 IGMP Configuration...................................................................................................................68
4.1 Introduction to IGMP.......................................................................................................................................69
4.2 IGMP Features Supported by the S9700..........................................................................................................69
4.3 Configuring Basic IGMP Functions.................................................................................................................70
4.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................70
4.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast..............................................................................................................................71
4.3.3 Enabling the IGMP Function...................................................................................................................72
4.3.4 (Optional) Specifying the IGMP Version................................................................................................72
4.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Static IGMP Group.........................................................................................73
4.3.6 (Optional) Configuring an IGMP Multicast Group Policy......................................................................74
4.3.7 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................74
4.4 Setting the Parameters of IGMP Features........................................................................................................75
4.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................75
4.4.2 Configuring IGMP Message Options......................................................................................................76
4.4.3 Configuring the IGMPv1 Querier............................................................................................................78
4.4.4 Configuring the IGMPv2 or IGMPv3 Querier........................................................................................79
4.4.5 Configuring IGMP Prompt Leave...........................................................................................................81
4.4.6 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................82
4.5 Configuring SSM Mapping..............................................................................................................................83
4.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................83
4.5.2 Enabling SSM Mapping..........................................................................................................................84
4.5.3 Configuring the SSM Mapping Policy....................................................................................................84
4.5.4 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................85
4.6 Configuration IGMP Limit Function................................................................................................................86
4.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................86
4.6.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global IGMP Group Memberships...........................................86
4.6.3 Setting the Maximum Number of Global IGMP Entries for an Instance................................................87
4.6.4 Configuring the Maximum Number of IGMP Group Memberships on an Interface..............................87
4.6.5 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................88
4.7 Maintaining IGMP............................................................................................................................................88
4.7.1 Clearing the Information About an IGMP Group...................................................................................88
4.7.2 Monitoring the Running Status of IGMP................................................................................................88
4.7.3 Debugging IGMP....................................................................................................................................89
4.8 Configuration Examples...................................................................................................................................89
4.8.1 Example for Configuring Basic IGMP Functions...................................................................................89
4.8.2 Example for Configuring SSM Mapping................................................................................................93
4.8.3 Example for Configuring IGMP Limit....................................................................................................99
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration................................................................................................104
5.1 PIM-DM Overview.........................................................................................................................................106
5.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700...................................................................................................107
5.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions..........................................................................................................108
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
vi
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
5.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................108
5.3.2 Enabling IPv4 Multicast Routing..........................................................................................................109
5.3.3 Enabling PIM-DM.................................................................................................................................109
5.3.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................110
5.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Multicast Source.....................................................................................112
5.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................112
5.4.2 Configuring the Lifetime of a Source....................................................................................................112
5.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses.....................................................................113
5.4.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................114
5.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbor Relationships.......................................................114
5.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................114
5.5.2 Configuring the Interval for Sending Hello Messages..........................................................................115
5.5.3 Configuring the Timeout Period of a Neighbor.....................................................................................116
5.5.4 Refusing to Receive the Hello Message Without the Generation ID Option........................................117
5.5.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering.....................................................................................................118
5.5.6 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................119
5.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune........................................................................................................119
5.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................119
5.6.2 Configuring the Period for an Interface to Keep the Prune State..........................................................120
5.6.3 Configuring the Delay for Transmitting Prune Messages in a LAN.....................................................121
5.6.4 Configuring the Interval for Overriding the Prune Action....................................................................122
5.6.5 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................123
5.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh............................................................................................123
5.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................124
5.7.2 Disabling State-Refresh.........................................................................................................................124
5.7.3 Configuring the Interval for Sending State-Refresh Messages.............................................................125
5.7.4 Configuring the Period for Receiving the Next State-Refresh Message...............................................126
5.7.5 Configuring the TTL Value Carried in a State-Refresh Message.........................................................126
5.7.6 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................127
5.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Graft.........................................................................................................128
5.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................128
5.8.2 Configuring the Interval for Retransmitting Graft Messages................................................................128
5.8.3 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................129
5.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert........................................................................................................130
5.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................130
5.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State............................................................................131
5.9.3 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................132
5.10 Configuring PIM Silent Function.................................................................................................................132
5.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................133
5.10.2 Configuring PIM Silent.......................................................................................................................134
5.10.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................134
5.11 Maintaining PIM-DM (IPv4)........................................................................................................................135
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
vii
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
5.11.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages......................................................................................135
5.11.2 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM...............................................................................................136
5.11.3 Debugging PIM...................................................................................................................................137
5.12 Configuration Example.................................................................................................................................137
5.12.1 Example for Configuring the PIM-DM Network................................................................................137
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration................................................................................................143
6.1 PIM-SM Overview.........................................................................................................................................145
6.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700....................................................................................................146
6.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions...........................................................................................................148
6.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................148
6.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast Routing..............................................................................................................149
6.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-SM Functions.......................................................................................................150
6.3.4 (Optional) Configuring a Static RP.......................................................................................................151
6.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Dynamic RP..................................................................................................152
6.3.6 (Optional) Configuring the SSM Group Address Range.......................................................................154
6.3.7 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................154
6.4 Adjusting Control Parameters for a Multicast Source....................................................................................155
6.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................155
6.4.2 Configuring the Lifetime of a Source....................................................................................................156
6.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses.....................................................................156
6.4.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................157
6.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR.................................................................................158
6.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................158
6.5.2 Adjusting C-RP Parameters...................................................................................................................159
6.5.3 Adjusting C-BSR Parameters................................................................................................................159
6.5.4 Configuring the BSR Boundary............................................................................................................160
6.5.5 (Optional) Configuring the BSR Address Range..................................................................................161
6.5.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Valid C-RP Addresses...............................................................162
6.5.7 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................162
6.6 Configuring a BSR Administrative Domain..................................................................................................163
6.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................163
6.6.2 Enabling a BSR Administrative Domain...............................................................................................164
6.6.3 Configuring the Boundary of a BSR Administrative Domain..............................................................164
6.6.4 Adjusting C-BSR Parameters................................................................................................................165
6.6.5 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................166
6.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for Establishing the Neighbor Relationship...................................................166
6.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................166
6.7.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Establishing the Neighbor Relationship......................................167
6.7.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Electing a DR..............................................................................169
6.7.4 Enabling the Function of Tracking a Downstream Neighbor................................................................170
6.7.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering.....................................................................................................171
6.7.6 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................172
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
viii
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
6.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Source Registering...................................................................................172
6.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................172
6.8.2 Configuring PIM-SM Register Messages..............................................................................................173
6.8.3 Configuring PIM-SM Register Suppression..........................................................................................174
6.8.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................175
6.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding...............................................................................................175
6.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................175
6.9.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Keeping the Forwarding State.....................................................176
6.9.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Prune............................................................................................177
6.9.4 Configuring Join Information Filtering.................................................................................................179
6.9.5 (Optional) Configuring Parameters for Join/Prune Messages...............................................................179
6.9.6 Configuring Neighbor Check................................................................................................................180
6.9.7 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................181
6.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert......................................................................................................181
6.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................182
6.10.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State..........................................................................182
6.10.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................183
6.11 Configuring the SPT Switchover..................................................................................................................184
6.11.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................184
6.11.2 (Optional) Configuring the Interval for Checking the Forwarding Rate of Multicast Data................185
6.11.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................186
6.12 Configuring PIM BFD..................................................................................................................................187
6.12.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................187
6.12.2 Enabling PIM BFD..............................................................................................................................187
6.12.3 (Optional) Adjusting BFD Parameters................................................................................................188
6.12.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................189
6.13 Configuring PIM GR....................................................................................................................................189
6.13.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................189
6.13.2 Enabling PIM GR................................................................................................................................190
6.13.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................191
6.14 Configuring PIM Silent................................................................................................................................191
6.14.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................191
6.14.2 Configuring PIM Silent.......................................................................................................................192
6.14.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................193
6.15 Maintaining PIM-SM (IPv4)........................................................................................................................194
6.15.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages......................................................................................194
6.15.2 Clearing the PIM Status of the Specified Downstream Interfaces of PIM Entries.............................194
6.15.3 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM-SM........................................................................................195
6.15.4 Debugging PIM...................................................................................................................................196
6.16 Configuration Examples...............................................................................................................................197
6.16.1 Example for Configuring the PIM-SM Network.................................................................................197
6.16.2 Example for Configuring SPT Switchover in PIM-SM Domain........................................................207
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
ix
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
6.16.3 Example for Configuring PIM BFD....................................................................................................212
6.16.4 Example for Configuring PIM GR......................................................................................................216
7 MSDP Configuration................................................................................................................224
7.1 MSDP Overview.............................................................................................................................................226
7.2 MSDP Features Supported by the S9700.......................................................................................................226
7.3 Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast...............................................................................................228
7.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................228
7.3.2 Configuring Intra-AS MSDP Peers.......................................................................................................229
7.3.3 Configuring Inter-AS MSDP Peers on MBGP Peers............................................................................231
7.3.4 Configuring Static RPF Peers................................................................................................................232
7.3.5 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................233
7.4 Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain........................................................................................234
7.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................234
7.4.2 Configuring the Interface Address of an RP.........................................................................................235
7.4.3 Configuring a C-RP...............................................................................................................................236
7.4.4 Statically Configuring an RP.................................................................................................................236
7.4.5 Configuring an MSDP Peer...................................................................................................................237
7.4.6 Specifying the Logical RP Address for an SA Message.......................................................................238
7.4.7 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................239
7.5 Managing MSDP Peer Connections...............................................................................................................240
7.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................240
7.5.2 Controlling the Sessions Between MSDP Peers....................................................................................240
7.5.3 Adjusting the interval for Retrying Setting up an MSDP Peer Connection..........................................241
7.5.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................242
7.6 Configuring SA Cache....................................................................................................................................242
7.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................242
7.6.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of (S, G) Entries in the Cache......................................................243
7.6.3 Disabling the SA Cache Function.........................................................................................................244
7.6.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................244
7.7 Configuring the SA Request...........................................................................................................................245
7.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................245
7.7.2 Configuring "Sending SA Request Messages" on the Local switch.....................................................246
7.7.3 (Optional) Configuring the Filtering Rules for Receiving SA Request Messages................................247
7.7.4 Check the Configuration........................................................................................................................247
7.8 Transmitting Burst Multicast Data Between Domains...................................................................................248
7.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................248
7.8.2 Encapsulating a Multicast Data Packet in an SA message....................................................................249
7.8.3 (Optional) Setting the TTL Threshold for Forwarding an SA Message Containing a Multicast Data Packet
........................................................................................................................................................................250
7.8.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................250
7.9 Configuring the Filtering Rules for SA Messages..........................................................................................252
7.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................252
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
x
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
7.9.2 Setting Rules for Creating an SA Message...........................................................................................253
7.9.3 Setting Rules for Receiving an SA Message.........................................................................................254
7.9.4 Setting Rules for Forwarding an SA Message.......................................................................................254
7.9.5 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................255
7.10 Configuring MSDP Authentication..............................................................................................................256
7.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................256
7.10.2 Configuring MSDP MD5 Authentication............................................................................................257
7.10.3 Configuring MSDP Key-Chain Authentication..................................................................................258
7.10.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................259
7.11 Maintaining MSDP.......................................................................................................................................259
7.11.1 Clearing Statistics of MSDP Peers......................................................................................................259
7.11.2 Clearing (S, G) Information in SA Cache...........................................................................................260
7.11.3 Monitoring the Running Status of MSDP...........................................................................................260
7.11.4 Debugging MSDP................................................................................................................................261
7.12 Configuration Examples...............................................................................................................................262
7.12.1 Example for Configuring Basic MSDP Functions..............................................................................262
7.12.2 Example for Configuring Inter-AS Multicast by Using Static RPF Peers..........................................272
7.12.3 Example for Configuring Anycast RP.................................................................................................278
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration........................................................................................285
8.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast VPN..................................................................................................................286
8.2 IPv4 Multicast VPN Supported by the S9700................................................................................................287
8.3 Configuring Basic MD VPN Functions..........................................................................................................288
8.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................288
8.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast Routing..............................................................................................................289
8.3.3 Configuring the Eth-Trunk as a Multicast Loopback Interface.............................................................289
8.3.4 Configuring Share-Group and Binding an MTI....................................................................................290
8.3.5 Configuring an MTI...............................................................................................................................291
8.3.6 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................292
8.4 Configuring Switch-MDT Switchover...........................................................................................................292
8.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................292
8.4.2 (Optional) Setting Switching Parameters of Switch-MDT....................................................................293
8.4.3 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................294
8.5 Maintaining IPv4 Multicast VPN...................................................................................................................295
8.5.1 Monitoring the Running Status of IPv4 Multicast VPN........................................................................295
8.5.2 Debugging IPv4 Multicast VPN............................................................................................................296
8.5.3 Controlling the Output of Logs.............................................................................................................296
8.6 Configuration Examples.................................................................................................................................297
8.6.1 Example for Configuring a Single-AS MD VPN..................................................................................297
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management....................................................................................321
9.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast Routing Management........................................................................................323
9.2 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Features Supported by the S9700.......................................................323
9.3 Configuring a Static Multicast Route.............................................................................................................325
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
xi
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
9.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................326
9.3.2 Configuring a Static Multicast Route Function.....................................................................................326
9.3.3 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................327
9.4 Configuring the Multicast Routing Policy......................................................................................................328
9.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................328
9.4.2 Configuring Longest Match of Multicast Route....................................................................................329
9.4.3 Configuring Multicast Load Splitting....................................................................................................330
9.4.4 Configuring a Multicast Load Splitting Weight....................................................................................332
9.4.5 (Optional) Optimizing Storage for Multicast Forwarding Entries........................................................332
9.4.6 (Optional) Configuring the Multicast Hash Algorithm.........................................................................333
9.4.7 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................334
9.5 Configuring the Multicast Forwarding Scope................................................................................................334
9.5.1 Establish the Configuration Task..........................................................................................................335
9.5.2 Configuring the Multicast Forwarding Boundary.................................................................................335
9.5.3 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................336
9.6 Configuring Control Parameters of the Multicast Forwarding Table.............................................................336
9.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................336
9.6.2 Setting the Maximum Number of Entries in Multicast Forwarding Table............................................337
9.6.3 Setting the Maximum Number of Downstream Nodes of Multicast Forwarding Entry.......................338
9.6.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................340
9.7 Maintaining the Multicast Policy...................................................................................................................340
9.7.1 Testing Multicast Routing.....................................................................................................................340
9.7.2 Check RPF Paths and Multicast Paths...................................................................................................340
9.7.3 Clearing Multicast Routing and Forwarding Entries.............................................................................341
9.7.4 Monitoring the Status of Multicast Routing and Forwarding................................................................342
9.7.5 Debugging Multicast Routing and Forwarding.....................................................................................343
9.8 Configuration Examples.................................................................................................................................343
9.8.1 Example for Changing Static Multicast Routes to RPF Routes............................................................343
9.8.2 Example for Connecting RPF Routes Through Static Multicast Routes...............................................347
9.8.3 Example for Configuring Multicast Load Splitting...............................................................................352
10 MLD Configuration................................................................................................................361
10.1 MLD Overview.............................................................................................................................................363
10.2 MLD Features Supported by the S9700.......................................................................................................363
10.3 Configuring Basic MLD Functions..............................................................................................................364
10.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................364
10.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing........................................................................................................365
10.3.3 Enabling MLD.....................................................................................................................................365
10.3.4 (Optional) Configuring the MLD Version...........................................................................................366
10.3.5 (Optional) Configuring an Interface to Statically Join a Group..........................................................367
10.3.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Groups an Interface Can Join...................................................367
10.3.7 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................368
10.4 Configuring Options of an MLD Packet......................................................................................................368
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
xii
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
10.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................368
10.4.2 Configuring the Router-Alert Option of an MLD Packet....................................................................369
10.4.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................370
10.5 Configuring MLD Query Control.................................................................................................................370
10.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................370
10.5.2 (Optional) Configuring MLD Query and Response............................................................................371
10.5.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................374
10.6 Configuring SSM Mapping..........................................................................................................................374
10.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................374
10.6.2 Enabling SSM Mapping......................................................................................................................375
10.6.3 Configuring a Static SSM Mapping Policy.........................................................................................376
10.6.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................377
10.7 Configuration MLD Limit Function.............................................................................................................377
10.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................377
10.7.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global MLD Group Memberships........................................378
10.7.3 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global MLD Entries in a Single Instance.............................379
10.7.4 Configuring the Maximum Number of MLD Group Memberships on an Interface...........................379
10.7.5 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................380
10.8 Maintaining MLD.........................................................................................................................................380
10.8.1 Clearing Information about MLD Groups...........................................................................................381
10.8.2 Monitoring the Running Status of MLD.............................................................................................381
10.8.3 Debugging MLD..................................................................................................................................382
10.9 Configuration Example.................................................................................................................................383
10.9.1 Example for Configuring Basic MLD Functions................................................................................383
10.9.2 Example for Configuring MLD Limit.................................................................................................386
11 MLD Snooping Configuration..............................................................................................391
11.1 Overview of MLD Snooping........................................................................................................................392
11.2 MLD Snooping Features Supported by the S9700.......................................................................................392
11.3 Configuring Basic Functions of MLD Snooping.........................................................................................393
11.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................393
11.3.2 Enabling MLD snooping on the S9700...............................................................................................393
11.3.3 (Optional) Configuring an Interface as a Static Router Interface........................................................394
11.3.4 (Optional) Adding an Interface to a Multicast Group Statically.........................................................395
11.3.5 Enabling the MLD Snooping Querier.................................................................................................395
11.3.6 (Optional) Configuring MLD Message Suppression...........................................................................397
11.3.7 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................397
11.4 Configuring MLD Snooping Proxy..............................................................................................................398
11.5 Configuring an IPv6 Layer 2 Multicast Policy.............................................................................................399
11.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................399
11.5.2 Configuring a Multicast Group Policy................................................................................................400
11.5.3 Configuring Prompt Leave of Interfaces.............................................................................................401
11.5.4 Setting the Maximum Number of Multicast Groups That an Interface Can Dynamically Join..........401
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
xiii
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
11.5.5 Enabling IGMP Snooping...................................................................................................................402
11.5.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................402
11.6 (Optional) Modifying Parameters of MLD Snooping..................................................................................403
11.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................403
11.6.2 (Optional) Setting the Aging Time of the Router Interface.................................................................404
11.6.3 Setting the Duration for Suppressing the Same MLD Messages........................................................404
11.6.4 (Optional) Configuring the Router Alert Option in MLD Messages..................................................405
11.6.5 Enabling the MLD Snooping Module to Respond to Changes of the Layer 2 Network Topology
........................................................................................................................................................................405
11.6.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................406
11.7 Maintaining MLD Snooping........................................................................................................................407
11.7.1 Clearing MLD Snooping Entries.........................................................................................................407
11.7.2 Clearing the Statistics on MLD Snooping...........................................................................................407
11.7.3 Debugging MLD Snooping.................................................................................................................408
11.8 Configuration Examples...............................................................................................................................408
11.8.1 Example for Configuring a Multicast Group Policy...........................................................................408
11.8.2 Example for Configuring Prompt Leave of Interfaces in a VLAN.....................................................411
11.8.3 Example for Configuring a Static Router Interface.............................................................................413
11.8.4 Example for Enabling the MLD Snooping Module to Respond to Changes of the Layer 2 Network
Topology.........................................................................................................................................................414
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration..............................................................................................419
12.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview.....................................................................................................................................421
12.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700.................................................................................................421
12.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions.............................................................................................422
12.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................422
12.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing........................................................................................................423
12.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions.........................................................................................423
12.3.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................424
12.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source...................................................................................................425
12.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................425
12.4.2 Configuring the Keepalive Period of a Source....................................................................................425
12.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses...................................................................426
12.4.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................427
12.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors...........................................................................427
12.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................427
12.5.2 Configuring the Interval for Sending Hello Messages........................................................................428
12.5.3 Configuring the Timeout Period of a Neighbor...................................................................................429
12.5.4 Refusing to Receive the Hello Message Without the Generation ID Option......................................430
12.5.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering...................................................................................................431
12.5.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................431
12.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune......................................................................................................432
12.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................432
12.6.2 Configuring the Period for an Interface to Keep the Prune State........................................................433
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
xiv
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
12.6.3 Configuring the Delay for Transmitting Prune Messages in a LAN...................................................434
12.6.4 Configuring the Interval for Overriding the Prune Action..................................................................435
12.6.5 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................436
12.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh..........................................................................................436
12.7.1 Estalishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................436
12.7.2 Disabling State-Refresh.......................................................................................................................437
12.7.3 Configuring the Interval for Sending State-Refresh Messages...........................................................438
12.7.4 Configuring the Period for Receiving the Next State-Refresh Message.............................................438
12.7.5 Configuring the TTL Value of a State-Refresh Message....................................................................439
12.7.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................439
12.8 Adjusting Control Messages for Graft..........................................................................................................440
12.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................440
12.8.2 Setting the Interval for Retransmitting Graft Messages......................................................................441
12.8.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................441
12.9 Adjusting Control Messages for Assert........................................................................................................442
12.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................442
12.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State..........................................................................443
12.9.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................444
12.10 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent Function......................................................................................................444
12.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.................................................................................................445
12.10.2 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent............................................................................................................446
12.10.3 Checking the Configuration...............................................................................................................446
12.11 Maintaining PIM-DM.................................................................................................................................447
12.11.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages....................................................................................447
12.11.2 Monitoring Running Status of PIM-DM...........................................................................................447
12.11.3 Debugging PIM-IPv6........................................................................................................................448
12.12 Configuration Example...............................................................................................................................449
12.12.1 Example for Configuring the IPv6 PIM-DM Network.....................................................................449
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration..............................................................................................454
13.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview.....................................................................................................................................456
13.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700..................................................................................................456
13.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions..............................................................................................458
13.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................459
13.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing........................................................................................................460
13.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions..........................................................................................460
13.3.4 (Optional) Configuring an Embedded-RP...........................................................................................461
13.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Static RP.....................................................................................................462
13.3.6 (Optional) Configuring a Dynamic RP................................................................................................463
13.3.7 (Optional) Configuring the SSM Group Address Range.....................................................................464
13.3.8 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................465
13.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source...................................................................................................466
13.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................466
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
xv
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
13.4.2 Configuring the Keepalive Period of a Source....................................................................................466
13.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses...................................................................467
13.4.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................468
13.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-RP and a C-BSR...............................................................................468
13.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................468
13.5.2 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-RP............................................................................................469
13.5.3 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-BSR..........................................................................................470
13.5.4 Configuring the BSR Service Boundary.............................................................................................471
13.5.5 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Legal BSR addresses................................................................472
13.5.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Legal C-RP Addresses.............................................................472
13.5.7 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................473
13.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors...........................................................................473
13.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................474
13.6.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Maintaining PIM-IPv6 Neighbors.............................................474
13.6.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Electing a DR............................................................................476
13.6.4 Enabling the Function of Tracking a Downstream Neighbor..............................................................477
13.6.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering...................................................................................................478
13.6.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................479
13.7 Adjusting Control Parameters of Source Registering...................................................................................479
13.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................479
13.7.2 Configuring Rules for Filtering PIM-SM (IPv6) Register Messages..................................................480
13.7.3 Configuring PIM-SM (IPv6) Registering Suppression.......................................................................481
13.7.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................481
13.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding.............................................................................................482
13.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................482
13.8.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Keeping the Forwarding Relationship.......................................483
13.8.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Prune..........................................................................................484
13.8.4 Configuring Join Information Filtering...............................................................................................485
13.8.5 (Optional) Configuring Parameters for Join/Prune Messages.............................................................486
13.8.6 Configuring Neighbor Check..............................................................................................................487
13.8.7 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................487
13.9 Configuring Control Parameters for Assert..................................................................................................488
13.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................488
13.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State..........................................................................489
13.9.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................490
13.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for the SPT Switchover..............................................................................490
13.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.................................................................................................490
13.10.2 (Optional) Adjusting Conditions of the SPT Switchover..................................................................492
13.10.3 (Optional) Configuring the Interval for Checking the Forwarding Rate of Multicast Data..............492
13.10.4 Checking the Configuration...............................................................................................................493
13.11 Configuring PIM GR (IPv6).......................................................................................................................493
13.11.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.................................................................................................493
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
xvi
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Contents
13.11.2 Enabling PIM GR (IPv6)...................................................................................................................494
13.11.3 Checking the Configuration...............................................................................................................495
13.12 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent.....................................................................................................................495
13.12.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.................................................................................................495
13.12.2 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent............................................................................................................496
13.12.3 Checking the Configuration...............................................................................................................497
13.13 Maintaining PIM-SM.................................................................................................................................497
13.13.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM-IPv6 Control Messages...........................................................................498
13.13.2 Clearing the PIM Status of the Specified Downstream Interfaces of PIM Entries...........................498
13.13.3 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM-SM......................................................................................499
13.13.4 Debugging PIM-IPv6........................................................................................................................499
13.14 Configuration Example...............................................................................................................................500
13.14.1 Example for Configuring the IPv6 PIM-SM Network......................................................................500
13.14.2 Example for Configuring PIM GR (IPv6).........................................................................................508
14 IPv6 Multicast Routing Management..................................................................................516
14.1 Overview of IPv6 Multicast Routing Management......................................................................................518
14.2 IPv6 Multicast Routing Management Features Supported by the S9700.....................................................518
14.3 Configuring the IPv6 Multicast Routing Policy...........................................................................................519
14.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................519
14.3.2 Configuring IPv6 Multicast Load Splitting.........................................................................................520
14.3.3 Configuring an IPv6 Multicast Load Splitting Weight.......................................................................521
14.3.4 (Optional) Optimizing Storage for Multicast Forwarding Entries......................................................522
14.3.5 Configuring the Multicast Hash Algorithm.........................................................................................523
14.3.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................523
14.4 Limiting the Range of Multicast Forwarding...............................................................................................524
14.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................524
14.4.2 Configuring the IPv6 Multicast Forwarding Boundary on an Interface..............................................524
14.4.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................525
14.5 Configuring Control Parameters of the IPv6 Multicast Forwarding Table..................................................525
14.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................525
14.5.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of Entries in the IPv6 Multicast Forwarding Table...................526
14.5.3 Configuring the Maximum Number of Downstream Nodes of a Single Forwarding Entry...............527
14.5.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................527
14.6 Maintaining IPv6 Multicast Routing Management......................................................................................528
14.6.1 Clearing IPv6 Multicast Forwarding Entries and Routing Entries......................................................528
14.6.2 Monitoring the Running Status of IPv6 Multicast Forwarding and Routing......................................528
14.6.3 Debugging IPv6 Multicast Forwarding and Routing..........................................................................529
14.7 Configuration Examples...............................................................................................................................530
14.7.1 Example for Configuring IPv6 Multicast Load Splitting....................................................................530
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
xvii
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
1
1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide
IP Multicast Configuration Guide
About This Chapter
The system supports the construction of multicast services through multicast protocols in IPv4
and IPv6 networks. In addition, the typical configuration solutions of multicast networks are
provided.
1.1 IP Multicast Overview
1.2 IP Multicast Features Supported by the S9700
1.3 IPv4 Multicast Configuration Guide
This section describes multicast addresses, protocols, and typical configuration solutions in IPv4
networks.
1.4 IPv6 Multicast Configuration Guide
This section describes multicast addresses, protocols, and typical configuration solutions on an
IPv6 network.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
1
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide
1.1 IP Multicast Overview
Multicast is a Point to Multi-Point (P2MP) data transmission mode. During data transmission,
multicast can ensure the security of information. Multicast consumes limited network
bandwidth.
The multicast technology applied to IPv4 and IPv6 is called IP multicast.
The Internet services implemented through IP multicast include IPTV, Video and Audio
Conferences, e-learning, and remote medicine.
1.2 IP Multicast Features Supported by the S9700
In the S9700, IPv4 networks and IPv6 networks can support multicast services, but networks
that run IPv4 and IPv6 simultaneously do not support multicast services.
1.3 IPv4 Multicast Configuration Guide
This section describes multicast addresses, protocols, and typical configuration solutions in IPv4
networks.
1.3.1 IPv4 Multicast Addresses
The IPv4 multicast addresses range from 224.0.0.0 to 239.255.255.255. Table 1-1 shows the
ranges of various IPv4 multicast addresses.
The multicast group address available for multicast data services ranges from 224.0.1.0 to
239.255.255.255. Any host (or other receiving device) that joins a multicast group within this
range becomes a member of the group, and can identify and receive IP packets with the IP
multicast address as the destination address. The members of a group can be distributed at any
position in the network. The hosts can join or leave a multicast group at any time.
Table 1-1 Class D addresses
Class D Address Range
Description
224.0.0.0 to 224.0.0.255
Indicates the reserved group addresses for local links. The
addresses are reserved by Internet Assigned Number
Authority (IANA) for routing protocols, and are called
permanent multicast group addresses. The addresses are
used to identify a group of specific network devices rather
than being used for multicast forwarding.
224.0.1.0 to 231.255.255.255
Indicates Any-Source Multicast (ASM) addresses. The
addresses are valid in the entire network.
233.0.0.0 to 238.255.255.255
232.0.0.0 to 232.255.255.255
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Indicates Source-Specific Multicast (SSM) addresses.
This is the default SSM group address scope, and is valid
in the entire network.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
2
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide
Class D Address Range
Description
239.0.0.0 to 239.255.255.255
Indicates administration multicast addresses. The default
range of BSR administrative domain group addresses is
valid only in the local BSR administration domain. The
addresses are private addresses. You can configure the
same address in different BSR administration domains.
1.3.2 IPv4 Multicast Protocols
To implement a complete set of IPv4 multicast services, various multicast protocols deployed
in the network need to cooperate with each other, as shown in Figure 1-1.
Figure 1-1 Location of each IPv4 multicast protocol
IPv4 Network
AS1
IPv4 Network
AS2
Source
PIM
MSDP
PIM
IGMP
IGMP
User
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
User
3
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide
Table 1-2 Multicast protocols
Applied Location
Objectives
Multicast Protocol
Between hosts and
multicast switches
Connecting hosts to a multicast
network:
Internet Group
Management Protocol
(IGMP)
l Ensure that the members can
dynamically join and leave a
group at the host side.
l Manage and maintain the
member relationship at the switch
side and exchange information
with the upper-layer multicast
routing protocols.
Between intra-domain
multicast switches
Multicast routing and forwarding:
l Create multicast routes on
demand.
l Respond to the changes of the
network topology and maintain
the multicast routing table.
Protocol Independent
Multicast (PIM), including
Protocol Independent
Multicast-Dense Mode
(PIM-DM) and Protocol
Independent MulticastSparse Mode (PIM-SM)
l Forward packets according to the
routing table.
Between inter-domain
multicast switches
Sharing information about interdomain multicast sources:
l Switches in the domain where the
source resides transmit the local
source information to switches in
other domains.
Multicast Source
Discovery Protocol
(MSDP)
l Switches in different domains
transmit the source information.
1.3.3 Typical Configuration Solution
CAUTION
Customize configuration solutions according to the actual network conditions and service
requirements. The configuration solution in this section functions only as a reference.
The network environments are classified into two types, which need different configuration
solutions. For details, refer to the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide Multicast.
NOTE
Ensure that unicast routes work normally in the network before configuring IP multicast.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
4
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide
Small-Scale Network
A small-scale network, such as a test network, is suitable to implement multicast data
transmission in a Local Area Network (LAN), and does not interconnect with the Internet.
Perform the following configurations:
1.
Enable multicast on all S9700s in the network.
2.
Enable PIM-DM on all interfaces of the S9700s.
3.
Enable IGMP on the S9700 interface connected to hosts.
4.
If multicast needs to be deployed in a VPN, perform the preceding configurations in the
private network and public network respectively, and configure the Multicast Domain
(MD) on PEs.
Large-Scale Network
A large-scale network is suitable to transmit multicast services on an ISP network, and
interconnects with the Internet.
Perform the following configurations:
1.
Enable multicast on all S9700s in the network.
2.
Enable PIM-SM on all interfaces of the S9700s.
3.
Enable IGMP on the S9700 interface connected to hosts.
4.
Configure an RP, specify a static RP, or elect an RP from C-RPs.
5.
Divide a network into PIM-SM domains.
6.
Configure MSDP in the PIM-SM domain and implement the anycast RP.
7.
Configure MSDP between PIM-SM domains. Generally, MSDP cooperates with MBGP.
1.3.4 Controlling Multicast Forwarding
IP multicast guides the forwarding of multicast packets by using the multicast routing table and
forwarding table. You can adjust the transmission path of multicast data by configuring the
Reverse Path Forwarding (RPF) routing policy, and limit multicast forwarding by configuring
the forwarding policy and the capacity of the forwarding table.
For details, refer to the chapter 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management in the S9700 Core
Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast.
1.4 IPv6 Multicast Configuration Guide
This section describes multicast addresses, protocols, and typical configuration solutions on an
IPv6 network.
1.4.1 IPv6 Multicast Addresses
Figure 1-2 shows the format of an IPv6 multicast address.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
5
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide
Figure 1-2 Format of an IPv6 multicast address
0
7
FF
11
flags
15
scope
31
reserved (80bit)
group ID (32bit)
The meaning of each field is as follows:
l
The IPv6 multicast address begins with FF.
l
Flags (four-bit): The meaning of the last bit is as follows:
– 0: indicates that the address is a well-known multicast address defined by IANA.
– 1 or 2: indicates multicast addresses within the ASM group address range.
– 3: indicates multicast addresses within the SSM group address range.
– Other: indicates unallocated ones. It can also indicate the multicast addresses within the
ASM group address range.
l
Scope (four-bit): indicates that the multicast group contains only the nodes of the same
local network, the same site, and the same organization. The meaning of each field is as
follows:
– 0: reserved
– 1: node/interface-local scope
– 2: link-local scope
– 3: reserved
– 4: admin-local scope
– 5: site-local scope
– 8: organization-local scope
– E: global scope
– F: reserved
– Other: unassigned
Table 1-3 shows the scopes and meanings of fixed IPv6 multicast addresses.
Table 1-3 Description of IPv6 Multicast Addresses
Scope
Description
FF0x::/32
Indicates the well-known multicast addresses defined by
the IANA. For details, see Table 1-4.
FF1x::/32 (x cannot be 1 or 2)
Indicates ASM addresses. The addresses are valid in the
entire network.
FF2x::/32 (x cannot be 1 or 2)
FF3x::/32 (x cannot be 1 or 2)
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Indicates SSM addresses. This is the default SSM group
address scope, and is valid in the entire network.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
6
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide
Table 1-4 Description of commonly-used IPv6 multicast Addresses
Scope
IPv6 Multicast
Address
Description
Node/interface-local
scope
FF01:0:0:0:0:0:0:1
Indicates all node (interface) addresses.
FF01:0:0:0:0:0:0:2
Indicates all router addresses.
Link-local scope
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:1
Indicates all node addresses.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:2
Indicates all router addresses.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:3
Indicates the undefined address.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:4
Indicates the Distance Vector Multicast
Routing Protocol (DVMRP) routers.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:5
Indicates OSPF IGP routers.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:6
Indicates OSPF IGP designated routers.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:7
Indicates ST routers.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:8
Indicates ST hosts.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:9
Indicates RIP routers.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:A
Indicates EIGRP routers.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:B
Indicates mobile agents.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:D
Indicates all PIM routers.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:E
Indicates RSVP encapsulation.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:1:1
Indicates the link name.
FF02:0:0:0:0:0:1:2
Indicates all DHCP agents.
FF02:0:0:0:0:1:FFXX:X
XXX
Indicates the solicited node address.
XX:XXXX indicates the last 24 bits of
the IPv6 address of a node.
FF05:0:0:0:0:0:0:2
Indicates all router addresses.
FF05:0:0:0:0:0:1:3
Indicates all DHCP severs.
FF05:0:0:0:0:0:1:4
Indicates all DHCP relays.
FF05:0:0:0:0:0:1:1000 to
FF05:0:0:0:0:0:1:13FF
Indicates the service location.
Site-local scope
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
7
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide
1.4.2 IPv6 Multicast Protocols
To implement a complete set of IPv6 multicast services, various multicast protocols deployed
in a network need to cooperate with each other, as shown in Figure 1-3.
Figure 1-3 Location of each IPv6 multicast protocol
IPv6 Network
MLD
Receiver
UserA
PIM
Source
Multicast
Receiver
UserB
PIM
Server
PIM
MLD
Receiver
UserC
UserD
Table 1-5 IPv6 multicast protocols
Location
Objectives
Multicast Protocol
Between hosts
and multicast
switches
Connecting hosts to a multicast network:
Multicast Listener Discovery
(MLD)
l Implement the dynamic join and
leaving of members at the host side.
l Manage and maintain the member
relationship at the switch side and
exchange information with the upperlayer multicast routing protocols.
Between
multicast
switches
Multicast routing and forwarding:
l Create multicast routes on demand.
PIM-IPv6, including the PIMDM and PIM-SM modes
l Dynamically respond to the changes
of the network topology and maintain
the multicast routing table.
l Forward packets according to the
routing table.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
8
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide
1.4.3 Typical Configuration Solution
CAUTION
Customize configuration solutions according to the actual network conditions and service
requirements. The configuration solution in this section functions only as a reference.
The network environments are classified into two types, which are suitable for different
configuration solutions. For details, refer to the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide
- Multicast.
NOTE
Ensure that IPv6 unicast routes work normally in the network before configuring IP multicast.
Small-Scale Network
A small-scale network, such as a test network, is suitable to implement multicast data
transmission in a Local Area Network (LAN), and does not interconnect with the Internet.
Perform the following configurations:
1.
Enable multicast on all switches in the network.
2.
Enable PIM-DM (IPv6) on all switch interfaces.
3.
Enable MLD on switch interfaces connected to hosts.
Large-Scale Network
A large-scale network is suitable to transmit multicast services on an ISP network, and
interconnects with the Internet.
Perform the following configurations:
1.
Enable multicast on all switches in the network.
2.
Enable PIM-SM (IPv6) on all switch interfaces.
3.
Enable MLD on switch interfaces connected to hosts.
4.
Configure an RP. You can configure an embedded RP, a static RP, or a BSR-RP.
1.4.4 Controlling Multicast Forwarding
IP multicast guides the forwarding of multicast packets by using the multicast routing table and
forwarding table. You can adjust the transmission path of multicast data by configuring the RPF
routing policy, and limit multicast forwarding by configuring the forwarding policy and the
capacity of the forwarding table.
For details, refer to the chapter 14 IPv6 Multicast Routing Management in the S9700 Core
Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
9
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
2
IGMP Snooping Configuration
About This Chapter
This chapter describes the procedure for configuring IGMP snooping and maintenance
commands, and provides configuration examples.
2.1 IGMP Snooping Overview
This section describes the functions and advantages of the IGMP snooping protocol.
2.2 IGMP Snooping Supported by the S9700
This section describes IGMP snooping features supported by the S9700.
2.3 Configuring IGMP Snooping
This section describes how to configure IGMP snooping in a VLAN.
2.4 Configuring a Static Multicast MAC Address
This section describes how to configure a static multicast MAC address.
2.5 Configuring the IGMP Snooping Proxy for the VLAN
This section describes how to configure IGMP snooping proxy.
2.6 Configuring a Layer 2 Multicast Policy
This section describes how to configure a Layer 2 multicast policy.
2.7 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast CAC
This section describes how to configure the Layer 2 multicast CAC function.
2.8 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast SSM Mapping
This section describes how to configure the Layer 2 multicast SSM mapping function.
2.9 Maintaining Layer 2 Multicast
Maintaining Layer 2 multicast involves resetting Layer 2 Multicast statistics, and debugging
IGMP Snooping.
2.10 Configuration examples
This section provides several configuration examples of Layer 2 multicast.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
10
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
2.1 IGMP Snooping Overview
This section describes the functions and advantages of the IGMP snooping protocol.
IGMP Snooping Function
Internet Group Management Protocol Snooping (IGMP snooping) is a Layer 2 multicast
protocol. The IGMP snooping protocol maintains information about the outgoing interfaces of
multicast packets by listening to multicast protocol packets exchanged between the router and
hosts. Thus the IGMP snooping protocol manages and controls the forwarding of multicast
packets.
After receiving multicast packets from an upstream device, an Ethernet device at the edge of the
access network forwards the multicast packets to multicast receivers. As shown in Figure 2-1,
multicast data is broadcast at the data link layer by default, which wastes network bandwidth
and causes multicast data to be sent to unpaid subscribers.
If IGMP snooping is configured on the Layer 2 device, multicast data of a known group is
forwarded to specified receivers (paid subscribers) but not broadcast at the data link layer.
Figure 2-1 Comparison before and after IGMP snooping is configured on a Layer 2 device
Multicast packet transmission
without IGMP Snooping
Multicast packet transmission
when IGMP Snooping runs
Source
Source
Router
Router
PIM
PIM
Switch
Reciever A
Reciever B
Switch
Reciever A
Reciever B
Multicast Packet
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
11
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
IGMP Snooping Advantages
The IGMP snooping protocol forwards multicast information only to the specified receivers
through Layer 2 multicast. It has the following advantages:
l
Reducing broadcast packets on Layer 2 networks, and thus saving network bandwidth
l
Enhancing the security of multicast information
l
Performing accounting for each host independently
2.2 IGMP Snooping Supported by the S9700
This section describes IGMP snooping features supported by the S9700.
Basic Features of IGMP Snooping
The S9700 supports VLAN-based IGMP snooping.
IGMP snooping implements Layer 2 multicast and controls multicast data forwarding by
listening to multicast protocol packets sent between an upstream router and a downstream host
and maintaining downstream interface information.
The S9700 supports the following IGMP snooping functions:
l
Configures a router interface as a static router interface.
l
Adds interfaces to a multicast group statically.
l
Supports the IGMP snooping querier function.
l
Suppresses IGMP snooping messages.
l
Adjusts IGMP snooping parameters to optimize the Layer 2 multicast network.
Static Multicast MAC Address
In Layer 2 multicast, you can dynamically create multicast MAC address entries using Layer 2
multicast protocols such as IGMP snooping or manually configure multicast MAC address
entries. After a multicast MAC address is configured on an interface, the MAC address is bound
to the interface and multicast packets destined for this MAC address are forwarded only by this
interface.
IGMP Snooping Proxy
Configuring IGMP snooping proxy on an edge device can reduce the number of IGMP Report
and Leave messages received by an upstream Layer 3 device and improve performance of the
upstream Layer 3 device. The device configured with IGMP snooping proxy functions as a host
for its upstream device and a querier for its downstream host.
Layer 2 Multicast Policy
The S9700 uses Layer 2 multicast policies according to networking requirements:
l
Configures a multicast group policy to control the multicast groups that users can join.
l
Enables interfaces to quickly leave multicast groups.
l
Configures multicast entry overwriting.
l
Filters Layer 2 multicast data on an interface.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
12
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Discards unknown multicast data packets, preventing them from being broadcast in
VLANs.
IGMP Snooping SSM Mapping
In the SSM model, if IGMPv3 is run on a receiver host, you can specify the multicast source for
IGMPv3 multicast data packets; if only IGMPv1 or IGMPv2 can be run on the receiver host,
you cannot specify the multicast source for IGMPv1 or IGMPv2 multicast data packets. IGMP
snooping SSM mapping is a solution. It generates a mapping between a multicast group and a
multicast source. (*, G) information in IGMPv1 or IGMPv2 multicast data packets is then
mapped to (S, G) information, providing SSM services for the hosts running IGMPv1 or
IGMPv2.
Layer 2 Multicast CAC
CAC is short for Call Admission Control. The Layer 2 multicast CAC is a part of the IPTV
multicast solution. This function limits the number of IPTV programs in Layer 2 multicast,
ensuring the service quality for most users. This function has the following advantages:
l
Controls multicast service accurately.
l
Ensures the service quality for most VoD users.
l
Reduces the impact of multicast attack.
2.3 Configuring IGMP Snooping
This section describes how to configure IGMP snooping in a VLAN.
2.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
Internet Group Management Protocol Snooping (IGMP snooping) is a Layer 2 multicast
protocol. The IGMP snooping protocol maintains information about the outgoing interfaces of
multicast packets by listening to multicast protocol packets exchanged between the router and
hosts. Thus the IGMP snooping protocol manages and controls the forwarding of multicast
packets.
If IGMP snooping is configured on the Layer 2 device, multicast data of a known group is
forwarded to specified receivers (paid subscribers) but not broadcast at the data link layer.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring IGMP snooping in a VLAN, complete the following tasks:
l
Connecting interfaces and configuring the physical parameters of each interface to make
the physical layer in Up state
l
Creating a VLAN
l
Adding interfaces to the VLAN
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
13
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Data Preparation
To configure IGMP snooping in a VLAN, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
ID of the VLAN
2
(Optional) Version of IGMP messages
3
(Optional) Types and numbers of interfaces
4
(Optional) Parameters of a querier: interval
for sending IGMP General Query messages,
robustness variable, maximum response time,
and interval for sending Last Member Query
messages
5
(Optional) Suppression duration of IGMP
messages
6
(Optional) Aging time of the router interface
7
(Optional) Source IP address of IGMP Query
messages
2.3.2 Enabling IGMP Snooping
Context
By default, IGMP snooping is disabled on the S9700. You need to enable IGMP snooping on
the S9700.
You can set the forwarding mode of multicast data so that the multicast flows can be forwarded
based on IP addresses or MAC addresses. When multicast IP addresses are mapped to MAC
addresses, up to 32 IP addresses can be mapped to one MAC address. Therefore, it is
recommended that multicast data be forwarded based on IP addresses; otherwise, unregistered
users may receive the multicast data.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 (Optional) Run:
assign multicast-resource-mode optimize
The multicast forwarding table is optimized.
If a multicast forwarding table needs to contain more than 4096 entries, run this command to
optimize the multicast forwarding table before enabling IGMP snooping.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
14
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping enable
IGMP snooping is enabled globally.
Step 4 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 5 (Optional)Run:
l2-multicast forwarding-mode { ip | mac }
The multicast flows in the VLAN are forwarded based on IP addresses or MAC addresses.
By default, multicast flows are forwarded based on IP addresses.
CAUTION
Before setting the forwarding mode of multicast data in a VLAN, disable IGMP snooping in the
VLAN. After setting the forwarding mode, enable IGMP snooping in the VLAN for the
configuration to take effect.
Step 6 Run:
igmp-snooping enable
IGMP snooping is enabled in the VLAN.
NOTE
To enable the IGMP Snooping function of multi-VLANs, run the igmp-snooping enable [ vlan vlan-id1
[ to vlan-id2 ] & <1-10> ] command in the system-view.
Step 7 (Optional)Run:
igmp-snooping version { 1 | 2 |3 }
The version of IGMP messages that the S9700 can process is set.
By default, the S9700 can process messages of IGMPv1 and IGMPv2 but cannot process
messages of IGMPv3.
NOTE
When the forwarding in a VLAN is based on the MAC address, the IGMP message version cannot be set
to IGMPv3.
----End
2.3.3 (Optional) Configuring a Static Router Interface
Context
By default, dynamic interface learning is enabled in a VLAN. A switch decides whether to add
dynamic router interfaces by monitoring IGMP Query or PIM Hello messages. When a dynamic
router interface does not receive an IGMP Query or a PIM Hello message before it times out,
the switch deletes the interface from the router interface list.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
15
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
If a switch needs to forward multicast data from an interface for a long period of time, configure
this interface as a static router interface.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
(Optional)undo igmp-snooping router-learning
Dynamic learning of router interfaces is disabled in the VLAN.
Step 4 Run:
quit
The system view is displayed.
Step 5 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk
interface. It is the interface that connects the S9700 to the upstream router.
Step 6 Run:
igmp-snooping static-router-port vlan { { vlan-id [ to vlan-id ] } &<1-10> }
The interface is configured as a static router interface.
----End
2.3.4 (Optional) Configuring Multicast Group Member Interfaces
Context
By default, an interface dynamically learns forwarding entries. A switch decides whether to add
dynamic member interfaces by monitoring IGMP Membership Report messages. If a dynamic
member interface does not receive an IGMP Membership Report message from a multicast group
before the interface times out, the switch deletes the interface from the outbound interface list.
If the hosts connected to an interface need to receive the multicast data of a specific multicast
group or multicast source group, add the interface statically to the multicast group or multicast
source group. The interface is called a static member interface.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
16
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk
interface.
Step 3 (Optional) Run:
undo igmp-snooping learning vlan { vlan-id { [ &<1-10> ][to vlan-id ] | all } }
The interface is disabled from learning forwarding entries.
Step 4 Run:
l2-multicast static-group { [ source-address source-ip-address ] group-address
group-ip-address } vlan { { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } &<1-10> }
The interface is added to a multicast group statically. It is then a static member interface. You
can also run the l2-multicast static-group [ source-address source-ip-address ] groupaddress group-ip-address1 to group-ip-address2 vlan vlan-id command to add the interface to
multiple multicast groups.
----End
2.3.5 (Optional) Configuring IGMP Snooping Querier
Context
If IGMP messages sent from the upstream router cannot reach the S9700 for certain reasons, for
example, IGMP is not enabled or if the multicast forwarding entries on the upstream router are
statically configured and do not need to be dynamically learned, you can configure the IGMP
snooping querier on the S9700. The IGMP snooping querier then sends IGMP Query messages.
You can adjust parameters of the IGMP snooping querier as required.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping querier enable
The IGMP snooping querier is enabled for the VLAN.
By default, an IGMP snooping querier is disabled.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
17
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
NOTE
After IGMP snooping querier is enabled in a VLAN, the switch periodically broadcasts IGMP Query
messages to all the interfaces in the VLAN, including router interfaces. This may result in IGMP snooping
querier reelection. If an IGMP snooping querier already exists on a multicast network, configuring IGMP
snooping querier is not recommended.
IGMP snooping querier cannot be enabled in a VLAN if the corresponding VLANIF interface has IGMP
enabled.
IGMP snooping querier and IGMP snooping proxy cannot be enabled in the same VLAN.
Step 4 (Optional) Run:
igmp-snooping query-interval query-interval
The interval at which the querier sends IGMP General Query messages is set.
By default, the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is 60 seconds.
Step 5 (Optional) Run:
igmp-snooping robust-count robust-count
The robustness variable of the querier is set.
By default, the IGMP robustness variable is 2.
Step 6 (Optional) Run:
igmp-snooping max-response-time max-response-time
The maximum response time of IGMP Query messages is set.
By default, the maximum response time of IGMP Query messages is 10 seconds.
NOTE
The maximum response time must be shorter than the interval at which General Query messages are sent.
When receiving IGMP Report messages from hosts, the S9700 sets the aging time of member interfaces
using the following formula: Aging time = IGMP robustness variable x Interval at which IGMP General
Query messages are sent + Maximum response time.
Step 7 (Optional) Run:
igmp-snooping lastmember-queryinterval lastmember-queryinterval
The interval at which the querier sends Last Member Query (IGMP Group-Specific Query)
messages is set.
By default, the interval at which IGMP Group-Specific Query messages are sent is 1 second.
NOTE
After receiving IGMP Leave messages from hosts, the S9700 sets the aging time of member interfaces by
using the following formula: Interval at which IGMP Group-Specific Query messages are sent x IGMP
robustness variable.
IGMPv1 hosts do not send Leave messages when leaving multicast groups. Therefore, the igmp-snooping
lastmember-queryinterval command is valid only when the IGMP snooping version is set to 2 in the
VLAN.
Step 8 (Optional) Run:
quit
Return to the system view.
Step 9 (Optional) Run:
igmp-snooping send-query source-address ip-address
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
18
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
The source IP address of an IGMP General Query message is set.
By default, the source address of an IGMP General Query message is 192.168.0.1. When
192.168.0.1 has been used by other devices on the network, run this command to change the
source IP address of an IGMP General Query message.
----End
2.3.6 (Optional) Configuring IGMP Message Suppression
Context
Hosts running IGMP in a VLAN use a snooping mechanism to suppress Report messages that
member hosts send to join the same multicast group. However, many duplicate Report messages
may be sent when the suppression time expires. In addition, hosts running IGMPv2 and IGMPv3
send duplicate Leave messages when they leave a multicast group.
After a Layer 2 device is enabled to suppress Report and Leave messages, it sends Membership
Report messages only when the first member joins a multicast group or the last member of a
multicast group leaves the group.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping report-suppress
IGMP message suppression is enabled.
NOTE
When configuring IGMP message suppression, pay attention to the following points:
l When IGMP message suppression is configured in a VLAN, IGMP cannot be enabled on the
corresponding VLANIF interface.
l The functions of IGMP snooping proxy and IGMP message suppression cannot be configured in the
same VLAN.
l The switch can suppress duplicate Membership Report messages even when IGMP message
suppression is disabled. The default message suppression time is 10 seconds. To change the suppression
time, run the igmp-snooping suppress-time suppress-time command. To disable IGMP message
suppression, set the suppression time to 0.
----End
2.3.7 (Optional) Disabling Users from Dynamically Joining
Multicast Groups
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
19
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Context
If an upstream multicast group is a non-Huawei device and has static multicast groups configured
on the interface connected to the S9700, multicast users are not allowed to dynamically join or
leave the multicast groups. In this case, disable the S9700 from sending IGMP Membership
Report messages to the upstream router.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping static-group suppress-dynamic-join
The S9700 is disabled from sending IGMP Membership Report messages to the upstream router
so that multicast users cannot dynamically join or leave multicast groups.
----End
2.3.8 (Optional) Adjusting IGMP Snooping Parameters
Context
You can adjust the following IGMP snooping parameters to optimize the S9700 multicast
performance according to the actual network situation.
l
Aging time of a router interface
When a short-term congestion occurs on the network, it takes a longer time to transmit
Query messages from the IGMP querier to the S9700. If a router interface on the S9700
ages within this period, the S9700 does not send Report or Leave messages to the router
interface. As a result, multicast data forwarding may be interrupted. To solve this problem,
set a longer aging time for the router interface on an unstable network.
l
Router-Alert option
By default, the S9700 does not check whether IGMP messages contain the Router-Alert
option and sends all the IGMP messages to the upper-layer routing protocol. Discarding
IGMP messages without the Router-Alert option improves device performance, reduces
cost, and enhances security of the upper-layer routing protocol.
l
Response to Layer 2 topology change events
This function enables the S9700 to detect Layer 2 topology changes and correctly forward
multicast data according to the new topology.
l
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Source IP address of IGMP Query messages sent by the S9700
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
20
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping router-aging-time router-aging-time
The aging time is set for router interfaces.
By default:
l If a router interface receives an IGMP Query message, the S9700 sets the remaining aging
time of the interface to 180 seconds.
l If the router interface receives a PIM Hello packet and the Holdtime value of the Hello packet
is larger than the remaining aging time of the interface, the S9700 sets the aging time of the
interface to the Holdtime value contained in the PIM Hello packet. If the Holdtime value of
the Hello packet is smaller than the remaining aging time of the interface, the S9700 does
not reset the aging time of the interface.
Step 4 Run:
igmp-snooping require-router-alert
The S9700 is configured to process only the IGMP messages with the Router-Alert option in
the IP header.
By default, the S9700 can process the IGMP messages without the Router-Alert option in the
IP header received from a VLAN.
Step 5 Run:
igmp-snooping send-router-alert
The S9700 is configured to send the IGMP messages with the Router-Alert option in the IP
header.
By default, the S9700 sends the IGMP messages with the Router-Alert option in the IP header.
Step 6 Run:
quit
Exit the VLAN view.
Step 7 Run:
igmp-snooping send-query enable
The S9700 is configured to send IGMP General Query messages when receiving topology
change events.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
21
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
NOTE
This command is generally used on a ring network. When the ring network topology changes, the S9700
sends IGMP General Query messages with source IP address 0.0.0.0. If the source IP address of IGMP
General Query messages is not 0.0.0.0, run the igmp-snooping send-query source-address ip-address
command to set the source IP address to 0.0.0.0.
----End
2.3.9 Checking the Configuration
Prerequisites
The configuration of IGMP snooping in a VLAN is complete.
Procedure
l
Run the display igmp-snooping configuration command to check the non-default
configurations of IGMP snooping.
l
Run the display igmp-snooping [ vlan vlan-id ] command to check the configuration of
IGMP snooping in a VLAN.
l
Run the display igmp-snooping statistics vlan [ vlan-id ] command to check the statistics
of IGMP snooping in a VLAN.
l
Run the display igmp-snooping port-info [ vlan vlan-id [ group-address groupaddress ] ] [ verbose ] command to check the information about member interfaces of a
multicast group.
l
Run the display igmp-snooping router-port vlan vlan-idcommand to check the
information about router interfaces.
l
Run the display l2-multicast forwarding-table vlan [ [ source-address sourceaddress ] group-address { group-address | router-group } ] command to check the
multicast forwarding table of a VLAN.
l
Run the display igmp-snooping querier vlan [ vlan-id ] command to check the enabling
information about the IGMP snooping querier.
----End
Example
Run the display igmp-snooping configuration command, and you can view the information
about the non-default IGMP snooping configurations of all VLANs.
<Quidway> display igmp-snooping configuration
IGMP Snooping Configuration for VLAN 7
igmp-snooping enable
igmp-snooping version 3
igmp-snooping querier enable
If the configurations succeed, you can obtain the following information after running the display
igmp-snooping [ vlan vlan-id ] command:
l
IGMP snooping is enabled in the VLAN.
l
The IGMP version is set correctly.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
22
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
l
Aging time of the router interface, interval for sending Last Member Query messages,
interval for sending IGMP General Query messages, maximum response time, suppression
duration of IGMP messages, and IGMP robustness variable are correctly set.
l
The Router Alert option is set correctly.
l
The function that sends IGMP Query messages to member interfaces in a VLAN and packet
suppression function are configured correctly.
l
Router interface learning is configured correctly.
The following is an example.
<Quidway> display igmp-snooping vlan 3
IGMP Snooping Information for VLAN 3
IGMP Snooping is Enabled
IGMP Version is Set to default 2
IGMP Query Interval is Set to default 60
IGMP Max Response Interval is Set to default 10
IGMP Robustness is Set to default 2
IGMP Last Member Query Interval is Set to default 1
IGMP Router Port Aging Interval is Set to 180s or holdtime in hello
IGMP Filter Group-Policy is Set to default : Permit All
IGMP Prompt Leave Disable
IGMP Router Alert is Not Required
IGMP Send Router Alert Enable
IGMP Proxy Disable
IGMP Report Suppress Disable
IGMP Suppress Time is set to default 10 seconds
IGMP Querier Disable
IGMP Router Port Learning Enable
IGMP SSM-Mapping Disable
IGMP Suppress-dynamic-join Disable
Run the display igmp-snooping router-port vlan vlan-id command, and you can view the
information about router interfaces.
<Quidway> display igmp-snooping router-port vlan 3
Port Name
UpTime
Expires
Flags
-------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 3, 2 router-port(s)
GE2/0/1
03:28:16
00:01:20
DYNAMIC
GE2/0/3
2d:10h
-STATIC
Run the display igmp-snooping port-info [ vlan vlan-id ] [ group-address group-address ]
[ verbose ] command, and you can view the information about member interfaces.
<Quidway> display igmp-snooping port-info
----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port
Flag
Flag: S:Static
D:Dynamic
M: Ssm-mapping
----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 101, 1 Entry(s)
(*, 225.0.0.1) GE1/0/1
-S1 port(s)
VLAN 102, 1 Entry(s)
(*, 225.0.0.1) GE1/0/2
-D1 port(s)
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
Run the display l2-multicast forwarding-table vlan 7 command, and you can view the
multicast forwarding table of VLAN 7.
<Quidway> display l2-multicast forwarding-table vlan 7
VLAN ID : 7, Forwarding Mode : IP
----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group)
Interface
Out-Vlan
----------------------------------------------------------------------Router-port
GigabitEthernet1/0/0
7
(1.1.1.1, 232.1.1.1)
GigabitEthernet1/0/0
7
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
23
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
GigabitEthernet2/0/0
7
----------------------------------------------------------------------Total Group(s) : 1
Run the display igmp-snooping querier vlan [ vlan-id ] command. If the querier is displayed
as Enabled, it indicates that the querier is successfully enabled.
<Quidway> display igmp-snooping querier vlan
VLAN
Querier-state
----------------------------------------------3
Enable
total entry 1
2.4 Configuring a Static Multicast MAC Address
This section describes how to configure a static multicast MAC address.
Applicable Environment
If a Layer 2 switch receives a multicast data packet whose destination MAC address is not a
multicast MAC address, the switch cannot find the matching entry in the MAC address table.
Therefore, the switch broadcasts the multicast packet in the VLAN. This wastes bandwidth and
threatens network security.
To save bandwidth and ensure network security, configure a static multicast MAC address on
an interface so that multicast packets destined for the multicast MAC address are forwarded only
by this interface.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring a static multicast MAC address, complete the following task:
l
Creating a VLAN and adding the interface that needs to be configured with a static multicast
MAC address to the VLAN
Data Preparation
To configure a static multicast MAC address, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Number of the interface to be configured with
a static multicast MAC address
2
ID of the VLAN that the interface belongs to
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Configure a static multicast MAC address:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
24
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
l Configure a static multicast MAC address on an interface:
1.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface type can be Ethernet, GE, XGE, or Eth-Trunk.
2.
Run:
mac-address multicast mac-address vlan vlan-id
A static multicast MAC address is configured on the interface.
l Configure a static multicast MAC address on multiple interfaces:
Run:
mac-address multicast mac-address interface { interface-type interface-number1
[ to interface-type interface-number2 ] } &<1-10> vlan vlan-id
The static multicast MAC address is configured on multiple interfaces.
The interface numbers must be consecutive; the specified interfaces must be on the same
board; interface-number2 must be greater than interface-number1.
After a static multicast MAC address is configured on interfaces, multicast packets destined for
the multicast MAC address are forwarded only to the interfaces.
Note the following points when configuring a static multicast MAC address:
l The specified VLAN exists and the interfaces have been added to the VLAN.
l The value of mac-address must be a multicast MAC address, which starts with 01.
l The MAC address cannot be in the range from 0100-5E00-0000 to 0100-5E00-7FFF (used
for IPv4 multicast) or 3333-xxxx-xxxx (used for IPv6 multicast).
l The VLAN cannot be a super-VLAN, a leased line VLAN, or the control VLAN of a Smart
Ethernet Protocol (SEP) segment or Rapid Ring Protection Protocol (RRPP) ring.
----End
Checking the Configuration
l
Run the display mac-address multicast [ [ mac-address ] vlan vlan-id ] command to check
the configured static multicast MAC addresses.
l
Run the display mac-address multicast [ vlan vlan-id ] total-number command to check
the number of configured static multicast MAC addresses.
# View static multicast MAC address entries in VLAN 10.
<Quidway> display mac-address multicast vlan 10
-------------------------------------------------------------------MAC Address
VLANID
Out-Interface
-------------------------------------------------------------------0111-1111-2222
10
GigabitEthernet1/0/1
GigabitEthernet1/0/2
2 port(s)
-------------------------------------------------------------------Total Group(s) : 1
# View the number of static multicast MAC address entries in VLAN 10.
<Quidway> display mac-address multicast vlan 10 total-number
Total number of mac-address : 3
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
25
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
2.5 Configuring the IGMP Snooping Proxy for the VLAN
This section describes how to configure IGMP snooping proxy.
Applicable Environment
After the IGMP snooping proxy is configured on the S9700, the S9700 replaces the upstream
router to send IGMP Query messages to the downstream devices, and receives the IGMP Report
and IGMP Leave messages from the downstream devices. In this way, bandwidth consumption
between the upstream router and the S9700 is reduced and the workload on the upstream router
is also reduced.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring the IGMP snooping proxy, enable IGMP snooping globally and in a specified
VLAN.
Data Preparation
None
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping proxy
The IGMP snooping proxy is configured.
NOTE
IGMP snooping proxy cannot be enabled in a VLAN if the corresponding VLANIF interface has IGMP
enabled.
The IGMP snooping querier and IGMP message suppression functions can be enabled in the same VLAN
to implement the IGMP snooping proxy function. After you configure the IGMP snooping proxy function
in a VLAN, do not configure the IGMP snooping querier or IGMP message suppression function in the
VLAN. For detailed configurations of IGMP snooping querier and IGMP message suppression, see 2.3.5
(Optional) Configuring IGMP Snooping Querier and 2.3.6 (Optional) Configuring IGMP Message
Suppression.
Step 4 Run:
quit
Return to the system view.
Step 5 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
26
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk
interface.
Step 6 Run:
igmp-snooping proxy-uplink-port
The S9700 is prohibited from sending IGMP Query messages to router interfaces.
NOTE
After IGMP snooping proxy is enabled in a VLAN, the switch periodically broadcasts IGMP Query
messages to all interfaces in the VLAN, including the router interface in the VLAN. This may result in
IGMP querier reelection. To prevent IGMP querier reelection, run the igmp-snooping proxy-uplinkport command on the router interface to disable the switch from sending IGMP Query messages to the
router interface.
----End
Checking the Configuration
Run the display igmp-snooping configuration command to check the non-default IGMP
snooping configuration.
If the command output shows that the IGMP snooping proxy function has been enabled, the
configuration succeeds.
# View the non-default IGMP snooping configuration in VLAN 10.
<Quidway> display igmp-snooping vlan 10 configuration
IGMP Snooping Configuration for VLAN 10
igmp-snooping enable
igmp-snooping proxy
2.6 Configuring a Layer 2 Multicast Policy
This section describes how to configure a Layer 2 multicast policy.
2.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
A Layer 2 multicast policy controls the multicast programs that users can order on a switch with
IGMP snooping enabled. This policy improves multicast network controllability and security.
The S9700 supports the following Layer 2 multicast policies:
l
Configures multicast group policy, prohibiting multicast member interfaces from joining
the specified multicast group.
l
Enables interfaces to quickly leave multicast groups.
l
Configures multicast entry overwriting.
l
Filters out multicast data packets sent from specified VLANs on an interface.
l
Discards unknown multicast data packets, preventing them from being broadcast in
VLANs.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
27
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
You can use Layer 2 multicast policies according to network requirements.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring a Layer 2 multicast policy, complete the following tasks:
l
Enabling IGMP snooping globally and in a VLAN
l
Creating VLANs and adding interfaces to these VLANs
Data Preparation
To configure a Layer 2 multicast policy, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Types and numbers of interfaces
2
ACL rules applied to a multicast group policy
3
ACL rules applied to prompt leave of
multicast member interfaces
2.6.2 Configuring a Multicast Group Policy
Context
A multicast group policy determines which multicast groups the hosts in a VLAN can join.
NOTE
When creating an ACL in a multicast group policy for a VLAN, specify the deny parameter in the rule
command to prohibit the hosts in the VLAN from joining all or specified multicast groups.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping group-policy acl-number [ version number ]
A multicast group policy is configured to prohibit the hosts in the specified VLANs from joining
the specified multicast group.
By default, the hosts in a VLAN can join any multicast group. If the IGMP version is not specified
for a multicast group policy, the S9700 applies the policy to all the received IGMP messages
regardless of their versions.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
28
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
NOTE
A multicast group policy does not apply to static multicast entries.
----End
2.6.3 Configuring Prompt Leave for Interfaces
Prerequisites
A basic ACL is configured to specify the IP multicast groups that hosts can leave.
For the configuration of the ACL, see ACL Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Security.
Context
When an interface on the S9700 receives an IGMP Leave message from a host, the S9700 deletes
the forwarding entry that corresponds to the interface from the multicast forwarding table
immediately without waiting for the aging of the forwarding entry. This is called prompt leave.
When each interface in a VLAN is connected to only one host, you can enable prompt leave for
interfaces in the VLAN.
NOTE
Prompt leave takes effect for interfaces in a VLAN only when the S9700 can process IGMPv2 or IGMPv3
messages.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping prompt-leave [ group-policy acl-number ]
Prompt leave is enabled for interfaces in the VLAN.
If group-policy acl-number is not specified, the S9700 immediately deletes the forwarding entry
corresponding to a member interface after receiving the Leave message from the interface.
By default, prompt leave is disabled for interfaces.
NOTE
On the S9700, the permit rule is applicable to all multicast groups by default. To configure prompt leave
for a specified multicast group, you need to use the rule deny source any command.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
29
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
2.6.4 Filtering Layer 2 Multicast Data on an Interface
Context
To reject certain types of multicast data, a network administrator can filter UDP packets from a
certain VLAN on an interface of the S9700.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk
interface.
Step 3 Run:
multicast-source-deny vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10>
The Layer 2 multicast data from a certain VLAN on the interface is rejected.
----End
2.6.5 Enabling the Discarding of Unknown Multicast Data Packets
in a VLAN
Context
Unknown multicast data packets are broadcast in a VLAN by default. If multicast services are
stable, for example, the static Layer 2 multicast service, unknown multicast data packets do not
need to be processed. You can enable the discarding of multicast data packets in such a case. If
multicast services are unstable, for example, users frequently join or leave multicast groups,
unknown multicast data packets need to be processed; otherwise some users cannot receive
multicast data.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
multicast drop-unknown
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
30
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Discarding unknown multicast data packets is enabled.
----End
2.6.6 Checking the Configuration
Prerequisites
All the configurations of the Layer 2 multicast policy are complete.
Procedure
l
Run the display igmp-snooping configuration command to check the non-default IGMP
snooping configuration.
You can view the configuration of a Layer 2 multicast policy in a VLAN by viewing the
non-default IGMP snooping configuration in the VLAN.
l
Run the display l2-multicast forwarding-table vlan vlan-id [ [ source-address sourceaddress ] group-address { group-address | router-group } ] command to view the Layer
2 multicast forwarding table in a specified VLAN.
You can check whether a Layer 2 multicast policy is used correctly by viewing Layer 2
multicast forwarding entries.
----End
Example
# View the non-default IGMP snooping configuration in VLAN 10.
<Quidway> display igmp-snooping vlan 10 configuration
IGMP Snooping Configuration for VLAN 10
igmp-snooping enable
igmp-snooping group-policy 2002
2.7 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast CAC
This section describes how to configure the Layer 2 multicast CAC function.
As shown in Figure 2-2, the UPE is connected to downlink devices through a Layer 2 network.
IGMP snooping is deployed on the UPE to implement multicast CAC on the VLAN, allowing
the UPE to control the number of IPTV channels requested by the downstream DSLAM or
switch.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
31
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Figure 2-2 Networking diagram of multicast CAC
BTV
NPE
IP/MPLS
Core
Switch
UPE
CE
DSLAM
NOTE
You can choose to configure multicast CAC for a VLAN, a Layer 2 interface, or an interface in a VLAN,
or you can configure multicast CAC for all of them.
2.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
The UPE can work in either of the following scenarios to provide multicast services based on
VLANs:
l
Static multicast groups are configured on the NPE and the UPE is configured as the querier.
In this scenario, the UPE does not process Query messages from the NPE. Instead, the UPE
only learns the Report messages sent from the user side to generate corresponding multicast
forwarding entries.
The UPE sends General Query messages periodically. If the UPE does not receive Report
messages from the user side, the corresponding entries on the UPE ages. When receiving
Leave messages, the UPE sends Group-Specific Query messages. You can also configure
static multicast groups on the UPE.
l
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
IGMP snooping is enabled on the UPE. When receiving Query messages from the NPE,
the UPE forwards the Query messages to all members on the VLAN. After receiving Report
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
32
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
messages from the user side, the UPE creates corresponding multicast forwarding entries.
If the later received Query message is from the same group and the corresponding multicast
forwarding entry does not reach the aging time, the UPE directly sends a Report message
to the NPE.
NOTE
This section describes only the scenario where IGMP snooping is deployed.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring multicast CAC for a VLAN, a Layer 2 interface, or an interface in a VLAN,
complete the following tasks:
l
Connecting interfaces between devices correctly
l
Configuring interfaces on the switches to ensure that the link layer protocol between the
switches is Up
Data Preparation
To configuring Layer 2 multicast CAC for a VLAN, a Layer 2 interface, or an interface in a
VLAN, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Channel name
2
Number of multicast group members
3
Number of multicast group members in a channel
4
ID of the VLAN or the type and number of the interface where multicast CAC
needs to be configured
2.7.2 Limiting the Number of Multicast Groups of a VLAN, a Layer
2 Interface, or an Interface in a VLAN
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
l2-multicast limit max-entry count [ except acl-number ]
Limitation on the number of global multicast groups is configured.
Step 3 Run:
l2-multicast limit max-entry count [ vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10> ]
[ except acl-number ]
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
33
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Limitation on the number of multicast groups in a VLAN is configured.
Step 4 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The Ethernet, GigabitEthernet, XGigabitEthernet, or Eth-Trunk interface view is displayed.
Step 5 Run:
l2-multicast limit max-entry count [ except acl-number ]
Limitation on the number of multicast groups on a Layer 2 interface is configured.
Step 6 Run:
l2-multicast limit max-entry count [ vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10> ]
[ except acl-number ]
Limitation on the number of multicast groups on an interface of a VLAN is configured.
NOTE
The except acl-number parameters exclude the multicast groups that are not limited. The parameters have
the same function in other configuration commands.
----End
2.7.3 Limiting the Number of Multicast Groups in a Channel for a
VLAN, an Interface, or an Interface in a VLAN
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
l2-multicast limit channel channel-name max-entry count [ vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlanid2 ] } &<1-10> ]
Limitation on the number of multicast groups in a channel is configured for the entire system or
a VLAN.
Step 3 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The Ethernet, GigabitEthernet, XGigabitEthernet, or Eth-Trunk interface view is displayed.
Step 4 Run:
l2-multicast limit channel channel-name max-entry count
Limitation on the number of multicast groups in a channel is configured on the interface.
Step 5 Run:
l2-multicast limit channel channel-name max-entry count [ vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlanid2 ] } &<1-10> ]
Limitation on the number of multicast groups in a channel is configured for the interface in a
specified VLAN.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
34
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
2.7.4 Configuring Channels on a VLAN
Context
Do as follows on the UPE.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 (Optional) Configure the global channels.
1.
Run:
l2-multicast-channel
The global channel view is displayed.
2.
Run:
channel channel-name [ type [ asm | ssm ] ]
A global channel is configured and the channel view is displayed.
3.
Run:
group group-address { group-mask-length | group-mask }
The multicast group member in the global channel is configured.
Step 3 Run:
quit
Return to the system view.
Step 4 Run:
l2-multicast-channel vlan vlan-id
The VLAN channel view is displayed.
Step 5 Run:
channel channel-name
The channel name is created.
The name of a VLAN channel must be different from the name of a global channel.
Step 6 Run:
group group-address { group-mask-length | group-mask }
The multicast group member in the channel is configured.
The specified group address must be different from the group addresses specified for other
channels in this VLAN or the group address of the global channel.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
35
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
2.7.5 Checking the Configuration
Prerequisites
The configurations of Layer 2 multicast CAC for a VLAN, a Layer 2 interface, or an interface
in a VLAN are complete.
Procedure
l
Run the display l2-multicast limit configuration command to check the configuration of
Layer 2 multicast CAC.
l
Run the display l2-multicast limit configuration vlan [ vlan-id ] command to check the
configuration of multicast CAC in a VLAN.
l
Run the display l2-multicast limit vlan [ vlan-id] [ channel channel-name ] command to
check the multicast CAC configuration of a channel in the VLAN.
l
Run the display l2-multicast limit interface interface-type interface-number command to
check the configuration of multicast CAC on an interface.
l
Run the display l2-multicast limit channel channel-name command to check the multicast
CAC configuration in a channel.
l
Run the display l2-multicast-channel channel channel-name command to check the
channel configuration.
----End
Example
Run the display l2-multicast limit configuration command, and you can check the
configuration of Layer 2 multicast CAC.
<Quidway> display l2-multicast limit configuration
L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is kbits/sec
--------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth
CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth
--------------------------------------------------------------------Global limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------100
---------------VLAN 20 limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------50
---------------VLAN 20 channel limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------bjtv
15
---------------interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 VLAN 10 limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------30
---------interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 VLAN 10 channel limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------cctv
20
----------
Run the display l2-multicast-channel vlan 10 command, and you can check the channel
configuration of a VLAN.
<Quidway> display l2-multicast-channel vlan 10
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
36
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Channel information on VLAN 10
ChannelName
Group/Mask
Source/Mask
Bandwidth
------------------------------------------------------------------------------njtv
226.1.1.0/24
*
0
226.1.2.0/24
*
0
226.1.3.0/24
*
0
--------------------------------------------------------------------njtv1
226.2.1.0/24
*
0
226.2.2.0/24
*
0
Run the display l2-multicast limit vlan 20 command, and you can check the configuration of
multicast CAC of a VLAN.
<Quidway> display l2-multicast limit vlan 20
L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is kbits/sec
--------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth
CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth
--------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 20 limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------50
---0
---VLAN 20 channel limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------bjtv
15
---0
----
Run the displayl2-multicast limit vlan 10 interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1 command, and you
can check the configuration of multicast CAC on an interface in a VLAN.
<Quidway> display l2-multicast limit vlan 10 interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1
L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is kbits/sec
--------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth
CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth
--------------------------------------------------------------------interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 VLAN 10 channel limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------cctv
20
-------------
2.8 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast SSM Mapping
This section describes how to configure the Layer 2 multicast SSM mapping function.
2.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
If the switch connected to user hosts is configured with IGMPv3, SSM mapping needs to be
configured on the switch to map the multicast group addresses not in the SSM group to the
specified source addresses.
When the switch running IGMPv3 receives an IGMPv2 packet whose address is in the SSM
group, the SSM mapping function can automatically map the address of the packet to the
specified source.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring SSM mapping, complete the following task:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
37
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Enabling global IGMP snooping
Data Preparation
To configure SSM mapping, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
(Optional) ACL rule
2
(Optional) SSM policy
3
Source addresses mapped to the multicast group addresses
2.8.2 (Optional) Configuring an SSM Group Policy
Context
If a user joins an ASM multicast group, you need to configure an SSM group policy in the VLAN
to add the multicast group address to the range of SSM group addresses.
NOTE
When you create an ACL for an SSM policy, the configuration takes effect only if you select permit and
specify a multicast address in the rule command. The configuration does not take effect if deny is selected
or if the specified address is not a multicast address.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping ssm-policy basic-acl-number
An SSM group policy is configured.
By default, the address of an SSM group ranges from 232.0.0.0 to 232.255.255.255. After you
configure an SSM policy, the multicast groups specified in the SSM policy are considered as
SSM groups.
----End
2.8.3 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast SSM Mapping
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
38
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Context
By configuring SSM mapping, you can set up one-to-one mappings between multicast groups
and multicast sources.
SSM mapping can be configured only when IGMP snooping is enabled globally and in the
corresponding VLAN and when the IGMP messages version is set to IGMPv3 in the VLAN.
If the multicast replication function is configured, you only need to configure SSM mapping in
the multicast VLAN.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping version 3
The version number of IGMP is set to 3.
The default version number of IGMP snooping is 2, but IGMPv2 version does not support SSM
mapping.
Step 4 Run:
igmp-snooping ssm-mapping enable
SSM mapping is enabled in the VLAN.
By default, SSM mapping is disabled.
Step 5 Run:
igmp-snooping ssm-mapping ip-group-address { ip-group-mask | mask-length } ipsource-address
The mapping between a multicast group address and a multicast source is configured.
The specified multicast group address must be in the range of multicast group addresses specified
by the SSM policy. For the configuration of the SSM policy, see 2.8.2 (Optional) Configuring
an SSM Group Policy.
----End
2.8.4 Checking the Configuration
Prerequisites
The configurations of SSM mapping are complete.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
39
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the display igmp-snooping port-info command to view the IGMP snooping entries
on an interface.
----End
Example
Run the display igmp-snooping port-info command, and you can view the IGMP snooping
entries on the interface. For example:
<Quidway> display igmp-snooping port-info vlan 10
----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port
Flag
Flag: S:Static
D:Dynamic
M: Ssm-mapping
----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 10, 3 Entry(s)
(*, 225.1.1.1) GE1/0/2
--M
1 port(s)
(*, 225.1.1.2) GE1/0/2
--M
1 port(s)
(*, 225.1.1.3) GE1/0/2
--M
1 port(s)
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
2.9 Maintaining Layer 2 Multicast
Maintaining Layer 2 multicast involves resetting Layer 2 Multicast statistics, and debugging
IGMP Snooping.
2.9.1 Clearing Static Entries in a Multicast Forwarding Table
Context
CAUTION
Static entries in a forwarding table cannot be restored after you clear them and you have to
configure them again. Confirm the operation before you run the following command.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
40
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk
interface.
Step 3 Run:
undo l2-multicast static-group [ source-address source-ip-address ] group-address
group-ip-address vlan { all | { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10> }
The interface is removed from a multicast group.
Or run:
undo l2-multicast static-group [ source-address source-ip-address ] group-address
group-ip-address1 to group-ip-address2 vlan vlan-id
The interface is removed from multiple multicast groups in a batch.
----End
2.9.2 Clearing Multicast Forwarding Entries
Context
CAUTION
Running this command disables hosts in a VLAN from receiving certain multicast flows. The
hosts in the VLAN receive the multicast flows again only after the S9700 receives IGMP Report
messages from the hosts again and the forwarding entries are regenerated on the S9700.
Procedure
l
Run the reset igmp-snooping group { all | vlan { vlan-id | all } } command in the user
view to clear the dynamic forwarding entries in the multicast forwarding table.
NOTE
This command cannot clear static forwarding entries and dynamic router port entries.
----End
2.9.3 Clearing the Statistics on IGMP Snooping
Context
CAUTION
The statistics on IGMP snooping cannot be restored after you clear them. So, confirm the action
before you use the command.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
41
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the reset igmp-snooping statistics { all | vlan { vlan-id | all } } command in the user
view to clear the statistics on IGMP snooping.
----End
2.9.4 Debugging IGMP Snooping
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging
igmp-snooping all command to disable it immediately.
Procedure
l
Run the debugging igmp-snooping { all | aps | event | fwd | general | leave [ basic-aclnumber ] | mvlan | packet [ advance-acl-number ] | query [ advance-acl-number ] |
report [ advance-acl-number ] | syn | timer } command in the user view to enable
debugging of IGMP snooping.
----End
2.9.5 Debugging Layer 2 Multicast CAC
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging
all command to disable it immediately.
Procedure
l
Run the debugging l2-multicast limit { all | check | configuration | event }command to
enable the debugging of multicast CAC.
----End
2.10 Configuration examples
This section provides several configuration examples of Layer 2 multicast.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
42
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
2.10.1 Example for Configuring IGMP Snooping
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 2-3, GE 3/0/1 of the S9700 is connected to a router on the multicast source
side, and GE 1/0/1 is connected to hosts. You are required to configure IGMP snooping to ensure
that three hosts in VLAN 3 can receive multicast data from multicast groups in the range of
225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.3 permanently.
Figure 2-3 Networking diagram for configuring VLAN-based IGMP snooping
DHCP server
Multicast source
IP/MPLS core
VLAN3
GE3/0/1
Switch
GE1/0/1
Host3
Host4
Host5
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Create a VLAN and add interfaces to the VLAN.
2.
Enable IGMP snooping globally and in the VLAN.
3.
Configure a static router interface.
4.
Configure static multicast groups 225.1.1.1, 225.1.1.2, and 225.1.1.3.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
ID of the VLAN that GE 1/0/1 and GE 3/0/1 belong to: VLAN 3
l
Static router interface: GE 3/0/1
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
43
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Addresses of static multicast groups: 225.1.1.1, 225.1.1.2, 225.1.1.3
Procedure
Step 1 Create a VLAN and add interfaces to the VLAN.
<Switch> system-view
[Switch] vlan 3
[Switch-vlan3] quit
[Switch] interface gigabitethernet
[Switch-GigabitEthernet3/0/1] port
[Switch-GigabitEthernet3/0/1] quit
[Switch] interface gigabitethernet
[Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port
[Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit
3/0/1
hybrid tagged vlan 3
1/0/1
hybrid tagged vlan 3
Step 2 Enable IGMP snooping.
# Enable IGMP snooping globally.
[Switch] igmp-snooping enable
# Enable IGMP snooping in VLAN 3.
[Switch] vlan 3
[Switch-vlan3] igmp-snooping enable
[Switch-vlan3] quit
Step 3 Configure GE 3/0/1 as the static router interface of VLAN 3.
[Switch] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/1
[Switch-GigabitEthernet3/0/1] igmp-snooping static-router-port vlan 3
[Switch-GigabitEthernet3/0/1] quit
Step 4 Configure static multicast groups.
[Switch] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1
[Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] l2-multicast static-group group-address 225.1.1.1
vlan 3
[Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] l2-multicast static-group group-address 225.1.1.2
vlan 3
[Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] l2-multicast static-group group-address 225.1.1.3
vlan 3
[Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit
Step 5 Verify the configuration.
# Check all configurations of IGMP snooping.
<Switch> display igmp-snooping vlan configuration
IGMP Snooping Configuration for VLAN 3
igmp-snooping enable
According to the preceding information, the IGMP snooping of the VLAN is enabled.
# Check the configuration of the static router interface.
Run the display igmp-snooping router-port vlan 3 command on the S9700.
<Switch> display igmp-snooping router-port vlan 3
Port Name
UpTime
Expires
Flags
--------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 3, 1 router-port(s)
GigabitEthernet3/0/1
00:01:02 -STATIC
According to the preceding information, GE 3/0/1 is configured as a static router interface.
# Verify the information about member interfaces of a static multicast group.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
44
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
[Switch] display igmp-snooping port-info
----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port
Flag
Flag: S:Static
D:Dynamic
M: Ssm-mapping
----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 3, 3 Entry(s)
(*, 225.1.1.1) GE1/0/1
S-1 port(s)
(*, 225.1.1.2) GE1/0/1
S-1 port(s)
(*, 225.1.1.3) GE1/0/1
S-1 port(s)
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
According to the preceding information, multicast groups 225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.3 are configured
with static forwarding entries.
# View the multicast forwarding table.
[Switch] display l2-multicast forwarding-table vlan 3
VLAN ID : 10, Forwarding Mode : IP
-------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group)
Interface
Out-Vlan
-------------------------------------------------------------------Router-port
GigabitEthernet3/0/1
3
(*, 225.1.1.1)
GigabitEthernet1/0/1
3
GigabitEthernet3/0/1
3
(*, 225.1.1.2)
GigabitEthernet1/0/1
3
GigabitEthernet3/0/1
3
(*, 225.1.1.3)
GigabitEthernet1/0/1
3
GigabitEthernet3/0/1
3
-------------------------------------------------------------------Total Group(s) : 3
The preceding information shows the VLAN ID and outgoing interface mapping the data from
multicast groups 225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.3.
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of the S9700
#
sysname Switch
#
vlan batch 3
#
igmp-snooping enable
#
vlan 3
igmp-snooping enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1
port hybrid tagged vlan 3
l2-multicast static-group group-address 225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.3 vlan 3
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/1
port hybrid tagged vlan 3
igmp-snooping static-router-port vlan 3
#
return
2.10.2 Example for Configuring Layer 2 Multicast CAC for a VLAN
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
45
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Networking Requirements
As shown in the figure, Switch A and Switch B are connected through VLAN 20; Switch B and
Switch C are connected through the MPLS/VPLS network and Switch C is connected to the TV
server on the Internet.
The Layer 2 multicast CAC based on VLAN 20 is configured on GE1/0/0 of Switch B. The
multicast CAC limits the number of multicast groups in VLAN 20 to 50 and the number of
multicast group members in channel bjtv in VLAN 20 to 15.
An intranet is connected to GE1/0/1 of Switch B through VLAN 10. The VLAN-based multicast
CAC is configured on GE1/0/1 in VLAN 10 to limit the channel that users can join to cctv and
the number of members in the channel to 20.
Figure 2-4 Networking diagram of Layer 2 multicast CAC for a VLAN
SwitchB
GE1/0/1
VLAN20 GE1/0/0
SwitchA
MPLS/
VPLS
GE1/0/1
Internet
SwitchC
TV Server
VLAN10
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Configure VLAN 20 on Switch A and Switch B.
2.
Enable global IGMP snooping.
3.
Configure Layer 2 multicast CAC in the system view and the VLAN view.
4.
Configure multicast groups for the channel in VLAN 10 on Switch B.
5.
Configure VLAN-based Layer 2 multicast CAC on an interface of Switch B in VLAN 10.
6.
Set the global group address range for the channel bjtv to 224.0.0.1-224.0.0.255, and the
global group address range for the channel cctv to 225.0.0.1-225.0.0.255.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
1.
VLAN ID between Switch A and Switch B
2.
Limits of Layer 2 multicast CAC, including number of multicast groups and number of
channels
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
46
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Configure VLAN 20 on Switch A and Switch B.
# Configure Switch A.
<SwitchA> system-view
[SwitchA] vlan 20
[SwitchA-vlan20] quit
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port link-type trunk
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port trunk allow-pass vlan 20
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit
# Configure Switch B.
<SwitchB> system-view
[SwitchB] vlan 20
[SwitchB-vlan20] quit
[SwitchB] interface gigabitethernet
[SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port
[SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port
[SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[SwitchB] interface gigabitethernet
[SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port
[SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port
1/0/0
link-type access
default vlan 20
1/0/1
link-type trunk
trunk allow-pass vlan 10
Step 2 Enable global IGMP snooping on Switch A and Switch B.
[SwitchA] igmp-snooping enable
[SwitchB] igmp-snooping enable
Step 3 Enable IGMP snooping in VLANs.
# Enable IGMP snooping for VLAN 10 and VLAN 20 on Switch B.
[SwitchB] vlan 20
[SwitchB-vlan20] igmp-snooping enable
[SwitchB-vlan20] quit
[SwitchB] vlan 10
[SwitchB-vlan10] igmp-snooping enable
# Enable IGMP snooping for VLAN 20 on Switch A.
[SwitchA] vlan 20
[SwitchA-vlan20] igmp-snooping enable
Step 4 Configure Layer 2 multicast CAC in the system view and configure the group limit to 100
globally. The multicast CAC limits the number of multicast groups in VLAN 20 to 50 and the
number of multicast groups in channel bjtv in VLAN 20 to 15
[SwitchB] l2-multicast limit max-entry 100
[SwitchB] l2-multicast limit max-entry 50 vlan 20
[SwitchB] l2-multicast limit channel bjtv max-entry 15 vlan 20
Step 5 Configure Layer 2 multicast CAC on GE1/0/1 of Switch B. The VLAN-based multicast CAC
is configured on GE1/0/1 in VLAN 10 to limit the channel that users can join to cctv and the
number of members in the channel to 20
[SwitchB]interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1
[SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/1]l2-multicast limit channel cctv max-entry 20 vlan 10
Step 6 On SwitchB, set the global group address range for the channel bjtv to 224.0.0.1-224.0.0.255,
and the global group address range for the channel cctv to 225.0.0.1-225.0.0.255.
[SwitchB] l2-multicast-channel
[SwitchB-l2-channel-glb] channel bjtv type asm
[SwitchB-l2-channel-glb-bjtv] group 224.0.0.0 24
[SwitchB-l2-channel-glb-bjtv] quit
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
47
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
[SwitchB-l2-channel-glb] channel cctv type asm
[SwitchB-l2-channel-glb-cctv] group 225.0.0.0 24
Step 7 Verify the configuration.
Run the display l2-multicast limit configuration command to check the configurations of Layer
2 multicast CAC.
The following are the configurations of Switch B.
[SwitchB] display l2-multicast limit configuration
L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is kbits/sec
--------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth
CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth
--------------------------------------------------------------------Global limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------100
------------VLAN 20 limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------50
------------VLAN 20 channel limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------bjtv
15
------------interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 VLAN 10 channel limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------cctv
20
-------------
Run the display l2-multicast limit vlan 20 command to check the configurations of Layer 2
multicast CAC in VLAN 20.
The following are the configurations of Switch B.
[SwitchB] display l2-multicast limit vlan 20
L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is kbits/sec
--------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth
CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth
--------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 20 limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------50
0
VLAN 20 channel limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------bjtv
15
0
-
Run the displayl2-multicast limit vlan 10 interface command to check the configurations of
multicast CAC of an interface in the VLAN.
The following are the configurations of Switch B.
[SwitchB] display l2-multicast limit vlan 10 interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1
L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is Mbits/sec
--------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth
CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth
--------------------------------------------------------------------interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 VLAN 10 channel limit information:
--------------------------------------------------------------------cctv
20
-
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
48
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
20
-
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 20
#
igmp-snooping enable
#
vlan 20
igmp-snooping enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 20
#
return
l
Configuration file of Switch B
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 10 20
#
igmp-snooping enable
l2-multicast limit max-entry 100
l2-multicast limit max-entry 50 vlan 20
l2-multicast limit channel bjtv max-entry 15 vlan 20
#
vlan 10
igmp-snooping enable
#
vlan 20
igmp-snooping enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port link-type access
port default vlan 20
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 10
l2-multicast limit channel cctv max-entry 20 vlan 10
#
l2-multicast-channel
channel bjtv type asm
group 224.0.0.0 255.255.255.0
channel cctv type asm
group 225.0.0.0 255.255.255.0
return
2.10.3 Example for Configuring IGMP Snooping SSM Mapping
Networking Requirements
On the network shown in Figure 2-5, IGMPv2 is run on Switch and Host 1 and Host 2, and
IGMPv3 is run on the last-hop router Router A on the multicast source side. Switch A is the
S9700 device. GE 1/0/0 on Switch A is connected to Router A and GE 1/0/1 on Switch A is
connected to a switch directly connected with users. GE 1/0/0 on Switch A is a static router
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
49
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
interface and GE 1/0/1 is statically added to multicast group 224.1.1.1. GE 1/0/0 and GE 1/0/1
both join VLAN 10 and IGMP SSM mapping is deployed on Router A.
It is required that IGMP snooping SSM mapping be configured on Switch A in the VLAN to
work jointly with IGMP SSM mapping. IGMP snooping SSM mapping also generates a mapping
between a multicast group and a multicast source. (*, G) information in IGMPv1 or IGMPv2
multicast data packets is then mapped to (S, G) information, providing SSM services for the
hosts running IGMPv1 or IGMPv2.
Figure 2-5 Networking diagram for configuring IGMP snooping SSM mapping
Source 2
10.1.1.2
Internet/
Intranet
Source 1
10.1.1.1
RouterA
SwitchA
GE1/0/0
GE1/0/1
Switch
SSM Mapping
VLAN10
Host1
Host2
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Configure basic IGMP snooping functions so that users can receive multicast data from
multicast sources.
2.
Configure an SSM group policy for IGMP snooping to add the ASM group addresses of
users to the SSM group address range.
3.
Configure IGMP snooping SSM mapping so that users can receive multicast data from a
specified multicast source.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
VLAN 10 to which GE 1/0/0 and GE 1/0/1 on Switch A are added
l
IGMPv3 run on Switch A and IGMPv2 run on Switch, Host 1, and Host 2
l
Multicast source address 10.1.1.2
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
50
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
Address of the multicast group to which GE 1/0/1 is statically added (224.1.1.1 is used in
this example)
Procedure
Step 1 Configure a VLAN.
# Configure Switch A.
<Quidway> system-view
[Quidway] sysname SwitchA
[SwitchA] vlan 10
[SwitchA-vlan10] quit
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit
1/0/0
hybrid pvid vlan 10
hybrid untagged vlan 10
1/0/1
hybrid pvid vlan 10
hybrid untagged vlan 10
Step 2 Enable global IGMP snooping and IGMP snooping in the VLAN.
# Configure Switch A.
[SwitchA] igmp-snooping enable
[SwitchA] vlan 10
[SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping enable
Step 3 Configure IGMPv3 on Switch A and configure IGMPv2 on hosts. The hosts are not allowed to
upgrade the IGMP version to 3.
# Configure Switch A.
[SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping version 3
[SwitchA-vlan10] quit
Step 4 Configure GE 1/0/0 as a static router interface in VLAN 10 and add GE 1/0/1 statically to
multicast group 224.1.1.1.
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] igmp-snooping static-router-port vlan 10
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] l2-multicast static-group group-address 224.1.1.1
vlan 10
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit
Step 5 Configure an SSM group policy for IGMP snooping and enable IGMP snooping SSM mapping.
[SwitchA] acl number 2008
[SwitchA-acl-basic-2008] rule 5 permit source 224.1.1.1 0
[SwitchA-acl-basic-2008] quit
[SwitchA] vlan 10
[SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping ssm-policy 2008
[SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping ssm-mapping enable
[SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping ssm-mapping 224.1.1.1 24 10.1.1.2
[SwitchA-vlan10] quit
Step 6 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display igmp-snooping vlan configuration command on Switch A. You can view
IGMP snooping configurations in the VLAN.
[SwitchA] display igmp-snooping vlan configuration
IGMP Snooping Configuration for VLAN 10
igmp-snooping enable
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
51
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
2 IGMP Snooping Configuration
igmp-snooping
igmp-snooping
igmp-snooping
igmp-snooping
version 3
ssm-mapping enable
ssm-policy 2008
ssm-mapping 224.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.1.2
# After SwitchA receives a Report message, run the display igmp-snooping port-info command
to view the configurations on the interface.
[SwitchA] display igmp-snooping port-info
----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port
Flag
Flag: S:Static
D:Dynamic
M: Ssm-mapping
----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 10, 1 Entry(s)
(10.1.1.2, 224.1.1.1) GE1/0/1
--M
1 port(s)
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of Switch A
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 10
#
igmp-snooping enable
#
acl number 2008
rule 5 permit source 224.1.1.1 0
#
vlan 10
igmp-snooping enable
igmp-snooping ssm-mapping enable
igmp-snooping version 3
igmp-snooping ssm-policy 2008
igmp-snooping ssm-mapping 224.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.1.2
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
igmp-snooping static-router-port vlan 10
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
l2-multicast static-group group-address 224.1.1.1 vlan 10
#
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
52
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
About This Chapter
This chapter describes the procedure for configuring multicast VLAN replication and
maintenance commands, and provides configuration examples.
3.1 Multicast VLAN Replication Overview
After multicast VLAN replication is configured on a switch, the upstream router only needs to
transmit multicast data to a multicast VLAN. This function saves bandwidth because the
upstream router does not need to send a copy of multicast data to each user VLAN.
3.2 Multicast VLAN Replication Supported by the S9700
This section describes the multicast VLAN replication features supported by the S9700.
3.3 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs
This section describes how to implement multicast VLAN replication based on user VLANs.
3.4 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on Interfaces
This section describes how to configure multicast VLAN replication based on interfaces.
3.5 Configuration Examples
This section provides configuration examples of multicast VLAN replication.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
53
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
3.1 Multicast VLAN Replication Overview
After multicast VLAN replication is configured on a switch, the upstream router only needs to
transmit multicast data to a multicast VLAN. This function saves bandwidth because the
upstream router does not need to send a copy of multicast data to each user VLAN.
In traditional multicast transmission mode, the upstream router must copy multicast data for
each user VLAN and send all copies to the switch when users in different VLANs request the
program provided by the same multicast source. This mode wastes network bandwidth and adds
workload on the router.
When users in multiple VLANs require the program of the same multicast source, you can
configure the VLANs as the user VLANs of a multicast VLAN on the switch. The upstream
router only needs to send multicast data to the multicast VLAN and does not need to send a copy
to each user VLAN. When the switch receives multicast data packets from the upstream router,
it distributes multicast data packets to the user VLANs that have multicast receivers.
3.2 Multicast VLAN Replication Supported by the S9700
This section describes the multicast VLAN replication features supported by the S9700.
Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs
and reduces workload of the router
Figure 3-1 shows the traditional multicast data transmission mode. When HostA, HostB, and
HostC in different VLANs join the same multicast group, the Layer 3 device (router) must copy
multicast data for each VLAN and send all copies to the Layer 2 device (switch). This wastes
bandwidth and burdens the router.
Figure 3-1 Traditional multicast data transmission
Multicast Packet
VLAN 2
VLAN 3
Receiver
HostA
VLAN 2
VLAN 4
Receiver
HostB
Source
Router
Switch
VLAN 3
Receiver
HostC
VLAN 4
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
54
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
Figure 3-2 shows multicast data transmission after multicast VLAN replication is configured.
The router only needs to copy multicast data for the multicast VLAN and sends the data to the
switch. This saves network bandwidth and reduces workload of the router.
Figure 3-2 Multicast VLAN replication
Multicast Packet
Multicast VLAN
VLAN 2
VLAN 3
Receiver
HostA
VLAN 2
VLAN 4
Receiver
HostB
Source
Router
Switch
VLAN 3
Receiver
HostC
VLAN 4
On the S9700, a multicast VLAN can have multiple user VLANs.
Multicast VLAN Replication Based on Interfaces
A carrier provides the multicast service for multiple Internet service providers (ISPs) and assigns
a multicast VLAN to each ISP to isolate multicast data and routes. The ISPs provide multicast
services for users on different interfaces. The interfaces may be added to the same user VLAN,
so multicast packets of an ISP may be sent to users that do not subscribe to services of this ISP.
To protect interests of ISPs, the carrier can bind user VLANs to multicast VLANs on the userside interfaces. As shown in Figure 3-3, after multicast VLANs are bound to user VLANs on
user-side interfaces, multicast data packets are only sent to user VLANs on the specified
interfaces.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
55
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
Figure 3-3 Multicast data transmission before and after multicast VLAN replication is
configured on interfaces
Multicast Packet
Multicast VLAN 2
Multicast VLAN 3
Multicast Packet
Multicast VLAN 2
Multicast VLAN 3
Router
Source
Router
Source
Switch
ISP1
VLAN4
Receiver
HostA
Switch
ISP1
VLAN4
ISP2
VLAN4
HostA
Receiver
HostA
ISP2
VLAN4
HostA
3.3 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User
VLANs
This section describes how to implement multicast VLAN replication based on user VLANs.
3.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
In traditional multicast transmission mode, a router must copy multicast data for each user VLAN
and send all copies to the downstream device when users in different VLANs request the program
provided by the same multicast source. This mode wastes network bandwidth and adds workload
on the router.
Multicast VLAN replication helps to manage and control the multicast source and the multicast
group members. This function enables users in different VLANs to receive the same multicast
flow and saves bandwidth.
In multicast VLAN replication implementation, VLANs are classified into multicast VLANs
and multiple user VLANs. The S9700 interface connected to a multicast source belongs to a
multicast VLAN, and interfaces connected to members of a multicast group belong to user
VLANs. The multicast VLAN aggregates multicast flows, and user VLANs receive data from
the multicast VLAN.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
56
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring multicast VLAN replication based on user VLANs, complete the following
tasks:
l
Connecting interfaces and setting physical parameters for the interfaces to ensure that the
physical status of the interfaces is Up
l
Enabling IGMP snooping globally
Data Preparation
To configure multicast VLAN replication based on user VLANs, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Multicast VLAN ID
2
User VLAN IDs
3
Types and numbers of interfaces
3.3.2 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User
VLANs
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
A VLAN is created and the VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping enable
IGMP snooping is enabled in the VLAN.
Step 4 Run:
multicast-vlan enable
Multicast VLAN replication is enabled, and the VLAN is configured as a multicast VLAN.
By default, multicast VLAN replication is disabled.
After IP multicast is configured on the S9700, no multicast VLAN can be configured.
Step 5 Run:
multicast-vlan user-vlan { { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10> }
User VLANs are bound to the multicast VLAN.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
57
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
The vlan-id1 and vlan-id2 parameters specify user VLAN IDs. The value of vlan-id2 must be
greater than the value of vlan-id1.
NOTE
The user VLANs specified in the command must be existing VLANs enabled with IGMP snooping and
cannot be multicast VLANs or user VLANs of another multicast VLAN.
----End
3.3.3 Adding Interfaces to VLANs
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Add a network-side interface to a multicast VLAN.
1.
Run the interface interface-type interface-number command to enter the network-side
interface view.
2.
Configure the network-side interface as a trunk or hybrid interface and add the interface to
the multicast VLAN. For the configuration procedure, see Dividing a LAN into VLANs
Based on Ports.
3.
Run the quit command to return to the system view.
Step 3 Add a user-side interface to a user VLAN.
1.
Run the interface interface-type interface-number command to enter the user-side interface
view
2.
Configure the user-side interface as a trunk or hybrid interface and add the interface to the
user VLAN. For the configuration procedure, see Dividing a LAN into VLANs Based on
Ports.
----End
3.3.4 Checking the Configuration
Prerequisites
The configuration of multicast VLAN replication is complete.
Procedure
l
Run the display multicast-vlan vlan [ vlan-id ] command to view information about a
multicast VLAN.
----End
Example
Run the display multicast-vlan vlan [ vlan-id ] command to view information about a multicast
VLAN.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
58
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
<Quidway> display multicast-vlan vlan 3
Multicast-vlan
: 3
User-vlan Number
: 2
IGMP snooping state
: Enable
MLD snooping state
: Disable
User-vlan
Snooping-state
----------------------------------------------100
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable
200
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable
Run the display user-vlan vlan [ vlan-id ] command to view information about user VLANs.
<Quidway> display user-vlan vlan
Total user vlan
2
user-vlan snooping-state
multicast-vlan snooping-state
----------------------------------------------------------------------------100
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 3
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable
200
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 3
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable
3.4 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on
Interfaces
This section describes how to configure multicast VLAN replication based on interfaces.
3.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
A carrier provides the multicast service for multiple Internet service providers (ISPs) and assigns
a multicast VLAN to each ISP to isolate multicast data and routes. The ISPs provide multicast
services for users on different interfaces. The interfaces may be added to the same user VLAN,
so multicast packets of an ISP may be sent to users that do not subscribe to services of this ISP.
To protect interests of ISPs, the carrier can bind user VLANs to multicast VLANs on the userside interfaces. Multicast data packets of a user VLAN are then sent to the specified interface.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring multicast VLAN replication based on interfaces, complete the following
tasks:
l
Connecting interfaces and setting physical parameters for the interfaces to ensure that the
physical status of the interfaces is Up
l
Enabling IGMP snooping globally
Data Preparation
To configure multicast VLAN replication based on interfaces, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
No.
Data
1
Multicast VLAN ID
2
User VLAN IDs
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
59
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
No.
Data
3
Types and numbers of interfaces
3.4.2 Creating a Multicast VLAN
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
A VLAN is created and the VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
igmp-snooping enable
IGMP snooping is enabled in the VLAN.
----End
3.4.3 Binding User VLANs to a Multicast VLAN on an Interface
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
l2-multicast-bind vlan vlanid1 [ to vlanid2 ] mvlan mvlanid
User VLANs are bound to a multicast VLAN on the interface.
This command is used on user-side interfaces.
NOTE
After a user VLAN is bound to a multicast VLAN on an interface, Layer 2 multicast call admission control
(CAC) based on the interface and Layer 2 multicast CAC based on the interface and user VLAN do not
take effect on the interface. However, you can configure Layer 2 multicast CAC based on the interface and
a non-user VLAN.
The user VLANs must exist, and cannot be multicast VLANs or user VLANs of another multicast VLAN.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
60
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
3.4.4 Adding Interfaces to VLANs
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Add a network-side interface to a multicast VLAN.
1.
Run the interface interface-type interface-number command to enter the network-side
interface view.
2.
Configure the network-side interface as a trunk or hybrid interface and add the interface to
the multicast VLAN. For the configuration procedure, see Dividing a LAN into VLANs
Based on Ports.
3.
Run the quit command to return to the system view.
Step 3 Add a user-side interface to a user VLAN.
1.
Run the interface interface-type interface-number command to enter the user-side interface
view
2.
Configure the user-side interface as a trunk or hybrid interface and add the interface to the
user VLAN. For the configuration procedure, see Dividing a LAN into VLANs Based on
Ports.
----End
3.4.5 Checking the Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the display l2-multicast-bind [ mvlan vlan-id ] command to view information about
a multicast VLAN and user VLANs bound to the multicast VLAN on an interface.
----End
Example
Run the display l2-multicast-bind [ mvlan vlan-id ] command to view information about a
multicast VLAN and its user VLANs.
<Quidway> display l2-multicast-bind mvlan 90
------------------------------------------------------------------Port
Startvlan
Endvlan
Mvlan
------------------------------------------------------------------GigabitEthernet1/0/9
901
-90
------------------------------------------------------------------Total Table(s) : 1
3.5 Configuration Examples
This section provides configuration examples of multicast VLAN replication.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
61
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
3.5.1 Example for Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based
on User VLANs
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 3-4, RouterA is connected to the multicast source. GE1/0/0 of RouterA is
connected to GE1/0/0 of SwitchA. GE1/0/0 of SwitchA belongs to VLAN 10. HostA, HostB,
and HostC are connected to GE1/0/1, GE1/0/2, and GE1/0/3 of SwitchA and belong to VLAN
100, VLAN 200, and VLAN 300 respectively.
To save network bandwidth, you can configure multicast VLAN replication based on user
VLANs on SwitchA. RouterA then only needs to send one copy of multicast data to the multicast
VLAN, and SwitchA distributes multicast data to user VLANs.
Figure 3-4 Networking diagram for configuring multicast VLAN replication based on user
VLANs
Source
GE1/0/0 RouterA
VLAN10
GE1/0/0 SwitchA
GE1/0/1
GE1/0/3
GE1/0/2
VLAN100
VLAN200
HostA
Reciever
HostB
Reciever
VLAN300
HostC
Reciever
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Enable IGMP snooping globally.
2.
Create a multicast VLAN and enable IGMP snooping in the multicast VLAN.
3.
Create user VLANs.
4.
Bind the user VLANs to the multicast VLAN.
5.
Add the network-side interface and user-side interfaces to VLANs as hybrid interfaces.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
62
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Interface connected to RouterA and the VLAN that the interface belongs to
l
User-side interfaces and the VLANs that the interfaces belong to
Procedure
Step 1 Enable IGMP snooping globally.
<SwitchA> system-view
[SwitchA] igmp-snooping enable
Step 2 Create a multicast VLAN and enable IGMP snooping in the multicast VLAN.
[SwitchA] vlan 10
[SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping enable
[SwitchA-vlan10] multicast-vlan enable
[SwitchA-vlan10] quit
Step 3 Create user VLANs and enable IGMP snooping in the user VLANs.
[SwitchA] vlan 100
[SwitchA-vlan100] igmp-snooping enable
[SwitchA-vlan100] quit
[SwitchA] vlan 200
[SwitchA-vlan200] igmp-snooping enable
[SwitchA-vlan200] quit
[SwitchA] vlan 300
[SwitchA-vlan300] igmp-snooping enable
[SwitchA-vlan300] quit
Step 4 Bind user VLANs 100, 200, and 300 to multicast VLAN 10.
[Switch] vlan 10
[Switch-vlan3] multicast-vlan user-vlan 100 200 300
[Switch-vlan3] quit
Step 5 Add interfaces to VLANs as hybrid interfaces.
# Add GE1/0/0 to multicast VLAN 10.
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/0
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 10
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 10
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
# Add GE1/0/1 to VLAN 100, GE1/0/2 to VLAN 200, and GE1/0/3 to VLAN 300.
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/1
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port hybrid
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port hybrid
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/2
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] port hybrid
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] port hybrid
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] quit
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/3
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/3] port hybrid
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/3] port hybrid
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/3] quit
pvid vlan 100
untagged vlan 100
pvid vlan 200
untagged vlan 200
pvid vlan 300
untagged vlan 300
Step 6 Verify the configuration. View information about the multicast VLAN and user VLANs on
SwitchA.
[SwitchA] display multicast-vlan vlan
Total multicast vlan
1
multicast-vlan
user-vlan number
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
snooping-state
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
63
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
---------------------------------------------------------------10
3
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable
[SwitchA] display user-vlan vlan
Total user vlan
3
user-vlan snooping-state
multicast-vlan snooping-state
----------------------------------------------------------------------------100
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 10
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable
200
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 10
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable
300
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 10
IGMP Enable /MLD Disable
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 10 100 200 300
#
igmp-snooping enable
#
vlan 10
igmp-snooping enable
multicast-vlan enable
multicast-vlan user-vlan 100 200 300
#
vlan 100
igmp-snooping enable
#
vlan 200
igmp-snooping enable
#
vlan 300
igmp-snooping enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
return
3.5.2 Example for Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based
on Interfaces
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 3-5, the Router is connected to the multicast source. GE1/0/0 of the Switch
A is connected to the Router. GE1/0/1 provides services for ISP1, and GE1/0/2 provides services
for ISP2. ISP1 and ISP2 use multicast VLAN 2 and VLAN 3 respectively to provide multicast
services for users. GE1/0/1 and GE1/0/2 belong to user VLAN 10.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
64
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
To protect interests of the ISPs and ensure that multicast packets of each ISP are only sent to
users of the ISP, multicast VLANs and user VLANs can be bound on the user-side interfaces.
After the configuration is complete, multicast data of an ISP will be sent only to the interface
connected to the ISP.
Figure 3-5 Networking diagram for configuring multicast VLAN replication based on interfaces
Router GE1/0/0
Source
GE1/0/0
GE1/0/1
GE1/0/2
SwitchA
ISP1
VLAN10
ISP2
VLAN10
Receiver
HostB
Receiver
HostA
Mulcast Packet
Mulcast VLAN 2
Mulcast VLAN 3
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Create multicast VLANs 2 and 3 and enable IGMP snooping in the multicast VLANs.
2.
Create user VLAN 10.
3.
Bind the user VLAN to multicast VLANs on GE1/0/1 and GE1/0/2.
4.
Add the network-side interface and user-side interfaces to VLANs as hybrid interfaces.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Interface connected to the Router and the VLAN that the interface belongs to
l
User-side interfaces and the VLANs that the interfaces belong to
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
65
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Create multicast VLANs 2 and 3 and enable IGMP snooping in the multicast VLANs.
<SwitchA> system-view
[SwitchA] igmp-snooping enable
[SwitchA] vlan 2
[SwitchA-vlan2] igmp-snooping enable
[SwitchA-vlan2] quit
[SwitchA] vlan 3
[SwitchA-vlan3] igmp-snooping enable
[SwitchA-vlan3] quit
Step 2 Create user VLAN 10.
[SwitchA] vlan batch 10
Step 3 Bind the user VLAN to multicast VLANs on GE1/0/1 and GE1/0/2.
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/1
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] l2-multicast-bind vlan 10 mvlan 2
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/2
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] l2-multicast-bind vlan 10 mvlan 3
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] quit
Step 4 Add GE1/0/0 to the multicast VLANs, and add GE1/0/1 and GE1/0/2 to the user VLAN.
# Add GE1/0/0 to multicast VLANs 2 and 3 as a trunk interface.
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/0
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port link-type trunk
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port trunk allow-pass vlan 2 3
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
# Add GE1/0/1 and GE1/0/2 to VLAN 10 as hybrid interfaces.
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/1
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port hybrid
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port hybrid
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/2
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] port hybrid
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] port hybrid
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] quit
pvid vlan 10
untagged vlan 10
pvid vlan 10
untagged vlan 10
Step 5 Verify the configuration.
Run the display l2-multicast-bind [ mvlan vlan-id ] command on the Switch A to view binding
between user VLANs and multicast VLANs.
<SwitchA> display l2-multicast-bind
------------------------------------------------------------------Port
Startvlan
Endvlan
Mvlan
------------------------------------------------------------------GigabitEthernet1/0/1
10
-2
GigabitEthernet1/0/2
10
-3
------------------------------------------------------------------Total Table(s) : 2
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of the Switch A
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 2 to 3 10
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
66
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration
#
igmp-snooping enable
#
vlan 2
igmp-snooping enable
multicast-vlan enable
#
vlan 3
igmp-snooping enable
multicast-vlan enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 2 to 3
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
l2-multicast-bind vlan 10 mvlan 2
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
l2-multicast-bind vlan 10 mvlan 3
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
67
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
4
IGMP Configuration
About This Chapter
This chapter describes the procedure for configuring IGMP and commands for maintaining
IGMP, and provides configuration examples.
4.1 Introduction to IGMP
This section describes the principle of IGMP.
4.2 IGMP Features Supported by the S9700
This section describes IGMP features supported by the S9700.
4.3 Configuring Basic IGMP Functions
This section describes how to configure and apply IGMP.
4.4 Setting the Parameters of IGMP Features
This section describes how to set the parameters of IGMP features.
4.5 Configuring SSM Mapping
This section describes the applications of SSM mapping and the method of configuring SSM
mapping.
4.6 Configuration IGMP Limit Function
This section describes how to configure the IGMP limit function.
4.7 Maintaining IGMP
This section describes how to maintain IGMP.
4.8 Configuration Examples
This section provides several configuration examples of IGMP.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
68
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
4.1 Introduction to IGMP
This section describes the principle of IGMP.
In the TCP/IP protocol suite, the Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) manages IPv4
multicast members. It sets up and maintains the multicast membership between IP hosts and
adjacent multicast routers.
As a routing switch, the S9700 supports IP multicast. When IGMP is configured, the S9700 can
be used as a multicast switch. IGMP is the signaling mechanism of the host towards the
S9700, which is used by IP multicast in an end user network. IGMP needs to be enabled on hosts
and on S9700s.
NOTE
l Whether the host supports IGMP depends on the used operating system.
l The switch mentioned in the following contents is an S9700 supporting the Layer 3 multicast protocol
and multicast router function.
l
All receiver hosts that participate in multicast transmission must be enabled with IGMP.
A host can join or leave a multicast group at any time and from any position. The number
of members of a multicast group is not limited.
l
Through IGMP, a multicast L3 device can know whether there is a multicast group receiver,
namely, a group member, on the network segment to which an interface of the router is
connected. Each host needs to save only the information about the groups that the host itself
joins.
At present, IGMP has three versions: IGMPv1 (defined by RFC 1112), IGMPv2 (defined by
RFC 2236), and IGMPv3 (defined by RFC 3376). All IGMP versions support the Any-Source
Multicast (ASM) model. IGMPv3 can be directly applied to the Source-Specific Multicast
(SSM) model, while IGMPv1 and IGMPv2 require the support of SSM mapping.
4.2 IGMP Features Supported by the S9700
This section describes IGMP features supported by the S9700.
Basic IGMP Functions
The basic IGMP features that the S9700 supports are as follows:
l
Supporting IGMPv1, IGMPv2, and IGMPv3 and configurable version.
l
Supporting the static IGMP.
l
Configuring the range of multicast groups that an interface can join.
Router-Alert Option
IGMPv2 and IGMPv3 have the Group-Specific and Source/Group-Specific Query messages.
The groups are varied and an S9700 cannot join all groups. Therefore, the IGMP needs to use
the Router-Alert option. Then the IGMP can send messages for the groups that the local
S9700 does not join to the upper-level protocol for processing.
You can determine whether to set the Router-Alert option in the IGMP messages to be sent and
whether the received IGMP messages must contain the Router-Alert option.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
69
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
IGMP Query Controller
For IGMPv1, you can set the interval for sending General Query messages and robustness
variable.
NOTE
IGMPv1 does not support querier election. Therefore, you need to enable PIM for querier election.
For IGMPv2, you can set the interval for sending General Query messages, robustness variable,
maximum response duration of IGMP Query messages, and IGMP prompt leave.
For IGMPv3, you can set the interval for sending General Query messages, robustness variable,
and maximum response time of IGMP Query messages.
SSM-Mapping
An S9700 can serve hosts of IGMPv1 and IGMPv2 after you configure SSM-Mapping on the
S9700.
IGMP Limit
l
The function of IGMP Limit is applicable to IPv4 PIM-SM and IPv4 PIM-DM networks.
To limit the number of users accessing IP core networks, you can configure the IGMP limit
function.
– Configure the maximum number of global IGMP group memberships on a S9700.
– Configure the maximum number of IGMP group memberships on an interface.
NOTE
If the IGMP limit function is required to be configured globally, and for an interface on the same
S9700, it is recommended that the limits on the number of global IGMP group memberships, and the
number of IGMP group memberships on the interface should be in descending order.
4.3 Configuring Basic IGMP Functions
This section describes how to configure and apply IGMP.
4.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
IGMP is applied to the network segment in which a host is connected to an S9700. IGMP needs
to run on both the S9700 and the host. The following contents describe how to configure IGMP
on an S9700.
You must enable IP multicast routing before configuring IGMP. IP multicast routing is the
prerequisite of configuring all multicast functions. If IP multicast routing is disabled, the
multicast-related configurations cannot take effect.
IGMP needs to be enabled on the VLANIF interface that is connected to the host. The matching
IGMP version needs to be configured on the S9700 and host because the IGMP messages vary
according to version. The later version on the S9700 side is compatible with the earlier version
on the host side. Other configurations can be performed only after IGMP is enabled.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
70
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
The host where the IGMP is run responds to the IGMP Query message of the S9700. If the host
gives no response and the operation times out, the S9700 considers that the multicast group does
not contain any member on the network segment and cancels data forwarding.
To enable hosts on the network segment of the interface to join the specified groups and receive
packets from the groups, you can set an ACL on the related interface to limit the range of groups
that the interface serves.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring basic IGMP functions, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring the parameters of the link layer protocol and the IP address of the interface to
enable the link-layer protocol
l
Configuring the unicast routing protocol to ensure that IP routes between nodes are
reachable
Data Preparation
To configure basic IGMP functions, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
ID of the VLAN to which the interface
communicating with the host belongs
2
IGMP version
3
IP addresses of the multicast group and
multicast source
4
ACL rule for filtering multicast groups
4.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast
Context
The IP multicast function is the prerequisite of configuring other multicast protocols. Do as
follows on the S9700 connected to a host.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 (Optional) Run:
assign multicast-resource-mode optimize
The multicast forwarding table is optimized.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
71
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
If a multicast forwarding table needs to contain more than 4096 entries, run this command to
optimize the multicast forwarding table before enabling IP multicast routing.
Step 3 Run:
multicast routing-enable
IP multicast routing is enabled.
By default, the IP multicast routing function is disabled on an S9700
----End
4.3.3 Enabling the IGMP Function
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
igmp enable
The IGMP function is enabled.
By default, the IGMP function is disabled on an interface.
NOTE
If PIM-SM or PIM-DM is also required on this interface, PIM-SM or PIM-DM must be enabled before
IGMP is enabled.
----End
4.3.4 (Optional) Specifying the IGMP Version
Context
CAUTION
Make sure that all the interfaces on S9700s are configured with IGMP of the same version on
one network segment. By default, IGMPv2 is adopted.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
72
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
igmp version { 1 | 2 | 3 }
The IGMP version is specified on the interface.
----End
4.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Static IGMP Group
Context
After an interface is added to a multicast group statically, the S9700 considers that multicast
group members exist on the network segment that the interface belongs to. Therefore, S9700
receives the multicast data sent to the multicast group.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type
interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
igmp static-group group-address [ inc-step-mask { group-mask | group-mask-length }
number group-number ] [ source source-address ]
The interface is added to the multicast group or multicast source group statically.
If a loopback interface is used, the S9700 forwards the received data only when a user demands
the data. In this case, the bandwidth usage is reduced. If a VLANIF interface is adopted, the
S9700 forwards the received data directly.
If a loopback interface is used, the S9700 forwards the received data only when a user requests
the data. This reduces the CPU usage. VLANIF interfaces, POS interfaces, and IP-Trunk
interfaces forward multicast data immediately.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
73
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
By default, an interface is not statically added to any multicast group.
----End
4.3.6 (Optional) Configuring an IGMP Multicast Group Policy
Context
To enable hosts on the network to which the interface is connected to join the specified multicast
groups and to receive messages from the groups, you need to set an ACL rule on the related
interface to filter the received messages. In this case, the range of groups that the interface serves
can be limited.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type
interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
igmp group-policy { acl-number | acl-name acl-name } [ 1 | 2 | 3 ]
The range of multicast groups that the interface can join is configured.
By default, an interface can join any multicast group.
----End
4.3.7 Checking the Configuration
Prerequisites
The configuration of basic IGMP functions is complete.
Procedure
l
Run the display igmp interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command
to check the configuration and running status of IGMP on an interface.
l
Run the display igmp group [ group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * static command to check the information about the members of the static IGMP
multicast group.
l
Run the display igmp group[ group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * [ verbose ] command to check the information about the members that
dynamically join the IGMP multicast group.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
74
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
Example
Run the display igmp interface vlanif 3 command to check the configuration of IGMP on
VLANIF 3.
<Quidway> display igmp interface vlanif 3
Interface information
Vlanif10
(100.0.0.3):
IGMP is enabled
Current IGMP version is 2
IGMP state: up
IGMP group policy: none
IGMP limit: Value of query interval for IGMP (negotiated): Value of query interval for IGMP (configured): 60 s
Value of other querier timeout for IGMP: Value of maximum query response time for IGMP: 10 s
Querier for IGMP: 100.0.0.3 (this router)
Run the display igmp group static command to check the information about the static IGMP
multicast group.
<Quidway> display igmp group static
Static join group information
Total 2 entries, Total 2 active entries
Group Address
Source Address Interface
225.0.0.10
0.0.0.0
Loop1
232.1.1.20
10.0.0.1
Vlanif3
State
UP
UP
Expires
never
never
4.4 Setting the Parameters of IGMP Features
This section describes how to set the parameters of IGMP features.
Context
By default, IGMP can work normally. In the S9700, you can change the values of related
parameters according to the specific network environment. You can perform the following
configurations as required.
NOTE
l The configuration in the IGMP view is valid globally. The configuration in the interface view is valid
only for the specific interface.
l If this command is configured in the interface view and the IGMP view, the values set in the interface
view are preferred. If this command is not configured in the interface view, the values configured in
the IGMP view are valid.
4.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
IGMPv2 and IGMPv3 have the Group-Specific and Source/Group-Specific Query messages.
The groups are varied and an S9700 cannot join all groups. Therefore, the IGMP needs to use
the Router-Alert option. Then the IGMP can send messages for the groups that the local device
does not join to the upper protocol for processing.
The IGMP querier periodically sends IGMP Query messages on the shared network connected
to receivers. When receiving a Report message from a member, the querier updates information
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
75
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
about the membership. If non-queriers do not receive any General Query message within the
Keepalive period of the IGMP querier, the querier is considered faulty, and a new round of the
querier election is triggered automatically.
In some cases, one host matches a port. Therefore, a querier matches only one receiver host.
When a receiver host switches between multiple groups frequently, you can enable the prompt
leave mechanism on the querier.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring IGMP message options and timers, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring the unicast routing protocol to make the IP routes of nodes be reachable
l
4.3 Configuring Basic IGMP Functions
Data Preparation
To configure IGMP message options and related timers, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Whether the Router-Alert option is contained
in the packet
2
Interval for sending IGMP General Query
messages
3
IGMP robustness variable
4
Maximum response duration of the IGMP
Query messages
5
Keepalive period of the other IGMP queriers
6
Interval for sending IGMP Group-Specific
Query messages
7
ACL that limits the application range of
prompt leave
4.4.2 Configuring IGMP Message Options
Context
The Router-Alert option requires the S9700 to send the received IGMP messages that have not
been added to IGMP groups to the upper layer protocol. By default, the S9700 sends IGMP
messages containing the Router-Alert option, but does not check the Router-Alert option in the
received messages. That is, the S9700 processes all the received IGMP messages, regardless
whether the messages contain the Router-Alert option. If require-router-alert is configured,
the S9700 checks this option.
The Router-Alert option can be configured globally or on an interface.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
76
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
l
The global configuration is valid on each interface.
l
The configuration on an interface is valid only for the specific interface. The configuration
on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the Router-Alert option
is not configured on the interface, the global configuration is used.
l
Configuring IGMP message options globally
Procedure
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
igmp
The IGMP view is displayed.
3.
Run:
require-router-alert
The S9700 is configured to ignore the IGMP messages that do not contain the RouterAlert option.
4.
Run:
send-router-alert
The S9700 is configured to add the Router-Alert option to the IGMP message header.
NOTE
After you run the send-router-alert command, information about the Router-Alert option will
not be displayed when you view the current configuration. To view information about the
Router-Alert option, run the undo send-router-alert command first.
l
Configuring IGMP message options for the interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
igmp require-router-alert
The S9700 is configured to ignore the IGMP messages that do not contain the RouterAlert option.
4.
Run:
igmp send-router-alert
The S9700 is configured to add the Router-Alert option to the IGMP message header.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
77
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
NOTE
After you run the igmp send-router-alert command, information about the Router-Alert
option will not be displayed when you view the current configuration. To view information
about the Router-Alert option, run the undo igmp send-router-alert command first.
----End
4.4.3 Configuring the IGMPv1 Querier
Context
The IGMP querier can be configured globally or on an interface.
l
The global configuration is valid on each interface.
l
The configuration on an interface is valid only for the specific interface. The configuration
on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the IGMP querier is not
configured on the interface, the global configuration is used.
When the IGMP version is IGMPv1, the configurable parameters of the IGMP querier include
the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages and IGMP robustness variable.
Procedure
l
Configuring the global IGMP querier
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
igmp
The IGMP view is displayed.
3.
Run:
timer query interval
The interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is set.
By default, the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is 60 seconds.
4.
Run:
robust-count robust-value
The IGMP robustness variable is set.
When the S9700 starts, the S9700 sends General Query messages robust-value times.
The interval between the messages is 1/4 of the interval for sending IGMP General
Query messages. By default, the robustness variable is 2.
l
Configuring the IGMP querier on an interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
78
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
igmp timer query interval
The interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is set.
By default, the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is 60 seconds.
4.
Run:
igmp robust-count robust-value
The IGMP robustness variable is set.
When the S9700 starts, the S9700 sends General Query messages robust-value times.
The interval between the messages is 1/4 of the interval for sending IGMP General
Query messages. By default, the robustness variable is 2.
----End
4.4.4 Configuring the IGMPv2 or IGMPv3 Querier
Context
The IGMP querier can be configured globally or on an interface.
l
The global configuration is valid on each interface.
l
The configuration on an interface is valid only for the specified interface. The configuration
on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the IGMP querier is not
configured on the interface, the global configuration is used.
When the version of IGMP is IGMPv2 or IGMPv3, the configurable parameters of the IGMP
querier include the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages, interval for sending
IGMP Group-Specific Query messages, maximum response time for IGMP Query messages,
Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers, and IGMP robustness variable.
NOTE
In actual configuration, ensure that the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is greater than
the maximum response time for IGMP Query messages and is smaller than the Keepalive period of other
IGMP queriers.
Procedure
l
Configuring the IGMP querier globally
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
igmp
The IGMP view is displayed.
3.
Run:
timer query interval
The interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is set.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
79
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
By default, the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is 60 seconds.
4.
Run:
robust-count robust-value
The IGMP robustness variable is set.
– When the system starts, the system sends General Query messages for a number
of times specified by the value of the robustness variable. The interval for sending
General Query messages is 1/4 of the interval for sending IGMP General Query
messages.
– When receiving a Leave message, the S9700 sends the IGMP Group-Specific
Query messages for the time specified by the value of the robustness variable at
the interval that you set.
By default, the robustness variable is 2.
5.
Run:
max-response-time interval
The maximum response time for an IGMP Query message is set.
By default, the maximum response time for an IGMP Query message is 10 seconds.
6.
Run:
timer other-querier-present interval
The Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers is set.
By default, the Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers = Robustness variable x
Interval for sending General Query messages + Maximum response time x 1/2. When
the values of the parameters in the formula are the default values, the Keepalive period
of other IGMP queriers is 125 seconds.
7.
Run:
lastmember-queryinterval interval
The interval at which S9700 sends IGMP Group-Specific Query messages is set.
By default, the interval for sending IGMP Group-Specific Query messages is 1 second.
l
Configuring the IGMP querier on an interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
igmp timer query interval
The interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is set.
By default, the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is 60 seconds.
4.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Run:
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
80
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
igmp robust-count robust-value
The IGMP robustness variable is set.
– When the system starts, the system sends General Query messages for a number
of times specified by the value of the robustness variable. The interval for sending
messages is 1/4 of the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages.
– When receiving a Leave message, the S9700 sends IGMP Group-Specific Query
messages for the time specified by the value of the robustness variable at the
interval that you set.
By default, the robustness variable is 2.
5.
Run:
igmp max-response-time interval
The maximum response time for IGMP Query messages is set.
By default, the maximum response time for an IGMP Query message is 10 seconds.
6.
Run:
igmp timer other-querier-present interval
The Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers is set.
By default, Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers = Robustness variable x Interval
for sending General Query messages + Maximum response time x 1/2. When the
values of the parameters to the right of the equal mark are the default values, the
Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers is 125 seconds.
7.
Run:
igmp lastmember-queryinterval interval
The interval at which the S9700 sends IGMP Group-Specific Query messages is set.
By default, the interval for sending IGMP Group-Specific Query messages is 1 second.
8.
Run:
igmp on-demand
The (S, G) entry never times out. The interface does not send IGMP Query messages.
By default, the interface sends Query messages and participates in querier election.
NOTE
Both IGMPv2 and IGMPv3 support the igmp on-demand command.
----End
4.4.5 Configuring IGMP Prompt Leave
Context
After receiving a Leave message from a host, the querier reports the message to the upstream
router instead of sending a Last Member Query message. This process is called IGMP prompt
leave. In this manner, the delay in response is reduced and the bandwidth occupied by various
messages is saved.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
81
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
NOTE
l
IGMP prompt leave is applicable to IGMPv2 and IGMPv3.
l
When the IGMP version is IGMPv1, the IGMP prompt leave does not take effect even if there is
information about this function in current configuration.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
VLANIF Interface view, POS Interface view, IP-Trunk Interface view, Loopback interface view
Step 3 Run:
igmp prompt-leave [ group-policy basic-acl-number ]
The S9700 leaves the group immediately without sending the Last Member Query message.
By default, the S9700 sends the Last Member Query message after receiving a Leave message
from a host.
----End
4.4.6 Checking the Configuration
Prerequisites
The configuration of basic IGMP functions and parameters is complete.
Procedure
l
Run the display igmp group [ group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * [ static | verbose ] command to check the information about members of an
IGMP multicast group.
l
Run the display igmp interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command
to check the configuration and running status of IGMP on the interface.
l
Run the display igmp routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-masklength } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] ]* [ static ]
command to check the information about the IGMP routing table.
Run the preceding command, and you can obtain the following result:
– The membership information of the IGMP multicast group is correct.
– The configuration and running status of IGMP on an S9700 interface are correct.
– A matched multicast forwarding interface exists in the downstream list of the (*, G) or
(S, G) entry.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
82
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
Example
Run the display igmp group interface vlanif 3 static command, and you can view the IGMP
configuration on VLANIF 3.
<Quidway> display igmp group interface vlanif 3 static
Static join group information
Total 2 entries
Specified interface state:UP
Total 2 entries matched
Group Address
232.1.1.1
225.0.0.10
Source Address
10.0.0.1
0.0.0.0
Expires
never
never
Run the display igmp routing-table command, and you can view the IGMP routing table.
NOTE
The IGMP routing table is generated only after PIM is enabled.
<Quidway> display igmp routing-table
Total 1 entry
00001. (*, 225.0.0.10)
List of 1 downstream interface
Vlanif3 (100.0.0.3),
Protocol: STATIC
4.5 Configuring SSM Mapping
This section describes the applications of SSM mapping and the method of configuring SSM
mapping.
4.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
In the network segment where the SSM model is used to provide multicast services, some hosts
must run IGMPv1 or IGMPv2 because of some limitations. To provide services for these hosts,
you need to configure the SSM static mapping on S9700s.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring SSM mapping, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring the unicast routing protocol to ensure that the IP routes between nodes are
reachable
l
4.3.3 Enabling the IGMP Function
Data Preparation
To configure SSM mapping, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
83
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
No.
Data
1
Interface that needs to be enabled with SSM
mapping
2
Addresses and masks of the multicast group
and multicast source
4.5.2 Enabling SSM Mapping
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
igmp enable
The IGMP function is enabled.
Step 4 Run:
igmp version 3
The version number of IGMP is set to 3.
To ensure that hosts running any IGMP version on the network segment can obtain SSM services,
it is recommended to run IGMPv3 on the S9700 interface.
Step 5 Run:
igmp ssm-mapping enable
SSM mapping is enabled.
----End
4.5.3 Configuring the SSM Mapping Policy
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
84
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
Step 2 Run:
igmp
The IGMP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
ssm-mapping group-address { mask | mask-length } source-address
An SSM group is mapped to a source.
The IP addresses of SSM groups range from 232.0.0.0 to 232.255.255.255. You can run the
command repeatedly to map an SSM group to multiple sources.
l group-address { mask | mask-length }: specifies the group address and mask.
l source-address: specifies the address of the source mapping the SSM group.
----End
4.5.4 Checking the Configuration
Prerequisites
The configuration of SSM mapping is complete.
Procedure
l
Run the display igmp group [ group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ]* ssm-mapping [ verbose ] command to check the address of a specific source or
group.
l
Run the display igmp ssm-mapping { group [ group-address ] | interface [ interfacetype interface-number ] } command to check the information about SSM mapping of a
specific source or group.
----End
Example
Run the display igmp ssm-mapping group [ group-address ] command, and you can view the
information about SSM mapping of a specified group address.
<Quidway> display igmp ssm-mapping group 232.0.0.1
IGMP SSM-Mapping conversion table of VPN-Instance: public net
Total 2 entries
2 entries matched
00001. (10.0.0.1, 232.0.0.1)
00002. (10.0.0.2, 232.0.0.1)
Total 2 entries matched
Run the display igmp ssm-mapping interface interface-type interface-number command, and
you can view information about SSM mapping on a specified interface.
<Quidway> display igmp ssm-mapping interface vlanif 3
Info: IGMP SSM-Mapping is enabled
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
85
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
4.6 Configuration IGMP Limit Function
This section describes how to configure the IGMP limit function.
4.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
To limit IPTV ICPs and the number of users accessing IP core networks, you can configure the
IGMP limit function.
The IGMP limit function is configured on the last-hop S9700 connected to users. You can
perform the following configurations as required:
l
Configure the maximum number of global IGMP group memberships on a S9700.
l
Configure the maximum number of IGMP entries in a single instance.
l
Configure the maximum number of IGMP group memberships on an interface.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring the IGMP limit function, complete the following task:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
4.3 Configuring Basic IGMP Functions
Data Preparation
To configure the IGMP limit function, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Maximum number of global IGMP group memberships
2
Maximum number of IGMP group memberships in a single instance
3
Maximum number of IGMP group memberships on an interface
4.6.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global IGMP Group
Memberships
Context
Do as follows on the S9700 connected to hosts.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
86
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
igmp global limit number
The maximum number of global IGMP entries of all instances is set.
----End
4.6.3 Setting the Maximum Number of Global IGMP Entries for an
Instance
Context
Do as follows on the S9700 connected to user hosts.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
igmp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The IGMP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
limit number
The maximum number of global IGMP entries of an instance is set.
----End
4.6.4 Configuring the Maximum Number of IGMP Group
Memberships on an Interface
Context
Do as follows on the S9700 connected to hosts.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The IGMP interface view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
87
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
igmp limit number
The maximum number of IGMP group memberships is set on the interface.
----End
4.6.5 Checking the Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the display igmp interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command
to check the configuration and running of IGMP on an interface.
----End
4.7 Maintaining IGMP
This section describes how to maintain IGMP.
4.7.1 Clearing the Information About an IGMP Group
Context
CAUTION
The IGMP group that an interface dynamically joins is deleted after you run the reset igmp
group command. Receivers may not receive multicast information normally. Therefore, confirm
the action before run the command.
You can run the following commands to clear the information about an IGMP group in the user
view.
Procedure
l
Run the reset igmp group { all | interface interface-type interface-number { all | groupaddress [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] [ source-address [ mask { sourcemask | source-mask-length } ] ] } } command to clear the IGMP group that the interface
already dynamically joins.
----End
4.7.2 Monitoring the Running Status of IGMP
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
88
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
Context
To check the running status of IGMP during routine maintenance, run the following display
commands in any view.
Procedure
l
Run the display igmp group [ group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] [ static ] [ verbose ] command to check the information about the IGMP multicast
group.
l
Run the display igmp group ssm-mapping [ verbose ] command to check the information
about the multicast group that is already configured with SSM mapping.
l
Run the display igmp interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command
to check the configuration and running status of IGMP on the interface.
l
Run the display igmp routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-masklength } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] ]* [ static ]
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] command to check the information about the
IGMP routing table.
l
Run the display igmp ssm-mapping { group [ group-address ] | interface [ interfacetype interface-number ] } command to check the information about SSM mapping of a
specific source or group.
----End
4.7.3 Debugging IGMP
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging
all command to disable it immediately.
Procedure
l
Run the debugging igmp { all | event | leave | report | query | timer } command to enable
the debugging of IGMP.
l
Run the debugging igmp ssm-mapping [ advanced-acl-number ] command to enable the
debugging of SSM mapping.
----End
4.8 Configuration Examples
This section provides several configuration examples of IGMP.
4.8.1 Example for Configuring Basic IGMP Functions
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
89
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
Networking Requirements
On the network as shown in Figure 4-1, the unicast routing function is normal. You are required
to implement multicast on the network to enable hosts to receive the Video On Demand (VOD)
information.
When the hosts connected to a certain interface need to receive a popular program for a long
time, you can add the interface to a multicast group statically. As shown in the following figure,
if HostA needs to receive the multicast data from the multicast group 225.1.1.1 for a long time,
you need to add GE 1/0/0 on the SwitchA to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically.
Figure 4-1 Networking diagram for configuring basic IGMP functions
Ethernet
HostA
SwitchA
GE1/0/0
GE2/0/0
N1
Receiver
HostB
SwitchB
PIM
network
Leaf
network
GE1/0/0
GE2/0/0
HostC
Receiver
SwitchC
GE2/0/0
N2
GE1/0/0
HostD
Ethernet
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 10
10.110.1.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 11
192.168.1.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 20
10.110.2.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 21
192.168.2.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 20
10.110.2.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 31
192.168.3.1/24
SwitchB
SwitchC
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Enable multicast on all Switches providing multicast services.
2.
Enable PIM-SM on all the interfaces on Switch.
3.
Enable IGMP on the interfaces on the host side.
4.
Add VLANIF 10 on SwitchA to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
90
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
l
Version of IGMP running between Switches and hosts
l
Static multicast group address: 225.1.1.1
NOTE
This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure IGMP.
Procedure
Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch.
Configure the IP address and mask of each interface according to Figure 4-1. Configure OSPF
to ensure the communication between SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC on the network layer,
and to ensure the dynamic update through the unicast routing protocol.
For details on how to configure IP addresses of interfaces, see OSPF Configuration in the
S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Service. For details on how to configure
OSPF, see IP Addresses Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide
- IP Routing.
Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-SM on all interfaces.
# Enable multicast on SwitchA and enable PIM-SM on all interfaces. The configurations of
SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here.
[SwitchA] multicast routing-enable
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 10
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] pim sm
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] quit
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 11
[SwitchA-Vlanif11] pim sm
[SwitchA-Vlanif11] quit
Step 3 Enable IGMP on the interfaces connected to hosts.
# Enable IGMP on VLANIF 10 on SwitchA and configure the IGMP version as IGMPv2. The
configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not
provided here.
NOTE
By default, IGMPv2 is used and you do not need to set the IGMP version here. To use other IGMP versions,
run the igmp version command to set the version.
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 10
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] igmp enable
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] igmp version 2
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] quit
Step 4 Add VLANIF 10 on SwitchA to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically. In this manner, the
hosts connected to VLANIF 10 can steadily receive the multicast data sent to the multicast group
225.1.1.1.
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 10
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] igmp static-group 225.1.1.1
Step 5 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display igmp interface command. You can check the configuration and running status
of IGMP on each interface. For example, the information about IGMP on VLANIF 10 of
SwitchA is as follows:
<SwitchA> display igmp interface vlanif 10
Interface information of VPN-Instance: public net
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
91
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
Vlanif 10(10.110.1.1):
IGMP is enabled
Current IGMP version is 2
IGMP state: up
IGMP group policy: none
IGMP limit: Value of query interval for IGMP (negotiated): Value of query interval for IGMP (configured): 60 s
Value of other querier timeout for IGMP: 0 s
Value of maximum query response time for IGMP: 10 s
Querier for IGMP: 10.110.1.1 (this router)
# Run the display igmp routing-table command on SwitchA. You can check whether VLANIF
10 is added to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically. If the (*, 225.1.1.1) entry exists on
SwitchA, the downstream interface is VLANIF 10, and the protocol type is STATIC, you can
infer that VLANIF 10 is added to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically.
<SwitchA> display igmp routing-table
Routing table of VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 entry
00001. (*, 225.1.1.1)
List of 1 downstream interface
Vlanif10 (10.110.1.1),
Protocol: STATIC
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 10 11
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif10
ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
igmp static-group 225.1.1.1
#
interface Vlanif11
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
#
interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 11
port hybrid untagged vlan 11
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchB
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 20 21
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
92
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif20
ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
#
interface Vlanif21
ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 20
port hybrid untagged vlan 20
#
interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 21
port hybrid untagged vlan 21
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 20 31
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif20
ip address 10.110.2.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
#
interface Vlanif31
ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 20
port hybrid untagged vlan 20
#
interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 31
port hybrid untagged vlan 31
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
4.8.2 Example for Configuring SSM Mapping
Networking Requirements
On the multicast network as shown in Figure 4-2, PIM-SM is run and ASM and SSM models
are used to provide multicast services. IGMPv3 is run on the interface on the Switch connected
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
93
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
to the Receiver. The IGMP version on the Receiver is IGMPv2 and cannot be upgraded to
IGMPv3.
The range of SSM group addresses on the current network is 232.1.1.0/24. S1, S2, and S3 send
multicast data to the multicast group whose IP address is in this range. The Receiver receives
the multicast data only from S1 and S3.
Solution: Configure SSM mapping on SwitchD.
Figure 4-2 Networking of the SSM mapping configuration
S2
133.133.2.1/24 SwitchB
GE3/0/0
GE1/0/0
S3
SwitchC 133.133.3.1/24
GE3/0/0
GE1/0/0
GE2/0/0
GE2/0/0
S1
133.133.1.1/24
GE1/0/0
PIM-SM
GE2/0/0
SwitchA
GE3/0/0
GE2/0/0
Receiver
133.133.4.1/24
GE1/0/0
GE3/0/0
SwitchD
Switch
Physical interfaces
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 10
133.133.1.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 20
192.168.1.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 30
192.168.4.2/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 11
133.133.2.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 20
192.168.1.2/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 31
192.168.2.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 12
133.133.3.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 21
192.168.3.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 31
192.168.2.2/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 13
133.133.4.2/24
GE2/0/0
VLANIF 21
192.168.3.2/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 30
192.168.4.1/24
SwitchB
SwitchC
SwitchD
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Enable SSM mapping on the interfaces of the Switches connected to hosts.
2.
Set the range of SSM group addresses on all the Switches in the PIM-SM domain.
3.
Configure the static SSM mapping rules on the Switches where SSM mapping is enabled.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
94
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
l
Range of SSM multicast groups
l
IP addresses of Source 1 and Source 3
NOTE
This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure SSM mapping.
Procedure
Step 1 Create VLANs and add interfaces to the VLANs.
Step 2 Configure the IP address of each VLANIF and the unicast routing protocol according to Figure
4-2.
Step 3 Enable IGMP and SSM mapping on the interfaces connected to hosts.
[SwitchD] multicast routing-enable
[SwitchD] interface vlanif 13
[SwitchD-Vlanif13] igmp enable
[SwitchD-Vlanif13] igmp version 3
[SwitchD-Vlanif13] igmp ssm-mapping enable
[SwitchD-Vlanif13] quit
Step 4 Configure the range of SSM group addresses.
# Set the range of SSM group addresses to 232.1.1.0/24 on all Switches. The configurations of
SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to configuration of SwitchA, and are not mentioned
here.
[SwitchA] acl number 2000
[SwitchA-acl-basic-2000] rule permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
[SwitchA-acl-basic-2000] quit
[SwitchA] pim
[SwitchA-pim] ssm-policy 2000
Step 5 Configure static SSM mapping rules on the Switches connected to hosts.
# Map the multicast group in the range of 232.1.1.0/24 to Source 1 and Source 3.
[SwitchD] igmp
[SwitchD-igmp] ssm-mapping 232.1.1.0 24 133.133.1.1
[SwitchD-igmp] ssm-mapping 232.1.1.0 24 133.133.3.1
# Check the information about SSM mapping of specific sources and group addresses on
Switches.
<SwitchD> display igmp ssm-mapping group
IGMP SSM-Mapping conversion table of VPN-Instance: public net
Total 2 entries
2 entries matched
00001. (133.133.1.1, 232.1.1.0)
00002. (133.133.3.1, 232.1.1.0)
Total 2 entries matched
Step 6 Verify the configuration.
# The Receiver joins the group 232.1.1.1.
# Run the display igmp group ssm-mapping command to view the information about the
specific sources or group addresses on the Switches. Take the information about the specific
source or group address on SwitchD for example:
<SwitchD> display igmp group ssm-mapping
IGMP SSM mapping interface group report information of VPN-Instance: public net
Vlanif10 (133.133.4.2):
Total 1 IGMP SSM-Mapping Group reported
Group Address
Last Reporter
Uptime
Expires
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
95
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
232.1.1.1
4 IGMP Configuration
133.133.4.1
00:01:44
00:00:26
<SwitchD> display igmp group ssm-mapping verbose
Interface group report information of VPN-Instance: public net
Vlanif10 (133.133.4.2):
Total entry on this interface: 1
Total 1 IGMP SSM-Mapping Group reported
Group: 232.1.1.1
Uptime: 00:01:52
Expires: 00:00:18
Last reporter: 133.133.4.1
Last-member-query-counter: 0
Last-member-query-timer-expiry: off
Group mode: exclude
Version1-host-present-timer-expiry: off
Version2-host-present-timer-expiry: 00:00:17
# Run the display pim routing-table command to view the PIM-SM multicast routing table on
a Switch. Take the information displayed on SwitchD for example:
<SwitchD> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 2 (S, G) entries
(133.133.1.1, 232.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.3.2
Protocol: pim-ssm, Flag:
UpTime: 00:11:25
Upstream interface: Vlanif30
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.2
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif13
Protocol: pim-ssm, UpTime: 00:11:25, Expires:(133.133.3.1, 232.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.3.2
Protocol: pim-ssm, Flag:
UpTime: 00:11:25
Upstream interface: Vlanif21
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.3.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.3.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif13
Protocol: pim-ssm, UpTime: 00:11:25, Expires:-
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 10 20 30
#
multicast routing-enable
#
acl number 2000
rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
interface Vlanif10
ip address 133.133.1.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif20
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
96
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif30
ip address 192.168.4.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 20
port hybrid untagged vlan 20
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 30
port hybrid untagged vlan 30
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 133.133.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255
#
pim
ssm-policy 2000
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchB
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 11 20 31
#
multicast routing-enable
#
acl number 2000
rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
interface Vlanif11
ip address 133.133.2.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif20
ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif31
ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 11
port hybrid untagged vlan 11
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 20
port hybrid untagged vlan 20
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 31
port hybrid untagged vlan 31
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 133.133.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
97
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
pim
ssm-policy 2000
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 12 21 31
#
multicast routing-enable
#
acl number 2000
rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
interface Vlanif12
ip address 133.133.3.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif21
ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif31
ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 12
port hybrid untagged vlan 12
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 21
port hybrid untagged vlan 21
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 31
port hybrid untagged vlan 31
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 133.133.3.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
#
pim
ssm-policy 2000
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchD
#
sysname SwitchD
#
vlan batch 13 21 30
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif13
ip address 133.133.4.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
igmp version 3
igmp ssm-mapping enable
#
interface Vlaniaf21
ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
98
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
interface Vlanif30
ip address 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 13
port hybrid untagged vlan 13
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 21
port hybrid untagged vlan 21
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 30
port hybrid untagged vlan 30
#
pim
ssm-policy 2000
#
acl number 2000
rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
igmp
ssm-mapping 232.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 133.133.1.1
ssm-mapping 232.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 133.133.3.1
#
return
4.8.3 Example for Configuring IGMP Limit
Networking Requirements
When many users are watching multiple video programs, they occupy high bandwidth. As a
result, the device performance degrades and the multicast data received by users is unstable.
The traditional multicast technologies control the multicast networks by limiting the number of
multicast forwarding entries or the number of outgoing interfaces in a multicast forwarding entry.
These technologies, however, cannot flexibly manage the real-time video services or available
resources on the IPTV network.
The IGMP limit function allows users to plan network resources properly and limit the number
of multicast groups that users can join. As shown in Figure 4-3, the IGMP limit for the entire
system, an instance, and an interface needs to be configured on SwitchA, SwitchB, and
SwitchC connected to user hosts to limit the number of multicast groups that users can join.
When the number of users in a multicast group reaches the upper limit, no IGMP entry can be
created for the multicast group. This ensures that the multicast data received by the users in the
multicast group is stable.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
99
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
Figure 4-3 Networking diagram of IGMP limit
Ethernet
HostA
Receiver
SwitchA
GE2/0/0
192.168.1.1/24
GE2/0/0
192.168.2.1/24
PIM network
N1
GE1/0/0
10.110.1.1/24
SwitchB GE1/0/0
10.110.2.1/24
HostB
Leaf network
HostC
Receiver
SwitchC GE1/0/0
10.110.2.2/24
N2
HostD
GE2/0/0
192.168.3.1/24
Ethernet
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE1/0/0
VLANIF10
10.110.1.1/24
GE2/0/0
VLANIF11
192.168.1.1/24
GE1/0/0
VLANIF20
10.110.2.1/24
GE2/0/0
VLANIF21
192.168.2.1/24
GE1/0/0
VLANIF20
10.110.3.1/24
GE2/0/0
VLANIF31
192.168.3.1/24
SwitchB
SwitchC
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Enable multicast on all the switches providing multicast services. The multicast function
must be enabled before you enable IGMP.
2.
Enable PIM-SM on all the VLANIF interfaces of the switches.
3.
Enable IGMP on the VLANIF interfaces connected to user hosts.
4.
Add GE1/0/0 of SwitchA to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically to enable user hosts to
receive stable multicast data.
5.
Set the maximum number of IGMP group memberships on SwitchA.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Version of IGMP running between switches and user hosts
l
Static multicast group address, 225.1.1.1
l
Maximum number of member relationships in an IGMP group
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
100
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Enable the multicast function and enable IGMP and PIM-SM on the user-side interfaces.
# Enable the multicast function on SwitchA, enable IGMP and PIM-SM on VLANIF 10, and
set the IGMP version to v2. The configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to the
configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here.
[SwitchA] multicast routing-enable
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid tagged vlan 10
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 10
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] pim sm
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] quit
Step 2 Add GE1/0/0 of SwitchA to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 to enable the user hosts connected to
GE1/0/0 to receive stable multicast data sent to the multicast group 225.1.1.1.
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 10
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] igmp static-group 225.1.1.1
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] quit
Step 3 Set the maximum number of member relationships in the IGMP group on the switch directly
connected to the user hosts.
# Set the maximum number of IGMP member relationships on SwitchA to 50.
[SwitchA] igmp global limit 50
# Set the maximum number of IGMP member relationships in the public network instance to
40.
[SwitchA] igmp
[SwitchA-igmp] limit 40
[SwitchA-igmp] quit
# Set the maximum number of IGMP member relationships on VLANIF 10 matching GE1/0/0
to 30.
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 10
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] igmp limit 30
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] quit
# The configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and
are not provided here.
Step 4 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display igmp interface command to check the configuration and running status of
IGMP on each interface of the switch. The IGMP information on VLANIF 10 of switchA is as
follows:
<SwitchA> display igmp interface vlanif 10
Interface information of VPN-Instance: public net
vlanif10(10.110.1.1):
IGMP is enabled
Current IGMP version is 2
IGMP state: up
IGMP group policy: none
IGMP limit: 30
Value of query interval for IGMP (negotiated): Value of query interval for IGMP (configured): 60 s
Value of other querier timeout for IGMP: 0 s
Value of maximum query response time for IGMP: 10 s
Querier for IGMP: 10.110.1.1 (this router)
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
101
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
You can find that a maximum of 30 IGMP member relationships can be created on VLANIF 10
of SwitchA.
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 10 11
#
igmp global limit 50
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif10
pim sm
igmp enable
igmp limit 30
ip address 10.110.1.1 24
#
interface Vlanif11
ip address 192.168.1.1 24
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 11
port hybrid untagged vlan 11
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
igmp
limit 40
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchB
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 20 21
#
igmp global limit 50
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif20
pim sm
igmp enable
igmp limit 30
ip address 10.110.2.1 24
#
interface Vlanif21
ip address 192.168.2.1 24
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 20
port hybrid untagged vlan 20
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
102
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
4 IGMP Configuration
port hybrid pvid vlan 21
port hybrid untagged vlan 21
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
#
igmp
limit 40
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 20 31
#
igmp global limit 50
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif20
pim sm
igmp enable
igmp limit 30
ip address 10.110.3.1 24
#
interface Vlanif31
ip address 192.168.2.2 24
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 20
port hybrid untagged vlan 20
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 31
port hybrid untagged vlan 31
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.3.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
#
igmp
limit 40
#
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
103
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
5
PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
About This Chapter
The PIM protocol is used to implement multicast routing and data forwarding inside an AS. The
PIM-DM protocol is a multicast routing protocol of dense node. It is applicable to a small-scale
network with densely-distributed members.
5.1 PIM-DM Overview
In the network where multicast group members are densely distributed and each network
segment may have multicast group members, PIM-DM builds a unidirectional and loop-free
SPT from the multicast source to the group member through periodical flooding and pruning.
5.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700
The system can work normally with default PIM-DM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust
parameters related to neighbor discovery, prune, state refresh, graft, and assert according to
specific scenarios. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent
function to enhance the PIM-DM security.
5.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions
Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before enabling IPv4 multicast routing, and enable PIMDM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the PIM-DM network can work
normally.
5.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Multicast Source
A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This
helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream
receivers to enhance security.
5.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbor Relationships
PIM devices exchange Hello messages to set up neighbor relationships and negotiate various
control parameters for controlling the neighbor relationships.
5.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune
When the last member leaves a group, the multicast device sends a Prune message upstream,
requesting the upstream device to execute the prune action. If other downstream devices on the
same network segment need the multicast data for this group, they need to send Join messages
to override the prune action.
5.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh
In a PIM-DM network, the periodic flooding-pruning wastes lots of network resources. To
prevent the pruned interface from forwarding messages because the prune timer times out, you
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
104
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
can enable the State-Refresh function. The multicast device then sends State-Refresh messages
periodically to refresh the prune state of the interface and maintain the SPT.
5.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Graft
To make new members in a network to quickly receive multicast data, a multicast device actively
sends a Graft message through an upstream interface, requesting the upstream device to forward
multicast data to this network segment.
5.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert
If a multicast device can receive multicast data through an downstream interface, this indicates
that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert
message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream
device.
5.10 Configuring PIM Silent Function
The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM.
In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send
the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To
avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state.
5.11 Maintaining PIM-DM (IPv4)
Maintaining PIM-DM involves resetting PIM statistics, monitoring PIM running status and
debugging PIM.
5.12 Configuration Example
Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic PIM-DM network.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
105
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
5.1 PIM-DM Overview
In the network where multicast group members are densely distributed and each network
segment may have multicast group members, PIM-DM builds a unidirectional and loop-free
SPT from the multicast source to the group member through periodical flooding and pruning.
CAUTION
This chapter is concerned only about the PIM-DM configuration in an IPv4 network.
The Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) is a multicast protocol that is independent of unicast
routing protocol such as static route, RIP, OSPF, IS-IS, and BGP. Multicast routing is
independent of unicast routing protocols, except that unicast routing protocols are used to
generate related multicast routing entries.
Based on the Reverse Path Forwarding (RPF), PIM transmits multicast data across a network.
RPF constructs a multicast forwarding tree by using the existing unicast routing information.
When a multicast packet reaches a switch, the switch performs the RPF check first. If the packet
does not pass the RPF check, the switch directly discards the packet.
NOTE
For details about RPF, see IPv4 Multicast Routing Management.
The Protocol Independent Multicast-Dense Mode (PIM-DM) is applicable to a small-scale
network with densely-distributed members.
The functions and location of PIM-DM in a multicast network are shown in Figure 5-1.
Figure 5-1 Location of PIM-DM on the multicast network
IGMP
PIM-DM
Source
Multicast
Server
Receiver
UserA
Receiver
UserB
PIM-DM
PIM-DM
IGMP
Receiver
UserC
Receiver
UserD
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
106
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
The Protocol Independent Multicast-Sparse Mode (PIM-SM) is applicable to a large-scale
network with sparsely-distributed members. For details about PIM-SM, see PIM-SM (IPv4)
Configuration.
5.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700
The system can work normally with default PIM-DM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust
parameters related to neighbor discovery, prune, state refresh, graft, and assert according to
specific scenarios. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent
function to enhance the PIM-DM security.
Controlling the Forwarding of a Multicast Source
You can configure the Keepalive period of a multicast source and the filtering rules based on
multicast sources.
Adjusting Control Parameters for Setting Up Neighbor Relationship
You can set the following control parameters:
l
The interval for sending Hello messages
l
The period for keeping neighbors reachable
l
Whether the Hello messages without the Generation ID option are received
l
The maximum delay for triggering Hello messages
l
Neighbor filtering function: An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the
addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering
rules
Adjusting Control Parameters for Pruning
You can adjust the following control parameters for pruning:
l
The interval for keeping the Prune state of the downstream interface
l
The delay from the time when the current switch receives a Prune message from a
downstream switch to the time when the current switch performs the prune action in the
LAN
l
The period for overriding the prune action
Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh
You can enable or disable State-Refresh, set the interval for sending PIM State-Refresh
messages, set the minimum interval for receiving the next State-Refresh message, and set the
TTL value for forwarding State-Refresh messages on the switch directly connected to the source.
Adjusting Control Parameters for Graft
You can set the interval for retransmitting Graft messages.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
107
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert
You can set the period for a switch to retain the Assert state. The switch that fails in the election
prevents the downstream interface from forwarding multicast data during this period. After the
period expires, the downstream interface continues to forward multicast data.
Attack Defense Using PIM Silent
Some hosts may send a large number of malicious PIM Hello messages, which results in the
suspension of the switch. The PIM Silent function can then be configured on the interfaces
connected to hosts to protect the switch.
PIM Multi-instance
In multi-instance applications, multicast switchs need to maintain the PIM neighbor list and
multicast routing table for different VPN instances and keep the information independent among
multiple instances.
When a switch receives a multicast data packet, the switch needs to distinguish the VPN instance
to which the packet belongs and forward the packet based on the multicast routing table of the
specific VPN instance, or create a PIM multicast routing entry of the VPN instance.
5.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions
Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before enabling IPv4 multicast routing, and enable PIMDM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the PIM-DM network can work
normally.
5.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring basic PIM-DM functions, configure a unicast IPv4 routing protocol.
Applicable Environment
PIM-DM is applicable to a small-scale network, and most network segments of the network have
receivers.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring basic PIM-DM functions, complete the following configuration tasks:
l
Configuring an IPv4 unicast routing protocol
Data Preparation
To configure basic PIM-DM functions, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
No.
Data
1
Type and number of an interface
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
108
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
5.3.2 Enabling IPv4 Multicast Routing
Prior to configuring all IPv4 multicast features, enable IPv4 multicast routing.
Context
CAUTION
The configuration related to the VPN instance is applicable only to the PE switch. If the interface
of the VPN instance connects to hosts, run the commands in Step 3 and Step 4.
Do as follows on the switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 (Optional) Run:
assign multicast-resource-mode optimize
The multicast replication capability of LPUs is improved. If each multicast packet needs to be
replicated into more than 8192 copies, run this command to improve the multicast replication
capability before enabling IP multicast routing.
Step 3 Run:
multicast routing-enable
IPv4 multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance.
Step 4 (Optional) Run:
ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name
The VPN instance view is displayed.
Step 5 (Optional) Run:
ipv4-family
The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address
family view is displayed.
Step 6 (Optional) Run:
multicast routing-enable
IPv4 multicast routing is enabled in the VPN instance IPv4 address family.
----End
5.3.3 Enabling PIM-DM
An interface can set up PIM neighbor relationship with other devices after PIM-DM is enabled
on it.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
109
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
Context
NOTE
PIM-SM and PIM-DM cannot be enabled on an interface at the same time. The PIM mode must be the
same on all the interfaces of the same instance. When switches are distributed in PIM-DM domains, enable
PIM-SM on all non-boundary interfaces.
Do as follows on the switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim dm
PIM-DM is enabled.
After PIM-DM is enabled on the interface and the PIM neighbor relationship is set up between
switches, the protocol packets sent by the PIM neighbors can be processed. You can run the
undo pim dm command to disable PIM-DM on the interface.
----End
5.3.4 Checking the Configuration
After PIM-DM is configured successfully, you can check information about the PIM interface,
PIM neighbor, and PIM routing table through commands..
Procedure
l
Run the command display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ]
interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] to check PIM on
interfaces of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances.
l
Run the command display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ]
neighbor [ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * to
check PIM neighbors of the public network, VPN instance, or all instances.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table of the public network, VPN
instance, or all instances.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
110
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
Example
Run the display pim interface verbose command, and you can view the detailed information
about PIM on the interface in the public network instance.
<Quidway> display pim interface verbose
VPN-Instance: public net
Interface: Vlanif117, PIM version: 2
PIM mode: Dense
PIM state: down
PIM DR: PIM DR Priority (configured): 1
PIM neighbor count: PIM hello interval: 30 s
PIM LAN delay (negotiated): PIM LAN delay (configured): 500 ms
PIM hello override interval (negotiated): PIM hello override interval (configured): 2500 ms
PIM Silent: disabled
PIM neighbor tracking (negotiated): PIM neighbor tracking (configured): disabled
PIM generation ID: PIM require-GenID: disabled
PIM hello hold interval: 105 s
PIM assert hold interval: 180 s
PIM triggered hello delay: 5 s
PIM J/P interval: 60 s
PIM J/P hold interval: 210 s
PIM state-refresh processing: enabled
PIM state-refresh interval: 60 s
PIM graft retry interval: 3 s
PIM state-refresh capability on link: capable
PIM BFD: disabled
PIM dr-switch-delay timer : not configured
Number of routers on link not using DR priority: Number of routers on link not using LAN delay: Number of routers on link not using neighbor tracking: ACL of PIM neighbor policy: ACL of PIM ASM join policy: ACL of PIM SSM join policy: ACL of PIM join policy: -
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
111
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
5.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Multicast Source
A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This
helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream
receivers to enhance security.
5.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-DM are configured, you can configure the lifetime of a multicast
source and source address-based filtering rules as required.
Applicable Environment
This configuration is applicable to all PIM-DM networks.
A PIM switch checks the passing multicast data. By checking whether the data matches the
filtering rule, the switch determines whether to forward the data. In this case, you can regard the
switch as the filter of the multicast data. The filter helps to control the data flow and limit the
information that downstream receivers can obtain. Network security is thus ensured.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring control parameters of a multicast source, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions
Data Preparation
To configure control parameters of a multicast source, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Keepalive period of a multicast source
2
Filtering rules of multicast source addresses
5.4.2 Configuring the Lifetime of a Source
A multicast device starts a timer for each (S, G) entry. If the multicast device does not receive
any multicast packets from a multicast source within the set lifetime of the multicast source, it
considers that the (S, G) entry becomes invalid and the multicast source stops sending multicast
data to the multicast group.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM switch:
NOTE
If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
112
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
source-lifetime interval
The lifetime of a source is set.
If a switch does not receive any (S, G) packet in the lifetime of the source, the switch considers
that the source stops sending multicast data to G and the (S, G) entry becomes invalid.
When State-Refresh is enabled, the lifetime of the multicast source is prolonged to about the
value of interval.
----End
5.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses
After ACL rules are configured, a multicast device can filter the received multicast packets based
on source addresses or source/group addresses.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
source-policy { acl-number | acl-name acl-name }
The filter is configured.
The effect of the filtering is more obvious if the filter is closer to the source.
l If the basic ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses that pass the
filtering are forwarded.
l If the advanced ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses and group
addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
113
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
NOTE
l If acl-number | acl-name acl-name is specified in the source-policy command and ACL rules are
created, only the multicast packets whose source addresses match the ACL rules are permitted.
l If acl-number | acl-name acl-name is specified in the source-policy command and no ACL rule is
created, the multicast packets with any source addresses are not forwarded.
l The source-policy command does not filter the static (S, G) entries and the PIM entries of the Join
messages received from private networks.
----End
5.4.4 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters of a multicast source are adjusted, you can run commands to check
entries in the PIM routing table.
Procedure
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
5.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbor
Relationships
PIM devices exchange Hello messages to set up neighbor relationships and negotiate various
control parameters for controlling the neighbor relationships.
5.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-DM are configured, you can adjust related parameters of Hello
messages for controlling the neighbor relationships, and configure the neighbor filtering function
to enhance security as required.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
114
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
Applicable Environment
PIM switchs exchange Hello messages to set up neighbor relationships and negotiate various
control parameters.
The Switch under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust
related parameters according to the specific network environment.
NOTE
If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for maintaining neighbor relationships, complete the
following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for maintaining neighbor relationships, you need the following
data.
No.
Data
1
Timeout period of the neighbor
2
Interval for sending Hello messages
3
Maximum delay for triggering Hello messages
4
Number or name of the ACL used to filter PIM neighbors
5.5.2 Configuring the Interval for Sending Hello Messages
The interval for sending Hello messages can be set either globally or on an interface. The
configuration in the interface view is prior to the configuration in the PIM view. When the
interval is not configured in the interface view, the configuration in the PIM view takes effect.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
NOTE
The configuration involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
115
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
timer hello interval
The interval for sending Hello messages is set.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
pim timer hello interval
The interval for sending Hello messages is set.
4.
Run:
pim triggered-hello-delay interval
The maximum delay for triggering Hello messages is set.
After the maximum delay is set, the conflict caused by multiple PIM switchs sending
Hello messages simultaneously is prevented.
----End
5.5.3 Configuring the Timeout Period of a Neighbor
The timeout period of a neighbor can be set either globally or on an interface. If the multicast
device does not receive any Hello message from a neighbor when the timeout period is expired,
the device considers that the neighbor is unreachable. The timeout period of the neighbor must
be longer than the interval for sending Hello messages.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
116
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
NOTE
The configuration involves the following two cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
hello-option holdtime interval
The timeout period during which the neighbor is reachable is set.
If no Hello message is received from a neighbor in the timeout period, the neighbor
is considered unreachable.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
pim hello-option holdtime interval
The timeout period during which the neighbor is reachable is set.
If no Hello message is received from a neighbor in the timeout period, the neighbor
is considered unreachable.
----End
5.5.4 Refusing to Receive the Hello Message Without the
Generation ID Option
When the Generation ID option in the Hello message received from an upstream neighbor
changes, it indicates that the status of the upstream neighbor changes. Therefore, you can
configure a PIM interface to deny the Hello messages without Generation ID options to obtain
the upstream neighbor status in real time.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
117
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim require-genid
The Generation ID option is set in a Hello message.
The Hello message without the Generation ID option is rejected.
When the Generation ID option in the Hello message received from an upstream neighbor
changes, it indicates that the pim state of upstream neighbor changes, for example restarts. If a
switch does not want to receive data from an upstream neighbor, the switch sends a Prune
message after receiving a data packet from the upstream neighbor.
----End
5.5.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering
To prevent some unknown devices from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is
required. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the
filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering rules.
Context
To prevent some switch from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is required.
Do as follows on the switch running PIM-DM:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim neighbor-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name }
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
118
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
PIM neighbor filtering is configured.
An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules
and deletes the neighbors unmatching the filtering rules.
NOTE
When configuring the neighbor filtering function on the interface, you must also configure the neighbor
filtering function correspondingly on the switch that sets up the neighbor relationship with the interface.
----End
5.5.6 Checking the Configuration
After the neighbor control parameters are adjusted, you can run commands to check information
about the PIM interface and the PIM neighbor.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an
interface.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] neighbor
[ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to
check information about a PIM neighbor.
----End
5.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune
When the last member leaves a group, the multicast device sends a Prune message upstream,
requesting the upstream device to execute the prune action. If other downstream devices on the
same network segment need the multicast data for this group, they need to send Join messages
to override the prune action.
5.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic PIM-DM functions are configured, you can set the period for an interface to keep
the prune state, delay for transmitting Prune messages in a LAN, and interval for overriding the
prune action as required.
Applicable Environment
When the last member leaves its group, the switch sends a Prune message through an upstream
interface. After receiving the Prune message, the upstream switch performs the prune action and
stops sending multicast packets to this network segment. If other downstream switchs exist in
the network, the switchs need to send a Join message to override the prune action.
Switchs can work normally under the control of the default parameter values. Users can adjust
related parameters according to the specific network environment.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
119
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
NOTE
The configuration involves the following two cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for prune, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-DM(IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for prune, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Timeout period of the Prune state
2
Delay for transmitting Prune messages
3
Interval for overriding the prune action
5.6.2 Configuring the Period for an Interface to Keep the Prune State
The period for an interface to keep the prune state can be set either globally or on an interface.
After the period expires, the pruned interface starts to forward messages again. If the multicast
device receives a State-Refresh message before the period expires, it resets the timer, that is, it
refreshes the prune state.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
holdtime join-prune interval
The period during which the downstream interface is in the Prune state is set.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
120
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
After the period expires, the pruned interface starts to forward packets again. Before
the period expires, the switch refreshes the Prune state when receiving a State-Refresh
message.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
pim holdtime join-prune interval
The period during which the downstream interface is in the Prune state is set.
After the period is expired, the pruned interface starts to forward packets again.
Before the period expires, the switch refreshes the Prune state when receiving a StateRefresh message.
----End
5.6.3 Configuring the Delay for Transmitting Prune Messages in a
LAN
The delay for transmitting Prune messages in a LAN can be set either globally or on an interface.
When the values of lan-delay on all devices along the same link are different, the maximum
value of these values is preferred.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
hello-option lan-delay interval
The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set.
l
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Configuration on an Interface
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
121
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
1.
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
pim hello-option lan-delay interval
The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set.
----End
5.6.4 Configuring the Interval for Overriding the Prune Action
When a device sends a Prune message to the upstream in the same network segament, if other
devices still needs to receive the multicast data, the device must send a Join message upstream
within the override-interval.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
hello-option override-interval interval
The interval for overriding the prune action is set.
When a switch sends a Prune message to the upstream switch in the same network
segament, if other switch still requests the multicast data, it needs to send a Join
message to the upstream switch in the override-interval period.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
122
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
pim hello-option override-interval interval
The interval for overriding the prune action is set.
----End
5.6.5 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for prune are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM
interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through
commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information
about PIM on an interface.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message
counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent or received PIM control packets.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
5.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh
In a PIM-DM network, the periodic flooding-pruning wastes lots of network resources. To
prevent the pruned interface from forwarding messages because the prune timer times out, you
can enable the State-Refresh function. The multicast device then sends State-Refresh messages
periodically to refresh the prune state of the interface and maintain the SPT.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
123
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
5.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-DM are configured, you can set the interval for sending StateRefresh messages, period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message, and TTL value
carried in the State-Refresh message as required.
Applicable Environment
In a PIM-DM network, periodical flooding-prune wastes a lot of network resources. To prevent
a pruned interface from forwarding packets, you can enable the State-Refresh function.
Switch periodically send State-Refresh messages to refresh the prune state of interfaces and
maintain the SPT.
Switchs can work normally under the control of the default parameter values. Users can adjust
related parameters according to the specific network environment.
NOTE
If there is no specific requirement, default values are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for State-Refresh, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for State-Refresh, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages
2
Period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message
3
TTL value for forwarding State-Refresh messages
5.7.2 Disabling State-Refresh
After this function is disabled on the interface, the interface cannot forward any State-Refresh
messages.
Context
Do as follows on all the switchs in the PIM-DM domain.
NOTE
By default, PIM-DM State-Refresh is enabled on the interface.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
124
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
undo pim state-refresh-capable
PIM-DM State-Refresh is disabled.
The interface on which PIM-DM State-Refresh is disabled cannot forward any State-Refresh
message.
NOTE
You can run the pim state-refresh-capable command to re-enable PIM-DM State-Refresh on the interface.
----End
5.7.3 Configuring the Interval for Sending State-Refresh Messages
To prevent pruned interfaces from forwarding messages after the prune state timer times out,
you need to set the interval for sending State-Refresh messages to be shorter than the period for
keeping the Prune state.
Context
Do as follows on all the switchs in the PIM-DM domain:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
state-refresh-interval interval
The interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages is set.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
125
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
NOTE
l This command is applicable to the first-hop switch connecting with the multicast source.
l The interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages should be shorter than the timeout period for
keeping the Prune state.
l You can run the holdtime join-prune command to set the timeout period for keeping the Prune state.
----End
5.7.4 Configuring the Period for Receiving the Next State-Refresh
Message
A multicast device may receive PIM State-Refresh messages from multiple routers in a short
period and some PIM State-Refresh messages are repeated. Before the state-refresh timer times
out, the device discards the received repeated State-Refresh messages. The device is allowed to
receive the next State-Refresh message only after the timer times out.
Context
Do as follows on all the PIM-DM switchs in the PIM-DM domain:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
state-refresh-rate-limit interval
The period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message is set.
----End
5.7.5 Configuring the TTL Value Carried in a State-Refresh
Message
After receiving the PIM State-Refresh message, a multicast device decrements the TTL value
by 1 and then forwards the message downstream until the TTL value becomes 0. In a smallsized network, the PIM State-Refresh message is transmitted circularly on the network. You can
adjust the TTL value according to the network scale.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switchs directly connected to the source in the PIM-DM domain:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
126
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
state-refresh-ttl ttl-value
The TTL value carried in the State-Refresh message is set.
NOTE
This command is valid only on the switch directly connected to the source.
----End
5.7.6 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for state-refresh are adjusted, you can check information about the
PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through
commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an
interface.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message
counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent or received PIM control messages.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
127
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
5.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Graft
To make new members in a network to quickly receive multicast data, a multicast device actively
sends a Graft message through an upstream interface, requesting the upstream device to forward
multicast data to this network segment.
5.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-DM are configured, you can set the interval for retransmitting Graft
messages as required.
Applicable Environment
In a PIM-DM network, if State-Refresh is not enabled, a pruned interface can forward packets
after the Prune state times out. If State-Refresh is enabled, the pruned interface may never
forward packets.
To enable new members in the network to receive multicast data quickly, a PIM-DM switch
sends a Graft message through an upstream interface. After receiving the Graft message, the
upstream switch responds immediately with a Graft-Ack message and enables the interface that
receives the Graft message to forward packets.
Switchs can work normally under the control of the default parameter values. Users can adjust
the related parameters according to the specific network environment.
NOTE
If there is no specific requirement, default values are recommended.
Pre-configuration Task
Before configuring control parameters for graft, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions
Data Preparation
To configure control parameters for graft, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Interval for retransmitting Graft messages
5.8.2 Configuring the Interval for Retransmitting Graft Messages
In PIM-DM mode, when a member joins a pruned group, the multicast device sends a Graft
message and waits for an ACK message from the upstream device. If the downstream device
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
128
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
does not receive any ACK message within a certain period, the device resends the Graft message
until it receives an ACK message from the upstream device.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim timer graft-retry interval
The interval for retransmitting Graft messages is set.
If the local switch does not receive any Graft-Ack message from the upstream switch in a
specified period, it resends a Graft message.
----End
5.8.3 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for graft are adjusted, you can check information about the
unacknowledged PIM-DM graft, PIM interface, and PIM routing table and statistics about PIM
control messages through commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an
interface.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] grafts command
to check an unacknowledged PIM-DM graft.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message
counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of the sent or received PIM control messages.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
129
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
5.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert
If a multicast device can receive multicast data through an downstream interface, this indicates
that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert
message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream
device.
5.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-DM are configured, you can set the holdtime of the Assert state as
required.
Applicable Environment
When a PIM-DM switch receives multicast data through a downstream interface, it indicates
that other upstream switchs exist in the network segment. The switch sends Assert messages
through the interface to elect the unique upstream switch.
Switchs can work normally under the control of the default parameter values. Users can adjust
related parameters according to the specific network environment.
NOTE
If there is no specific requirement, default values are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for Assert, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for Assert, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
130
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
No.
Data
1
Period for keeping the Assert state
5.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State
The device that fails in the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding multicast
data. After the holdtime of the Assert state expires, the downstream interface can forward
multicast data.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
NOTE
The configuration involves the following two cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
holdtime assert interval
The period for holding the Assert state is set.
The switch that fails in the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding
multicast data.
After the Holdtime of the Assert state expires, the downstream interface can forward
packets.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
131
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3.
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
Run:
pim holdtime assert interval
The period for holding the Assert state is set.
The switch that fails in the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding
multicast data.
After the Holdtime period of the Assert state expires, the downstream interface can
forward packets.
----End
5.9.3 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for assert are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM
interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through
commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an
interface.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message
counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent or received PIM control messages.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
5.10 Configuring PIM Silent Function
The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM.
In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
132
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To
avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state.
5.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-DM and IGMP are configured, you can configure the PIM silent
function on the interface connected with the user host. This interface should be enabled with
PIM-DM and IGMP first.
Applicable Environment
On the access layer, the interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with PIM. You
can set up the PIM neighbor relationship on the interface to process various PIM packets. The
configuration, however, has the security vulnerability. When a host maliciously generates PIM
Hello messages and sends many packets to a switch, the switch may fail.
To prevent the preceding case, you can set the status of the interface to PIM silent. When the
interface is in the PIM silent state, the interface is prevented from receiving and forwarding any
PIM packet. All PIM neighbor relationships and PIM state machines on the interface are deleted.
At the same time, IGMP on the interface is not affected.
To enable PIM silent, the network environment must meet the following conditions:
l
PIM silent is applicable only to the interface directly connected to the host network segment
that is connected only to this switch.
CAUTION
If PIM silent is enabled on the interface connected to a switch, the PIM neighbor relationship
cannot be established and a multicast fault may occur.
If the host network segment is connected to multiple switchs and PIM silent is enabled on
multiple interfaces of the switchs, these interfaces do not send Assert messages. Therefore,
multiple interfaces that forward multicast data exist in the user network segment. A multicast
fault thus occurs.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring PIM silent, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to make the network reachable
l
Configuring PIM-DM
l
Configuring IGMP
Data Preparation
To configure PIM silent, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
No.
Data
1
Type and number of the interface connected to hosts
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
133
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
5.10.2 Configuring PIM Silent
After the interface is configured with PIM silent, it is forbidden to receive or forward any PIM
protocol packet. All PIM neighbors and PIM state machines on this interface are deleted. Then,
this interface automatically becomes the DR. IGMP on the interface is not affected.
Context
Do as follows on the interface connected to the host network segment:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim silent
PIM silent is enabled.
After PIM silent is enabled, the Hello message attack of malicious hosts is effectively prevented,
and the switch is protected.
----End
5.10.3 Checking the Configuration
After PIM silent is configured, you can run the command to check information about the PIM
interface.
Prerequisites
All the configurations of PIM silent are complete.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an
interface.
----End
Example
Run the display pim interface verbose command, and you can find that the configuration is
complete.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
134
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
<Quidway> display pim interface Vlanif 10 verbose
VPN-Instance: public net
Interface: Vlanif10,
PIM version: 2
PIM mode: Dense
PIM state: down
PIM DR: PIM DR Priority (configured): 1
PIM neighbor count: PIM hello interval: 30 s
PIM LAN delay (negotiated): PIM LAN delay (configured): 500 ms
PIM hello override interval (negotiated): PIM hello override interval (configured): 2500 ms
PIM Silent: enabled
PIM neighbor tracking (negotiated): PIM neighbor tracking (configured): disabled
PIM generation ID: PIM require-GenID: disabled
PIM hello hold interval: 105 s
PIM assert hold interval: 180 s
PIM triggered hello delay: 5 s
PIM J/P interval: 60 s
PIM J/P hold interval: 210 s
PIM state-refresh processing: enabled
PIM state-refresh interval: 60 s
PIM graft retry interval: 3 s
PIM state-refresh capability on link: capable
PIM BFD: disabled
PIM dr-switch-delay timer : not configured
Number of routers on link not using DR priority: Number of routers on link not using LAN delay: Number of routers on link not using neighbor tracking: ACL of PIM neighbor policy: ACL of PIM ASM join policy: ACL of PIM SSM join policy: ACL of PIM join policy: -
5.11 Maintaining PIM-DM (IPv4)
Maintaining PIM-DM involves resetting PIM statistics, monitoring PIM running status and
debugging PIM.
5.11.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages
If you need to re-collect the statistics about PIM control messages, you can reset the existent
statistics. Note that the statistics cannot be restored after you reset them. This operation does not
affect normal running of PIM.
Context
CAUTION
The statistics of the PIM control messages on the interface cannot be restored after you reset
them. Confirm the action before you run the command.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
135
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the reset pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message
counters [ interface interface-type interface-number ] command in the user view to clear
the statistics of the PIM control messages on an interface.
----End
5.11.2 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM
During the routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know the
running of PIM.
Context
In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running
status of PIM.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] claimed-route
[ source-address ] command in any view to check the unicast routes used by PIM.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message
counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command in any view to check the number of sent or received PIM control
messages.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] grafts command
in any view to check unacknowledged PIM-DM Graft messages.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information
about PIM on an interface.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] neighbor
[ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to
check information about a PIM neighbor.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
136
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
5.11.3 Debugging PIM
When a fault occurs during the running of PIM, run the debugging commands in the user view
and check the contents of sent and received packets for fault location.
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging
all command to disable it immediately.
When a PIM fault occurs, run the following debugging command in the user view to debug PIM
and locate the fault.
Procedure
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] all command
in the user view to enable all the debugging of PIM.
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] event
[ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM events.
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routingtable [ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM
routes.
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] assert
[ advanced-acl-number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the
debugging of PIM Assert.
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] staterefresh [ advanced-acl-number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable
the debugging of PIM State-Refresh.
----End
5.12 Configuration Example
Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic PIM-DM network.
5.12.1 Example for Configuring the PIM-DM Network
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
137
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
Networking Requirements
On the experiment network shown in Figure 5-2, multicast is deployed. The unicast routes work
normally. The Switches on the network need to be configured properly so that hosts can receive
the VOD information in multicast mode.
Figure 5-2 Networking diagram for configuring basic PIM-DM functions
SwitchA
Ethernet
Ethernet
GE1/0/0
Source
Receiver
HostA
GE2/0/0
N1
PIM-DM
GE3/0/0
GE4/0/0
GE1/0/0
SwitchD
GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0
Leaf network
GE2/0/0
SwitchB
GE1/0/0
GE2/0/0
SwitchC
N2
Receiver
HostB
Ethernet
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.1.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 101
10.110.1.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 200
192.168.2.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 102
10.110.2.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.3.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 102
10.110.2.2/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 200
192.168.2.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.3.2/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.1.2/24
GE 4/0/0
VLANIF 103
10.110.5.1/24
SwitchB
SwitchC
SwitchD
Configuration Roadmap
In a small-scale experiment network, PIM-DM is adopted to configure multicast. Enable PIM
silent on the VLANIF interfaces of SwitchA to protect SwitchA from Hello message attacks.
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Enable a unicast routing protocol on the Switch.
2.
Enable multicast on the Switch.
3.
Enable PIM-DM on each interface.
4.
Enable PIM silent and configure IGMP on the VLANIF interfaces connected to hosts.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
138
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
l
Address of multicast group G: 225.1.1.1/24
l
Address of multicast group S: 10.110.5.100/24
l
Version of the IGMP protocol running between routers and hosts: IGMPv2
NOTE
This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure PIM-DM.
Procedure
Step 1 Enable a unicast routing protocol on the Switch. The configuration procedure is not provided
here.
Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and enable PIM-DM on all interfaces.
# Enable multicast on SwitchA and enable PIM-DM on each interface. The configurations of
SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not
provided here.
[SwitchA] multicast
[SwitchA] interface
[SwitchA-Vlanif100]
[SwitchA-Vlanif100]
[SwitchA] interface
[SwitchA-Vlanif101]
[SwitchA-Vlanif101]
routing-enable
vlanif 100
pim dm
quit
vlanif 101
pim dm
quit
Step 3 Configure the interfaces connected to hosts to be PIM silent and configure IGMP on the interface.
# On SwitchA, configure the vlanif interfaces connected to hosts to be PIM silent, and configure
IGMP on the interface. The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to
configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here.
[SwitchA] interface
[SwitchA-Vlanif101]
[SwitchA-Vlanif101]
[SwitchA-Vlanif101]
vlanif 101
pim silent
igmp enable
quit
Step 4 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display pim interface command to view the configuration and operating of PIM on
the router interface. The display of the PIM configuration on SwitchD is as follows:
<SwitchD> display pim interface
VPN-Instance: public net
Interface
State NbrCnt
Vlanif103
up
0
Vlanif100
up
0
Vlanif200
up
0
Vlanif300
up
0
HelloInt
30
30
30
30
DR-Pri
1
1
1
1
DR-Address
10.110.5.1 (local)
192.168.1.2 (local)
192.168.2.2 (local)
192.168.3.2 (local)
# Run the display pim neighbor command to check the PIM neighbor relationship between the
Switches. The display of the PIM neighbor relationship on SwitchD is as follows:
<SwitchD> display pim neighbor
VPN-Instance: public net
Total Number of Neighbors = 3
Neighbor
Session
192.168.1.1
N
192.168.2.1
N
192.168.3.1
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Interface
Uptime
Expires
Dr-Priority
Vlanif100
00:02:22
00:01:27
1
Vlanif200
00:00:22
00:01:29
1
Vlanif300
00:00:23
00:01:31
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
1
BFD-
N
139
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
# Run the display pim routing-table command to view the PIM multicast routing table on the
Switch. Assume that HostA needs to receive the information about multicast group G
225.1.1.1/24. When sending multicast packets to multicast group G, multicast source S
10.110.5.100/24 generates an SPT through flooding and the (S, G) entries exist on SwitchA and
SwitchD that are in the SPT. When HostA joins multicast group G, an (*, G) entry is generated
on SwitchA. The information displayed on SwitchB and SwitchC is similar to the information
displayed on SwitchA. The displayed information is as follows:
<SwitchA> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 03:54:19
Upstream interface: NULL
Upstream neighbor: NULL
RPF prime neighbor: NULL
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif101
Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 01:38:19, Expires: never
(10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1)
Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: ACT
UpTime: 00:00:44
Upstream interface: Vlanif100
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.2
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.1.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif101
Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:00:44, Expires: never
<SwitchD> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 0 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1)
Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: LOC ACT
UpTime: 01:35:25
Upstream interface: Vlanif103
Upstream neighbor: NULL
RPF prime neighbor: NULL
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 2
1: Vlanif100
Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:03:27, Expires: never
2: Vlanif200
Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:03:27, Expires: never
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
multicast routing-enable
#
vlan batch 100 101
#
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
140
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif101
ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
pim silent
igmp enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 101
port hybrid untagged vlan 101
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchB
#
sysname SwitchB
#
multicast routing-enable
#
vlan batch 200 102
#
interface Vlanif102
ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
igmp enable
#
interface Vlanif200
ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 102
port hybrid untagged vlan 102
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
multicast routing-enable
#
vlan batch 102 300
#
interface Vlanif102
ip address 10.110.2.2 255.255.255.0
pim dm
igmp enable
#
interface Vlanif300
ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
141
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration
pim dm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 102
port hybrid untagged vlan 102
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchD
#
sysname SwitchD
#
multicast routing-enable
#
vlan batch 100 103 200 300
#
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif103
ip address 10.110.5.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif200
ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif300
ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet4/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 103
port hybrid untagged vlan 103
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.5.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
142
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
6
PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
About This Chapter
The PIM protocol is used to implement multicast routing and data forwarding inside an AS. The
PIM-SM protocol is a multicast routing protocol of sparse node. It is applicable to a large-scale
network with sparsely-distributed members.
6.1 PIM-SM Overview
In a PIM-SM network, group members are sparsely distributed and almost all the network
segments do not have group members resided. Therefore, an RP is a forwarding core of the PIMSM network. All PIM devices in the PIM-SM network must know the location of the RP and
the RP collects information about both group members and multicast sources.
6.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700
The system can work normally with default PIM-SM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust
parameters related to neighbor discovery, forwarding, DR, RP, join, register, and assert. In
addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent function to enhance the
PIM-SM security. PIM-SM supports SSM, PIM BFD, PIM GR, and SPT switchover.
6.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv4 multicast routing and enable
PIM-SM on each interface of the multicast device. Configure static or dynamic RP so that the
PIM-SM network can work normally.
6.4 Adjusting Control Parameters for a Multicast Source
A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This
helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream
receivers to enhance security.
6.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR
If a dynamic RP is used, you can adjust parameters of C-RPs and C-BSR as required. If there is
no special requirement, default values are recommended.
6.6 Configuring a BSR Administrative Domain
A PIM-SM network can be divided into multiple BSR administrative domains and a global
domain. This effectively reduces the load of a single BSR, and provides a special service for
specific multicast groups.
6.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for Establishing the Neighbor Relationship
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
143
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters
by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as
required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values.
6.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Source Registering
In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the multicast source encapsulates multicast
data in a Register message and sends it to the RP in unicast mode. The RP then decapsulates the
message, and forwards the multicast data to receivers along the RPT. The system supports the
Register message filtering and suppression functions.
6.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding
A multicast device sends Join messages upstream to require to forward multicast data and Prune
messages upstream for requiring to stop forwarding multicast data. You can adjust control
parameters for multicast data forwarding as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt
default values.
6.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert
If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates
that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert
message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream
device.
6.11 Configuring the SPT Switchover
A high volume of multicast data traffic increases the load of an RP, and may result in a fault.
To solve this problem, PIM-SM allows the RP or the DR at the group member side to trigger
the SPT switchover when the rate of multicast packets is high.
6.12 Configuring PIM BFD
After detecting a fault on the peer, BFD immediately notifies the PIM module to trigger a new
DR election rather than waits until the neighbor relationship times out. This shortens the period
during which multicast data transmission is discontinued and thus improves the reliability of
multicast data transmission.
6.13 Configuring PIM GR
In a PIM-SM network, PIM GR can be applied to a device with dual main control boards to
ensure normal multicast data forwarding during master-slave switchover.
6.14 Configuring PIM Silent
The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM.
In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send
the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To
avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state.
6.15 Maintaining PIM-SM (IPv4)
Maintaining PIM-SM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status.
6.16 Configuration Examples
Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic PIM-SM network and
configure basic functions of PIM-SM.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
144
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
6.1 PIM-SM Overview
In a PIM-SM network, group members are sparsely distributed and almost all the network
segments do not have group members resided. Therefore, an RP is a forwarding core of the PIMSM network. All PIM devices in the PIM-SM network must know the location of the RP and
the RP collects information about both group members and multicast sources.
The Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) indicates that any unicast routing protocol, such as
static route, RIP, OSPF, IS-IS, or BGP, can provide the routing information for IP multicast.
multicast routing is independent of unicast routing protocols, except that the unicast routing table
is used to generated multicast routing entries.
PIM forwards multicast packets by using the Reverse Path Forwarding (RPF) mechanism. The
RPF mechanism is used to create the multicast forwarding tree through the existing unicast
routing information. When a multicast packet arrives at a switch, the switch performs the RPF
check on the packet. If the RPF check succeeds, a multicast routing entry is created for
forwarding the multicast packet. If the RPF check fails, the packet is discarded.
NOTE
For details of RPF, refer to the chapter IPv4 Multicast Routing Management.
The working process of the Protocol Independent Multicast-Sparse Mode (PIM-SM) consists
of neighbor discovery, assert, DR election, RP discovery, join, prune, register, and SPT
switchover.
As shown in Figure 6-1, PIM-SM is used in a large-scale network with sparsely distributed
group members.
Figure 6-1 Application of PIM-SM a the multicast network
Receiver
IGMP
Source
PIM-SM
PIM-SM
Multicast
Server
PIM-SM
UserA
PIM-SM
PIM-SM
Receiver
IGMP
UserB
PIM-SM
Receiver
PIM-SM
IGMP
UserC
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
145
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
NOTE
l The Protocol Independent Multicast Dense Mode (PIM-DM) is applicable to a small-scale network
with densely distributed members.
l PIM-SM can be used to construct the Any-Source Multicast (ASM) and Source-Specific Multicast
(SSM) models.
6.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700
The system can work normally with default PIM-SM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust
parameters related to neighbor discovery, forwarding, DR, RP, join, register, and assert. In
addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent function to enhance the
PIM-SM security. PIM-SM supports SSM, PIM BFD, PIM GR, and SPT switchover.
Basic PIM-SM Functions
PIM-SM supports the ASM and SSM models. You can set the range of ASM group addresses
or the range of SSM group addresses.
Static RP
You can specify a static RP on all the switchs in a PIM-SM domain. When a dynamic RP exists
in the domain, the dynamic RP is preferred by default, but you can configure the static RP to be
preferred.
Dynamic RP
You can configure C-RPs and C-BSRs in a PIM-SM domain and set the unified rules used to
dynamically generated the BSR and the RP. You can adjust the priority for C-RP election, adjust
the lifetime of the advertisement message on the BSR received from the C-RP, adjust the interval
for the C-RP to send advertisement messages, and specify an Access Control List (ACL) to limit
the range of the multicast groups served by the C-RP.
BSR
You can specify the C-BSR in the BSR domain, adjust the hash length used by the RP for C-RP
election, adjust the priority used for BSR election, and adjust the legal BSR address range. To
limit the transmission of BSR messages, you can configure the BSR service boundary on an
interface of the switch on the boundary of the BSR domain.
Filtering Policy Based on Source Addresses
You can configure filtering rules of the multicast source address to control multicast sources.
You can configure the policy to filter Register messages, and suppress PIM-SM Register
messages.
BSR Administrative Domain
You can configure the service boundary of the BSR administrative domain and the boundary of
the administrative domain by using the related commands.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
146
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Adjusting Parameters for Maintaining PIM-SM Neighbors
You can adjust the following parameters about PIM-SM neighbors, including:
l
Interval for sending Hello messages
l
Time period for the neighbor to hold the reachable state
l
Whether to receive the Hello messages with Generation IDs
l
Maximum delay in triggering the Hello messages
l
Priority for DR election
l
DR switching delay
l
Neighbor filtering function: An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the
addresses matching the filtering rules.
Configuring Control Parameters for Multicast Forwarding
You can adjust control parameters for multicast forwarding, including:
l
Interval for sending Join messages
l
Time period for the downstream interface to keep the forwarding state
l
Time for overriding the prune action
l
Filtering Join information in the Join/Prune messages
l
Neighbor check function: checks whether the Join/Prune and Assert messages are sent to
or received from a PIM neighbor. If not, these messages are not processed.
Configuring Control Parameters for Assert
You can configure the period for retaining the Assert state of the switch interface.
Adjusting Control Parameters for SPT Switchover
You can adjust conditions of the SPT switchover and the interval for checking the forwarding
rate of multicast data.
PIM BFD
In the S9700, you can dynamically set up the BFD session to detect the status of the link between
PIM neighbors. Once a fault occurs on the link, BFD reports the fault to PIM.
PIM GR
The S9700 supports the PIM GR function on the switch with double MPUs. PIM GR ensures
normal multicast data forwarding during master-slave switchover of the switch.
Configuring PIM Silent
On the access layer, the switch interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with
PIM. You can establish a PIM neighbor on the switch interface to process various PIM packets.
The configuration, however, has the security vulnerability. When a host maliciously generates
PIM Hello packets and sends the packets in large quantity, the switch may break down.
To prevent the preceding case, you can set the status of the switch interface to PIM silent. When
the interface is in the PIM silent state, the interface is prohibited from receiving and forwarding
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
147
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
any PIM packet. Then all PIM neighbors and PIM state machines on the interface are deleted.
The interface acts as the static DR and immediately takes effect. At the same time, IGMP on the
interface are not affected.
Multi-Instance PIM
In multi-instance applications, a multicast switch needs to maintain the PIM neighbor list,
multicast routing table, BSR information, and RP-Set information for different VPN instances
and keep the information independent between the instances. The switch functions as multiple
multicast switchs running PIM independently.
When a switch receives a data packet, it needs to differentiate which VPN instance the packet
belongs to and forward it based on the multicast routing table of that VPN instance, or create
PIM-related multicast routing entries in that VPN instance.
PIM for Anycast RP
Through PIM for Anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain, IP routing will automatically select the
topologically closest RP for each source and receiver. This releases burdens on a single RP,
implements RP backup, and optimizes multicast forwarding paths.
6.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv4 multicast routing and enable
PIM-SM on each interface of the multicast device. Configure static or dynamic RP so that the
PIM-SM network can work normally.
6.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring basic PIM-SM functions, configure an IPv4 unicast routing protocol.
Applicable Environment
A PIM-SM network can adopt the ASM and SSM models to provide multicast services for user
hosts. The integrated components (including the RP) of the ASM model must be configured in
the network first. The SSM group address range is then adjusted as required.
NOTE
The SSM model is only supported in IGMPv3. If user hosts must run IGMPv1 or IGMPv2, configure IGMP
SSM mapping on switch interfaces.
Through IGMP, a switch knows the multicast group G that a user wants to join.
l
If G is in the SSM group address range and the source S is specified when the user joins G
through IGMPv3, the SSM model is used to provide multicast services.
l
If G is in the SSM group address range and the switch is configured with the (S, G) SSM
mapping rules, the SSM model is used to provide multicast services.
l
If G is not in the SSM group address range, the ASM model is used to provide multicast
services.
In the PIM-SM network, the ASM model supports the following methods to obtain an RP. You
can select the method as required.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
148
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Static RP: To obtain a static RP, manually configure RP on each switch in the PIM-SM
domain. For the large-scale PIM network, configuring the static RP is complicated. To
enhance the robustness and the operating management of the multicast network, the static
RP is usually used as the backup of the BSR-RP.
A multicast group may be in the service range of the dynamic RP and the static RP
simultaneously. By default, The switch prefers the dynamic RP. If the static RP precedence is
configured, the static RP is preferred.
Different multicast groups correspond to different RPs. Compared with all groups corresponding
to an RP, this can reduce the burden of an RP and enhance the robustness of the network.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring basic PIM-SM functions, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
Data Preparation
To configure basic PIM-SM functions, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Static RP address
2
ACL rule indicating the service scope of static RP
3
C-RP priority
4
ACL rule indicating the service scope of C-RP
5
Interval for C-RP sending Advertisement message
6
Timeout of the period during which BSR waits to receive the Advertisement message
from C-RP.
7
C-BSR Hash mask length
8
C-BSR priority
9
SSM group address range
6.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast Routing
Prior to configuring all IPv4 multicast features, enable IPv4 multicast routing.
Context
CAUTION
The configuration related to the VPN instance is applicable only to the PE switch. If the interface
of the VPN instance connects to the host, run the commands in step 3 and step 4.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
149
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Do as follows on the switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 (Optional) Run:
assign multicast-resource-mode optimize
The multicast replication capability of LPUs is improved. If each multicast packet needs to be
replicated into more than 8192 copies, run this command to improve the multicast replication
capability before enabling IP multicast routing.
Step 3 Run:
multicast routing-enable
IP multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance.
Step 4 (Optional) Run:
ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name
The VPN instance view is displayed.
Step 5 (Optional) Run:
ipv4-family
The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address
family view is displayed.
Step 6 (Optional) Run:
multicast routing-enable
IP multicast routing is enabled is enabled in the VPN instance IPv4 address family.
Before enable the multicast routing, the Route-distinguisher of the VPN instance must be
configured first.
----End
6.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-SM Functions
An interface can set up PIM neighbor relationship with other devices after PIM-SM is enabled
on it.
Context
NOTE
PIM-SM and PIM-DM cannot be enabled on an interface at the same time. The PIM mode on all interfaces
that belong to the same instance must be consistent. When the switch is distributed in the PIM-SM domain,
enable PIM-SM on all non-boundary interfaces.
Do as follows on the switch:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
150
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim sm
PIM SM is enabled.
After PIM SM is enabled on the interface and PIM neighbor relationships are set up between
switches, the protocol packets from the PIM neighbors can be processed.
----End
6.3.4 (Optional) Configuring a Static RP
When only one RP exists in the network, you can manually configure a static RP rather than a
dynamic RP. This can save the bandwidth occupied by message exchange between the C-RP
and the BSR. The configurations about the static RP should be the same on all the devices in a
PIM-SM domain.
Context
CAUTION
When the static RP and the dynamic RP are configured in the PIM-SM at the same time, faults
may occur in the network. So, confirm the action before you run the command. If you want to
use only the dynamic RP in the PIM-SM network, skip the configuration.
Do as follows on all switchs in a PIM-SM domain. The switchs where static RP is not configured
cannot participate in multicast forwarding in this PIM-SM domain.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
151
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Step 3 Run:
static-rp rp-address [ basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name ] [ preferred ]
The static RP is specified.
You can run the command repeatedly to configure multiple static RPs for the switch.
NOTE
All switchs in the PIM-SM area must be configured with the same static-rp command.
l rp-address: specifies the static RP address.
l basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name: specifies the ACL. The ACL defines the range of
the multicast group served by the static RP. When the range of multicast groups that multiple
static RPs serve overlaps, the static RP with the largest IP address functions as the RP.
l preferred: indicates the preference of the static RP. If the C-RP is configured in the network
at the same time, the switch prefers the RP statically specified after preferred is used.
Otherwise, C-RP is preferred.
----End
6.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Dynamic RP
In a PIM-SM domain, you can select several PIM devices and configure C-RPs on the devices.
Then, an RP is elected from these C-RPs. The C-BSRs should also be configured and a BSR is
elected from these C-BSRs. The BSR is responsible for collecting and advertising the C-RP
information on the network. The system supports the auto-RP listening function.
Context
CAUTION
The configuration is applicable only to the dynamic RP. If you want to use the static RP in the
network, skip the configuration.
Do as follows on the switch that may become RP in the PIM-SM domain:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
c-rp interface-type interface-number [ group-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name
acl-name } | priority priority | holdtime hold-interval | advertisement-interval
adv-interval ] *
The C-RP is configured.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
152
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
l interface-type interface-number: specifies the interface where the C-RP resides. The
interface must be configured with PIM-SM.
l group-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name }: specifies the multicast group
permitted by ACL and served by the C-RP. By default, C-RP serves all multicast groups.
l priority priority: specifies the priority for electing C-RP. The greater is the value, the lower
is the priority. By default, it is 0.
In the RP election, the C-RP with the highest priority wins. In case of the same priority, the
hash function is used and the C-RP with the greatest hash value wins. In case of the same
priority and the same hash value, the C-RP with the highest IP address wins.
NOTE
It is recommended to configure the loopback interfaces as RPs.
If the address borrowing is configured, it is not recommended to configure C-RP on the interfaces that
have the same addresses. If the priorities of the interfaces are different, the BSR considers that the CRP configuration is repeatedly modified.
l holdtime hold-interval: specifies the interval during which the BSR waits for the
Advertisement message from the C-RP. By default, the interval is 150 seconds.
l advertisement-interval adv-interval: specifies the interval during which the C-RP sends the
Advertisement message. By default, the interval is 60 seconds.
Step 4 Run:
c-bsr interface-type interface-number [ hash-length [ priority ] ]
The C-BSR is configured.
l interface-type interface-number: specifies the interface where the C-BSR resides. The
interface must be configured with the PIM-SM.
l hash-length: specifies the length of the hash. According to the G, C-RP address, and the value
of hash-length, switchs calculate the C-RPs that have the same priority and require to serve
G by operating hash functions, and compare the calculation results. The C-RP with the
greatest calculated value functions as the RP that serves G.
l priority: specifies the priority used by switchs to join the BSR election. The greater is the
value, the higher is the priority. By default, it is 0.
In the BSR election, the C-BSR with the highest priority wins. In the case of the same priority,
the C-BSR with the largest IP address wins.
Step 5 (Optional) Run:
bsm semantic fragmentation
The BSR message fragmentation is enabled.
It is recommended to enable BSR message fragmentation on all devices on the network because
BSR message fragmentation can solve the problem faced by IP fragmentation that all fragments
become unavailable due to loss of fragment information.
Step 6 (Optional) Run:
auto-rp listening enable
The Auto-RP listening is enabled.
When the switch interworks with a switch supporting auto-RP, this command needs to be
configured on the switch.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
153
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
6.3.6 (Optional) Configuring the SSM Group Address Range
The default SSM group address range is 232.0.0.0/8. You can manually configure the SSM group
address range. Ensure that the SSM group address ranges configured on all devices in the network
are identical.
Context
This configuration is optional. By default, the SSM group address range is 232.0.0.0/8.
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
ssm-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name }
The SSM group address range is configured.
NOTE
Ensure that the SSM group address range of all switchs in the network is consistent.
----End
6.3.7 Checking the Configuration
After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can check information about the BSR, RP,
PIM interface, PIM neighbor, and PIM routing table through commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bsr-info command
to check the BSR in a PIM-SM domain.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an
interface.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] neighbor
[ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to
check a PIM neighbor.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
154
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rp-info [ groupaddress ] command to check the RP in a PIM-SM domain.
----End
6.4 Adjusting Control Parameters for a Multicast Source
A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This
helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream
receivers to enhance security.
6.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can configure the lifetime of a multicast
source and source address-based filtering rules as required.
Applicable Environment
All the configurations in this section are applicable to the ASM and SSM models.
PIM switchs check the multicast data that passes by. By checking whether the data matches the
filtering rule, the switchs determine whether to forward the data. That is, the switchs in the PIM
domain function as filters. The filters help to control the data flow, and to limit the information
that the downstream receiver can obtain.
Switchs can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows users to adjust
the parameters as required.
NOTE
If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for a multicast source, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a certain unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for a multicast source, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
155
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
No.
Data
1
Lifetime of a multicast source
2
Filtering rules based on multicast source addresses
6.4.2 Configuring the Lifetime of a Source
A multicast device starts a timer for each (S, G) entry. If the multicast device does not receive
any multicast packets from a multicast source within the set lifetime of the multicast source, it
considers that the (S, G) entry becomes invalid and the multicast source stops sending multicast
data to the multicast group.
Context
Do as follows on the switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
source-lifetime interval
The lifetime of a source is configured.
If the lifetime of the source expires, the (S, G) entry becomes invalid.
----End
6.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses
After ACL rules are configured, a multicast device can filter the received multicast packets based
on source addresses or source/group addresses.
Context
Do as follows on the switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
156
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
source-policy { acl-number | acl-name acl-name }
A filter is configured.
If the basic ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses that pass the filtering
are forwarded.
If the advanced ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses and group
addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded.
NOTE
l If acl-number | acl-name acl-name is specified in the source-policy command, the multicast packets
with the specified source address or source and group addresses are forwarded.
l If acl-number | acl-name acl-name is specified in the source-policy command and no ACL rule is
created, the multicast packets with any source addresses are not forwarded.
l The source-policy command does not filter the static (S, G) entries and the PIM entries of the Join
messages received from private networks.
----End
6.4.4 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters of a multicast source are adjusted, you can run commands to check
entries in the PIM routing table.
Procedure
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
157
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
6.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR
If a dynamic RP is used, you can adjust parameters of C-RPs and C-BSR as required. If there is
no special requirement, default values are recommended.
6.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
If dynamic RP is used, after basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust parameters
of the C-RP and C-BSR, configure a BSR boundary, and set valid address ranges for BSRs and
C-RPs.
Applicable Environment
This section describes how to adjust control parameters of the C-RP and the C-BSR by using
commands in the ASM model.
NOTE
The configuration is applicable only to a BSR-RP. If you want to use only a static RP in the network, skip
the configuration.
The switch can work properly by using default values of control parameters. The S9700 allows
users to adjust parameters.
NOTE
Default values are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust various control parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
No.
Data
1
C-RP priority
2
Interval for a C-RP to send Advertisement messages
3
Timeout of the period during which a BSR waits to receive Advertisement messages
from a C-RP
4
Hash mask length of a C-BSR
5
Priority of a C-BSR
6
Interval for a C-BSR to send Bootstrap messages
7
Time of holding the Bootstrap message received from a BSR
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
158
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
No.
Data
8
ACL defining the valid BSR address scope
6.5.2 Adjusting C-RP Parameters
C-RPs periodically send Advertisement messages to a BSR. The Advertisement messages carry
C-RP priorities. You can adjust the C-RP priority, the interval for sending Advertisement
messages, and the holdtime of Advertisement messages on a device configured with the C-RP.
Context
Do as follows on the switch configured with the C-RP:
NOTE
You can re-set various parameters of a C-RP. This configuration is optional. If there is no specific
requirement, default values of parameters are recommended.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
c-rp priority priority
The C-RP priority is set.
Step 4 Run:
c-rp advertisement-interval interval
The interval during which the C-RP sends Advertisement messages is set.
Step 5 Run:
c-rp holdtime interval
The time for holding the Advertisement message from a C-RP is set. The value must be greater
than the interval for a C-RP to send advertisement messages.
The C-RP periodically sends advertisement messages to the BSR. After receiving the
advertisement messages, the BSR obtains the Holdtime of the C-RP from the message. During
the Holdtime, the C-RP is valid. When the Holdtime expires, the C-RP ages out.
----End
6.5.3 Adjusting C-BSR Parameters
At first, each C-BSR considers itself as a BSR and sends Bootstrap messages to all devices in
the network. You can adjust the hash mask length of the C-BSR carried in a Bootstrap message,
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
159
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
the C-BSR priority, the interval for sending Bootstrap messages, and the holdtime of Bootstrap
messages on a device configured with the C-BSR.
Context
Do as follows on the switch configured with the C-BSR:
NOTE
You can re-set various parameters of a C-BSR. This configuration is optional. If there is no specific
requirement, the default values of parameters are recommended.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
c-bsr hash-length hash-length
The hash mask length of a C-BSR is set.
Step 4 Run:
c-bsr priority priority
The priority of the C-BSR is set.
Step 5 Run:
c-bsr interval interval
The interval for the BSR to send Bootstrap messages is set.
Step 6 Run:
c-bsr holdtime interval
The time of holding the Bootstrap message received from a BSR is set.
The BSR periodically sends a Bootstrap message to the network. After receiving the Bootstrap
message, the switchs keep the message for a certain time. During the period, the BSR election
stops temporarily. If the Holdtime timer times out, a new round of BSR election is triggered
among C-BSRs.
NOTE
Ensure that the value of c-bsr holdtime is greater than the value of c-bsr interval. Otherwise, the winner
of BSR election cannot be fixed.
----End
6.5.4 Configuring the BSR Boundary
A BSR boundary can be configured on an interface. Bootstrap messages cannot pass the BSR
boundary. Multiple BSR boundary interfaces divide the network into different PIM-SM
domains.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
160
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Context
Do as follows on the switch that may become the BSR boundary:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim bsr-boundary
The BSR boundary is configured. Bootstrap messages cannot pass the BSR boundary.
By default, all the PIM-SM switchs on the network can receive Bootstrap messages.
----End
6.5.5 (Optional) Configuring the BSR Address Range
ACL-based policies can be set on all devices to filter C-BSR addresses. The devices then receive
only the Bootstrap messages with the source addresses being in the valid C-BSR address range.
Thus, BSR spoofing is avoided.
Context
Do as follows on all switches in the PIM-SM domain:
NOTE
By default, all BSR packets are received without the BSR source address check.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
bsr-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name }
The legal range of BSR addresses is set.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
161
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
After receiving a BSR message, the switch checks the source address of the message. If the
source address is not within the range of legal addresses, the message is discarded. BSR spoofing
is thus prevented.
{ basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } specifies the basic ACL. The ACL defines the
filtering policy for the source address range of the BSR messages.
----End
6.5.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Valid C-RP Addresses
ACL-based policies can be set on all C-BSRs to filter C-RP addresses and addresses of the groups
that the C-RPs serve. The BSR adds C-RP information to the RP-set only when the addresses
are in the set legal address range. Thus, C-RP spoofing is avoided.
Context
Do as follows on all the C-BSRs in the PIM-SM domain:
NOTE
This configuration is optional. By default, a switch does not check the C-RP address and the group address
contained in a received Advertisement message and adds them to the RP-set.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
crp-policy { advanced-acl-number | acl-name acl-name }
The range of the valid C-RP addresses and the range of the multicast group addresses that a
switch serves are specified. When receiving an Advertisement message, the switch checks the
C-RP address and the addresses of the groups that the C-RP serves in the message. The C-RP
address and the addresses of the groups that the C-RP serves are added to the RP-Set only when
they are in the valid address range. The C-RP spoofing can thus be prevented.
{ advanced-acl-number | acl-name acl-name }: specifies the advanced ACL. The ACL defines
the filtering policy for the C-RP address range and the address range of the groups that a C-RP
serves.
----End
6.5.7 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters of C-RPs and C-BSRs are adjusted, you can check information
about the BSR and RP and check whether a BSR boundary is configured on the interface through
commands.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
162
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bsr-info command
to check the BSR in a PIM-SM domain.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rp-info [ groupaddress ] command to check the RP in a PIM-SM domain.
----End
6.6 Configuring a BSR Administrative Domain
A PIM-SM network can be divided into multiple BSR administrative domains and a global
domain. This effectively reduces the load of a single BSR, and provides a special service for
specific multicast groups.
6.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After dynamic RP and basic PIM-SM functions are configured, you can configure BSR
administrative domains as required. Each BSR administrative domain maintains a BSR and
provides services for the multicast groups within a specific address range. Multicast groups that
do not belong to any BSR administrative domain are served by the global domain.
Applicable Environment
This section describes how to configure a BSR administrative domain in the ASM model through
commands.
In the traditional mode, a PIM-SM network maintains only one BSR and all multicast groups in
the network are in the administrative range of the BSR. To better manage the domains, the PIMSM network is divided into multiple BSR administrative domains. Each BSR administrative
domain maintains only one BSR that serves specified multicast groups. BSR administrative
domains are geographically isolated. Multicast packets of a BSR administrative domain cannot
pass the border of the domain.
The address of a multicast group served by a BSR administrative domain is valid only in the
BSR administrative domain. The addresses of multicast groups served by different BSR
administrative domains can be identical and these addresses are equal to private multicast group
addresses.
Multicast groups that do not belong to any BSR administrative domain are served by the global
domain. Global domain maintains only one BSR that serves the remaining multicast groups.
Dividing a PIM-SM network into multiple BSR administrative domains and a global domain
effectively reduces the load of a single BSR, and provides a special service for specific multicast
groups.
The switch can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows users to
adjust the parameters.
NOTE
Default values are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring a BSR administrative domain, complete the following tasks:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
163
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
Data Preparation
To configure a BSR administrative domain, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Priority and hash mask length for electing a BSR in a BSR domain
2
Priority and hash mask length of electing the global domain BSR
6.6.2 Enabling a BSR Administrative Domain
Enable BSR administrative domains on all devices in a PIM-SM network.
Context
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM network:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
c-bsr admin-scope
The division of BSR administrative domains is enabled in a PIM-SM network.
----End
6.6.3 Configuring the Boundary of a BSR Administrative Domain
After an interface is configured as a BSR administrative domain boundary, all the multicast
packets for the groups in this BSR administrative domain cannot pass this interface.
Context
Do as follows on all switchs at the boundary of a BSR administrative domain:
NOTE
The switchs outside the BSR administrative domain cannot forward the multicast packets of the BSR
administrative domain.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
164
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
multicast boundary group-address { mask | mask-length }
The BSR administrative domain boundary is configured. Multicast packets that belong to the
BSR administrative domain cannot traverse the boundary.
----End
6.6.4 Adjusting C-BSR Parameters
You can adjust the C-BSR parameters of the BSR administrative domain and the global domain
as required.
Context
Do as follows on all C-BSRs:
NOTE
The C-BSR configuration involves three cases:
l Global configuration: For global configuration, see Adjusting Control Parameters of the C-RP and
C-BSR. It is valid in the global domain and each BSR administrative domain.
l Configuration in a BSR administrative domain: Because the configuration in a BSR administrative
domain takes precedence over the global configuration, the global configuration is used when the
configuration in a BSR administrative domain is not done.
l Configuration in the global domain: Because the configuration in the global domain takes precedence
over the global configuration, the global configuration is used when the configuration in the global
domain is not done.
Procedure
l
Configuration in a BSR Administrative Domain
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
c-bsr group group-address { mask | mask-length } [ hash-length hashlength | priority priority ] *
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
165
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
The C-BSR parameters are configured.
– group-address { mask | mask-length }: specifies the range of the multicast groups
served by a C-BSR. Group addresses in the 239.0.0.0/8 are valid group addresses.
– hash-length hash-length: specifies the hash mask length of a C-BSR.
– priority priority: specifies the priority of a C-BSR.
l
Configuration in the Global Domain
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
c-bsr global [ hash-length hash-length | priority priority ] *
The C-BSR parameters are configured.
– hash-length hash-length: specifies the hash mask length of a C-BSR.
– priority priority: specifies the priority of a C-BSR.
----End
6.6.5 Checking the Configuration
After a BSR administrative domain is configured, you can run commands to view configurations
about the BSR and RP.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bsr-info command
to check the BSR in a PIM-SM domain.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rp-info [ groupaddress ] command to check the RP in a PIM-SM domain.
----End
6.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for Establishing the
Neighbor Relationship
Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters
by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as
required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values.
6.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust related parameters of Hello
messages for controlling neighbor relationships, and configure the downstream neighbor
tracking function and the neighbor filtering function.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
166
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Applicable Environment
The configuration in this section is applicable to both the ASM model and the SSM model.
The PIM switchs send Hello messages to each other to establish the neighbor relationship,
negotiate the control parameters, and elect a DR.
The switch can work normally by default. The S9700 allows the users to adjust the parameters
as required.
NOTE
It is recommended to adopt the default value if there is no special requirement.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring control parameters for establishing the neighbor relationship, complete the
following tasks:
l
Configuring unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust the control parameters for establishing the neighbor relationship, you need the
following data.
No.
Data
1
Priority of the DR that is elected
2
Timeout period for waiting for Hello messages from a neighbor
3
Interval for sending Hello messages
4
Maximum delay for triggering Hello messages
5
DR switchover delay, that is, the period during which the original entries are still
valid when the interface changes from a DR to a non-DR.
6
Number or name of the ACL used to filter PIM neighbors
6.7.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Establishing the
Neighbor Relationship
Control Parameters for Establishing the Neighbor Relationship can be configured either globally
or on an interface. The configuration in the interface view is prior to the configuration in the
PIM view. When the interval is not configured in the interface view, the configuration in the
PIM view takes effect.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-SM switch.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
167
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
NOTE
The configuration involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
timer hello interval
The interval for sending Hello messages is set.
4.
Run:
hello-option holdtime interval
The timeout period of holding the reachable state of a neighbor is set.
If no Hello message is received after the interval expires, the neighbor is considered
unreachable.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
pim timer hello interval
The interval for sending Hello messages is set.
4.
Run:
pim triggered-hello-delay interval
The maximum delay for triggering Hello messages is set.
This can prevent the conflict of Hello messages sent by multiple PIM switchs at the
same time.
5.
Run:
pim hello-option holdtime interval
The timeout period of holding the reachable state of a neighbor is set.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
168
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
If no Hello message is received after the interval expires, the neighbor is considered
unreachable.
6.
Run:
pim require-genid
The Generation ID option is contained in a received Hello message. The Hello message
without the Generation ID option is rejected.
By default, the switch handles the Hello message without the Generation option.
----End
6.7.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Electing a DR
The control parameters for electing a DR can be set either globally or on an interface.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-SM switch:
NOTE
The configuration involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
hello-option dr-priority priority
The DR priority is set.
On a shared network segment where all PIM switchs support the DR priority, the
interface with the highest priority acts as the DR. In the case of the same priority, the
interface with the largest IP address acts as the DR. If a minimum of one PIM
switch does not support the DR priority, the interface with the largest IP address acts
as the DR.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
169
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
pim hello-option dr-priority priority
The DR priority is set.
On a shared network segment where all PIM switchs support the DR priority, the
interface with the highest priority acts as the DR. In the case of the same priority, the
interface with the largest IP address acts as the DR. If a minimum of one PIM
switch does not support the DR priority, the interface with the largest IP address acts
as the DR.
4.
Run:
pim timer dr-switch-delay interval
The DR switchover delay is configured and the delay is specified.
When an interface changes from a DR to a non-DR, the original entries are valid till
the delay expires.
By default, once an interface changes from a DR to a non-DR, the original entries are
deleted immediately.
----End
6.7.4 Enabling the Function of Tracking a Downstream Neighbor
When the Generation ID option in the Hello message received from an upstream neighbor
changes, it indicates that the status of the upstream neighbor changes. Therefore, you can
configure a PIM interface to deny the Hello messages without Generation ID options to obtain
the upstream neighbor status in real time.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-SM switch:
NOTE
The configuration involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on the interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
170
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3.
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Run:
hello-option neighbor-tracking
The function of tracking a downstream neighbor is enabled.
After this function is enabled, information about the downstream neighbor who has
sent a Join message and whose Join state does not times out is recorded.
NOTE
The function of tracking downstream neighbors cannot be implemented unless all the PIM
switchs in the shared network segment are enabled with this function.
l
Configuration on an interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
pim hello-option neighbor-tracking
The function of tracking a downstream neighbor is enabled.
After this function is enabled, information about the downstream neighbor who has
sent a Join message and whose Join state does not times out is recorded.
NOTE
The function of tracking downstream neighbors cannot be implemented unless all PIM
switchs in the shared network segment are enabled with this function.
----End
6.7.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering
To prevent some unknown devices from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is
required. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the
filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering rules.
Context
To prevent some switches from establishing unauthorized neighbor relationships through the
PIM protocol, configure the local device to filter PIM neighbors.
Do as follows on the switch enabled with PIM-SM:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
171
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim neighbor-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name }
PIM neighbor filtering is configured.
An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules
and deletes the neighbors unmatching the filtering rules.
NOTE
When configuring the neighbor filtering function on the interface, you must also configure the neighbor
filtering function correspondingly on the switch that sets up the neighbor relationship with the interface.
----End
6.7.6 Checking the Configuration
After the neighbor control parameters are adjusted, you can run commands to check information
about the PIM interface and the PIM neighbor.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an
interface.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] neighbor
[ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to
check a PIM neighbor.
----End
6.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Source Registering
In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the multicast source encapsulates multicast
data in a Register message and sends it to the RP in unicast mode. The RP then decapsulates the
message, and forwards the multicast data to receivers along the RPT. The system supports the
Register message filtering and suppression functions.
6.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can configure filtering policies and the
checksum method for Register messages and configure PIM-SM Register suppression as
required.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
172
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Applicable Environment
This section describes how to configure the control parameters of the source registering through
commands.
In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the source S encapsulates multicast data in
a Register message and sends it to the RP in unicast mode. The RP then decapsulates the message,
and forwards it along the RPT.
After the SPT switchover on the RP is complete, the multicast data reaches the RP along the
SPT tree in the multicast mode. The RP sends a Register-stop message to the DR at the source
side. The DR stops sending Register messages and enters the suppressed state. During the register
suppression, the DR periodically sends null-register packets to inform that the source is still in
the active state. After the timeout of the register suppression, the DR starts to send Register
message again.
The switch can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows the users
to adjust the parameters as required.
NOTE
It is recommended to adopt default values if there is no special requirement.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for source registering, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for source registering, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
ACL rules used by the RP to filter Register messages
2
Whether the checksum is calculated only according to the header of a Register
message
3
Timeout for keeping the suppressed state of registering
4
Interval for sending null Register messages to the RP
6.8.2 Configuring PIM-SM Register Messages
You can configure filtering policies for Register messages on all the devices that may become
RPs. By default, the checksum is calculated based on the entire Register message. You can
configure the device to calculate the checksum based on only the header of a Register message.
Context
Do as follows on all switchs that may become an RP:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
173
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
register-policy { advanced-acl-number | acl-name acl-name }
The policy for filtering Register messages is set.
The RP applies the policy to filter received Register messages.
Step 4 Run:
register-header-checksum
The checksum is calculated only according to the header of a Register message.
By default, the checksum is calculated according to the entire message.
----End
6.8.3 Configuring PIM-SM Register Suppression
You can set the timeout period for keeping the register suppression state and the interval for
sending null Register messages on all the devices that may becomes DRs at the multicast source
side.
Context
Do as follows on all the switchs that may become the DR at the multicast source side:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
register-suppression-timeout interval
The timeout for keeping the suppressed state of registering is set.
Step 4 Run:
probe-interval interval
The interval for sending null Register messages is set.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
174
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
NOTE
The probe-interval value must be smaller than half of register-suppression-timeout value.
----End
6.8.4 Checking the Configuration
After control parameters for source registering are adjusted, you can run the corresponding
command to check information about the PIM interface.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an
interface.
----End
6.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding
A multicast device sends Join messages upstream to require to forward multicast data and Prune
messages upstream for requiring to stop forwarding multicast data. You can adjust control
parameters for multicast data forwarding as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt
default values.
6.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust related control parameters of
forwarding relationship maintenance, and configure the Join information filtering and neighbor
checking functions to enhance security as required.
Applicable Environment
The configurations in this section are applicable to the ASM model and the SSM model.
When the first member of a group appears in the network segment, the switch sends a Join
message through an upstream interface, requiring the upstream switch to forward packets to the
network segment.
When the last member of the group leaves, the switch sends a Prune message through an upstream
interface, requiring the upstream switch to perform the Prune action and to stop forwarding
packets to this network segment. If other downstream switchs in this network segment still want
to receive data of this group, they must send a Join message to override the Prune action.
In the ASM model, a switch periodically sends Join messages to the RP to prevent RPT branches
from being deleted due to timeout.
The switch can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows users to
adjust the parameters as required.
NOTE
It is recommended to adopt default values if there is no special requirement.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
175
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for forwarding, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a certain unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for forwarding, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Interval for sending Join/Prune messages
2
Interval for holding the Join/Prune state
3
Delay for transmitting Prune messages
4
Period of overriding the Prune action
5
Number or name of the ACL used to filter join information in the Join/Prune messages
6
Whether neighbor check needs to be performed after Join/Prune message and Assert
messages are sent or received
6.9.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Keeping the Forwarding
State
The control parameters of multicast data forwarding can be set either globally or on an interface.
The parameters specify the interval for sending Join/Prune messages and the period for a
downstream interface to keep the Join/Prune state.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-SM switch:
NOTE
The configuration involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on the interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
176
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
timer join-prune interval
The interval for sending Join/Prune messages is set.
4.
Run:
holdtime join-prune interval
The interval for holding the Join/Prune state of a downstream interface is set.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
pim timer join-prune interval
The interval for sending Join/Prune messages is set.
4.
Run:
pim holdtime join-prune interval
The interval for holding the Join/Prune state of a downstream interface is set.
5.
Run:
pim require-genid
The Generation ID option is contained in a received Hello message. The Hello message
without the Generation ID option is rejected.
By default, the switch handles the Hello message without the Generation option.
The change of the Generation ID in the Hello message received from an upstream
neighbor indicates that the upstream neighbor is lost or the status of the upstream
neighbor has changed. The switch immediately sends the Join/Prune message to the
upstream switch to refresh the status.
----End
6.9.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Prune
The control parameters for prune can be set either globally or on an interface. The parameters
specify the delay for transmitting messages in a LAN and the interval for overriding the Prune
action.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-SM switch:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
177
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
NOTE
The configuration involves the following cases:
l Global Configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on the interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
hello-option lan-delay interval
The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set.
A Hello message carries lan-delay and override-interval . PPT indicates the delay
from the time when a switch receives the Prune message from a downstream interface
to the time when the switch performs the prune action to suppress the forwarding of
the downstream interface. The PPT is obtained by the lan-delay plus override-interval.
If the switch receives a Join message from a downstream switch within the PPT, the
switch does not perform the prune action.
4.
Run:
hello-option override-interval interval
The interval for overriding the Prune action is set.
When a switch sends a Prune message to the upstream switch in the same network
segament, if other switch still requests the multicast data, it needs to send a Join
message to the upstream switch in the override-interval period.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
pim hello-option lan-delay interval
The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set.
4.
Run:
pim hello-option override-interval interval
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
178
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
The interval for overriding the Prune action is set.
----End
6.9.4 Configuring Join Information Filtering
A Join/Prune message received by an interface may contain both join information and prune
information. You can configure the interface to filter join information based on ACL rules. The
device then creates PIM entries for only the join information matching ACL rules.
Context
A Join/Prune message received by an interface may contain both join information and prune
information. You can configure the switch to filter join information based on ACL rules. The
switch then creates PIM entries for only the join information matching ACL rules, which can
avoid access of illegal users.
Do as follows on the switch enabled with PIM-SM:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim join-policy { asm { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } | ssm { advanced-aclnumber | acl-name acl-name } | advanced-acl-number | acl-name acl-name }
Join information filtering is configured.
----End
6.9.5 (Optional) Configuring Parameters for Join/Prune Messages
The parameters such as the maximum message size and number of (S, G) entries, and the message
package function can be configured for PIM Join/Prune messages.
Context
Perform the following steps on the PIM-SM-enabled switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
179
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
join-prune max-packet-length packet-length
The maximum size of each PIM-SM Join/Prune message to be sent is configured.
The default size is 8100 bytes.
Step 4 Run:
join-prune periodic-messages queue-size queue-size
The maximum number of entries carried in a PIM-SM Join/Prune message that is sent every
second is configured.
The default value is 1020.
Step 5 Run:
join-prune triggered-message-pack disable
The function to package Join/Prune messages in real time is disabled. This function is enabled
by default.
----End
6.9.6 Configuring Neighbor Check
If PIM neighbor check is enabled, a device checks whether the Join/Prune and Assert messages
are sent to or received from PIM neighbors. If not, the device drops the messages.
Context
By default, checking whether the Join/Prune message and Assert messages are sent to or received
from a PIM neighbor is not enabled.
If PIM neighbor checking is required, it is recommended to configure the neighbor checking
function on the devices connected with user devices rather than on the internal devices of the
network. Then, the switch checks whether the Join/Prune and Assert messages are sent to or
received from a PIM neighbor. If not, the switch drops the messages.
Do as follows on the switch enabled with PIM-SM:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
180
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Step 3 Run:
neighbor-check { receive | send }
The neighbor check function is configured.
You can specify both receive and send to enable the PIM neighbor check function for the
received and sent Join/Prune and Assert messages.
----End
6.9.7 Checking the Configuration
After control parameters for multicast data forwarding are adjusted, you can check information
about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages
through commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an
interface.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message
counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent or received PIM control messages.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
6.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert
If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates
that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert
message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream
device.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
181
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
6.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can set the period for holding the Assert
state as required.
Applicable Environment
The configurations in this section ares applicable to the ASM model and the SSM model.
If a PIM-SM switch receives multicast data through a downstream interface, it indicates that
other upstream switchs exist in this network segment. switchs send Assert messages to elect the
unique upstream switch.
The switch can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows users to
adjust the parameters as required.
NOTE
It is recommended to adopt default values if there is no special requirement.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for assert, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a certain unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for assert, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Period for holding the Assert state
6.10.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State
The device that fails in the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding multicast
data during the Assert state. After the holdtime of the Assert state expires, the downstream
interface can forward multicast data.
Context
Do as follows on all the switchs in the PIM-SM domain:
NOTE
The configuration involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
182
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
3.
Run:
holdtime assert interval
The period for holding the Assert state is set.
The switch that fails in the election prevents the downstream interface from forwarding
multicast packets within the interval. After the interval expires, the downstream
interface starts to forward multicast packets.
l
Configuration on the Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or
an IP-Trunk interface.
3.
Run:
pim holdtime assert interval
The period for holding the Assert state is configured.
The switch that fails in the election prohibits the downstream interface from
forwarding multicast packets within this interval. After the interval expires, the
downstream interface starts to forward multicast packets.
----End
6.10.3 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for assert are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM
interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through
commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an
interface.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message
counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graft-
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
183
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent or received PIM control messages.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
6.11 Configuring the SPT Switchover
A high volume of multicast data traffic increases the load of an RP, and may result in a fault.
To solve this problem, PIM-SM allows the RP or the DR at the group member side to trigger
the SPT switchover when the rate of multicast packets is high.
6.11.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust control parameters for SPT
switchover as required.
Applicable Environment
This section describes how to configure the control parameters of the SPT switchover through
commands.
In a PIM-SM network, each multicast group corresponds to an RPT. At first, all multicast sources
encapsulate data in Register messages, and send them to the RP in the unicast mode. The RP
decapsulates the messages and forwards them along the RPT.
Forwarding multicast data by using the RPT has the following defects:
l
The DR at the source side and the RP need to encapsulate and decapsulate packets.
l
Forwarding path may not be the shortest path from the source to receivers.
l
Large-volume data flow increases the load of the RP, and may cause a fault.
The solution to the preceding defects is that:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
184
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
l
SPT switchover triggered by the RP: The RP sends a Join message to the source, and
establishes a multicast route along the shortest path from the source to the RP. The
subsequent packets are forwarded along the path.
l
SPT switchover triggered by the DR at the member side: The DR at the member side checks
the forwarding rate of multicast data. If the DR finds that the rate exceeds the threshold,
the DR tiggers the SPT switchover immediately. The DR sends a Join message to the source,
and establishes a multicast route along the shortest path from the source to the DR. The
subsequent packets are forwarded along the path.
Switchs can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows users to adjust
the parameters as required.
NOTE
It is recommended to adopt default values if there is no special requirement.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring the SPT switchover, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
Data Preparation
To configure the SPT switchover, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Rate threshold that the DR at the member side switches packets from the RPT to the
SPT
2
Group filtering policy and sequence policy for the switchover from the RPT to the
SPT
3
Interval for checking the rate threshold of multicast data before the RPT-to-SPT
switchover
6.11.2 (Optional) Configuring the Interval for Checking the
Forwarding Rate of Multicast Data
You can configure conditions for the SPT switchover and set the interval for checking the
forwarding rate of multicast data on the DR at the group member side.
Context
Do as follows on all the switchs that may become a DR at the member side:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
185
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
spt-switch-threshold { traffic-rate | infinity } [ group-policy { basic-acl-number
| acl-name acl-name } [ order order-value ] ]
The SPT switchover condition is set.
l traffic-rate: specifies the rate threshold of the SPT switchover.
l infinity: indicates that the SPT switchover is not triggered forever.
l group-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } [ order order-value]: specifies the
range of the multicast groups that use the threshold. By default, the threshold is applicable
to all multicast groups.
Step 4 Run:
timer spt-switch interval
The interval for checking the forwarding rate of multicast data is set.
----End
6.11.3 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for SPT switchover are adjusted, you can run commands to check
entries in the PIM routing table.
Procedure
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type
interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ]
* [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] *
[ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
186
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
6.12 Configuring PIM BFD
After detecting a fault on the peer, BFD immediately notifies the PIM module to trigger a new
DR election rather than waits until the neighbor relationship times out. This shortens the period
during which multicast data transmission is discontinued and thus improves the reliability of
multicast data transmission.
6.12.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can configure PIM BFD to improve PIM
network reliability, and adjust BFD parameters as required.
Networking Requirements
Generally, if the current DR in a shared network segment is faulty, other PIM neighbors triggers
a new round of DR election only after the neighbor relationship times out. The duration that data
transmission is interrupted is not shorter than the timeout period of the neighbor relationship.
Generally, it is of second level.
BFD features fast detection of faults, and is up to the millisecond level. BFD can detect statuses
of PIM neighbors in the shared network segment. When BFD detects that a peer is faulty, BFD
immediately reports it to PIM. PIM then triggers a new round of DR election without waiting
for the timeout of the neighbor relationship. This shortens the duration of interruption of data
transmission and enhances the reliability of the network.
PIM BFD is also applicable to the assert election in a shared network segment. It can fast respond
to the fault of the interface that wins the assert election.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring PIM BFD, complete the following task:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
l
Enabling BFD in the system view
Data Preparation
To configure PIM BFD, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Minimum intervals for sending and receiving BFD detection messages, and local
detection multiple
6.12.2 Enabling PIM BFD
Enable PIM BFD on the devices that set up a PIM neighbor relationship.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
187
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Context
Do as follows on PIM switchs that set up the neighbor relationship:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface must be a VLANIF interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim bfd enable
PIM BFD is enabled.
By default, PIM BFD is disabled.
----End
6.12.3 (Optional) Adjusting BFD Parameters
You can adjust PIM BFD parameters as required. PIM BFD parameters include the minimum
interval for sending and receiving PIM BFD packets and the local detection multiplier.
Context
Do as follows on two PIM switchs that set up the neighbor relationship:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed
The interface must be a VLANIF interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim bfd { min-tx-interval tx-value | min-rx-interval rx-value | detect-multiplier
multiplier-value }*
PIM BFD parameters are adjusted.
PIM BFD parameters include the minimum interval for sending PIM BFD messages, the
minimum interval for receiving PIM BFD messages, and the local detection multiple.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
188
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
If this command is not used, the default values of these parameters are used. When the BFD
parameters configured for other protocols are the same as those configured for PIM, the
configurations of the PIM BFD parameters are affected.
----End
6.12.4 Checking the Configuration
After PIM BFD is configured, you can run the command to check information about PIM BFD
sessions.
Procedure
l
Run the following commands to check information about a PIM BFD session.
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bfd session statistics
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bfd session
[ interface interface-type interface-number | neighbor neighbor-address ] *
----End
6.13 Configuring PIM GR
In a PIM-SM network, PIM GR can be applied to a device with dual main control boards to
ensure normal multicast data forwarding during master-slave switchover.
6.13.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can configure PIM GR to improve PIM
network reliability.
Applicable Environment
In some multicast applications, the switch may need to perform active/standby switchover. After
active/standby switchover, the new active main control board deletes the forwarding entries on
the interface board and re-learns the PIM routing table and multicast routing table. During this
process, multicast traffic is interrupted.
In the PIM-SM/SSM network, PIM Graceful Restart (GR) can be applied to the switch with dual
main control boards to ensure normal multicast traffic forwarding during active/standby
switchover.
The active main control board of the switch backs up PIM routing entries and Join/Prune
information to be sent upstream to the standby main control board. The interface board maintains
forwarding entries. Therefore, after active/standby switchover, the switch can actively and fast
send Join messages upstream to maintain the Join state of the upstream. In addition, the PIM
protocol sends Hello message carrying new Generation ID to all switchs enabled with PIM-SM.
When the downstream switch finds that the Generation ID of its neighbor changes, it sends a
Join/Prune message to the neighbor for re-creating routing entires, thereby ensuring non-stop
forwarding of multicast data on the forwarding plane.
If a dynamic RP is used on the network, after receiving a Hello message with the Generation ID
being changed, the DR or candidate DR unicasts a BSM message to the switch performing active/
standby switchover and the switch learns and restores RP information based on the received
BSM message. If the switch has not leant any RP information from the BSM messages, it obtains
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
189
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
the RP information from the Join/Prune message received from the downstream router and recreates multicast routing table.
NOTE
PIM GR is applicable to PIM-SM/SSM networks.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before enabling PIM GR, complete the following task:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol and enabling unicast GR
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions
Data Preparation
To enable PIM GR, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Unicast GR period
2
PIM GR period
6.13.2 Enabling PIM GR
After PIM GR is enabled on a device, you can set the PIM GR period as required.
Context
Do as follows on the switch enabled with PIM-SM:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
graceful-restart
PIM GR is enabled.
Step 4 (Optional) Run:
graceful-restart period period
The PIM GR period is set.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
190
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
By default, the PIM GR period is 120 seconds.
----End
6.13.3 Checking the Configuration
After PIM GR is configured, you can run the command to check whether the PIM routing table
is the same as that before master-slave switchover.
Procedure
Step 1 Run the following commands to check PIM routing table.
l display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number |
register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interfacenumber | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoinginterface-number [ number ] ]
l display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] |
source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface
{ interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude |
match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | register |
none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number
[ number ] ]
l display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number |
register } ] *
----End
6.14 Configuring PIM Silent
The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM.
In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send
the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To
avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state.
6.14.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of PIM-SM and IGMP are configured, you can configure the PIM silent
function on the interface connected with the user host. This interface should be enabled with
PIM-SM and IGMP first.
Applicable Environment
On the access layer, the interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with PIM. You
can establish the PIM neighbor relationship on the interface to process various PIM packets. The
configuration, however, has potential risks of security. When a host maliciously generates PIM
Hello packets and sends the packets in large quantity, the switch may fail.
To solve the problem, set the status of the interface to PIM silent. When the interface is in PIM
silent state, the interface is prevented from receiving and forwarding any PIM packet. All PIM
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
191
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
neighbors and PIM state machines on the interface are deleted. The interface acts as the static
DR and immediately takes effect. At the same time, IGMP on the interface are not affected.
PIM silent is applicable only to the interface directly connected to the host network segment that
is connected only to this switch.
CAUTION
If PIM silent is enabled on the interface connected to a switch, the PIM neighbor relationship
cannot be set up and a multicast fault may occur.
If the host network segment is connected to multiple switchs and PIM silent is enabled on
multiple interfaces, the interfaces become static DRs. Therefore, multiple DRs exist in this
network segment, and a fault occurs.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring PIM silent, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to make the network layer reachable
l
Configuring PIM-SM
l
Configuring IGMP
Data Preparation
To configure PIM silent, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
The type and number of the interface connected to hosts
6.14.2 Configuring PIM Silent
After the interface is configured with PIM silent, it is forbidden to receive or forward any PIM
protocol packet. All PIM neighbors and PIM state machines on this interface are deleted. Then,
this interface automatically becomes the DR. IGMP on the interface is not affected.
Context
Do as follows on the interface connected to the host network segment:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
192
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
pim silent
PIM silent is enabled.
After PIM silent is enabled, the Hello packet attack of malicious hosts is effectively prevented
and the switch is protected.
----End
6.14.3 Checking the Configuration
After PIM silent is configured, you can run the command to check information about the PIM
interface.
Prerequisites
All the configurations of PIM silent are complete.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an
interface.
----End
Example
Run the display pim interface verbose command, and you can find that the configuration is
complete.
<SwitchA> display pim interface verbose
VPN-Instance: public net
Interface: Vlanif10, 2.2.2.2
PIM version: 2
PIM mode: Sparse
PIM state: up
PIM DR: 2.2.2.2 (local)
PIM DR Priority (configured): 1
PIM neighbor count: 0
PIM hello interval: 30 s
PIM LAN delay (negotiated): 500 ms
PIM LAN delay (configured): 500 ms
PIM hello override interval (negotiated): 2500 ms
PIM hello override interval (configured): 2500 ms
PIM Silent: enabled
PIM neighbor tracking (negotiated): disabled
PIM neighbor tracking (configured): disabled
PIM generation ID: 0X2649E5DA
PIM require-genid: disabled
PIM hello hold interval: 105 s
PIM assert hold interval: 180 s
PIM triggered hello delay: 5 s
PIM J/P interval: 60 s
PIM J/P hold interval: 210 s
PIM BSR domain border: disabled
PIM BFD: disabled
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
193
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
PIM dr-switch-delay timer : not configured
Number of routers on link not using DR priority: 0
Number of routers on link not using LAN delay: 0
Number of routers on link not using neighbor tracking: 1
ACL of PIM neighbor policy: ACL of PIM ASM join policy: ACL of PIM SSM join policy: ACL of PIM join policy: -
6.15 Maintaining PIM-SM (IPv4)
Maintaining PIM-SM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status.
6.15.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages
If you need to re-collect the statistics about PIM control messages, you can reset the existent
statistics. Note that the statistics cannot be restored after you reset them. This operation does not
affect normal running of PIM.
Context
CAUTION
The statistics of PIM control messages on an interface cannot be restored after you clear it. So,
confirm the action before you use the command.
Procedure
l
Run the reset pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message
counters [ interface interface-type interface-number ] command in the user view to clear
the statistics of PIM control messages on an interface.
----End
6.15.2 Clearing the PIM Status of the Specified Downstream
Interfaces of PIM Entries
You can clear the PIM Join/Prune state and Assert state on the specified downstream interface
of a PIM entry. IGMP status and static multicast groups on this interface are not affected.
Context
CAUTION
Clearing PIM status of the downstream interfaces may trigger the sending of corresponding Join/
Prune messages, which affects multicast services.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
194
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Using the following command can clear join information about illegal users, and clear the PIM
status of the specified interface in a specified entry, such as PIM Join/Prune status and Assert
status.
The command cannot be used to clear the IGMP or static group join status on a specified
interface.
Procedure
Step 1 After confirming that PIM status of the specified downstream interfaces of the specified PIM
entry need to be cleared, run the reset pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] routing-table
group group-address mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } source source-address
interface interface-type interface-number command in the user view.
----End
6.15.3 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM-SM
During the routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know the
running of PIM.
Context
In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running
status of PIM-SM.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] claimed-route
[ source-address ] command in any view to check the unicast routes used by PIM.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bfd session
[ interface interface-type interface-number | neighbor neighbor-address ] * command in
any view to check information about a PIM BFD session.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bsr-info command
in any view to check information about the BSR in a PIM-SM domain.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message
counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command in any view to check the number of sent or received PIM control
messages.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface
[ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command in any view to check
PIM on an interface.
l
Run the command display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ]
neighbor [ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * to
check PIM neighbors.
l
Run the following commands in any view to check the PIM routing table.
– display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | extranet { source-vpn-instance { all | public | vpninstance-name } | receive-vpn-instance { all | vpn-instance-name } } | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register | mcast-extranet } | outgoing-
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
195
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register |
none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interfacenumber [ number ] ]
– display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | extranet
{ source-vpn-instance { all | public | vpn-instance-name } | receive-vpn-instance
{ all | vpn-instance-name } } | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number |
register | mcast-extranet } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match }
{ interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | register | none } |
mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number
[ number ] ]
– display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | extranet { source-vpn-instance
{ all | public | vpn-instance-name } | receive-vpn-instance { all | vpn-instancename } } | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register | mcastextranet } ] *
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rp-info [ groupaddress ] command in any view to check information about the RP to which a multicast
group corresponds.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] invalid-packet
[ interface interface-type interface-number | message-type { assert | graft | graft-afk |
state-refresh | bsr | hello | join-prune } ] * command in any view to check the statistics
about invalid PIM messages received by a device.
----End
6.15.4 Debugging PIM
When a fault occurs during the running of PIM, run the debugging commands in the user view
and check the contents of sent and received packets for fault location.
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, execute the undo
debugging all command to disable it immediately.
When a PIM fault occurs, run the following debugging command in the user view to debug PIM
and locate the fault.
Procedure
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] all command
in the user view to enable all the debugging of PIM.
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] event
[ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM events.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
196
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routingtable [ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM
routes.
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] assert
[ advanced-acl-number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the
debugging of PIM Assert.
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rp [ receive |
send ] command in the user view to the debugging of PIM RP.
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] register
[ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM
Register.
l
Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] msdp
[ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of the
information exchanged between PIM and MSDP.
l
Run the debugging pim bfd { all | create | delete | event } command in the user view to
enable the debugging of PIM BFD.
----End
6.16 Configuration Examples
Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic PIM-SM network and
configure basic functions of PIM-SM.
6.16.1 Example for Configuring the PIM-SM Network
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 6-2, multicast is deployed on the network of an Internet Service Provider
(ISP). The Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) is deployed on the network. The unicast routing
routes work normally and are connected to the Internet. The routers on the network need to be
configured properly so that hosts can receive the video on demand (VOD) in multicast mode.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
197
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Figure 6-2 Networking diagram for configuring PIM-SM multicast network
Ethernet
SwitchA
GE3/0/0
Ethernet
N1
Receiver
GE2/0/0
GE1/0/0
PIM-SM
SwitchE
GE2/0/0
GE3/0/0
Source GE3/0/0
GE1/0/0
GE2/0/0
GE4/0/0
SwitchD
GE1/0/0
GE4/0/0 GE1/0/0
GE2/0/0
GE1/0/0
SwitchC
HostA
Leaf networks
GE2/0/0
Receiver
SwitchB
HostB
N2
Ethernet
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.9.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 101
10.110.1.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 200
192.168.1.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.2.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 102
10.110.2.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 102
10.110.2.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 400
192.168.3.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 500
192.168.4.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 200
192.168.1.2/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 103
10.110.5.1/24
GE 4/0/0
VLANIF 104
10.110.4.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 400
192.168.3.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.2.2/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.9.2/24
GE 4/0/0
VLANIF 500
192.168.4.1/24
SwitchB
SwitchC
SwitchD
SwitchE
Configuration Roadmap
The ISP network connects to the Internet. The PIM-SM protocol is used to configure the
multicast function, which facilitates service expansion. The ASM and SSM models provide
multicast services. The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol. PIM is an intradomain multicast routing protocol that depends on a unicast routing protocol. The multicast
routing protocol can work normally after the unicast routing protocol works normally.
2.
Enable multicast on all Switches providing multicast services. Before configuring other
PIM-SM functions, you must enable the multicast function.
3.
Enable PIM-SM on all the interfaces of Switches. After PIM-SM is enabled, you can
configure other PIM-SM functions.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
198
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
NOTE
If IGMP is also required on this interface, PIM-SM must be enabled before IGMP is enabled. The
configuration order cannot be reversed; otherwise, the configuration of PIM fails.
4.
Enable IGMP on the interfaces of Switches connected to hosts. A receiver can join and
leave a multicast group freely by sending an IGMP message. The leaf Switches maintain
the multicast membership through IGMP.
5.
Enable the PIM silent function on interface that is directly connected to hosts. In this
manner, malicious hosts are prevented from simulating PIM Hello messages and security
of multicast routers is ensured.
NOTE
PIM silent is applicable only to the interfaces of a Switch directly connected to the host network
segment that is connected only to this Switch.
6.
Configure the RP. The RP is a root node of an RPT on the PIM-SM network. It is
recommended that you configure the RP on a device that has more multicast flows, for
example, SwitchE in Figure 6-2.
NOTE
l After creating an (*, G) entry according to the new multicast membership, the DR on the user
side sends Join/Prune messages towards the RP and updates the shared tree on the path.
l When a multicast data source starts to send data to groups, the DR unicasts the Register message
to the RP. After receiving the Register message, the RP decapsulates it and then forwards it to
other multicast members along the shared tree. At the same time, the RP sends a Register-Stop
message to the DR on the multicast source side. After the Register-Stop is performed, the RPT
can be switched to the SPT.
7.
(Optional) Set the BSR boundary on the interfaces connected to the Internet. The Bootstrap
message cannot pass through the BSR boundary; therefore, the BSR serves only this PIMSM domain. In this manner, multicast services can be controlled effectively.
8.
(Optional) Configure range of SSM group addresses on each Switch. Ensure that Switches
in the PIM-SM domain provide services only for multicast groups in the range of SSM
group addresses. In this manner, multicast can be controlled effectively.
NOTE
This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure PIM-SM.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Address of multicast group G: 225.1.1.1/24
l
Address of multicast group S: 10.110.5.100/24
l
Version of the IGMP protocol running between routers and hosts: IGMPv3
l
Range of SSM group addresses: 232.1.1.0/24
Procedure
Step 1 Configure the IP address of each interface and the unicast routing protocol.
# Configure IP addresses and masks of interfaces on the Switches according to Figure 6-2.
Configure OSPF between Switches to ensure that the Switches can communicate at the network
layer and update routes through the unicast routing protocol.
For details on how to configure IP addresses of interfaces, see IP Addresses Configuration in
the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Service. For details on how to
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
199
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
configure OSPF, see OSPF Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration
Guide - IP Routing.
Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-SM on all interfaces.
# Enable multicast on all the Switches and enable PIM-SM on all interfaces. The configurations
of SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not
provided here.
[SwitchA] multicast
[SwitchA] interface
[SwitchA-Vlanif101]
[SwitchA-Vlanif101]
[SwitchA] interface
[SwitchA-Vlanif100]
[SwitchA-Vlanif100]
[SwitchA] interface
[SwitchA-Vlanif200]
[SwitchA-Vlanif200]
routing-enable
vlanif 101
pim sm
quit
vlanif 100
pim sm
quit
vlanif 200
pim sm
quit
Step 3 Enable IGMP on the interfaces connected to hosts.
# Enable IGMP on the interface connecting SwitchA to hosts, and set the IGMP version to v3.
The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to configuration of SwitchA,
and are not provided here.
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 101
[SwitchA-Vlanif101] igmp enable
[SwitchA-Vlanif101] igmp version 3
Step 4 Enable PIM silent on SwitchA.
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 101
[SwitchA-Vlanif101] pim silent
Step 5 Configure the RP.
NOTE
The RP can be configured in two modes: the static RP and the dynamic RP. The static RP can be configured
together with the dynamic RP. You can also configure only the static RP or the dynamic RP. When the
static RP and the dynamic RP are configured simultaneously, you can change the parameter values to
specify which RP is preferred.
This example shows how to configure the static RP and the dynamic RP and to specify the
dynamic RP as the preferred RP and the static RP as the standby RP.
# Configure the dynamic RP on one or more Switches in the PIM-SM domain. In this example,
set the service range of the RP and specify the locations of the C-BSR and the C-RP on
SwitchE.
[SwitchE] acl number 2008
[SwitchE-acl-basic-2008] rule permit source 225.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
[SwitchE-acl-basic-2008] quit
[SwitchE] pim
[SwitchE-pim] c-bsr vlanif 100
[SwitchE-pim] c-rp vlanif 100 group-policy 2008
# Configure static RPs on all Switches. The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchC, SwitchD, and
SwitchE are similar to configuration on SwitchA, and are not provided here.
NOTE
If you enter preferred to the right of static-rp X.X.X.X, the static RP is selected as the RP in the PIM-SM
domain.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
200
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
[SwitchA] pim
[SwitchA-pim] static-rp 192.168.2.2
Step 6 Configure the BSR boundary on the interface connecting SwitchD to the Internet.
[SwitchD] interface vlanif 104
[SwitchD-Vlanif104] pim bsr-boundary
[SwitchD-Vlanif104] quit
Step 7 Configure the range of SSM group addresses.
# Set the range of SSM group addresses to 232.1.1.0/24 on all Switches. The configurations of
SwitchB, SwitchC, SwitchD, and SwitchE are the same as the configuration of SwitchA, and
are not provided here.
[SwitchA] acl number 2000
[SwitchA-acl-basic-2000] rule permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
[SwitchA-acl-basic-2000] quit
[SwitchA] pim
[SwitchA-pim] ssm-policy 2000
Step 8 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display pim interface command. You can view the configuration and running status
of PIM on the interface. For example, the PIM information displayed on SwitchC is as follows:
<SwitchC> display pim interface
VPN-Instance: public net
Interface
State
NbrCnt
HelloInt
Vlanif102
up
0
30
Vlanif400
up
1
30
DR-Pri
1
1
DR-Address
10.110.2.2
192.168.3.1
(local)
(local)
# Run the display pim bsr-info command to view information about BSR election on the
Switches. For example, the BSR information on SwitchA and SwitchE (including the C-BSR
information on SwitchE) is as follows:
<SwitchA> display pim bsr-info
VPN-Instance: public net
Elected AdminScoped BSR Count: 0
Elected BSR Address: 192.168.9.2
Priority: 0
Hash mask length: 30
State: Accept Preferred
Scope: Not scoped
Uptime: 01:40:40
Expires: 00:01:42
C-RP Count: 1
<SwitchE> display pim bsr-info
VPN-Instance: public net
Elected AdminScoped BSR Count: 0
Elected BSR Address: 192.168.9.2
Priority: 0
Mask length: 30
State: Elected
Scope: Not scoped
Uptime: 00:00:18
Next BSR message scheduled at :00:01:42
C-RP Count: 1
Candidate AdminScoped BSR Count: 0
Candidate BSR Address is: 192.168.9.2
Priority: 0
Hash mask length: 30
State:Elected
Scope: Not scoped
Wait to be BSR: 0
# Run the display pim rp-info command to view the RP information on the Switches. For
example, the RP information displayed on SwitchA is as follows:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
201
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
<SwitchA> display pim rp-info
VPN-Instance: public net
PIM-SM BSR RP Number:1
Group/MaskLen: 225.1.1.0/24
RP: 192.168.9.2
Priority: 0
Uptime: 00:45:13
Expires: 00:02:17
PIM SM static RP Number:1
Static RP: 192.168.2.2
# Run the display pim routing-table command. You can view the PIM multicast routing table.
Host A needs to receive the information from group 225.1.1.1/24, and HostB needs to receive
the information sent by the source 10.110.5.100/24 to the group 232.1.1.1/24. The displayed
information is as follows:
[SwitchA] display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.9.2
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 00:13:46
Upstream interface: vlanif100,
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.9.2
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.9.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif101
Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:13:46, Expires:(10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.9.2
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT
UpTime: 00:00:42
Upstream interface: vlanif200
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.2
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.1.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif101
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:[SwitchB] display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 232.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.9.2
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 00:10:12
Upstream interface: vlanif100,
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.9.2
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.9.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif102
Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:10:12, Expires:(10.110.5.100, 232.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.9.2
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT
UpTime: 00:00:42
Upstream interface: vlanif300
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.2
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.1.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif102
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
202
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:30, Expires:-
[SwitchD] display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 0 (*, G) entry; 2 (S, G) entry
(10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.9.2
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT
UpTime: 00:00:42
Upstream interface: vlanif103
Upstream neighbor: 10.110.5.100
RPF prime neighbor: 10.110.5.100
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif200
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:(10.110.5.100, 232.1.1.1)
Protocol: pim-ssm, Flag:
UpTime: 00:01:20
Upstream interface: vlanif103
Upstream neighbor: 10.110.5.100
RPF prime neighbor: 10.110.5.100
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif500
Protocol: pim-ssm, UpTime: 00:01:20, Expires:[SwitchE] display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.9.2 (local)
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 00:13:16
Upstream interface: Register
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.2
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif100
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:13:16, Expires: 00:03:22
(10.110.5.100, 232.1.1.1)
Protocol: pim-ssm, Flag:
UpTime: 00:01:22
Upstream interface: vlanif500
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.2
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif400
Protocol: pim-ssm, UpTime: 00:01:22, Expires:[SwitchC] display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (S, G) entry
(10.110.5.100, 232.1.1.1)
Protocol: pim-ssm, Flag:
UpTime: 00:01:25
Upstream interface: vlanif400
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.3.2
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.3.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
203
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
1: vlanif102
Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:01:25, Expires:-
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 100 101 200
#
multicast routing-enable
#
acl number 2000
rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.9.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif101
ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
igmp version 3
pim silent
#
interface vlanif 200
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 101
port hybrid untagged vlan 101
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.9.0 0.0.0.255
#
pim
static-rp 192.168.2.2
ssm-policy 2000
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchB
#
sysname SwitchB
#
multicast routing-enable
#
vlan batch 102 300
#
acl number 2000
rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
204
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
interface Vlanif102
ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
igmp version 3
#
interface Vlanif300
ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 102
port hybrid untagged vlan 102
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
#
pim
static-rp 192.168.2.2
ssm-policy 2000
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 102 400
#
multicast routing-enable
#
acl number 2000
rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
interface Vlanif102
ip address 10.110.2.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
igmp version 3
#
interface Vlanif400
ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 102
port hybrid untagged vlan 102
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 400
port hybrid untagged vlan 400
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
#
pim
static-rp 192.168.2.2
ssm-policy 2000
#
return
l
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Configuration file of SwitchD
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
205
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
#
sysname SwitchD
#
vlan batch 103 104 200 500
#
multicast routing-enable
#
acl number 2000
rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
interface Vlanif103
ip address 10.110.5.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif104
ip address 10.110.4.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
pim bsr-boundary
#
interface Vlanif200
ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif500
ip address 192.168.4.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 500
port hybrid untagged vlan 500
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 103
port hybrid untagged vlan 103
#
interface GigabitEthernet4/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 104
port hybrid untagged vlan 104
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.4.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.5.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255
#
pim
static-rp 192.168.2.2
ssm-policy 2000
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchE
#
sysname SwitchE
#
vlan batch 100 300 400 500
#
multicast routing-enable
#
acl number 2000
rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
acl number 2008
rule 5 permit source 225.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
206
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.9.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif300
ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif400
ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif500
ip address 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid tagged vlan 400
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet4/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 500
port hybrid untagged vlan 500
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.9.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255
#
pim
c-bsr vlanif 100
c-rp vlanif 100 group-policy 2008
static-rp 192.168.2.2
ssm-policy 2000
#
return
6.16.2 Example for Configuring SPT Switchover in PIM-SM
Domain
Networking Requirements
Receivers can receive the VOD information in multicast mode. The entire PIM network adopts
a single BSR administrative domain. By default, after receiving the first multicast data packet,
the RP and the DR on the receiver side perform the SPT switchover, finding the optimal path to
receive the multicast information from the multicast source. If the receiver requires that the SPT
switchover be performed after the traffic reaches the threshold, you need to configure the SPT
switchover function.
As shown in Figure 6-3, you need to configure the Switches properly. In this way, HostA on
the leaf network then can receive multicast data from the RP (GE1/0/0 of SwitchA). When the
transmission rate of multicast packets reaches 1024 kbit/s, the SPT switchover is performed.
After the SPT switchover, the path through which HostA receive multicast packets is SourceSwitchB-SwitchC--HostA.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
207
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Figure 6-3 Networking diagram for performing the SPT switchover in PIM-SM domain
SwitchA
GE2/0/0
Ethernet
GE1/0/0
PIM-SM
GE2/0/0
Source
GE3/0/0
GE1/0/0
GE1/0/0
GE3/0/0
GE2/0/0
SwitchB
SwitchC
Leaf networks
Receiver
HostA
Ethernet
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.1.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 200
192.168.3.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.2.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 200
192.168.3.2/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 101
10.110.5.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.1.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 102
10.110.2.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.2.2/24
SwitchB
SwitchC
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol.
2.
Enable the multicast function on all Switches, enable PIM-SM on all interfaces, and enable
IGMP on the interfaces connected to hosts.
3.
Configure the same static RP on each Switch.
4.
Perform the SPT switchover on SwitchC.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Address of multicast source S: 10.110.5.100/24
l
Address of multicast group G: 225.1.1.1/24
l
Version of IGMP running between SwitchC and the leaf network: 2
Procedure
Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
208
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
# Based on Figure 6-3, configure the IP address and mask of each interface on Switches; connect
the Switches through OSPF to ensure that SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC can connect to each
other at the network layer and can dynamically update routes through the unicast routing
protocol.
For details on how to configure IP addresses of interfaces, see IP Addresses Configuration in
the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Service. For details on how configure
OSPF, see OSPF Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP
Routing.
Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches, PIM-SM on all interfaces, and IGMP on the interfaces
connected to hosts.
# Enable multicast on all Switches, PIM-SM on all interfaces, and IGMP on the interface through
which SwitchC is connected to the leaf network. The configurations of SwitchA and SwitchB
are similar to the configuration of SwitchC, and are not provided here.
[SwitchC] multicast
[SwitchC] interface
[SwitchC-Vlanif102]
[SwitchC-Vlanif102]
[SwitchC-Vlanif102]
[SwitchC-Vlanif102]
[SwitchC] interface
[SwitchC-Vlanif300]
[SwitchC-Vlanif300]
[SwitchC] interface
[SwitchC-Vlanif100]
[SwitchC-Vlanif100]
routing-enable
vlanif 102
pim sm
igmp enable
igmp version 2
quit
vlanif 300
pim sm
quit
vlanif 100
pim sm
quit
Step 3 Configure the static RP.
# Configure the static RP on SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC. The configurations of SwitchB
and SwitchC are similar to configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here.
[SwitchA] pim
[SwitchA-pim] static-rp 192.168.1.1
Step 4 Configure the threshold of the SPT switchover.
# Configure SwitchC to perform the SPT switchover when the transmission rate of multicast
packets reaches 1024 kbit/s.
[SwitchC] pim
[SwitchC-pim] spt-switch-threshold 1024
[SwitchC-pim] quit
Step 5 Verify the configuration.
# The multicast source begins to send data to the multicast group, and HostA can receive the
data from the source. When the rate is smaller than 1024 kbit/s, you can run the display pim
routing-table command to view the PIM multicast routing table on SwitchC. You can find that
the upstream neighbor is SwitchA. The displayed information is as follows:
<SwitchC> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 00:13:46
Upstream interface: vlanif100
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.1.1
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
209
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif102
Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:13:46, Expires:(10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: ACT
UpTime: 00:00:42
Upstream interface: vlanif100
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.1.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif102
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:-
# When the rate is higher than 1024 kbit/s, you can run the display pim routing-table command
to view the PIM multicast routing table on SwitchC. You can find that the upstream neighbor is
SwitchB. The displayed information is as follows:
<SwitchC> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 00:13:46
Upstream interface: vlanif300,
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif102,
Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:13:46, Expires:(10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 192.168.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag:RPT SPT ACT
UpTime: 00:00:42
Upstream interface: vlanif300
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif102
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:-
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 100 200
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif200
ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
210
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
pim
static-rp 192.168.1.1
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchB
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 101 200 300
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif101
ip address 10.110.5.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif200
ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif300
ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 101
port hybrid untagged vlan 101
#
pim
static-rp 192.168.1.1
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.5.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
multicast routing-enable
#
vlan batch 100 102 300
#
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
211
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif102
ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
#
interface Vlanif300
ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 102
port hybrid untagged vlan 102
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
pim
spt-switch-threshold 1024
static-rp 192.168.1.1
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
6.16.3 Example for Configuring PIM BFD
Networking Requirements
On the multicast network shown in Figure 6-4, PIM-SM is run between Switches. Hosts receive
the VOD information from the multicast source. SwitchA is the DR on the source side.
SwitchB and SwitchC are connected to the segment where hosts reside. When the DR changes,
other Switches on the network segment can detect the change of the DR quickly.
You can set up the BFD session on the network segment where the host is located to respond to
the changes of the DR quickly. In addition, you can configure the DR switchover delay. In this
case, when a Switch is added to the network segment and may become a DR, the multicast
routing table of the original DR is reserved until the routing entries of the new DR are created.
Therefore, the packet loss due to the delay in creating multicast entries is prevented.
NOTE
After the delay of PIM DR switchover is set, the downstream receiver may receive two copies of the same
data during the DR switchover and the assert mechanism will be triggered. If you do not want to trigger
the assert mechanism, you do not need to set the DR switchover delay.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
212
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Figure 6-4 Configuring the PIM BFD networking in the shared network segment
SwitchA
Source
10.1.7.1/24
PIM-SM GE1/0/0
SwitchC
GE1/0/0
GE2/0/0
10.1.1.2/24
SwitchB
GE2/0/0
10.1.1.1/24
VLAN100
User1
User2
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Configure PIM BFD on the interfaces that connect Switches to the network segment where
the host is located.
2.
Set the PIM DR switchover delay on the interfaces that connect Switches to the network
segment where the host is located.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Parameters of PIM BFD sessions
l
PIM DR switchover delay
NOTE
This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure PIM-SM BFD.
Procedure
Step 1 Configure the IP address of each interface and the unicast routing protocol.
# Configure IP addresses and masks of interfaces on the Switches according to Figure 6-4.
Configure OSPF between Switches to ensure that the Switches can communicate at the network
layer and update routes through the unicast routing protocol.
For details on how to configure IP addresses of interfaces, see IP Addresses Configuration in
the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Service. For details on how configure
OSPF, see OSPF Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP
Routing.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
213
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Step 2 Enable BFD globally and configure PIM BFD in the interface view.
# Enable BFD globally on SwitchB and SwitchC, enable PIM BFD on the interfaces that are
connected to the network segment where the host resides, and set PIM BFD parameters. The
configuration on SwitchC is similar to the configuration on SwitchB and is not provided here.
[SwitchB] bfd
[SwitchB-bfd] quit
[SwitchB] interface vlanif 100
[SwitchB-Vlanif100] pim bfd enable
[SwitchB-Vlanif100] pim bfd min-tx-interval 100 min-rx-interval 100 detectmultiplier 3
Step 3 Configure the PIM DR switchover delay.
# Configure PIM DR switchover delay on SwitchB and SwitchC. The configuration on
SwitchC is similar to the configuration on SwitchB and is not provided here.
[SwitchB-Vlanif100] pim timer dr-switch-delay 20
[SwitchB-Vlanif100] quit
[SwitchB] quit
Step 4 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display pim interface verbose command, and you can view detailed information
about the interface that runs PIM. The information about the interface that runs PIM on
SwitchB indicates that the DR on the network segment where the host is located is SwitchC.
PIM BFD is enabled on the interface and the switchover delay is set.
<SwitchB> display pim interface vlanif100 verbose
VPN-Instance: public net
Interface: Vlanif100, 10.1.1.1
PIM version: 2
PIM mode: Sparse
PIM state: up
PIM DR: 10.1.1.2
PIM DR Priority (configured): 1
PIM neighbor count: 1
PIM hello interval: 30 s
PIM LAN delay (negotiated): 500 ms
PIM LAN delay (configured): 500 ms
PIM Hello override interval (negotiated): 2500 ms
PIM Hello override interval (configured): 2500 ms
PIM Silent: disabled
PIM neighbor tracking (negotiated): disabled
PIM neighbor tracking (configured): disabled
PIM generation ID: 0XF5712241
PIM require-GenID: disabled
PIM hello hold interval: 105 s
PIM assert hold interval: 180 s
PIM triggered hello delay: 5 s
PIM J/P interval: 60 s
PIM J/P hold interval: 210 s
PIM BSR domain border: disabled
PIM BFD: enable
PIM BFD min-tx-interval: 100 ms
PIM BFD min-rx-interval: 100 ms
PIM BFD detect-multiplier: 3
PIM dr-switch-delay timer : 20 s
Number of routers on link not using DR priority: 0
Number of routers on link not using LAN delay: 0
Number of routers on link not using neighbor tracking: 2
ACL of PIM neighbor policy: ACL of PIM ASM join policy: ACL of PIM SSM join policy: ACL of PIM join policy: -
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
214
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
# Run the display pim bfd session command to display information about the BFD session on
each Switch. You can check whether the BFD session is set up on each Switch.
<SwitchB> display pim bfd session
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 BFD session Created
Vlanif100 (10.1.1.1): Total 1 BFD session Created
Neighbor
10.1.1.2
ActTx(ms)
100
ActRx(ms)
100
ActMulti
3
Local/Remote
8192/8192
State
Up
# Run the display pim routing-table command to view the PLM routing table. SwitchC
functions as the DR. The (S, G) and (*, G) entries exist. The displayed information is as follows:
<SwitchC> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 10.1.5.2
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 00:13:46
Upstream interface:
vlanif200,
Upstream neighbor: 10.1.2.2
RPF prime neighbor: 10.1.2.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif100,
Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:13:46, Expires:(10.1.7.1, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 10.1.5.2
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT
UpTime: 00:00:42
Upstream interface: vlanif200
Upstream neighbor: 10.1.2.2
RPF prime neighbor: 10.1.2.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif100
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:-
----End
Configuration Files
l
SwitchA needs to be configured with only basic PIM SM functions. The configuration file
is not provided here.
l
The following is the configuration file of SwitchB. The configuration file of SwitchC is
similar to the configuration file of SwitchB, and is not provided here.
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 100 200
#
multicast routing-enable
#
bfd
#
interface Vlanif100
ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
pim bfd enable
pim bfd min-tx-interval 100 min-rx-interval 100
pim timer dr-switch-delay 20
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
215
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
#
interface Vlanif200
ip address 10.1.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.1.2.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
6.16.4 Example for Configuring PIM GR
Networking Requirements
In the multicast application, if the active/standby switchover occurs on a device, the new master
MPU deletes the multicast forwarding entries of the LPUs and relearns the PIM routes and
multicast forwarding entries. During this process, multicast traffic is interrupted.
The PIM GR function on an IPTV network can protect the core devices and edge devices. When
an active/standby switchover occurs, the PIM GR function ensures that the multicast data is
forwarded normally. In this way, the fault tolerance capability of the devices on the IPTV
network is improved.
As shown in Figure 6-5, multicast services are deployed on the network. When SwitchC enabled
with the PIM GR function forwards multicast data to the receiver, the master MPU backs up the
PIM routes and Join/Prune messages to be sent to the upstream device to the slave MPU. When
the active/standby switchover occurs on SwitchC, the LPUs maintain the existing forwarding
entries to ensure uninterrupted forwarding of multicast data. The receiver can always receive
multicast data from the source during the active/standby switchover.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
216
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Figure 6-5 Networking diagram of PIM GR
Ethernet
Leaf networks
SwitchA
Source
GE2/0/0
GE2/0/0
GE1/0/0
GE1/0/0
GE1/0/0
SwitchB
Loopback0
1.1.1.1/32
GE2/0/0
SwitchC
Receiver
HostA
PIM-SM
Ethernet
Device
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE1/0/0
VLANIF 10
192.168.2.1/24
Loopback0
SwitchB
SwitchC
1.1.1.1/32
GE2/0/0
VLANIF 20
10.110.1.1/24
GE1/0/0
VLANIF 10
192.168.2.2/24
GE2/0/0
VLANIF 40
192.168.4.1/24
GE1/0/0
VLANIF 40
192.168.4.2/24
GE2/0/0
VLANIF 60
10.110.2.1/24
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Configure the IP addresses and unicast routing protocols on the physical interfaces of the
switch matching the VLANIF interfaces.
2.
Enable the unicast GR function on each switch and set the GR period.
3.
Enable the multicast function, enable PIM-SM on the interface of the switch, and enable
IGMP on the interface connecting switch to the host.
4.
Configure an RP. Configure same static RPs on the switches.
5.
Enable the PIM GR function on SwitchC and set the GR period.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Multicast source address 10.110.1.100
l
Multicast group address 225.1.1.1
l
Unicast GR period
l
PIM GR period
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
217
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Configure the IP addresses and unicast routing protocols on the physical interfaces of the
switch matching the VLANIF interfaces.
# Configure the IP address and mask on each interface of the switches according to Figure
6-5. The switches are connected to each other through OSPF. SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC
can communicate with each other at the network layer.
For details on how to configure IP addresses of interfaces, see IP Addresses Configuration in
the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Service. For details on how to
configure OSPF, see OSPF Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration
Guide - IP Routing.
Step 2 Enable the unicast GR function on each switch and set the unicast GR period.
# Enable the unicast GR function on all the switches and set the unicast GR period to 200 seconds.
The configurations of SwitchA and SwitchB are similar to the configuration of SwitchC, and
are not provided here.
[SwitchC] ospf 1
[SwitchC-ospf-1]
[SwitchC-ospf-1]
[SwitchC-ospf-1]
[SwitchC-ospf-1]
opaque-capability enable
graceful-restart
graceful-restart period 200
quit
Step 3 Enable the multicast function, enable PIM SM on each interface of the switch, and enable IGMP
on the interfaces connecting switch to the host.
# Enable the multicast function on all switches, and enable PIM SM on each interface of the
switch, and enable IGMP on the interface connecting switchC to the host. The configurations
of SwitchA and SwitchB are similar to the configuration of SwitchC, and are not provided here.
[SwitchC] multicast routing-enable
[SwitchC] interface gigabitethernet
[SwitchC-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port
[SwitchC-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port
[SwitchC-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit
[SwitchC] interface vlanif 60
[SwitchC-Vlanif60] pim sm
[SwitchC-Vlanif60] igmp enable
[SwitchC-Vlanif60] quit
[SwitchC] interface gigabitethernet
[SwitchC-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port
[SwitchC-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port
[SwitchC-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[SwitchC] interface vlanif 50
[SwitchC-Vlanif40] pim sm
[SwitchC-Vlanif40] quit
2/0/0
hybrid pvid vlan 60
hybrid untagged vlan 60
1/0/0
hybrid pvid vlan 50
hybrid untagged vlan 50
Step 4 Configure the static RP.
# Create a loopback interface on SwitchA and enable PIM SM on the interface.
[SwitchA] interface
[SwitchA-Loopback0]
[SwitchA-Loopback0]
[SwitchA-Loopback0]
loopback 0
ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
pim sm
quit
# Configure the static RP on all the switches. The configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are
similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here.
[SwitchA] pim
[SwitchA-pim] static-rp 1.1.1.1
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
218
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
[SwitchA-pim] quit
Step 5 Enable PIM GR and set the PIM GR period.
# Enable the PIM GR function on SwitchC and set the PIM GR period to 300 seconds.
[SwitchC] pim
[SwitchC-pim] graceful-restart
[SwitchC-pim] graceful-restart period 300
[SwitchC-pim] quit
Step 6 Verify the configuration.
# Multicast source 10.110.1.100 sends data to multicast group 225.1.1.1. Host A sends an IGMP
Report message to join the multicast group and it can receive multicast data from the multicast
source. Before SwitchC performs an active/standby switchover, run the display pim routingtable command on SwitchB and SwitchC to view the multicast routing tables. The command
output is as follows:
<SwitchB> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 1.1.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 01:52:38
Upstream interface: Vlanif10
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif40
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 01:52:38, Expires: 00:02:53
(10.110.1.100, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 1.1.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT
UpTime: 01:52:38
Upstream interface: Vlanif10
upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif40
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 01:52:38, Expires: 00:03:03
<SwitchC> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 1.1.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 01:51:24
Upstream interface: Vlanif40
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif60
Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 01:51:24, Expires: (10.110.1.100, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 1.1.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT
UpTime: 01:51:24
Upstream interface: Vlanif40
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.1
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
219
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif60
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 01:51:24, Expires: -
# Run the active/standby switchover commands on SwitchC.
[SwitchC] slave switchover
# After SwitchC performs an active/standby switchover, during PIM GR, run the display pim
routing-table command on SwitchB and SwitchC to view the routing tables. The command
output is as follows:
<SwitchB> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 1.1.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 02:52:38
Upstream interface: Vlanif10
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif40
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 02:52:38, Expires: 00:03:00
(10.110.1.100, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 1.1.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT
UpTime: 02:52:38
Upstream interface: Vlanif10
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif40
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 02:52:38, Expires: 00:03:12
<SwitchC> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 1.1.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 02:51:24
Upstream interface: Vlanif40
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif60
Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 02:51:24, Expires: (10.110.1.100, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 1.1.1.1
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT
UpTime: 02:51:24
Upstream interface: Vlanif40
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif60
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 02:51:24, Expires: -
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
220
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
On a multicast network, the downstream switch periodically sends Join/Prune messages to the
upstream device to update the timeout period of PIM routing entries on the upstream, thereby
ensuring normal multicast data forwarding.
If the GR function is not configured on SwitchC, the new master MPU deletes the multicast
forwarding entries of the LPUs, receives the IGMP Report messages sent by hosts, and creates
the PIM routing entries. During the active/standby switchover, multicast traffic is interrupted.
The preceding information indicates that after SwitchC performs an active/standby switchover,
the downstream interface on SwitchB remains unchanged. That is, after SwitchC performs the
active/standby switchover, SwitchC sends the backup Join messages to the upstream device. In
this way, the multicast forwarding entries are maintained during GR to ensure nonstop multicast
data forwarding.
During the restoration of multicast routing entries on SwitchC, users can still receive multicast
data normally and services are not affected.
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 10 20
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif10
ip address 192.168.2.1 24
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif20
ip address 10.110.1.1 24
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 20
port hybrid untagged vlan 20
#
interface Loopback0
ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
ospf 1
opaque-capability enable
graceful-restart period 200
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0
#
pim
static-rp 1.1.1.1
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchB
#
sysname SwitchB
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
221
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
#
vlan batch 10 40
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif10
ip address 192.168.2.2 24
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif40
ip address 192.168.4.1 24
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 40
port hybrid untagged vlan 40
#
ospf 1
opaque-capability enable
graceful-restart period 200
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255
#
pim
static-rp 1.1.1.1
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 40 60
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif40
ip address 192.168.4.2 24
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif60
igmp enable
ip address 10.110.2.1 24
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 40
port hybrid untagged vlan 40
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 60
port hybrid untagged vlan 60
#
ospf 1
opaque-capability enable
graceful-restart period 200
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255
#
pim
static-rp 1.1.1.1
graceful-restart
graceful-restart period 300
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
222
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
223
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
7
MSDP Configuration
About This Chapter
The MSDP protocol is used to implement multicast routing and data forwarding between PIMSM domains and anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain.
7.1 MSDP Overview
MSDP functions to set up an MSDP peer relationship between RPs in different PIM-SM
domains. MSDP peers exchange (S, G) information by sending SA messages. In this manner,
MSDP peers share multicast source information and hosts can receive multicast data from the
multicast sources in another PIM-SM domain.
7.2 MSDP Features Supported by the S9700
MSDP is used to implement PIM-SM inter-domain multicast and anycast RP in a PIM-SM
domain. You can control connections between MSDP peers, adjust SA message parameters, and
configure authentication for MSDP peers and filtering policies for SA messages to enhance
MSDP security. The system supports multi-instance MSDP.
7.3 Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast
This section describes how to set up an MSDP peer relationship between PIM-SM domains in
an AS and how to configure MSDP peers to implement PIM-SM inter-domain multicast.
7.4 Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain
Anycast RP indicates that when multiple RPs with the same address reside in the same PIM-SM
domain and MSDP peer relationships are set up between these RPs, IP routing automatically
selects the topologically closest RP for each source and receiver. In this manner, burdens on a
single RP are released, RP backup is implemented, and the forwarding path is optimized.
7.5 Managing MSDP Peer Connections
MSDP peers should set up TCP connections. You can then flexibly control the sessions set up
between MSDP peers by closing or re-establishing TCP connections. You can also adjust the
interval for retrying to set up a TCP connection between MSDP peers.
7.6 Configuring SA Cache
An SA cache is used to save the (S, G) information carried in SA messages locally. When a
device needs to receive multicast data, it directly obtains available (S, G) information from the
SA cache.
7.7 Configuring the SA Request
If the capacity of the SA cache enabled on the remote MSDP peer is too large, configuring
"sending SA Request message" on the local device can shorten the time taken by a receiver to
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
224
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
obtain multicast source information. You can configure filtering rules for receiving SA Request
messages on a specified remote MSDP peer.
7.8 Transmitting Burst Multicast Data Between Domains
By default, an SA message carries only (S, G) information. Then, if burst multicast data need
be transmitted between domains, you can configure multicast data encapsulation for an SA
message on the source RP. In addition, you can set the TTL threshold to limit the transmission
scope of multicast data encapsulated in an SA message.
7.9 Configuring the Filtering Rules for SA Messages
By default, a device receives all SA messages that pass the RPF check, and forwards the SA
messages to all MSDP peers. To control the transmission of SA messages among MSDP peers,
you can configure rules to filter the constructing, receiving, and forwarding SA messages.
7.10 Configuring MSDP Authentication
MSDP peer authentication contains MSDP MD5 authentication and Key-Chain authentication.
You can choose either authentication mode.
7.11 Maintaining MSDP
Maintaining MSDP involves clearing MSDP peer statistics and (S, G) information in the SA
cache, and monitoring MSDP running status.
7.12 Configuration Examples
Configuration examples are provided to show how to implement PIM-SM inter-domain
multicast through MBGP, how to implement inter-AS multicast through static RPF peers, and
how to configure anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
225
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
7.1 MSDP Overview
MSDP functions to set up an MSDP peer relationship between RPs in different PIM-SM
domains. MSDP peers exchange (S, G) information by sending SA messages. In this manner,
MSDP peers share multicast source information and hosts can receive multicast data from the
multicast sources in another PIM-SM domain.
In the general PIM-SM mode, a multicast source registers only with the local rendezvous point
(RP). The information on the inter-domain multicast sources is isolated. The RP knows only the
source in its domain, establishes a multicast distribution tree (MDT) in its domain, and distributes
the data sent by the source to the local users.
A mechanism is required to enable the local RP to share the information on the multicast sources
of other domains. With the mechanism, the local RP can send Join messages to the multicast
sources of other domains and establish MDTs. Therefore, multicast packets can be transmitted
across domains, and hosts in the local domain can receive data sent by multicast sources in other
domains.
The Multicast Source Discovery Protocol (MSDP) is an inter-area multicast solution based on
multiple interconnected PIM-SM domains, and can solve the preceding problem.
MSDP achieves this objective by setting up the MSDP peer relationship between RPs of different
domains. MSDP peers share the information on multicast sources by sending Source Active
(SA) messages. They transmit the (S, G) information from the RP that the source S registers
with to other RPs connected to members of G.
MSDP peers are connected through the TCP connection. MSDP peers perform the RPF check
on received SA messages.
NOTE
MSDP is applicable only to PIM-SM domains, and useful only for the Any-Source Multicast (ASM) mode.
7.2 MSDP Features Supported by the S9700
MSDP is used to implement PIM-SM inter-domain multicast and anycast RP in a PIM-SM
domain. You can control connections between MSDP peers, adjust SA message parameters, and
configure authentication for MSDP peers and filtering policies for SA messages to enhance
MSDP security. The system supports multi-instance MSDP.
PIM-SM Inter-Domain Multicast
When a multicast network is divided into multiple PIM-SM domains, MSDP is used to connect
RPs in each domain to share the multicast source information. In this manner, hosts in a domain
can receive multicast data sent by multicast sources in other domains.
You can configure a loopback interface as a C-RP or a static RP or specify the address of a
loopback interface as a logical RP address for SA messages.
PIM-SM Intra-Domain Anycast RP
After anycast RP is applied to a PIM-SM domain, the multicast source registers with the nearest
RP and receivers send Join messages to the nearest RP. This reduces the burden of a single RP,
implements RP backup, and optimizes the forwarding path.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
226
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
You can use a loopback interface as a interface of C-RP or static RP and specify the logical RP
address for an SA message.
Configuring Control Parameters for Maintaining MSDP Peer Connections
In the S9700, you can set up and tear down an MSDP session, and configure the period for
retrying to send TCP connection requests to the remote MSDP peers.
Configuring SA Cache
By default, SA-Cache is enabled on switchs. Therefore, switchs can locally store the (S, G)
information carried in SA messages. When required to receive the multicast data, the switchs
can obtain the (S, G) information from the SA-Cache.
You can set the maximum number of cached (S, G) entries, which can effectively prevent the
Denial of Service (DoS) attack.
You can disable SA-Cache on a switch. After the SA-Cache on a switch is disabled, the
switch does not locally store the (S, G) information carried in SA messages. When the switch
needs to receive multicast data, it needs to wait for the SA message to be sent by its MSDP peer
in the next period. This causes a delay for receivers to obtain multicast source information.
Controlling SA Requests
Certain switchs cannot be enabled with SA Cache or the capacity of SA Cache on these
switchs is too small. When these switchs need to receive multicast data, they cannot immediately
obtain the valid (S, G) information but need to wait for the SA message to be sent by their MSDP
peers in the next period.
If SA Cache is enabled on the remote MSDP peer and the capacity of the SA Cache is large, you
can configure "sending SA request messages" on the local switch to reduce the period during
which receivers obtain multicast source information.
At the same time, you can also configure the filtering rules for receiving SA request messages
on the remote MSDP peers.
Transmitting Burst Multicast Data
When the interval for a certain multicast source to send multicast data is longer than the timeout
period of an (S, G) entry, the source DR can only encapsulate burst multicast data in Register
messages and send them to the source RP. The source RP uses SA messages to transmit (S, G)
information to the remote RP. The remote RP then sends an (S, G) Join message towards the
multicast source to create an SPT. Because of the timeout of the (S, G) entry, the remote user
cannot receive the multicast data sent by S.
The S9700 supports the transmission of burst multicast data. You can enable the function of
encapsulating a multicast data packet in an SA message on the source RP. The source RP can
then encapsulate multicast data in an SA message and send the message out. After receiving the
SA message, the remote RP decapsulates the message, and then forwards multicast data to hosts
in the domain along the RPT.
Setting the TTL threshold can limit the transmission scope of a multicast data packet contained
in an SA message. After receiving an SA message containing a multicast data packet, an MSDP
peer checks the TTL value in the IP header of the multicast packet. If the TTL value is equal to
or smaller than the threshold, the MSDP peer does not forward the SA message to the specific
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
227
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
remote peers. If the TTL value is greater than the threshold, the MSDP peer reduces the TTL
value in the IP header of the multicast packet by 1, and then encapsulates the multicast packet
in an SA message and sends the message out.
Rules for Creating, Receiving, and Forwarding SA Messages
By default, MSDP switchs receive all SA messages that pass the RPF check and forward them
to all MSDP peers.
To control the transmission of SA messages between MSDP peers, you can configure filtering
rules by using the following methods:
l
Setting rules for filtering SA messages based on multicast sources on the source RP
The source RP filters active multicast sources that register with the local switch, and then
determines whether to send (S, G) entries based on the rules.
l
Setting rules for filtering SA messages received from remote MSDP peers
When an SA message sent by a remote MSDP peer reaches the local switch, the switch
determines whether to receive the message based on the rules.
l
Setting rules for filtering SA messages forwarded to remote MSDP peers
Before forwarding an SA message to a remote MSDP peer, the local switch determines
whether to forward it based on the rules.
Multi-Instance MSDP
MSDP peer relationships can be set up between interfaces on multicast switchs that belong to
the same instance (including the public instance and VPN instance). MSDP peers exchange SA
message with each other. The inter-domain VPN multicast is thus implemented.
Multicast switchs on which multi-instance is applied maintain a set of MSDP mechanisms for
each instance. Multicast switchs also guarantee the information separation among different
instances; therefore, only MSDP and PIM-SM that belong to the same instance can interact.
By applying multi-instance, the S9700 implements inter-domain VPN multicast.
NOTE
For details of inter-domain VPN multicast, refer to the chapter Multicast VPN Configuration.
MSDP Authentication
Configuring MSDP MD5 or Key-Chain authentication can improve the security of TCP
connections set up between MSDP peers. Note that the MSDP peers must be configured with
the same authentication password; otherwise, the TCP connection cannot be set up between
MSDP peers and MSDP messages cannot be transmitted.
7.3 Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast
This section describes how to set up an MSDP peer relationship between PIM-SM domains in
an AS and how to configure MSDP peers to implement PIM-SM inter-domain multicast.
7.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring PIM-SM inter-domain multicast, you need to configure intra-domain
multicast.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
228
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Applicable Environment
When a large multicast network is divided into multiple PIM-SM domains, MSDP is used to
connect RPs of various domains to share the source information. In this manner, hosts in a domain
can receive multicast data sent by multicast sources in other domains.
To ensure that all RPs in the network can share the source information, reduce the scale of an
MSDP connected graph. It is recommended to configure MSDP peer relationships between all
RPs, including static RPs and C-RPs, in the network.
To ensure that SA messages transmitted between MSDP peers are not interrupted by RPF rules
and to reduce redundant traffic, the following solutions are recommended:
l
Add MSDP peers in the same AS to one Mesh Group.
l
If MSDP peers are in different ASs, select either of the following solutions:
– Establish an MBGP peer relationship and use the same interface address.
– Configure each other as a static RPF peer.
NOTE
Both BGP and MBGP can be used to set up inter-AS EBGP peer relationships. MBGP is recommended
because MBGP does not affect the unicast topology of a network.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring PIM-SM inter-domain multicast, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to enable interworking at the network layer
l
Enabling IP multicast
l
Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast
Data Preparation
To configure PIM-SM inter-domain multicast, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Address of a remote MSDP peer
2
Type and number of the local interface connected to MSDP peers
3
Description of an MSDP peer
4
Name of a mesh group
7.3.2 Configuring Intra-AS MSDP Peers
When multiple PIM-SM domains exist in an AS or multiple RPs serving different multicast
groups exist in a PIM-SM domain, you are recommended to configure MSDP peer relationships
between all RPs (including static RPs and C-RPs) and add all MSDP peers to a mesh group.
Context
Do as follows on the RPs of all PIM-SM domains that belong to the same AS:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
229
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
MSDP is enabled in the public network instance or VPN instances and the MSDP view is
displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address connect-interface interface-type interface-number
An MSDP peer connection is configured
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l interface-type interface-number: specifies the local interface connected to the remote MSDP
peer.
NOTE
The system does not advertise routes on MTIs to VPNs; therefore, it is not allowed to use MTIs to set up
an MSDP peer connection.
Step 4 (Optional) Run:
peer peer-address description text
The description of a remote MSDP peer is added.
This configuration helps to differentiate remote MSDP peers and manage the connections with
the remote MSDP peers.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l text: specifies the description text. The text is a string of 80 characters.
Step 5 Run:
peer peer-address mesh-group name
A remote MSDP peer is configured to join a mesh group.
That is, the remote MSDP peer is acknowledged as a member of the mesh group.
The parameters of this command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l name: specifies the name of a mesh group. The members of the same mesh group use the
same mesh group name.
Note the following:
l MSDP peer connections must be set up between all members of the same mesh group.
l All members of the mesh group must acknowledge each other as a member of the group.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
230
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
l An MSDP peer can belong to only one mesh group. If an MSDP peer is configured to join
different mesh groups for multiple times, only the latest configuration is valid.
----End
7.3.3 Configuring Inter-AS MSDP Peers on MBGP Peers
You can configure an MSDP peer relationship between RPs in different ASs that have set up an
MBGP peer relationship. In this manner, PIM-SM domains in different ASs can share multicast
source information.
Context
Establish the MBGP peer relationship between two RPs of different ASs and do as follows on
the MBGP peers:
NOTE
If the two RPs set up the BGP peer relationship, it is not necessary to set up the MBGP peer relationship
between them.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
MSDP is enabled in the public network instance or VPN instance, and the MSDP view is
displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address connect-interface interface-type interface-number
An MSDP peer connection is configured.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. The address is the same as that
of the remote BGP or MBGP peer.
l interface-type interface-number: specifies the local interface connected to the remote MSDP
peer. The interface is the same as the local BGP or MBGP interface.
Step 4 (Optional) Run:
peer peer-address description text
The description of the MSDP peer is added.
The configuration helps to distinguish the remote MSDP peers and manage the connections with
the remote MSDP peers.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
231
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
l text: specifies the description text. The text is a string of 80 characters.
----End
7.3.4 Configuring Static RPF Peers
You can configure a static RPF peer relationship between RPs in different ASs so that SA
messages which sent by RPF peer don't need do RPF check.
Context
NOTE
If Configuring Inter-AS MSDP Peers on MBGP Peers is complete, skip the configuration.
Do as follows on two RPs of different ASs:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
MSDP is enabled in the public network instance or VPN instance, and the MSDP view is
displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address connect-interface interface-type interface-number
An MSDP peer connection is configured.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l interface-type interface-number: specifies the local interface connected to the remote MSDP
peer.
Step 4 (Optional) Run:
peer peer-address description text
The description of a remote MSDP peer is added.
The configuration helps to distinguish remote MSDP peers and manage the connections with
the remote MSDP peers.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l text: specifies the description text. The text is a string of up to 80 characters.
Step 5 Run:
static-rpf-peer peer-address [ rp-policy ip-prefix-name ]
A remote MSDP peer is statically specified as an RPF peer.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
232
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
peer-address specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
----End
7.3.5 Checking the Configuration
After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast is configured, you can run related commands to check
brief and detailed information about MSDP peers.
Procedure
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command
to check the brief information about the statuses of all remote peers that establish MSDP
peer relationships with the local host.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status
[ peer-address ] to check the detailed information about the statuses of the specified remote
peers that establish the MSDP peer relationships with the local host.
----End
Example
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command. If the
brief information about the remote MSDP peer status is displayed, it means that the configuration
succeeds. For example:
<Quidway> display msdp brief
MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Configured
Up
Listen
Connect
Shutdown
2
2
0
0
0
Peer's Address
192.168.2.1
192.168.4.2
State
UP
UP
Up/Down time
01:07:08
00:06:39
AS
200
100
SA Count
8
13
Down
0
Reset Count
0
0
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status [ peeraddress ] command. If the verborse information about the remote MSDP peer status is displayed,
it means that the configuration succeeds. For example:
<Quidway> display msdp peer-status 10.110.11.11
MSDP Peer Information of VPN-Instance: public net
MSDP Peer 20.20.20.20, AS 100
Description:
Information about connection status:
State: Up
Up/down time: 14:41:08
Resets: 0
Connection interface: LoopBack0 (20.20.20.30)
Number of sent/received messages: 867/947
Number of discarded output messages: 0
Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 14:42:40
Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy:
Import policy: none
Export policy: none
Information about SA-Requests:
Policy to accept SA-Request messages: none
Sending SA-Requests status: disable
Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 0
SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA-cache maximum for the peer: none
Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0
Counters for MSDP message:
Count of RPF check failure: 0
Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
233
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0
Peer authentication: configured
Peer authentication type: KeyChain
7.4 Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain
Anycast RP indicates that when multiple RPs with the same address reside in the same PIM-SM
domain and MSDP peer relationships are set up between these RPs, IP routing automatically
selects the topologically closest RP for each source and receiver. In this manner, burdens on a
single RP are released, RP backup is implemented, and the forwarding path is optimized.
7.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
You can configure anycast RP in the scenario where devices in a PIM-SM domain are reachable,
PIM-SM is enabled on the interfaces configured with multicast routing, and no RP is configured
in the network.
Applicable Environment
In a traditional PIM-SM domain, each multicast group can be mapped to only one RP. When
the network is overloaded or the traffic is too concentrated, many network problems are caused.
For example, the pressure of the RP is too heavy, switchs converge slowly after the RP fails,
and the multicast forwarding path is not optimal.
After anycast RPs are applied in a PIM-SM domain, the source registers with the nearest RP and
hosts sends Join messages to the nearest RP. That is, the load of a single RP is abated, the RP
backup is implemented, and the forwarding path is optimized.
The recommended configuration solutions are as follows:
l
Configure loopback interfaces on multiple switchs in the PIM-SM domain respectively,
assign the same IP address to the loopback interfaces, and advertise the IP address by using
unicast routes.
l
Configure the loopback interfaces on the switchs as C-RPs or configure the address of the
loopback interface as a static RP on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain.
l
Set up the MSDP peer relationship between the switchs. If the number of switchs is greater
than three, it is recommended to set up the MSDP peer relationship between the switchs
and configure them to join the same mesh group.
l
Specify the logical RP address to transmit SA messages between the MSDP peers.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring an anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer
l
Enabling IP multicast
l
Configuring a PIM-SM domain without any RP
Data Preparation
To configure an anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
234
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
No.
Data
1
RP address
2
Interface and address of the local MSDP peer
3
Interface and address of the remote MSDP peer
4
Description of an MSDP peer
7.4.2 Configuring the Interface Address of an RP
Before configuring anycast RP on the devices in a PIM-SM domain, configure a loopback
interface on each device and assign the same IP address to the loopback interfaces. In addition,
advertise the IP address of the RP through unicast routes to ensure that each device has a
reachable route to the RP interface.
Context
Use a unicast routing protocol in the current network to advertise the address of the newly
configured RP interface. Ensure that all switchs in the network have a route to the RP.
In the PIM-SM domain, do as follows on multiple switchs on which the anycast RP is to be
configured:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface loopback interface-number
The loopback interface view is displayed.
Multiple RPs can use the same IP address in a network. The RPs, therefore, are configured on
the loopback interface.
Step 3 Run:
ip address ip-address { mask | mask-length }
The address of the loopback interface is configured.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l ip-address: specifies the address of an RP. The RPs configured on multiple devices uses the
same IP address.
l mask | mask-length: specifies the address mask of the loopback interface.
Step 4 Run:
pim sm
PIM-SM is enabled for the RP interface.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
235
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
NOTE
Before configuring a dynamic RP, you need to run this command. This command is not required when you
configure a static RP.
----End
7.4.3 Configuring a C-RP
A loopback interface is generally configured as a C-RP on the device to be configured with
anycast RP.
Context
NOTE
l If the PIM-SM network uses a static RP, the configuration is not necessary.
l If the PIM-SM network uses a BSR-RP, the configuration is mandatory. Before configuring a C-RP,
configure a BSR and BSP boundary. The BSR address cannot be the same as the C-RP address.
Do as follows on multiple switchs where anycast RP is to be configured in the PIM-SM domain:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
c-rp loopback interface-number
An interface is configured as a C-RP.
----End
7.4.4 Statically Configuring an RP
To configure a static RP, you need to configure the addresses of the loopback interfaces as the
RP addresses on all the devices in a PIM-SM domain.
Context
NOTE
l When the PIM-SM network uses a BSR-RP, the configuration is not necessary.
l When the PIM-SM network uses a static RP, the configuration is mandatory.
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
236
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
static-rp rp-address
The loopback interface address is configured as a static RP address.
----End
7.4.5 Configuring an MSDP Peer
MSDP peer relationships need be set up between RPs. If there are more than three devices,
MSDP peer relationships should be set up between any two devices and all MSDP peers should
be added to one mesh group.
Context
Do as follows on multiple switchs on which an anycast RP is to be created:
NOTE
If the number of switchs configured with the RPs that have the same IP address exceeds two, ensure the
interconnection between the switchs that set up MSDP peer relationship.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
MSDP is enabled in the public network instance or the VPN instance, and the MSDP view is
displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address connect-interface interface-type interface-number
An MSDP peer connection is created.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l interface-type interface-number: specifies the local interface.
Step 4 (Optional) Run:
peer peer-address description text
The description of the MSDP peer is added.
This configuration helps to differentiate remote MSDP peers and manage the connection with
the remote MSDP peers.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
237
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l text: specifies the description text. The text is a string of 80 characters.
Step 5 (Optional) Run:
peer peer-address mesh-group name
A remote MSDP peer is configured to join a mesh group.
That is, the remote MSDP peer is acknowledged as a member of the mesh group.
If only two switchs are configured with the anycast-RP, this configuration is not necessary.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l name: specifies the name of a mesh group. The members of the same mesh group use the
same mesh group name.
Note the following:
l MSDP peer connections must be set up between all members of the mesh group.
l All members of the mesh group must acknowledge each other as the member of the mesh
group.
l An MSDP peer belongs to only one mesh group. If an MSDP peer is configured to join
different mesh groups for many times, only the last configuration is valid.
----End
7.4.6 Specifying the Logical RP Address for an SA Message
After receiving an SA message, an MSDP peer performs the RPF check on the message. If the
remote RP address carried in the SA message is the same as the local RP address, the MSDP
peer discards the SA message. Therefore, you need to specify a logical RP address for SA
messages on the device on which anycast RP is to be configured.
Context
After receiving an SA message, an MSDP peer performs the RPF check on the message. If the
remote RP address carried in the SA message is the same as the local RP address, the SA message
is discarded.
Do as follows on the switchs on which the anycast RP is to be configured:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
238
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Step 3 Run:
originating-rp interface-type interface-number
The logical RP interface is configured. The logical RP interface cannot be the same as the actual
RP interface. It is recommended to configure the logical interface as the MSDP peer interface.
After the originating-rp command is used, the logical RP address carried in the SA message
sent by the switch replaces the RP address in the IP header of the SA message, and the SA
message can pass the RPF check after reaching the remote switch.
NOTE
The system does not advertise routes on the MTIs to VPNs; therefore, the MTIs cannot be used as logical
RPs.
----End
7.4.7 Checking the Configuration
After anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you can run related commands to check
brief information about MSDP peers and RP information of PIM routing entries.
Procedure
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command
to check the brief information of the MSDP peer status.
l
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table
command to check the information about the RP corresponding to the PIM routing table.
----End
Example
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command. If the
brief information about the remote MSDP peer status is displayed, it means that the configuration
succeeds. For example:
<Quidway> display msdp brief
MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Configured
Up
Listen
Connect
Shutdown
1
1
0
0
0
Peer's Address
2.2.2.2
State
UP
Up/Down time
00:10:17
AS
?
SA Count
0
Down
0
Reset Count
0
Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table
command. If the RP information corresponding to the routing table is displayed, it means that
the configuration succeeds. For example:
<Quidway> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 0 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(10.11.1.2, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 7.7.7.7 (local)
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT
UpTime: 00:01:57
Upstream interface: Vlanif10
Upstream neighbor: 10.3.1.2
RPF prime neighbor: 10.3.1.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif20
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: - , Expires:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
-
239
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
7.5 Managing MSDP Peer Connections
MSDP peers should set up TCP connections. You can then flexibly control the sessions set up
between MSDP peers by closing or re-establishing TCP connections. You can also adjust the
interval for retrying to set up a TCP connection between MSDP peers.
7.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast or anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you
can manage the connection between MSDP peers as required.
Applicable Environment
MSDP peers are connected by the TCP connection (the port number is 639). Users can close or
reestablish a TCP connection, and flexibly control the sessions set up between MSDP peers.
When a new MSDP peer is created, or when a closed MSDP peer connection is restarted, or
when a faulty MSDP peer tries recovering, the TCP connection needs to be immediately set up
between MSDP peers. Users can flexibly adjust the interval for retrying setting up an MSDP
peer connection.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before managing MSDP peer connections, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer
l
Enabling IP multicast
l
Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast
l
Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a
PIM-SM Domain
Data Preparation
To manage MSDP peer connections, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Address of a remote MSDP peer
2
The period for retrying sending the TCP connection request to the remote MSDP peer
of the local switch
7.5.2 Controlling the Sessions Between MSDP Peers
After the connection between MSDP peers is closed, the MSDP peers no longer exchange SA
messages and do not retry to set up a new connection. You can restart the connection between
the MSDP peers as required.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
240
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Context
Do as follows on the switch on which the MSDP peer is created:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
shutdown peer-address
A session with the remote MSDP peer is closed.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l After the session with the remote MSDP peer is closed, the TCP connection is closed, the
peers no longer transmit SA messages, and the peers do not re-try setting up the connection.
The configuration, however, is saved.
l You can run the undo shutdown peer-address command to open the session with the remote
MSDP peer, and reestablish the TCP connection.
----End
7.5.3 Adjusting the interval for Retrying Setting up an MSDP Peer
Connection
When a new MSDP peer relationship is created, when a closed MSDP peer connection is
restarted, or when a faulty MSDP peer tries recovering, a TCP connection needs to be
immediately set up between the MSDP peers. You can flexibly adjust the interval for retrying
to set up a TCP connection between MSDP peers.
Context
Do as follows on the switch on which the MSDP peer is created:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
241
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Step 3 Run:
timer retry interval
The period for retrying sending the TCP connection request to the remote MSDP peer is set
----End
7.5.4 Checking the Configuration
After a TCP connection is set up between MSDP peers, you can run related commands to check
brief and detailed information about MSDP peers.
Procedure
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command
to check the brief information about the statuses of all remote peers that establish MSDP
peer relationships with the local host.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status
[ peer-address ] to check the detailed information about the statuses of the specified remote
peers that establish the MSDP peer relationships with the local host.
----End
Example
<Quidway> display msdp brief
MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Configured
Up
Listen
Connect
Shutdown
2
2
0
0
0
Peer's Address
192.168.2.1
192.168.4.2
State
UP
UP
Up/Down time
01:07:08
00:06:39
AS
200
100
SA Count
8
13
Down
0
Reset Count
0
0
7.6 Configuring SA Cache
An SA cache is used to save the (S, G) information carried in SA messages locally. When a
device needs to receive multicast data, it directly obtains available (S, G) information from the
SA cache.
7.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast or anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you
can configure an SA cache as required.
Applicable Environment
By default, SA Cache is enabled on switchs on which MSDP peers are configured. The
switchs can locally store the (S, G) information carried in SA messages. When the switchs need
to receive (S, G) information, the switchs can obtain the (S, G) information from the SA Cache.
Setting the maximum number of (S, G) entries can prevent the Denial of Service (DoS) attack.
Users can disable the SA Cache of a switch. After the SA Cache of a switch is disabled, the
switch does not locally store the (S, G) information carried in SA messages. When a switch
wants to receive (S, G) data, it needs to waits for the SA message to be sent by its MSDP peer
in the next period. This delays receivers from obtaining multicast data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
242
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring SA Cache, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer
l
Enabling IP multicast
l
Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast
l
Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a
PIM-SM Domain
Data Preparation
To configure SA Cache, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Maximum number of (S, G) entries in the SA Cache
7.6.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of (S, G) Entries in the
Cache
Setting the maximum number of (S, G) entries in an SA cache can prevent DoS attacks.
Context
Do as follows on the switch on which the MSDP peer is configured:
NOTE
If the configuration is not done, default values are used.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address sa-cache-maximum sa-limit
The maximum number of (S, G) entries is set.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
243
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
l sa-limit: specifies the maximum number of cached (S, G) entries. The value of configuration
is valid when it is less than the specification of cache. Contrarily, specification of cache is
valid.
----End
7.6.3 Disabling the SA Cache Function
You are allowed to disable the SA cache function. Then, when a device wants to receive multicast
data, it needs to wait for the SA message to be sent by its MSDP peer in the next period. This
results in a delay in obtaining multicast data.
Context
Do as follows on the switch on which the MSDP peer is configured:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
undo cache-sa-enable
The SA Cache function is disabled.
NOTE
To reenable SA Cache, run the cache-sa-enable command in the MSDP view.
----End
7.6.4 Checking the Configuration
After the SA cache function is configured, you can run related commands to check the
information about entries in the SA cache.
Procedure
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress | source-address | [ 2-byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] ] * command to check
(S, G) entries in the SA Cache of the public network instance, VPN instance or all instances.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-count [ 2byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] command to check the number of (S, G) entries in the
SA Cache of the public network instance, VPN instance or all instances.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
244
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Example
Run the display msdp sa-cache command to check (S, G) entries in SA Cache.
<Quidway> display msdp sa-cache
MSDP Source-Active Cache Information of VPN-Instance: public net
MSDP Total Source-Active Cache - 3 entries
MSDP matched 3 entries
(8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.200)
Origin RP: 4.4.4.4
Pro: BGP, AS: 10
Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27
(8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.201)
Origin RP: 4.4.4.4
Pro: BGP, AS: 1.0
Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27
(8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.202)
Origin RP: 4.4.4.4
Pro: BGP, AS: 65535.65535
Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27
Run the display msdp sa-count command to check the number of (S, G) entries in SA Cache.
<Quidway> display msdp sa-count
MSDP Source-Active Count Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Number of cached Source-Active entries, counted by Peer
Peer's Address
Number of SA
10.10.10.10
5
Number of source and group, counted by AS
AS
Number of source
Number of group
?
3
3
Total 5 Source-Active entries matched
7.7 Configuring the SA Request
If the capacity of the SA cache enabled on the remote MSDP peer is too large, configuring
"sending SA Request message" on the local device can shorten the time taken by a receiver to
obtain multicast source information. You can configure filtering rules for receiving SA Request
messages on a specified remote MSDP peer.
7.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast or anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you
can configure "SA Request message sending" as required.
Applicable Environment
The capacity of SA Cache on certain switchs is small. When these switchs need to receive
multicast data, they cannot immediately obtain the valid (S, G) information and need to wait for
the SA message sent by their MSDP peers in the next period.
If SA Cache is enabled on the remote MSDP peer and the capacity of the SA Cache is large,
configuring "sending SA Request message" on the local switch can shorten the period during
which receivers obtain multicast source information.
l
When the local switch wants to receive (S, G) information, it sends an SA Request message
to a specified remote MSDP peer.
l
Once receiving the SA Request message, the MSDP peer responds to the SA Request
message with the required (S, G) information. If the "filtering rule of SA Request message"
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
245
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
is configured on the remote MSDP peer, it checks the SA Request messages received from
a specified peers and determines whether to respond according to the checking results.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring an SA request, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer
l
Enabling IP multicast
l
Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast
l
Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a
PIM-SM Domain
Data Preparation
To configure an SA request, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Address of a remote MSDP peer
2
Filtering list for receiving SA request messages
7.7.2 Configuring "Sending SA Request Messages" on the Local
switch
When a device receives a new Join message and no corresponding (S, G) entry exists locally or
in the SA cache, the device immediately sends an SA Request message to the specified MSDP
peer rather than waits for the SA message in the next period.
Context
Do as follows on the local switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address request-sa-enable
Sending SA Request message is configured.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
246
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
peer-address specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. When the local switch receives a
new Join message from a group, it sends an SA Request message only to peer-address.
----End
7.7.3 (Optional) Configuring the Filtering Rules for Receiving SA
Request Messages
You can configure rules for filtering the SA Request messages received from the local device
on a specified remote MSDP peer. If the SA Request message passes the filtering, the peer
immediately responds.
Context
Do as follows on the remote MSDP peer specified by using the peer peer-address request-saenable command. If the configuration is not done, once an SA message reaches, the switch
immediately responds to it with an SA message containing the required (S, G) information.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address sa-request-policy [ acl { basic-acl-number | acl-name } ]
The filtering rules for receiving SA Request messages are set.
l peer-address: specifies the address of an MSDP peer that sends the SA Request message.
l acl: specifies the filtering policy. If the ACL is not specified, all SA messages sent by a peer
are ignored. If the ACL is specified, only the SA messages that match the ACL are received
and other SA messages are discarded.
----End
7.7.4 Check the Configuration
After "SA Request message sending" is configured, you can run related commands to check
detailed information about MSDP peers and SA cache information.
Procedure
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status
[ peer-address ] command to check detailed information about the MSDP peer status.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress | source-address | [ 2-byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] ] * command to check
SA Cache of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
247
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Example
Run the display msdp peer-status [ peer-address ] command, and you can view the SARequests field and check whether the configuration is valid. For example:
<Quidway> display msdp peer-status
MSDP Peer 172.40.41.1, AS ?
Description:
Information about connection status:
State: Up
Up/down time: 00:26:41
Resets: 0
Connection interface: Vlanif10 (172.40.41.2)
Number of sent/received messages: 27/28
Number of discarded output messages: 0
Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 00:26:56
Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy:
Import policy: none
Export policy: none
Information about SA-Requests:
Policy to accept SA-Request messages: 2000
Sending SA-Requests status: enable
Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 0
SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA Cache maximum for the peer: none
Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0
Counters for MSDP message:
Count of RPF check failure: 0
Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 16/0
Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0
Peer authentication: configured
Peer authentication type: Key-Chain
7.8 Transmitting Burst Multicast Data Between Domains
By default, an SA message carries only (S, G) information. Then, if burst multicast data need
be transmitted between domains, you can configure multicast data encapsulation for an SA
message on the source RP. In addition, you can set the TTL threshold to limit the transmission
scope of multicast data encapsulated in an SA message.
7.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast or anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you
can configure the transmission of burst multicast data between domains as required.
Applicable Environment
The time during which certain multicast sources send multicast data is long, and is longer than
the timeout of an (S, G) entry. In this case, the source DR encapsulates multicast data packets
in Register messages one by one, and sends the messages to the source RP. The source RP then
uses SA messages to forward (S, G) entries to the remote RP.
The remote RP then sends a Join message to the source DR. An SPT is thus set up. Because of
the timeout of the (S, G) entry, remote users cannot receive multicast data sent by S.
After the function of encapsulating a multicast packet in an SA message is enabled on the source
RP, the source RP encapsulates multicast data in SA messages and sends them out. After
receiving an SA message, a remote RP decapsulates the message and forwards the multicast data
to users in the domain along the RPT.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
248
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Setting the TTL threshold can limit the transmission scope of a multicast packet contained in an
SA message. After receiving an SA message containing a multicast packet, an MSDP peer checks
the TTL value in the IP header of the multicast packet. If the TTL value is smaller than or equal
to the threshold, the MSDP peer does not forward the SA message to a specific remote peers. If
the TTL value is greater than the threshold, the MSDP peer reduces the TTL value in the IP
header of the multicast packet by 1, and then encapsulates the multicast packet in an SA message
and sends it out.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before transmitting burst multicast data between domains, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer
l
Enabling IP multicast
l
Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast
l
Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a
PIM-SM Domain
Data Preparation
To transmit burst multicast data between domains, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
TTL threshold for forwarding an SA message containing a multicast data packet
2
Address of a remote MSDP peer
7.8.2 Encapsulating a Multicast Data Packet in an SA message
By default, an SA message contains only (S, G) information, with no multicast data packets
encapsulated. You can configure multicast data encapsulation for an SA message on the source
RP configured with an MSDP peer.
Context
Do as follows on the source RP configured with an MSDP peer:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
encap-data-enable
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
249
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
A multicast data packet is encapsulated in an SA message.
By default, the SA message contains only (S, G) information, and does not contain a multicast
data packet.
----End
7.8.3 (Optional) Setting the TTL Threshold for Forwarding an SA
Message Containing a Multicast Data Packet
After receiving an SA massage encapsulated with a multicast data packet, an MSDP peer
forwards the SA message to a specified remote MSDP peer only when the TTL value of the
multicast packet is greater than the set threshold.
Context
Do as follows on the switch configured with an MSDP peer:
NOTE
If the configuration is not done, default values are used.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address minimum-ttl ttl
The TTL threshold of a multicast data packet is set.
After receiving an SA massage containing a multicast data packet, an MSDP peer forwards the
SA message to a specified remote MSDP peers only when the TTL value of the multicast packet
is greater than the threshold.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l ttl: specifies the value of the TTL threshold. By default, the value is 0.
----End
7.8.4 Checking the Configuration
After the transmission of burst multicast data is configured, you can run related commands to
check detailed information about MSDP peers and SA cache information.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
250
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress | source-address | [ 2-byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] ] * command to check
SA Cache of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status
[ peer-address ] command to check detailed information about the MSDP peer status.
----End
Example
Run the display msdp peer-status [ peer-address ] command, and you can view the minimum
TTL for forwarding an SA messages containing a data packet and check whether the
configuration is valid. For example:
<Quidway> display msdp peer-status
MSDP Peer Information of VPN-Instance: public net
MSDP Peer 172.40.41.1, AS ?
Description:
Information about connection status:
State: Up
Up/down time: 00:26:41
Resets: 0
Connection interface: Vlanif10 (172.40.41.2)
Number of sent/received messages: 27/28
Number of discarded output messages: 0
Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 00:26:56
Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy:
Import policy: none
Export policy: none
Information about SA-Requests:
Policy to accept SA-Request messages: 2000
Sending SA-Requests status: enable
Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 10
SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA Cache maximum for the peer: none
Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0
Counters for MSDP message:
Count of RPF check failure: 0
Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 16/0
Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0
Peer authentication: unconfigured
Peer authentication type: none
Run the display msdp sa-cache command to check the information about (S, G) entries in SA
Cache.
l
If group-address is specified, the (S, G) entry to which a specified group corresponds is
displayed.
l
If source-address is specified, the (S, G) entry to which a specified source corresponds is
displayed.
l
If 2-byte-as-number or 4-byte-as-number is specified, the (S, G) entry whose Origin RP
attribute belongs to a specified AS is displayed.
<Quidway> display msdp sa-cache
MSDP Source-Active Cache Information of VPN-Instance: public net
MSDP Total Source-Active Cache - 3 entries
MSDP matched 3 entries
(8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.200)
Origin RP: 4.4.4.4
Pro: BGP, AS: 10
Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
251
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
(8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.201)
Origin RP: 4.4.4.4
Pro: BGP, AS: 1.0
Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27
(8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.202)
Origin RP: 4.4.4.4
Pro: BGP, AS: 65535.65535
Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27
7.9 Configuring the Filtering Rules for SA Messages
By default, a device receives all SA messages that pass the RPF check, and forwards the SA
messages to all MSDP peers. To control the transmission of SA messages among MSDP peers,
you can configure rules to filter the constructing, receiving, and forwarding SA messages.
7.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast or anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you
can configure filtering rules for SA messages.
Applicable Environment
By default, MSDP switchs receive all SA messages that pass the RPF check and forward them
to all MSDP peers. To control of the transmission of SA messages among MSDP peers, users
can configure various filtering rules by using the following methods:
l
Setting the rules for filtering the multicast source of an SA message on the source RP. The
source RP filters active multicast sources that register with the local switch, and determines
the (S, G) entries to be sent according to the rules.
l
Setting the rules for filtering an SA message received from a remote MSDP peer. When an
SA message sent by a remote MSDP peer reaches a switch, the switch determines whether
to receive the message based on the rules.
l
Setting the rules for filtering an SA message forwarded to a remote MSDP peer. Before
forwarding the SA message to the remote MSDP peer, the switch determines whether to
forward it based on the rules.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring the filtering rules for SA messages, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer
l
Enabling IP multicast
l
Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast
l
Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a
PIM-SM Domain
Data Preparation
To configure the filtering rules for SA messages, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
252
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
No.
Data
1
Filtering list for creating SA messages
2
Filtering list for receiving SA messages
3
Filtering list for forwarding SA messages
4
Address of a remote MSDP peer
7.9.2 Setting Rules for Creating an SA Message
You can set rules for filtering the multicast source of an SA message on the source RP. The
source RP then filters locally registered and active multicast sources, and determines which (S,
G) information need be advertised based on the set rules.
Context
Do as follows on the source RP configured with an MSDP peer:
NOTE
If the configuration is not done, an SA message created by the source RP contains the information of all
local active sources.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
import-source [ acl { acl-number | acl-name } ]
The rules for filtering the multicast source of an SA message are set.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l acl: specifies the filtering list based on multicast sources. The SA message created by an
MSDP peer contains the local source information that match the filtering rules. The MSDP
peer can thus control the local (S, G) information.
l If the import-source command with acl is used, the SA message does not advertise any
information about the local active source.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
253
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
7.9.3 Setting Rules for Receiving an SA Message
You can set the rules for filtering the received SA messages on a specified remote MSDP peer.
When SA messages sent by a remote MSDP peer reach the local device, the local device
determines whether to accept the messages based on the set rules.
Context
Do as follows on the switch configured with MSDP:
NOTE
If the configuration is not done, the switch receives all SA messages that pass the RPF check.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address sa-policy import [ acl { { advanced-acl-number | acl-name } ]
The rules for filtering an SA message received from a remote MSDP peer are set.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l acl: specifies the advanced filtering list. Only the (S, G) information that passes the filtering
of the ACL is received. The (S, G) information is contained in an SA message sent by the
peer specified by peer-address .
l If the peer peer-address sa-policy import command without acl is used, the switch does not
receive any (S, G) information from the peer specified by peer-address.
----End
7.9.4 Setting Rules for Forwarding an SA Message
You can set the rules for filtering the SA messages to be forwarded to a remote MSDP peer on
a local device. The local device then determines whether to forward the received SA messages
based on the set rules.
Context
Do as follows on the switch enabled with MSDP:
NOTE
If the configuration is not done, the switch forwards all SA messages that pass the RPF check.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
254
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address sa-policy export [ acl advanced-acl-number ]
The rules for filtering an SA message forwarded to a remote MSDP peer is set.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer.
l acl: specifies the advanced filtering list. Only the (S, G) information that matches the ACL
rule is forwarded to the peer specified by peer-address.
l If the peer peer-address sa-policy export command without acl is used, the switch does not
forward any (S, G) information to the peer specified by peer-address.
----End
7.9.5 Checking the Configuration
After filtering rules for SA messages are configured, you can run related commands to check
detailed information about MSDP peers and SA cache information.
Procedure
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress | source-address | [ 2-byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] ] * command to check
SA Cache of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status
[ peer-address ] command to check detailed information about the MSDP peer status.
----End
Example
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status [ peeraddress ] command, and you can view information about the (Source, Group)-based SA filtering
policy field and check whether the configuration is valid. For example:
<Quidway> display msdp peer-status
MSDP Peer 172.40.41.1, AS ?
Description:
Information about connection status:
State: Up
Up/down time: 00:26:41
Resets: 0
Connection interface: Vlanif10 (172.40.41.2)
Number of sent/received messages: 27/28
Number of discarded output messages: 0
Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 00:26:56
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
255
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy:
Import policy: 3000
Export policy: 3002
Information about SA-Requests:
Policy to accept SA-Request messages: 2000
Sending SA-Requests status: enable
Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 10
SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA Cache maximum for the peer: none
Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0
Counters for MSDP message:
Count of RPF check failure: 0
Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 16/0
Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0
Peer authentication: unconfigured
Peer authentication type: none
Run the display msdp sa-cache command to check the information about (S, G) entries in SA
Cache.
l
If group-address is specified, the (S, G) entry to which a specified group corresponds is
displayed.
l
If source-address is specified, the (S, G) entry to which a specified source corresponds is
displayed.
l
If 2-byte-as-number or 4-byte-as-number is specified, the (S, G) entry whose Origin RP
attribute belongs to a specified AS is displayed.
<Quidway> display msdp sa-cache
MSDP Source-Active Cache Information of VPN-Instance: public net
MSDP Total Source-Active Cache - 3 entries
MSDP matched 3 entries
(8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.200)
Origin RP: 4.4.4.4
Pro: BGP, AS: 10
Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27
(8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.201)
Origin RP: 4.4.4.4
Pro: BGP, AS: 1.0
Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27
(8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.202)
Origin RP: 4.4.4.4
Pro: BGP, AS: 65535.65535
Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27
7.10 Configuring MSDP Authentication
MSDP peer authentication contains MSDP MD5 authentication and Key-Chain authentication.
You can choose either authentication mode.
7.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After Anycast RP is configured for PIM-SM intra-domain or inter-domain multicast, you can
configure MSDP authentication as required to ensure the security of the TCP connection between
MSDP peers.
Applicable Environment
Configuring MSDP authentication can enhance the security of the TCP connections between
MSDP peers.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
256
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring MSDP authentication, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement intra-domain IP interworking
l
Enabling IP multicast
l
Configuring PIM-SM domains to implement intra-domain multicast
l
Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a
PIM-SM Domain
Data Preparation
Before configuring MSDP authentication, prepare the following data:
No.
Data
1
IP address of the peer to be configured with MSDP authentication
2
Password for MSDP MD5 authentication
3
Key-Chain name for MSDP Key-Chain authentication
7.10.2 Configuring MSDP MD5 Authentication
The MSDP peers must be configured with the same authentication password; otherwise, the TCP
connection cannot be set up between MSDP peers and MSDP messages cannot be transmitted.
The authentication password on peers can be in different forms, that is, the password on one end
can be in the cipher text while the password on the peer can be in the plain text.
Context
By default, MSDP MD5 authentication is not configured.
Do as follows on the switch configured with MSDP peers:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp
[ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address password { cipher cipher-password | simple simple-password }
MSDP MD5 authentication is configured.
The MSDP MD5 authentication password is case sensitive and cannot contain any space.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
257
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
The MSDP peers must be configured with the same authentication password; otherwise, the TCP
connection cannot be set up between MSDP peers and MSDP messages cannot be transmitted.
The authentication password on peers can be in different forms, that is, the password on one end
can be in the cipher text while the password on the peer can be in the plain text.
NOTE
MSDP MD5 authentication and MSDP Key-Chain authentication are mutually exclusive.
Characters ^#^# and $@$@ are used to identify passwords with variable lengths. Characters ^#^# are the
prefix and suffix of a new password, and characters $@$@ are the prefix and suffix of an old password.
Neither of them can be both configured at the beginning and end of a plain text password.
----End
7.10.3 Configuring MSDP Key-Chain Authentication
You must configure Key-Chain authentication on both MSDP peers. Encryption algorithms and
passwords configured for Key-Chain authentication on both peers must be the same; otherwise,
the TCP connection cannot be set up between MSDP peers and MSDP messages cannot be
transmitted.
Context
By default, MSDP Key-Chain authentication is not configured.
Do as follows on the switch configured with MSDP peers:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The MSDP view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
peer peer-address keychain keychain-name
MSDP Key-Chain authentication is configured.
You must configure Key-Chain authentication on both MSDP peers. Encryption algorithms and
passwords configured for Key-Chain authentication on both peers must be the same; otherwise,
the TCP connection cannot be set up between MSDP peers and MSDP messages cannot be
transmitted.
Before configuring MSDP Key-Chain authentication, configure a Key-Chain in accordance with
the configured keychain-name; otherwise, the TCP connection cannot be set up.
NOTE
MSDP MD5 authentication and MSDP Key-Chain authentication are mutually exclusive.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
258
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
7.10.4 Checking the Configuration
After MSDP authentication is configured, you can run related commands to check brief and
detailed information about MSDP peers.
Procedure
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command
to check brief information about MSDP peers.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status
[ peer-address ] command to check detailed information about MSDP peers.
----End
Example
Run the display msdp peer-status [ peer-address ] command, and you can find the Peer
authentication and Peer authentication type fields in the command output. For example:
<Quidway> display msdp peer-status
MSDP Peer 172.40.41.1, AS ?
Description:
Information about connection status:
State: Up
Up/down time: 00:26:41
Resets: 0
Connection interface: Vlanif10 (172.40.41.2)
Number of sent/received messages: 27/28
Number of discarded output messages: 0
Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 00:26:56
Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy:
Import policy: 3000
Export policy: 3002
Information about SA-Requests:
Policy to accept SA-Request messages: 2000
Sending SA-Requests status: enable
Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 10
SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA-cache maximum for the peer: none
Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0
Counters for MSDP message:
Count of RPF check failure: 0
Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 16/0
Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0
Peer authentication: configured
Peer authentication type: KeyChain
7.11 Maintaining MSDP
Maintaining MSDP involves clearing MSDP peer statistics and (S, G) information in the SA
cache, and monitoring MSDP running status.
7.11.1 Clearing Statistics of MSDP Peers
When clear MSDP peer statistics, you can choose whether to reset the TCP connection between
MSDP peers. Note that MSDP peer statistics cannot be restored after you clear them. Resetting
the TCP connection will affect the running of MSDP.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
259
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Context
CAUTION
The statistics of MSDP peers cannot be restored after you clear it. So, confirm the action before
you use the command.
Procedure
l
Run the reset msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer [ peeraddress ] command in the user view to clear the TCP connection with a specified MSDP
peer and all statistics of the specified MSDP peer.
l
Run the reset msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] statistics [ peeraddress ] command in the user view to clear the statistics of an MSDP peer or multiple
MSDP peers of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances, if MSDP peers
are not reset.
l
Run the reset msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message
counters [ peer peer-address ] command in the user view to clear the statistics about the
received, sent, and discarded MSDP messages.
----End
7.11.2 Clearing (S, G) Information in SA Cache
When you want to reset contents in an SA cache, you can clear all (S, G) information from the
SA cache. Note that the (S, G) information cannot be restored after you clear it.
Context
CAUTION
The (S, G) information in SA Cache cannot be restored after you clear it. So, confirm the action
before you use the command.
Procedure
l
Run the reset msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress ] command in the user view to clear the entries in MSDP SA Cache.
----End
7.11.3 Monitoring the Running Status of MSDP
During the routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know the
running of MSDP.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
260
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Context
In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running
status of MSDP.
Procedure
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief [ state
{ connect | down | listen | shutdown | up } ] command in any view to check brief
information about the MSDP peer status.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status
[ peer-address ] command in any view to check detailed information about the status of an
MSDP peer of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress | source-address | { 2-byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number } ] * command in any
view to check the (S, G) information in SA Cache.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-count [ 2byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] command in any view to check the number of (S, G)
entries in MSDP Cache.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] controlmessage counters [ peer peer-address | message-type { source-active | sa-request | saresponse | keepalive | notification | traceroute-request | traceroute-reply | datapackets | unknown-type } ] * command in any view to check statistics about the received,
sent, and discarded MSDP messages.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] invalid-packet
[ peer peer-address | message-type { keepalive | notification | sa-request | sa-response
| source-active } ] * command in any view to check the statistics about invalid MSDP
messages received by a device.
l
Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rpf-peer
original-rp original-rp-address command in any view to check information about all the
RPF peers of a specific source's RP address, including RPF peer selection rules and RPF
route types.
----End
7.11.4 Debugging MSDP
When a fault occurs during the running of MSDP, run the debugging commands in the user view
and check the contents of sent and received packets for fault location.
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, execute the undo
debugging all command to disable it immediately.
When an MSDP fault occurs, run the following debugging commands in the user view to debug
MSDP and locate the fault.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
261
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the debugging msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] all command
in the user view to enable all the debugging of MSDP.
l
Run the debugging msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] connect
command in the user view to enable the debugging of the resetting of the MSDP peer
connection.
l
Run the debugging msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] event
command in the user view to enable the debugging of MSDP events.
l
Run the debugging msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] packet
command in the user view to enable the debugging of MSDP packets.
l
Run the debugging msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sourceactive command in the user view to enable the debugging of MSDP active sources.
----End
7.12 Configuration Examples
Configuration examples are provided to show how to implement PIM-SM inter-domain
multicast through MBGP, how to implement inter-AS multicast through static RPF peers, and
how to configure anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain.
7.12.1 Example for Configuring Basic MSDP Functions
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 7-1, two ASs exist on the network. Each AS contains one or more PIM-SM
domains; each PIM-SM domain has 0 or 1 multicast source and receiver. The receivers in PIMSM2 need to receive the multicast data sent by S3 in the PIM-SM3 domain and multicast data
sent by S1 in the PIM-SM1 domain.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
262
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Figure 7-1 Networking diagram for configuring basic MSDP functions
AS200
AS100
Loopback0
1.1.1.1/32
SwitchA
GE2/0/0
GE2/0/0
GE1/0/0
PIM-SM1
Loopback0
2.2.2.2/32
GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0
SwitchB
PIM-SM2
SwitchC GE1/0/0
GE2/0/0
GE2/0/0
SwitchD
GE3/0/0
GE3/0/0
S1
Receiver
SwitchF
GE2/0/0
GE2/0/0
GE1/0/0
SwitchE
PIM-SM3
Loopback0
3.3.3.3/32
S3
MSDP peer
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface/Logical interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 101
10.110.1.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.1.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 200
192.168.2.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.1.2/24
Loopback0
1.1.1.1/32
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 200
192.168.2.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.3.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 400
192.168.4.1/24
SwitchB
SwitchC
SwitchD
SwitchE
SwitchF
Loopback0
2.2.2.2/32
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 102
10.110.2.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.3.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 500
192.168.5.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 400
192.168.4.2/24
Loopback0
3.3.3.3/32
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 103
10.110.3.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 500
192.168.5.2/24
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Configure the IP addresses of the interfaces on each Switch and configure OSPF in the AS
to ensure that the unicast routes within the AS are reachable.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
263
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
2.
Configure EBGP peers and import BGP and OSPF routes into each other's routing table to
ensure that the unicast routes between ASs are reachable.
3.
Enable multicast and PIM-SM on each interface, configure the boundary domain, and
enable the IGMP function on the interfaces connected to hosts.
4.
Configure the C-BSR and C-RP. Configure the RPs of PIM-SM1 and PIM-SM2 on the
ASBR.
5.
Establish MSDP peer relationship between RPs of each domain. The MSDP peers and the
EBGP peers between ASs use the same interface addresses. According to the RPF rule, the
Switches receive SA messages from the next hop toward the source RP.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Address of multicast group G: 225.1.1.1/24
l
Number of the AS that SwitchA and SwitchB belong to, namely 100, and router ID of
SwitchB, namely, 1.1.1.1
l
Number of the AS that SwitchC and SwitchD belong to, namely 200, and Router ID of
SwitchC, namely, 2.2.2.2
l
Number of the AS that SwitchE and SwitchF belong to, namely 200
NOTE
This configuration example describes only the commands related to MSDP configuration.
Procedure
Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol.
# According to Figure 7-1, configure IP addresses and masks for the interfaces on each
Switch. Configure the OSPF protocol between Switches. Ensure the communication on the
network layer within an AS. Ensure the dynamic route update between Switches through unicast
routing protocol. The configuration procedure is not provided here.
Step 2 Configure EBGP peer relationship between ASs and import routes of BGP and OSPF into each
other's routing table.
# Configure EBGP on SwitchB and import OSPF routes.
[SwitchB] bgp
[SwitchB-bgp]
[SwitchB-bgp]
[SwitchB-bgp]
[SwitchB-bgp]
100
router-id 1.1.1.1
peer 192.168.2.2 as-number 200
import-route ospf 1
quit
# Configure EBGP on SwitchC and import OSPF routes.
[SwitchC] bgp
[SwitchC-bgp]
[SwitchC-bgp]
[SwitchC-bgp]
[SwitchC-bgp]
200
router-id 2.2.2.2
peer 192.168.2.1 as-number 100
import-route ospf 1
quit
# Import BGP routes to OSPF on SwitchB. The configuration on SwitchC is similar to the
configuration on SwitchB, and is not provided here.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
264
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
[SwitchB] ospf 1
[SwitchB-ospf-1] import-route bgp
[SwitchB-ospf-1] quit
Step 3 Enable multicast, enable PIM-SM on all interfaces, configure the domain boundary, and enable
IGMP on the interface connecting to the host.
# Enable multicast on SwitchB and enable PIM-SM on each interface. The configurations of
other Switches are similar to the configuration of SwitchB, and are not provided here.
[SwitchB] multicast
[SwitchB] interface
[SwitchB-Vlanif100]
[SwitchB-Vlanif100]
[SwitchB] interface
[SwitchB-Vlanif200]
routing-enable
vlanif 100
pim sm
quit
vlanif 200
pim sm
# Configure the domain boundary on VLANIF 100 of SwitchB.
[SwitchB-Vlanif100] pim bsr-boundary
[SwitchB-Vlanif100] quit
# Configure the domain boundary on VLANIF 200 and VLANIF 400 of SwitchC. Configure
the service boundary of BSR on VLANIF 400 of SwitchE. The configuration on SwitchE is
similar to the configuration on SwitchB, and is not provided here.
# Enable IGMP on the interface connecting SwitchD to the leaf network.
[SwitchD] interface vlanif 102
[SwitchD-Vlanif102] igmp enable
Step 4 Configure the C-BSR and C-RP.
# Create Loopback0, and then configure a C-BSR, and a C-RP on Loopback0 on SwitchB. The
configurations of SwitchC and SwitchE are similar to the configuration of SwitchB, and are not
provided here.
[SwitchB] interface loopback 0
[SwitchB-LoopBack0] ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
[SwitchB-LoopBack0] pim sm
[SwitchB-LoopBack0] quit
[SwitchB] pim
[SwitchB-pim] c-bsr loopback 0
[SwitchB-pim] c-rp loopback 0
[SwitchB-pim] quit
Step 5 Configure MSDP peer relations.
# Configure the MSDP peer relationship on SwitchB.
[SwitchB] msdp
[SwitchB-msdp] peer 192.168.2.2 connect-interface vlanif200
[SwitchB-msdp] quit
# Configure the MSDP peer relationship on SwitchC.
[SwitchC] msdp
[SwitchC-msdp] peer 192.168.2.1 connect-interface vlanif200
[SwitchC-msdp] peer 192.168.4.2 connect-interface vlanif400
[SwitchC-msdp] quit
# Configure the MSDP peer relationship on SwitchE.
[SwitchE] msdp
[SwitchE-msdp] peer 192.168.4.1 connect-interface vlanif400
[SwitchE-msdp] quit
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
265
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Step 6 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display bgp peer command to view the BGP peer relationship between Switches. For
example, the following information shows the BGP peer relationship on SwitchB and SwitchC:
<SwitchB> display bgp peer
BGP local router ID : 1.1.1.1
Local AS number : 100
Total number of peers : 1
Peer
PrefRcv
192.168.2.2
V
AS
4
200
Peers in established state : 1
MsgRcvd
MsgSent
24
21
OutQ
0
Up/Down
State
00:13:09
Established
6
<SwitchC> display bgp peer
BGP local router ID : 2.2.2.2
Local AS number : 200
Total number of peers : 1
Peer
PrefRcv
192.168.2.1
Peers in established state : 1
V
AS
MsgRcvd
MsgSent
OutQ
Up/Down
State
4
100
18
16
0
00:12:04
Established
1
# Run the display bgp routing-table command to view the BGP routing table on a Switch. For
example, the BGP routing table displayed on SwitchC is as follows:
<SwitchC> display bgp routing-table
BGP Local router ID is 2.2.2.2
Status codes: * - valid, > - best, d - damped,
h - history, i - internal, s - suppressed, S - Stale
Origin : i - IGP, e - EGP, ? - incomplete
Total Number of Routes: 5
Network
NextHop
*>
1.1.1.1/32
192.168.2.1
*>i
2.2.2.2/32
0.0.0.0
*>
192.168.2.0
0.0.0.0
*>
192.168.2.1/32
0.0.0.0
*>
192.168.2.2/32
0.0.0.0
MED
0
0
0
0
0
LocPrf
PrefVal
0
0
0
0
0
Path/Ogn
100?
?
?
?
?
# Run the display msdp brief command to view the status of the MSDP peer relationship
between Switches. The information about establishing MSDP peer relationship among SwitchB,
SwitchC and SwitchE is as follows:
<SwitchB> display msdp brief
MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Configured
Up
Listen
Connect
Shutdown
1
1
0
0
0
Peer's Address
192.168.2.2
State
UP
Up/Down time
00:12:27
AS
200
SA Count
13
Down
0
Reset Count
0
<SwitchC> display msdp brief
MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Configured
Up
Listen
Connect
Shutdown
2
2
0
0
0
Peer's Address
192.168.2.1
192.168.4.2
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
State
UP
UP
Up/Down time
01:07:08
00:06:39
AS
100
200
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
SA Count
8
13
Down
0
Reset Count
0
0
266
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
<SwitchE> display msdp brief
MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Configured
Up
Listen
Connect
Shutdown
1
1
0
0
0
Peer's Address
State
Up/Down time
AS
SA Count
192.168.4.1
UP
00:15:32
200
8
Down
0
Reset Count
0
# Run the display msdp peer-status command to view the details about MSDP peer relations
between Switches. The details displayed on SwitchB are as follows:
<SwitchB> display msdp peer-status
MSDP Peer Information of VPN-Instance: public net
MSDP Peer 192.168.2.2, AS 200
Description:
Information about connection status:
State: Up
Up/down time: 00:15:47
Resets: 0
Connection interface: vlanif200 (192.168.2.1)
Number of sent/received messages: 16/16
Number of discarded output messages: 0
Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 00:17:51
Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy:
Import policy: none
Export policy: none
Information about SA-Requests:
Policy to accept SA-Request messages: none
Sending SA-Requests status: disable
Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 0
SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA-cache maximum for the peer: none
Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0
Counters for MSDP message:
Count of RPF check failure: 0
Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0
Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0
Peer authentication: unconfigured
Peer authentication type: none
# Run the display pim routing-table command to view the PIM routing table on a Switch. When
multicast sources S1 (10.110.1.2/24) in PIM-SM1 and S3 (10.110.3.2/24) in PIM-SM3 send
multicast data to multicast group G (225.1.1.1/24), Receiver (10.110.2.2/24) in PIM-SM2 can
receive the multicast data. The PIM routing tables displayed on SwitchB and SwitchC are as
follows:
<SwitchB> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 0 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(10.110.1.2, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 1.1.1.1(local)
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT EXT ACT
UpTime: 00:00:42
Upstream interface: vlanif100
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.1
RPF pirme neighbor: 192.168.1.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif200
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:<SwitchC> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 2 (S, G) entries
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
267
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 2.2.2.2(local)
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC RPT
UpTime: 00:13:46
Upstream interface: NULL,
Upstream neighbor: NULL
RPF prime neighbor: NULL
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif300,
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:13:46, Expires:(10.110.1.2, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 2.2.2.2
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT MSDP ACT
UpTime: 00:00:42
Upstream interface: vlanif200
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif300
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:(10.110.3.2, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 2.2.2.2
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT MSDP ACT
UpTime: 00:00:42
Upstream interface: vlanif400
Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.2
RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif300
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:-
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 100 101
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif101
ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 101
port hybrid untagged vlan 101
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
268
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
7 MSDP Configuration
Configuration file of SwitchB
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 100 200
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif200
ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
pim bsr-boundary
#
interface LoopBack0
ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
bgp 100
router-id 1.1.1.1
peer 192.168.2.2 as-number 200
import-route ospf 1
#
ospf 1
import-route bgp
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0
#
pim
c-bsr LoopBack0
c-rp LoopBack0
#
msdp
peer 192.168.2.2 connect-interface vlanif200
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 200 300 400
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif200
ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
pim bsr-boundary
#
interface Vlanif300
ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif400
ip address 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
269
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
pim bsr-boundary
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 400
port hybrid untagged vlan 400
#
interface LoopBack0
ip address 2.2.2.2 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
bgp 200
router-id 2.2.2.2
peer 192.168.2.1 as-number 100
import-route ospf 1
#
ospf 1
import-route bgp
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255
network 2.2.2.2 0.0.0.0
#
pim
c-bsr LoopBack0
c-rp LoopBack0
#
msdp
peer 192.168.2.1 connect-interface vlanif200
peer 192.168.4.2 connect-interface vlanif400
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchD
#
sysname SwitchD
#
vlan batch 102 300
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif102
ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
#
interface Vlanif300
ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 102
port hybrid untagged vlan 102
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
270
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchE
#
sysname SwitchE
#
vlan batch 400 500
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif400
ip address 192.168.4.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
pim bsr-boundary
#
interface Vlanif500
ip address 192.168.5.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 500
port hybrid untagged vlan 500
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 400
port hybrid untagged vlan 400
#
interface LoopBack0
ip address 3.3.3.3 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.5.0 0.0.0.255
network 3.3.3.3 0.0.0.0
#
pim
c-bsr LoopBack0
c-rp LoopBack0
#
msdp
peer 192.168.4.1 connect-interface vlanif400
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchF
#
sysname SwitchF
#
vlan batch 103 500
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif103
ip address 10.110.3.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif500
ip address 192.168.5.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 103
port hybrid untagged vlan 103
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 500
port hybrid untagged vlan 500
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
271
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.5.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.3.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
7.12.2 Example for Configuring Inter-AS Multicast by Using Static
RPF Peers
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 7-2, two ASs exist on the network. Each AS contains one or more PIM-SM
domains; each PIM-SM domain has 0 or 1 multicast source and receiver. MSDP peers need to
be set up between PIM-SM domains to share the information of the multicast source.
Figure 7-2 Networking diagram for configuring inter-AS multicast by using static RPF peers
AS100
AS200
SwitchE
Loopback0
1.1.1.1/32
GE2/0/0
SwitchC
GE2/0/0
GE1/0/0
GE1/0/0
SwitchB
GE2/0/0
PIM-SM1
S1
GE2/0/0
GE3/0/0
GE1/0/0
SwitchA
Loopback0
2.2.2.2/32
GE1/0/0
GE1/0/0
GE3/0/0 SwitchD
PIM-SM2
Receiver
3.3.3.3/32
Loopback0
GE1/0/0
SwitchF
Receiver
SwitchG GE3/0/0
GE2/0/0
GE2/0/0
GE1/0/0
PIM-SM3
S2
BGP peers
Switch
Interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 500
192.168.5.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 400
192.168.4.2/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 101
10.110.1.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.1.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 200
192.168.2.2/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.1.1/24
SwitchB
SwitchC
Loopback0
GE 2/0/0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
1.1.1.1/32
VLANIF 400
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
192.168.4.1/24
272
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Loopback0
2.2.2.2/32
SwitchD
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.3.2/24
SwitchE
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.3.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 200
192.168.2.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 102
10.110.2.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 500
192.168.5.1/24
SwitchF
Loopback0
SwitchG
3.3.3.3/32
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 600
192.168.6.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 103
10.110.3.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 600
192.168.6.2/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 104
10.110.4.1/24
Configuration Roadmap
Set up an MSDP peer on the RP in each PIM-SM domain. Establish the static RPF peer
relationship between MSDP peers. In this way, the source information can be transmitted across
domains without changing unicast topology.
1.
Configure IP addresses for the interfaces on each Switch, configure OSPF in the AS,
configure EBGP between ASs, and import BGP and OSPF routes into each other's routing
table.
2.
Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-SM on all interfaces and enable IGMP on the
interfaces at the user side. Configure Loopback0, C-BSR, and C-RP. The Loopback 0
interfaces on SwitchC, SwitchD, and SwitchF function as the C-BSR and the C-RP of each
PIM-SM domain.
3.
Establish MSDP peer relationship between RPs of each domain. Establish the MSDP peer
relationship between SwitchC and SwitchD and establish the MSDP peer relationship
between SwitchC and SwitchF.
4.
Specify a static RPF peer for the MSDP peer. The static RPF peers of SwitchC are
SwitchD and SwitchF. SwitchD and SwitchF have only one static RPF peer, namely,
SwitchC. According to RPF rules, Switches receive SA messages from static RPF peers.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Number of the AS that SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC belong to: 100
l
Router IDs of SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC: 1.1.1.3, 1.1.1.2 and 1.1.1.1
l
Number of the AS that SwitchD and SwitchE belong to: 200
l
Router IDs of SwitchD and SwitchE: 2.2.2.2 and 2.2.2.1
l
Number of the AS that SwitchF and SwitchG belong to: 200
l
Router ID of SwitchF: 3.3.3.3
l
SwitchC uses the list-df policy to filter the SA messages from SwitchD and SwitchF.
l
SwitchD and SwitchF use the list-c policy to filter the SA messages from SwitchC.
NOTE
This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure static RPF peers.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
273
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol
# According to Figure 7-2, configure IP addresses and masks for the interfaces of each
Switch. Configure OSPF in the AS. Configure EBGP between SwitchA and SwitchF, and
between SwitchB and SwitchE. Import BGP and OSPF routes into each other's routing table.
Ensure that the Switches can communicate with each other at the network layer. Ensure the
dynamic route update between routers through the unicast routing protocol. The configuration
procedure is not provided here.
Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-SM on all interfaces, and enable the IGMP function
on the interfaces connected to the hosts. In addition, configure the service boundary of BSR on
the interfaces of Switches on the AS boundary.
# Enable multicast all the Switches and enable PIM-SM on each interface. The configurations
of other Switches are similar to configuration of SwitchC, and are not provided here.
[SwitchC] multicast
[SwitchC] interface
[SwitchC-Vlanif100]
[SwitchC-Vlanif100]
[SwitchC] interface
[SwitchC-Vlanif400]
[SwitchC-Vlanif400]
routing-enable
vlanif 100
pim sm
quit
vlanif 400
pim sm
quit
# Configure the service boundary of BSR on VLANIF 500 of SwitchA, VLANIF 200 of
SwitchB, VLANIF 200 of SwitchE, and VLANIF 500 of SwitchF. The configurations of
SwitchB, SwitchE, and SwitchF are similar to configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided
here.
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 500
[SwitchA-Vlanif500] pim bsr-boundary
[SwitchA-Vlanif500] quit
Step 3 Configure Loopback0, C-BSR, and C-RP.
# Configure loopback0, C-BSR, and C-RP on SwitchC, SwitchD, and SwitchF. The
configurations of SwitchD and SwitchF are similar to the configuration of SwitchC, and are not
provided here.
[SwitchC] interface loopback 0
[SwitchC-LoopBack0] ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
[SwitchC-LoopBack0] pim sm
[SwitchC-LoopBack0] quit
[SwitchC] pim
[SwitchC-pim] c-bsr loopback 0
[SwitchC-pim] c-rp loopback 0
[SwitchC-pim] quit
Step 4 Configure static RPF peers.
# Configure SwitchD and SwitchF as the static RPF peers of SwitchC.
[SwitchC] ip ip-prefix list-df permit 192.168.0.0 16 greater-equal 16 less-equal
32
[SwitchC] msdp
[SwitchC-msdp] peer 192.168.3.2 connect-interface vlanif100
[SwitchC-msdp] peer 192.168.5.1 connect-interface vlanif400
[SwitchC-msdp] static-rpf-peer 192.168.3.2 rp-policy list-df
[SwitchC-msdp] static-rpf-peer 192.168.5.1 rp-policy list-df
[SwitchC-msdp] quit
# Configure SwitchC as the static RPF peer of SwitchD and SwitchF. The configuration of
SwitchF is similar to the configuration of SwitchD, and is not provided here.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
274
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
[SwitchD] ip ip-prefix list-c permit 192.168.0.0 16 greater-equal 16 less-equal 32
[SwitchD] msdp
[SwitchD-msdp] peer 192.168.1.1 connect-interface vlanif300
[SwitchD-msdp] static-rpf-peer 192.168.1.1 rp-policy list-c
Step 5 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display bgp peer command to view the status of the BGP peer relationship between
Switches. No output information is displayed on SwitchC, which indicates that no BGP peer
relationship is set up between SwitchC and SwitchD, and between SwitchC and SwitchF.
# Run the display msdp brief command to view the status of the MSDP peer relationship
between Switches. When multicast source S1 in the PIM-SM1 domain sends multicast packets,
the receivers in the PIM-SM2 and PIM-SM3 domains can receive the packets. For example, the
displayed information of MSDP peers on SwitchC, SwitchD and SwitchF is as follows:
<SwitchC> display msdp brief
MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Configured
Up
Listen
Connect
Shutdown
2
2
0
0
0
Peer's Address
192.168.3.2
192.168.5.1
State
UP
UP
Up/Down time
01:07:08
00:16:39
AS
?
?
SA Count
8
13
<SwitchD> display msdp brief
MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Configured
Up
Listen
Connect
Shutdown
1
1
0
0
0
Peer's Address
192.168.1.1
State
UP
Up/Down time
01:07:09
AS
?
SA Count
8
<SwitchF> display msdp brief
MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Configured
Up
Listen
Connect
Shutdown
1
1
0
0
0
Peer's Address
192.168.4.1
State
UP
Up/Down time
00:16:40
AS
?
SA Count
13
Down
0
Reset Count
0
0
Down
0
Reset Count
0
Down
0
Reset Count
0
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA The configuration files of SwitchD and SwitchF are similar
to the configuration file of SwitchA, and are not provided here.
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 101 400 500
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif101
ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif400
ip address 192.168.4.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif500
ip address 192.168.5.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
pim bsr-boundary
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
275
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 500
port hybrid untagged vlan 500
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 400
port hybrid untagged vlan 400
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 101
port hybrid untagged vlan 101
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.5.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 100 400
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif 400
ip address 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 400
port hybrid untagged vlan 400
#
interface LoopBack0
ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255
network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0
#
pim
c-bsr LoopBack0
c-rp LoopBack0
#
ip ip-prefix list-df permit 192.168.0.0 16 greater-equal 16 less-equal 32
#
msdp
peer 192.168.3.2 connect-interface vlanif100
peer 192.168.5.1 connect-interface vlanif400
static-rpf-peer 192.168.3.2 rp-policy list-df
static-rpf-peer 192.168.5.1 rp-policy list-df
#
return
l
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Configuration file of SwitchD
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
276
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
#
sysname SwitchD
#
vlan batch 300
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif300
ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
interface LoopBack0
ip address 2.2.2.2 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255
network 2.2.2.2 0.0.0.0
#
pim
c-bsr LoopBack0
c-rp LoopBack0
#
ip ip-prefix list-c permit 192.168.0.0 16 greater-equal 16 less-equal 32
#
msdp
peer 192.168.1.1 connect-interface vlanif300
static-rpf-peer 192.168.1.1 rp-policy list-c
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchF
#
sysname SwitchF
#
vlan batch 500 600
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif500
ip address 192.168.5.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
pim bsr-boundary
#
interface Vlanif600
ip address 192.168.6.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 500
port hybrid untagged vlan 500
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 600
port hybrid untagged vlan 600
#
interface LoopBack0
ip address 3.3.3.3 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.5.0 0.0.0.255
network 192.168.6.0 0.0.0.255
network 3.3.3.3 0.0.0.0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
277
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
#
pim
c-bsr LoopBack0
c-rp LoopBack0
#
ip ip-prefix list-c permit 192.168.0.0 16 greater-equal 16 less-equal 32
#
msdp
peer 192.168.4.1 connect-interface vlanif500
static-rpf-peer 192.168.4.1 rp-policy list-c
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchG
#
sysname SwitchG
#
vlan batch 103 104 600
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif103
ip address 10.110.3.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif104
ip address 10.110.4.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
#
interface Vlanif600
ip address 192.168.6.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 103
port hybrid untagged vlan 103
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 600
port hybrid untagged vlan 600
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 104
port hybrid untagged vlan 104
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.6.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.3.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.4.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
7.12.3 Example for Configuring Anycast RP
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 7-3, a PIM-SM domain contains multiple multicast sources and receivers.
The MSDP peer relationship needs to be set up in the PIM-SM domain to implement RP load
balancing.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
278
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Figure 7-3 Networking diagram for configuring anycast RP
PIM-SM
S1
Source
GE1/0/0
SwitchB
Receiver
user2
GE2/0/0
Loopback10
GE3/0/0
GE1/0/0
GE2/0/0
SwitchD
Loopback1
GE1/0/0
SwitchA
Source
S2
Loopback0
GE2/0/0
Loopback0
GE2/0/0
Loopback1
SwitchC
GE1/0/0
GE1/0/0
GE3/0/0
Loopback10
GE2/0/0
SwitchE
Receiver
user1
MSDP peers
Switch
Interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 105
10.110.5.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 101
10.110.1.2/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 106
10.110.6.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 102
10.110.2.2/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.1.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 101
10.110.1.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 104
10.110.4.1/24
SwitchB
SwitchC
Loopback0
1.1.1.1/32
Loopback1
3.3.3.3/32
Loopback10
SwitchD
10.1.1.1/32
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.3.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 102
10.110.2.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 103
10.110.3.1/24
Loopback0
2.2.2.2/32
Loopback1
4.4.4.4/32
Loopback10
SwitchE
10.1.1.1/32
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 300
192.168.3.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 100
192.168.1.2/24
Configuration Roadmap
Configure anycast RPs. Then the receiver sends a Join message to the nearest RP and the
multicast source sends a Register message to the nearest RP.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
279
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
1.
Configure IP addresses for the interfaces of each Switch and configure OSPF in the PIMSM domain.
2.
Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-SM on all interfaces and enable the IGMP
function on the interfaces connected the hosts.
3.
Configure Loopback10 interfaces on SwitchC and SwitchD. Configure C-RPs on
Loopback10 interfaces, and configure the C-BSR on Loopback1.
4.
Configure MSDP peers on Loopback0 interfaces of SwitchC and SwitchD. According to
RPF rules, the Switches receive SA messages from the source RP.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Address of multicast group G: 225.1.1.1/24
l
Router ID of SwitchC: 1.1.1.1
l
Router ID of SwitchD: 2.2.2.2
NOTE
This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure anycast RP.
Procedure
Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol
# According to Figure 7-3, configure IP addresses and masks for the interfaces in the PIM-SM
domain. Configure the OSPF protocol between Switches. The configuration procedure is not
provided here.
Step 2 Enable multicast and configure PIM-SM.
# Enable multicast on all Switches, and PIM-SM on all interfaces. Enable the IGMP function
on the interfaces at the host side. The configurations of other Switches are similar to
configuration of SwitchC, and are not provided here.
[SwitchC] multicast
[SwitchC] interface
[SwitchC-Vlanif104]
[SwitchC-Vlanif104]
[SwitchC-Vlanif104]
[SwitchC] interface
[SwitchC-Vlanif102]
[SwitchC-Vlanif102]
[SwitchC] interface
[SwitchC-Vlanif100]
[SwitchC-Vlanif100]
routing-enable
vlanif 104
pim sm
igmp enable
quit
vlanif 101
pim sm
quit
vlanif 100
pim sm
quit
Step 3 Configure Loopback1, Loopback10, C-BSR, and C-RP.
# Configure the same address for Loopback1 and Loopback10 on both SwitchC and SwitchD.
Configure C-BSR on Loopback1 and C-RP on Loopback 10. The configuration of SwitchD is
similar to configuration of SwitchC, and is not provided here.
[SwitchC] interface loopback 1
[SwitchC-LoopBack1] ip address 3.3.3.3 255.255.255.255
[SwitchC-LoopBack1] pim sm
[SwitchC-LoopBack1] quit
[SwitchC] interface loopback 10
[SwitchC-LoopBack10] ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
[SwitchC-LoopBack10] pim sm
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
280
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
[SwitchC-LoopBack10] quit
[SwitchC] pim
[SwitchC-pim] c-bsr loopback 1
[SwitchC-pim] c-rp loopback 10
[SwitchC-pim] quit
Step 4 Configure Loopback0 interfaces and MSDP peers.
# Configure the MSDP peer on Loopback0 of SwitchC.
[SwitchC] interface loopback 0
[SwitchC-LoopBack0] ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
[SwitchC-LoopBack0] pim sm
[SwitchC-LoopBack0] quit
[SwitchC] msdp
[SwitchC-msdp] originating-rp loopback0
[SwitchC-msdp] peer 2.2.2.2 connect-interface loopback0
[SwitchC-msdp] quit
# Configure the MSDP peer on Loopback0 of SwitchD.
[SwitchD] interface loopback 0
[SwitchD-LoopBack0] ip address 2.2.2.2 255.255.255.255
[SwitchD-LoopBack0] pim sm
[SwitchD-LoopBack0] quit
[SwitchD] msdp
[SwitchD-msdp] originating-rp loopback0
[SwitchD-msdp] peer 1.1.1.1 connect-interface loopback0
[SwitchD-msdp] quit
Step 5 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display msdp brief command to view the status of the MSDP peer relationship
between Switches. Information about MSDP peers on SwitchC and SwitchD is as follows:
<SwitchC> display msdp brief
MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Configured
Up
Listen
Connect
Shutdown
1
1
0
0
0
Peer's Address
2.2.2.2
State
Up
Up/Down time
00:10:17
AS
?
Down
0
SA Count
0
Reset Count
0
<SwitchD> display msdp brief
MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net
Configured
Up
Listen
Connect
Shutdown
1
1
0
0
0
Peer's Address
State
Up/Down time
AS
SA Count
1.1.1.1
Up
00:10:18
?
0
Down
0
Reset Count
0
# Run the display pim routing-table command to view the PIM routing table on a Switch. In
the PIM-SM domain, multicast source S1 (10.110.5.100/24) sends multicast packets to multicast
group G (225.1.1.1). User 1 that joins G receives the multicast packets. Comparing information
about the PIM routing tables on SwitchC and SwitchD, you can find that SwitchC is the valid
RP. That is, S1 registers to SwitchC, and User 1 sends a Join message to SwitchC.
<SwitchC> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 10.1.1.1 (local)
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 00:28:49
Upstream interface: Register
Upstream neighbor: NULL
RPF prime neighbor: NULL
Downstream interface(s) information:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
281
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif104
Protocol: static, UpTime: 00:28:49, Expires: (10.110.5.1, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 10.1.1.1 (local)
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT 2MSDP ACT
UpTime: 00:02:26
Upstream interface: vlanif101
Upstream neighbor: 10.110.1.2
RPF prime neighbor: 10.110.1.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif104
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:02:26, Expires: <SwitchD> display pim routing-table
No output information is displayed.
# User 1 leaves group G, and multicast source S1 stops sending multicast packets to G. You can
run the reset multicast routing-table all and reset multicast forwarding-table all commands
to clear the multicast routing entries and multicast forwarding entries on SwitchC.
<SwitchC> reset multicast routing-table all
<SwitchC> reset multicast forwarding-table all
# User 2 joins group G, and multicast source S2 (10.110.6.100/24) sends multicast packets to
G. Comparing information about the PIM routing tables on SwitchC and SwitchD, you can find
that SwitchD is the valid RP. That is, S2 registers to SwitchD, and User 2 sends a Join message
to SwitchD.
<SwitchC> display pim routing-table
No output information is displayed.
<SwitchD> display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 10.1.1.1 (local)
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC RPT
UpTime: 00:07:23
Upstream interface: NULL,
Upstream neighbor: NULL
RPF prime neighbor: NULL
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif103,
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:07:23, Expires:(10.110.6.100, 225.1.1.1)
RP: 10.1.1.1 (local)
Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT 2MSDP ACT
UpTime: 00:10:20
Upstream interface: vlanif102
Upstream neighbor: 10.110.2.2
RPF prime neighbor: 10.110.2.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif103
Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:10:22, Expires: -
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
282
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA The configuration files of SwitchB and SwitchE are similar
to the configuration file of SwitchA, and are not provided here.
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 101 105
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif101
ip address 10.110.1.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif105
ip address 10.110.5.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 105
port hybrid untagged vlan 105
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 101
port hybrid untagged vlan 101
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.5.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC The configuration file of SwitchD IS similar to the
configuration file of SwitchC, and is not provided here.
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 100 101 104
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif101
ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif104
ip address 10.110.4.1 255.255.255.0
igmp enable
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 101
port hybrid untagged vlan 101
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 104
port hybrid untagged vlan 104
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
283
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
7 MSDP Configuration
interface LoopBack0
ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
interface LoopBack1
ip address 3.3.3.3 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
interface LoopBack10
ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.110.4.0 0.0.0.255
network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0
network 3.3.3.3 0.0.0.0
network 10.1.1.1 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
pim
c-bsr LoopBack1
c-rp LoopBack10
#
msdp
originating-rp LoopBack0
peer 2.2.2.2 connect-interface LoopBack0
#
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
284
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
About This Chapter
With wide applications of the VPN technology, the requirements for operating multicast services
over the VPN are increasingly stringent. Multicast VPN is mainly used in the MPLS/BGP VPN
for multicast data transmission.
8.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast VPN
This section takes the networking where the public network PE supports multi-instance IPv4
multicast VPN as an example to describe concepts of the IPv4 multicast VPN and networking
requirements for implementing the IPv4 multicast VPN.
8.2 IPv4 Multicast VPN Supported by the S9700
The system supports multiple IPv4 multicast VPN features, including MD VPNs, share-MDT
and switch-MDT switchover, and inter-AS MD VPNs.
8.3 Configuring Basic MD VPN Functions
By configuring the IPv4 multicast VPN through the MD solution, you can enable the
transmission of private multicast data over a public network. In this manner, multicast data in
the private network can traverse the public network and finally reach the receiver.
8.4 Configuring Switch-MDT Switchover
When multicast data packets are forwarded through the share-MDT in the public network, the
packets are forwarded to all PEs in the same VPN instance. Therefore, the high rate of multicast
data packets in the VPN will increase the burden on the PE. To solve this problem, you can
configure share-MDT and switch-MDT switchover to implement on-demand multicast, thereby,
saving bandwidth resource on the network.
8.5 Maintaining IPv4 Multicast VPN
Maintaining the IPv4 multicast VPN involves monitoring the running status of the IPv4 multicast
VPN and controlling the output of logs.
8.6 Configuration Examples
Examples for configuring the IPv4 multicast VPN.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
285
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
8.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast VPN
This section takes the networking where the public network PE supports multi-instance IPv4
multicast VPN as an example to describe concepts of the IPv4 multicast VPN and networking
requirements for implementing the IPv4 multicast VPN.
NOTE
EH1D2G24SSA0, EH1D2G24SCSA, EH1D2X12SSA0, EH1D2G48SBC0, EH1D2G48TBC0 boards do
not support multicast VPN.
TheS9700 implements multicast data transmission based on MPLS/BGP VPN.
As shown in Figure 8-1, when multicast VPN is deployed in the network, the network carries
three separate multicast services at the same time, that is, VPN A instance, VPN B instance, and
the public network instance. A multicast switch PE at the edge of the public network supports
multi-instance. The PE acts as multiple multicast switchs that run separately. Each instance
corresponds to a plane. The three planes are isolated.
Figure 8-1 Multicast VPN based on multi-instance
PE2
site4
site6
MD B
site5
PE1
VPN instance B
P
PE2
PE1
PIM
PE3
Public instance
MD A
site1
PE1
VPN instance A
site2
PE2
site3
PE3
The following takes VPN A instance as an example to explain multicast VPN.
l
S1 belongs to VPN A. S1 sends multicast data to G, a multicast group.
l
Among all possible data receivers, only members of VPN A (Site 1, Site 2, and Site 3) can
receive multicast data from S1.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
286
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
Multicast data is transmitted among sites in the public network and each site in multicast
mode.
To implement multicast VPN, the following network conditions need to be met:
l
Each site supports multicast based on VPN instances.
l
Public network supports multicast based on the public network instance.
l
PE device supports multi-instance multicast:
– Connecting sites through a VPN instance, and supporting multicast based on the VPN
instance
– Connecting the public network through the public instance, and supporting multicast
based on the public network instance
– Supporting information communication and data switching between the public network
instance and the VPN instance
8.2 IPv4 Multicast VPN Supported by the S9700
The system supports multiple IPv4 multicast VPN features, including MD VPNs, share-MDT
and switch-MDT switchover, and inter-AS MD VPNs.
MD VPN
The S9700 applies Multicast Domain (MD) to implement multicast VPN, which is called MD
VPN. In an MD, VPN data is transmitted through the Multicast Tunnel (MT).
The greatest advantage of the MD solution is that only PEs are required to support multi-instance.
MD neither needs to upgrade CEs and Ps, nor modify the previous Protocol Independent
Multicast (PIM) configuration on CEs and Ps. That is, the MD solution is transparent to CEs
and Ps.
Users can bind Share-Group to Multicast Tunnel Interfaces (MTIs), and set MTI parameters.
Share-Multicast Distribution Tree
For a VPN instance, data transmission in the public network is transparent. The VPN data is
seamlessly connected at MTIs on PEs: The VPN instance only knows that after it sends the VPN
data through an MTI on local PE, and the remote PE can receive the data through an MTI.
Actually, the data experiences the complex public network transmission process, that is,
multicast distribution tree (MDT) transmission.
The MDT that takes the address of Share-group as the group address is called Share-MDT. VPNs
use Share-Group to uniquely identify a Share-MDT.
Multicast can be enabled in a PIM-SM network or a PIM-DM network. In the two different
modes, the process of setting up a Share-MDT is different.
Switch-MDT Switchover
When multicast data is forwarded through a Share-MDT in the public network, the multicast
data is forwarded to all PEs that support the same VPN instance, regardless of whether there is
a receiver in the site connected to PEs. When the rate of VPN multicast data is higher, it may
lead to data flooding, which wastes the network bandwidth and adds load to PEs.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
287
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
The S9700 optimizes the MD. Special Switch-MDTs is set up between PEs connected to VPN
receivers and PEs connected to the VPN multicast source for VPN multicast data of a high rate
flowing to the public network. The multicast data flow is then switched from the Share-MDT
to the Switch-MDT. Multicast data can thus be transmitted on demand.
Users can configure the switching conditions of a Switch-MDT.
MD VPN across Multi-AS
When a VPN covers multiple ASs, it is necessary to connect VPN nodes among different ASs.
The following lists methods used by MD VPN to realize inter-AS multicast:
l
VPN instance-to-VPN Instance connection method
l
Multi-hop EBGP connection method
NOTE
For detailed implementation process, refer to the chapter "Multicast VPN" in the S9700 Core Routing
Switch Feature Description - IP Multicast.
8.3 Configuring Basic MD VPN Functions
By configuring the IPv4 multicast VPN through the MD solution, you can enable the
transmission of private multicast data over a public network. In this manner, multicast data in
the private network can traverse the public network and finally reach the receiver.
8.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring basic MD VPN functions, familiarize yourself with the applicable
environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the
configuration task quickly and accurately.
Applicable Environment
To implement multicast transmission in a VPN network, ensure that the VPN network works
normally. To enable a PE to receive information from multiple VPNs, the PE needs to
simultaneously support the public network instance and the VPN instance. The public network
is responsible for communicating with Ps, and each VPN instance is responsible for
communicating with each CE.
Configure multicast VPN by using the MD solution. Set up Share-MDT to forward multicast
packets. When the multicast forwarding rate exceeds the threshold, Share-MDT is switched to
Switch-MDT.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring basic MD VPN functions, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring MPLS/BGP VPN
l
Configuring public network multicast
Data Preparation
To configure basic MD VPN functions, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
288
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
No.
Data
1
VPN instance name and Route Distinguisher
2
Share-Group address
3
Address and MTU of MTI
8.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast Routing
Before configuring basic MD VPN functions, enable IP multicast routing.
Context
Do as follows on the PE switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
multicast routing-enable
IP multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance.
Step 3 Run:
ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name
The VPN instance view is displayed.
Step 4 Run:
ipv4-family
The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address
family view is displayed.
Step 5 Run:
route-distinguisher route-distinguisher
An RD is configured for the VPN instance IPv4 address family.
Step 6 Run:
multicast routing-enable
IP multicast routing is enabled for the VPN instance IPv4 address family.
----End
8.3.3 Configuring the Eth-Trunk as a Multicast Loopback Interface
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
289
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
Context
On a multicast VPN, all multicast data is processed by the GRE board. Therefore, an Eth-Trunk
must be configured, and a physical port on the GRE board must be added to the Eth-Trunk so
that multicast data can be forwarded to the GRE board for processing.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface eth-trunk trunk-id
The Eth-Trunk interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
service type multicast-tunnel
The Eth-Trunk is configured as a multicast loopback interface.
This command does not take effect if the Eth-Trunk contains member interfaces or other services
are configured on the Eth-Trunk. In addition, this command can run on only one Eth-Trunk of
a device.
Step 4 Run:
trunkport interface-type interface-number
A physical port is added to the Eth-Trunk.
The member interfaces in the Eth-Trunk must support the multicast tunnel service.
An Eth-Trunk set up between boards cannot be configured as a multicast loopback interface.
----End
8.3.4 Configuring Share-Group and Binding an MTI
When configuring the IPv4 multicast VPN, you need to configure a share-group address and the
MTI to be bound to the VPN instance. On one PE, different VPN instances cannot have the same
share-group address.
Context
Do as follows on the PE switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
290
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
The VPN instance view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
ipv4-family
The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address
family view is displayed.
Step 4 Run:
multicast-domain share-group group-address binding mtunnel number
A share group is configured. The system automatically creates an MTI, and then binds the share
group to the MTI and binds the MTI to the VPN instance IPv4 address family.
NOTE
After an MTI is created using the command in this step, the system automatically configures PIM on the
MTI. You do not need to configure PIM on this MTI.
PIM-SM is enabled on an MTI by default. If a physical interface configured with a PIM mode exists in the
same VPN with an MTI, the PIM mode of the MTI will be the same as that of the physical interface.
----End
8.3.5 Configuring an MTI
An MTI can send and receive multicast data only after being enabled with the multicast function.
Context
Do as follows on the PE switch:
NOTE
An MTI can be configured in either of the following modes:
l Automatic mode
l Manual mode
If both of the modes are configured, the manual configuration takes precedence over the automatic
configuration.
Procedure
l
Automatic configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name
The VPN instance view is displayed.
3.
Run:
ipv4-family
An IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4
address family view is displayed.
4.
Run:
multicast-domain source-interface interface-type interface-number
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
291
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
An interface from which an MTI references an IP address is specified.
l
Manual configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface mtunnel number
The MTI interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
ip address ip-address { mask | mask-length }
The address of the MTI is configured.
NOTE
The MTI address must be the same as the IP address that is used to set up the IBGP peer
relationship on the PE in the public network. Otherwise, the VPN multicast packets received
on the MTI cannot pass the RPF check.
----End
8.3.6 Checking the Configuration
After basic MD VPN functions are configured, you can check information about the share-group
and MTI of a specified VPN instance to ensure normal running of the VPN.
Procedure
l
Run the display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name share-group
[ local | remote ] command to check Share-Group information of a specified VPN instance
in an MD.
l
Run the display pim vpn-instance vpn-instance-name interface mtunnel interfacenumber [ verbose ] command to check information about an MTI.
----End
8.4 Configuring Switch-MDT Switchover
When multicast data packets are forwarded through the share-MDT in the public network, the
packets are forwarded to all PEs in the same VPN instance. Therefore, the high rate of multicast
data packets in the VPN will increase the burden on the PE. To solve this problem, you can
configure share-MDT and switch-MDT switchover to implement on-demand multicast, thereby,
saving bandwidth resource on the network.
8.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring share-MDT and switch-MDT switchover, familiarize yourself with the
applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete
the configuration task quickly and accurately.
Applicable Environment
When multicast data packets are forwarded through the share-MDT in the public network, the
packets are forwarded to all PEs that support the same VPN instance, regardless of whether there
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
292
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
is a receiver in the site to which a PE is connected. When the rate for forwarding VPN multicast
data packets is high, the packets may be flooded in the public network. This wastes network
bandwidth and increases the load of PEs.
In the S9700, you can determine whether to perform Switch-MDT switchover. If Switch-MDT
switchover is not configured, MDs use Share-MDT to transmit VPN multicast data forever.
l
When the rate of the VPN multicast data entering the public network exceeds the threshold,
the VPN multicast data can be switched from Share-MDT to a specified Switch-MDT. Ondemand multicast is thus implemented.
l
After the VPN multicast data is switched to the switch-MDT, the switchover conditions
may not be met. In this case, the VPN multicast data can be reversely switched from SwitchMDT to Share-MDT.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring Switch-MDT switchover, complete the task of Configuring Basic MD VPN
Functions.
Data Preparation
To configure Switch-MDT switchover, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
VPN instance name
2
The address range and mask of the switch-group-pool of Switch-MDT
3
Switching threshold
4
Delay for switching from Share-MDT to Switch-MDT
5
Delay for switching from Switch-MDT to Share-MDT
8.4.2 (Optional) Setting Switching Parameters of Switch-MDT
To reduce the burden on the PE and save bandwidth resources, you can establish a switch-MDT
for multicast data packets flowing from the VPN to the public network and switch the multicast
data packets from the share-MDT to the switch-MDT.
Context
Do as follows on the PE switch:
NOTE
This configuration is optional. If this configuration is not done, Switch-MDT switchover cannot be
performed and Share-MDT is always used to transmit VPN multicast data.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
293
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name
The VPN instance view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
ipv4-family
The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address
family view is displayed.
Step 4 Run:
multicast-domain switch-group-pool switch-group-pool { network-mask | network-masklength } [ threshold threshold-value | acl { advanced-acl-number | acl-name } ] *
The switch-group-pools of Switch-MDT and switch conditions are configured.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l switch-group-pool: specifies a switch-group-pool. It's suggested that the same VPN instance
enabled with the IPv4 address family on different PEs are configured with the same switchgroup-pool. On a PE, the Switch-Group address ranges to which different VPNs enabled
with the IPv4 address family correspond cannot overlap.
l threshold-value: Specifies the threshed. By default, it is 0 kbit/s.
l { advanced-acl-number | acl-name }: specifies the advanced ACL filtering rules. By default,
packets are not filtered.
Step 5 (Optional) Run:
multicast-domain switch-delay switch-delay
The delay for switching to Switch-MDT is configured.
By default, the delay is 5 seconds.
Step 6 (Optional) Run:
multicast-domain holddown-time interval
The duration for keeping the rate of VPN multicast data lower than the threshold before reversely
switching from Switch-MDT to Share-MDT is set.
By default, the delay for switching from Switch-MDT to Share-MDT is 60 seconds.
----End
8.4.3 Checking the Configuration
After share-MDT and switch-MDT switchover is configured, you can check information about
the switch-group sent and received by a specified VPN instance in the MD to ensure normal
running of the VPN.
Procedure
l
Run the following commands to check Switch-Group information received by a specified
VPN instance in the MD.
– display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group receive
brief
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
294
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
– display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group receive
[ active | group group-address | sender source-address | vpn-source-address [ mask
{ source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | vpn-group-address [ mask { group-masklength | group-mask } ] ] *
l
Run the display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group
send [ group group-address | reuse interval | vpn-source-address [ mask { source-masklength | source-mask } ] | vpn-group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] ] * command to check Switch-Group information sent by a specified VPN instance
in the MD.
----End
8.5 Maintaining IPv4 Multicast VPN
Maintaining the IPv4 multicast VPN involves monitoring the running status of the IPv4 multicast
VPN and controlling the output of logs.
8.5.1 Monitoring the Running Status of IPv4 Multicast VPN
During the routine maintenance of the IPv4 multicast VPN, you can run the display commands
in any view to know the running of the IPv4 multicast VPN.
Context
In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running
status of IPv4 Multicast VPN.
Procedure
l
Run the display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name share-group
[ local | remote ] command in any view to check information about Share-Group of a
specified VPN instance in an MD.
l
Run the following commands in any view to check information about Switch-Group
received by a specified VPN instance in an MD.
– display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group receive
brief
– display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group receive
[ active | group group-address | sender source-address | vpn-source-address [ mask
{ source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | vpn-group-address [ mask { group-masklength | group-mask } ] ] *
l
Run the display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group
send [ group group-address | reuse interval | vpn-source-address [ mask { source-masklength | source-mask } ] | vpn-group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] ] * command in any view to check information about the Switch-Group sent to a
specified VPN instance in an MD.
l
Run the display multicast-domain { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance }
control-message counters command in any view to check the statistics about sent and
received MDT switch messages in a specified VPN instance or all VPN instances.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
295
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
Run the display multicast-domain { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance }
invalid-packet command in any view to check the statistics about invalid MDT switch
messages received by a device.
----End
8.5.2 Debugging IPv4 Multicast VPN
When a fault occurs during the running of the IPv4 multicast VPN, run the debugging commands
in the user view and locate the fault based on the debugging information. Debugging affects the
performance of the system. So, after debugging, disable it immediately.
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. After debugging, run the undo debugging
all command to disable it immediately.
Procedure
l
Run the debugging md [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] { all | event
[ advanced-acl-number ] | packet } command in the user view to enable multicast
debugging in an MD.
----End
8.5.3 Controlling the Output of Logs
To know the running status of the system or locate a fault through logs, you can enable the output
of logs about the reused switch-group addresses.
Context
In the VPN instance on the source PE, if the number of VPN multicast data flows that need to
be switched is more than the number of group addresses in the switch-group-pool of SwitchMDT, the group addresses in the switch-group-pool can be used repeatedly.
By default, the logs of the reused Switch-Group addresses are not recorded.
To know the running status of the system or locate a fault through logs, do as follows on the PE:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
296
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
The VPN instance view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
ipv4-family
The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address
family view is displayed.
Step 4 Run:
multicast-domain log switch-group-reuse
The logs of the reused Switch-Group addresses are recorded.
----End
8.6 Configuration Examples
Examples for configuring the IPv4 multicast VPN.
8.6.1 Example for Configuring a Single-AS MD VPN
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 8-2, MD is used on the single-AS MPLS/BGP VPN to deploy multicast
services.
Figure 8-2 Networking diagram of a single-AS MD VPN
PC2
VPN
RED
Source2
GE1
CE-Rb
GE3
GE2
GE1
VPN
BLUE
Loopback1
GE1
VPN
RED
GE3 GE1
Loopback1
Public
GE1
GE2
GE1
CE-Ra
GE3
GE2
GE2
P
CE-Rc
PE-C
GE3
GE1
GE2
Loopback2
GE3
GE1Loopback1
GE2
VPN
BLUE
CE-Bc
PE-A
PC1 Loopback1
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
VPN
RED
GE2
GE2
PE-B
Source1
Loopback1
GE3
GE2
CE-Bb
PC3
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
GE1
PC4
297
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
NOTE
GE1 indicates GigabitEthernet 1/0/0; GE2 indicates GigabitEthernet 2/0/0; GE3 indicates GigabitEthernet
3/0/0.Table 8-1 lists the IP address of each interface in the figure.
Table 8-1 Configurations of the interfaces on switches
Device
Interface IP Address
Remarks
P
GE1: 192.168.6.2/24
-
VLANIF 10
GE2: 192.168.7.2/24
-
VLANIF 20
GE3: 192.168.8.2/24
-
VLANIF 30
PE-A
Loopback 1: 2.2.2.2/32
Loopback 1 acts as the C-RP for the public
network.
GE1: 192.168.6.1/24
VLANIF 40
GE1 belongs to the public network
instance.
GE2: 10.110.1.1/24
GE2 belongs to the VPN-RED instance.
VLANIF 50
GE3: 10.110.2.1/24
GE3 belongs to the VPN-RED instance.
VLANIF 60
Loopback 1: 1.1.1.1/32
Loopback 1 belongs to the public network
instance.
IBGP peer relationships are set up
between the Loopback 1 interfaces on PEA, PE-B, and PE-C.
PE-B
GE1: 192.168.7.1/24
VLANIF 70
GE1 belongs to the public network
instance.
GE2: 10.110.3.1/24
GE2 belongs to the VPN-BLUE instance.
VLANIF 80
GE3: 10.110.4.1/24
GE3 belongs to the VPN-RED instance.
VLANIF 90
Loopback 1: 1.1.1.2/32
Loopback 1 belongs to the public network
instance.
IBGP peer relationships are set up
between the Loopback 1 interfaces on PEA, PE-B, and PE-C.
PE-C
GE1: 192.168.8.1/24
VLANIF 100
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
GE1 belongs to the public network
instance.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
298
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
Device
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
Interface IP Address
Remarks
GE2: 10.110.5.1/24
GE2 belongs to the VPN-RED instance.
VLANIF 110
GE3: 10.110.6.1/24
GE3 belongs to the VPN-BLUE instance.
VLANIF 120
Loopback 1: 1.1.1.3/32
Loopback 1 belongs to the public network
instance.
IBGP peer relationships are set up
between the Loopback 1 interfaces on PEA, PE-B, and PE-C.
CE-Ra
Loopback 2: 33.33.33.33/32
Loopback 2 belongs to the VPN-BLUE
instance and acts as the C-RP of the
private network.
GE1: 10.110.7.1/24
-
VLANIF 130
GE2: 10.110.2.2/24
-
VLANIF 140
CE-Bb
GE1: 10.110.8.1/24
-
VLANIF 150
GE2: 10.110.3.2/24
-
VLANIF 160
CE-Rb
GE1: 10.110.9.1/24
-
VLANIF 170
GE2: 10.110.4.2/24
-
VLANIF 180
GE3: 10.110.12.1/24
-
VLANIF 190
CE-Rc
Loopback 1: 22.22.22.22/32
Loopback 1 belongs to the VPN-RED
instance and acts as the C-RP of the
private network.
GE1: 10.110.10.1/24
-
VLANIF 200
GE2: 10.110.5.2/24
-
VLANIF 210
GE3: 10.110.12.2/24
-
VLANIF 220
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
299
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
Device
Interface IP Address
Remarks
CE-Bc
GE1: 10.110.11.1/24
-
VLANIF 230
GE2: 10.110.6.2/24
-
VLANIF 240
Source1
10.110.7.2/24
Multicast source of VPN-RED
Source 2
10.110.8.2/24
Multicast source of VPN-BLUE
PC1
10.110.1.2/24
Multicast receiver of VPN-RED
PC2
10.110.9.2/24
Multicast receiver of VPN-RED
PC3
10.110.10.2/24
Multicast receiver of VPN-RED
PC4
10.110.11.2/24
Multicast receiver of VPN-BLUE
Table 8-2 Networking requirements of the single-AS MD VPN
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Item
Requirements
Multicast source
and receivers
The multicast source of VPN-RED is Source 1; the receivers of VPNRED are PC1, PC2, and PC3. The multicast source of VPN-BLUE is
Source 2 and the receiver of VPN-BLUE is PC4. The Share-Group
address of VPN-RED is 239.1.1.1; the addresses in the Switch-Group
address pool range from 225.2.2.1 to 225.2.2.16. The Share-Group
address of VPN-BLUE is 239.2.2.2; the addresses in the Switch-Group
address pool range from 225.4.4.1 to 225.4.4.16.
VPN instances to
which the interfaces
on the PEs belong
GE2 and GE3 on PE-A belong to the VPN-RED instance; GE1 and
Loopback 1 on PE-A belong to the public network instance; GE2 on
PE-B belongs to the VPN-BLUE instance; GE3 on PE-B belongs to
the VPN-RED instance; GE1 and Loopback 1 on PE-B belong to the
public network instance; GE2 on PE-C belongs to the VPN-RED
instance; GE3 and Loopback 2 on PE-C belong to the VPN-BLUE
instance; GE1 and Loopback 1 on PE-C belong to the public network
instance.
Routing protocols
and MPLS
OSPF is configured on the public network; RIP is configured between
PEs and switches (CEs). BGP peer connections are set up between the
Loopback 1 interfaces on PE-A, PE-B, and PE-C. All private network
routes are transmitted along these BGP peer connections. MPLS
forwarding starts on the public network.
Multicast function
Multicast is enabled on the P. Multicast is enabled on the public
network instances of PE-A, PE-B, and PE-C. Multicast is enabled on
the VPN-RED instances of PE-A, PE-B, and PE-C. Multicast is
enabled on the VPN-BLUE instances of PE-B and PE-C. Multicast is
enabled on CE-Ra, CE-Rb, CE-Rc, CE-Bb, and CE-Bc.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
300
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
Item
Requirements
IGMP
IGMP is enabled on GE2 on PE-A, GE1 interfaces of CE-Rb, CE-Rc,
CE-Bb, and CE-Bc.
PIM
PIM-SM is enabled on all the private network interfaces of VPN-RED
and VPN-BLUE. PIM-SM is enabled on all the interfaces of Ps and
CEs, and on all the public network interfaces of PEs. Loopback 1 of
the P acts as a C-BSR and C-RP for all the groups. Loopback 1 of the
CE-Rb acts as the C-BSR and C-RP for the private network VPN-RED
for all the groups. Loopback 2 of PE-C acts as the C-BSR and C-RP
for the private network VPN-BLUE for all the groups.
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Configure MPLS/BGP VPN; ensure that the VPN works normally and unicast routes are
reachable.
2.
On the PE, configure Eth-Trunk 10 as the multicast loopback interface.
3.
Enable the multicast function and the PIM function on the entire network. Configure the
public network-based multicast between PEs and Ps and configure the VPN instance-based
multicast between PEs and CEs.
4.
Configure the identical Share-Group address, MTI, and address pool range of Switch-MDT
for the same VPN instance on each PE.
5.
Configure the MTI address of each PE as the IBGP peer interface address on the public
network, and enable PIM on the MTI.
Data Preparation
See Table 8-2 in "Networking Requirements."
Procedure
Step 1 # Configure PE-A.
# Configure the ID of PE-A, enable IP multicast routing on the public network, configure the
ID of the MPLS LSR, and then enable LDP.
[PE-A] router id 1.1.1.1
[PE-A] multicast routing-enable
[PE-A] mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.1
[PE-A] mpls
[PE-A-mpls] quit
[PE-A] mpls ldp
[PE-A-mpls-ldp] quit
# Configure Eth-Trunk 10 as the multicast loopback interface.
[PE-A] interface eth-trunk 10
[PE-A-Eth-Trunk10] service type multicast-tunnel
[PE-A-Eth-Trunk10] trunkport GigabitEthernet 3/0/5
[PE-A-Eth-Trunk10] quit
# Create a VPN-RED instance and enter the VPN instance view. Configure the VPN IPv4 prefix
and create ingress and egress routes of the instance. Enable IP multicast routing and configure
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
301
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
the Share-Group. Specify the MTI to be bound to the VPN instance and address pool range of
Switch-MDT.
[PE-A] ip vpn-instance RED
[PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] route-distinguisher 100:1
[PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity
[PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity
[PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] multicast routing-enable
[PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding mtunnel 0
[PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.1 28
[PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] quit
# Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0 and start PIM-SM.
[PE-A] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
[PE-A-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 40
[PE-A-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 40
[PE-A-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[PE-A] interface vlanif 40
[PE-A-Vlanif40] ip address 192.168.6.1 24
[PE-A-Vlanif40] pim sm
[PE-A-Vlanif40] mpls
[PE-A-Vlanif40] mpls ldp
# Bind GigabitEthernet 2/0/0 to the VPN-RED instance, and start IGMP and PIM-SM.
[PE-A] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
[PE-A-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 50
[PE-A-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 50
[PE-A-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit
[PE-A] interface vlanif 50
[PE-A-Vlanif50] ip binding vpn-instance RED
[PE-A-Vlanif50] ip address 10.110.1.1 24
[PE-A-Vlanif50] pim sm
[PE-A-Vlanif50] igmp enable
# Bind GigabitEthernet 3/0/0 to the VPN-RED instance, and start PIM-SM.
[PE-A] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0
[PE-A-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 60
[PE-A-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 60
[PE-A-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit
[PE-A] interface vlanif 60
[PE-A-Vlanif60] ip binding vpn-instance RED
[PE-A-Vlanif60] ip address 10.110.2.1 24
[PE-A-Vlanif60] pim sm
# Assign an IP address to Loopback 1 and start PIM-SM.
[PE-A] interface
[PE-A-LoopBack1]
[PE-A-LoopBack1]
[PE-A-LoopBack1]
loopback 1
ip address 1.1.1.1 32
pim sm
quit
# Configure an IP address for MTI 0, which must be the same as the IP address of Loopback 1.
The system automatically binds MTI 0 to the VPN-RED instance. Start PIM-SM on the interface.
[PE-A] interface MTunnel 0
[PE-A-MTunnel0] ip address 1.1.1.1 32
[PE-A-MTunnel0] pim sm
[PE-A-MTunnel0] quit
# Configure unicast routing information of BGP, OSPF, and RIP.
[PE-A] bgp
[PE-A-bgp]
[PE-A-bgp]
[PE-A-bgp]
[PE-A-bgp]
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
100
group VPN-G internal
peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1
peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G
peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
302
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
[PE-A-bgp] ipv4-family vpn-instance RED
[PE-A-bgp-RED] import-route rip 2
[PE-A-bgp-RED] import-route direct
[PE-A-bgp-RED] quit
[PE-A-bgp] ipv4-family vpnv4
[PE-A-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer VPN-G enable
[PE-A-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G
[PE-A-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G
[PE-A-bgp-af-vpnv4] quit
[PE-A-bgp] quit
[PE-A] ospf 1
[PE-A-ospf-1] area 0.0.0.0
[PE-A-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0
[PE-A-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255
[PE-A-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] quit
[PE-A-ospf-1] quit
[PE-A] rip 2 vpn-instance RED
[PE-A-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0
[PE-A-rip-2] import-route bgp cost 3
Step 2 # Configure PE-B.
# Configure the ID of PE-B, enable IP multicast routing of the public network, configure the ID
of the MPLS LSR, and then enable LDP.
[PE-B] router id 1.1.1.2
[PE-B] multicast routing-enable
[PE-B] mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.2
[PE-B] mpls
[PE-B-mpls] quit
[PE-B] mpls ldp
[PE-B-mpls-ldp] quit
# Configure Eth-Trunk 10 as the multicast loopback interface.
[PE-B] interface eth-trunk 10
[PE-B-Eth-Trunk10] service type multicast-tunnel
[PE-B-Eth-Trunk10] trunkport GigabitEthernet 3/0/5
[PE-B-Eth-Trunk10] quit
# Create a VPN-BLUE instance and enter the VPN instance view. Configure the VPN IPv4
prefix and create ingress and egress routes of the instance. Start an IP multicast route and
configure the Share-Group. Specify the MTI to be bound to the VPN instance and switchaddress-pool range of Switch-MDT.
[PE-B] ip vpn-instance BLUE
[PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] route-distinguisher 200:1
[PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] vpn-target 200:1 export-extcommunity
[PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] vpn-target 200:1 import-extcommunity
[PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast routing-enable
[PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast-domain share-group 239.2.2.2 binding mtunnel 1
[PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.4.4.1 28
# Create a VPN-RED instance and enter the VPN instance view. Configure the VPN IPv4 prefix
and create ingress and egress routes of the instance. Start an IP multicast route and configure
the Share-Group. Specify the MTI to be bound to the VPN instance and switch-address-pool
range of Switch-MDT.
[PE-B] ip vpn-instance RED
[PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] route-distinguisher 100:1
[PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity
[PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity
[PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] multicast routing-enable
[PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding mtunnel 0
[PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.1 28
# Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0 and start PIM-SM.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
303
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
[PE-B] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
[PE-B-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 70
[PE-B-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 70
[PE-B-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[PE-B] interface vlanif 70
[PE-B-Vlanif70] ip address 192.168.7.1 24
[PE-B-Vlanif70] pim sm
[PE-B-Vlanif70] mpls
[PE-B-Vlanif70] mpls ldp
# Bind GigabitEthernet 2/0/0 to the VPN-BLUE instance, and start PIM-SM.
[PE-B] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
[PE-B-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 80
[PE-B-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 80
[PE-B-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit
[PE-B] interface vlanif 80
[PE-B-Vlanif80] ip binding vpn-instance BLUE
[PE-B-Vlanif80] ip address 10.110.3.1 24
[PE-B-Vlanif80] pim sm
# Bind GigabitEthernet 3/0/0 to the VPN-RED instance, and start PIM-SM.
[PE-B] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0
[PE-B-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 90
[PE-B-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 90
[PE-B-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit
[PE-B] interface vlanif 90
[PE-B-Vlanif90] ip binding vpn-instance RED
[PE-B-Vlanif90] ip address 10.110.4.1 24
[PE-B-Vlanif90] pim sm
# Assign an IP address to Loopback 1 and start PIM-SM.
[PE-B] interface
[PE-B-LoopBack1]
[PE-B-LoopBack1]
[PE-B-LoopBack1]
loopback 1
ip address 1.1.1.2 32
pim sm
quit
# Configure an IP address for MTI 0, which needs to be the same as the IP address of Loopback
1. Start PIM-SM on the interface.
[PE-B] interface MTunnel 0
[PE-B-MTunnel0] ip address 1.1.1.2 32
[PE-B-MTunnel0] pim sm
# Configure an IP address for MTI 1, which needs to be the same as the IP address of Loopback
1. Start PIM-SM on the interface.
[PE-B] interface MTunnel 1
[PE-B-MTunnel1] ip address 1.1.1.2 32
[PE-B-MTunnel1] pim sm
# Configure unicast routing information of BGP, OSPF, and RIP.
[PE-B] bgp 100
[PE-B-bgp] group VPN-G internal
[PE-B-bgp] peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1
[PE-B-bgp] peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G
[PE-B-bgp] peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G
[PE-B-bgp] ipv4-family vpn-instance RED
[PE-B-bgp-RED] import-route rip 2
[PE-B-bgp-RED] import-route direct
[PE-B-bgp-RED] quit
[PE-B-bgp] ipv4-family vpn-instance BLUE
[PE-B-bgp-BLUE] import-route rip 3
[PE-B-bgp-BLUE] import-route direct
[PE-B-bgp-BLUE] quit
[PE-B-bgp] ipv4-family vpnv4
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
304
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
[PE-B-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer VPN-G enable
[PE-B-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G
[PE-B-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G
[PE-B-bgp-af-vpnv4] quit
[PE-B-bgp] quit
[PE-B] ospf 1
[PE-B-ospf-1] area 0.0.0.0
[PE-B-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 1.1.1.2 0.0.0.0
[PE-B-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255
[PE-B-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] quit
[PE-B-ospf-1] quit
[PE-B] rip 2 vpn-instance RED
[PE-B-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0
[PE-B-rip-2] import-route bgp cost 3
[PE-B-rip-2] quit
[PE-B] rip 3 vpn-instance BLUE
[PE-B-rip-3] network 10.0.0.0
[PE-B-rip-3] import-route bgp cost 3
Step 3 # Configure PE-C.
# Configure the ID of PE-C, enable IP multicast routing of the public network, configure the ID
of the MPLS LSR, and then enable LDP.
[PE-C] router id 1.1.1.3
[PE-C] multicast routing-enable
[PE-C] mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.3
[PE-C] mpls
[PE-C-mpls] quit
[PE-C] mpls ldp
[PE-C-mpls-ldp] quit
# Configure Eth-Trunk 10 as the multicast loopback interface.
[PE-C] interface eth-trunk 10
[PE-C-Eth-Trunk10] service type multicast-tunnel
[PE-C-Eth-Trunk10] trunkport GigabitEthernet 3/0/5
[PE-C-Eth-Trunk10] quit
# Create a VPN-RED instance and enter the VPN instance view. Configure the VPN IPv4 prefix
and create ingress and egress routes of the instance. Start an IP multicast route and configure
the Share-Group. Specify the MTI to be bound to the VPN instance and switch-address-pool
range of Switch-MDT.
[PE-C] ip vpn-instance RED
[PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] route-distinguisher 100:1
[PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity
[PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity
[PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] multicast routing-enable
[PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding mtunnel 0
[PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.1 28
# Create a VPN-BLUE instance and enter the VPN instance view. Configure the VPN IPv4
prefix and create ingress and egress routes of the instance. Start an IP multicast route and
configure the Share-Group. Specify the MTI to be bound to the VPN instance and switchaddress-pool range of Switch-MDT.
[PE-C] ip vpn-instance BLUE
[PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] route-distinguisher 200:1
[PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] vpn-target 200:1 export-extcommunity
[PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] vpn-target 200:1 import-extcommunity
[PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast routing-enable
[PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast-domain share-group 239.2.2.2 binding mtunnel 1
[PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.4.4.1 28
# Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0 and start PIM-SM.
[PE-C] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
305
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
[PE-C-GigabitEthernet1/0/0]
[PE-C-GigabitEthernet1/0/0]
[PE-C-GigabitEthernet1/0/0]
[PE-C] interface vlanif 100
[PE-C-Vlanif100] ip address
[PE-C-Vlanif100] pim sm
[PE-C-Vlanif100] mpls
[PE-C-Vlanif100] mpls ldp
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
quit
192.168.8.1 24
# Bind GigabitEthernet 2/0/0 to the VPN-RED instance, and start PIM-SM.
[PE-C] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
[PE-C-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 110
[PE-C-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 110
[PE-C-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit
[PE-C] interface vlanif 110
[PE-C-Vlanif110] ip binding vpn-instance RED
[PE-C-Vlanif110] ip address 10.110.5.1 24
[PE-C-Vlanif110] pim sm
# Bind GigabitEthernet 3/0/0 to the VPN-BLUE instance, and start PIM-SM.
[PE-C] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0
[PE-C-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 120
[PE-C-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 120
[PE-C-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit
[PE-C] interface vlanif 120
[PE-C-Vlanif120] ip binding vpn-instance BLUE
[PE-C-Vlanif120] ip address 10.110.6.1 24
[PE-C-Vlanif120] pim sm
# Assign an IP address to Loopback 1 and start PIM-SM.
[PE-C] interface
[PE-C-LoopBack1]
[PE-C-LoopBack1]
[PE-C-LoopBack1]
loopback 1
ip address 1.1.1.3 32
pim sm
quit
# Configure an IP address for MTI 0, which needs to be the same as the IP address of Loopback
1. Start PIM-SM on the interface.
[PE-C] interface MTunnel 0
[PE-C-MTunnel0] ip address 1.1.1.3 32
[PE-C-MTunnel0] pim sm
# Configure an IP address for MTI 1, which needs to be the same as the IP address of Loopback
1. Start PIM-SM on the interface.
[PE-C] interface MTunnel 1
[PE-C-MTunnel1] ip address 1.1.1.3 32
[PE-C-MTunnel1] pim sm
# Bind Loopback 2 to the VPN-BLUE instance, and start PIM-SM.
[PE-C] interface
[PE-C-LoopBack2]
[PE-C-LoopBack2]
[PE-C-LoopBack2]
[PE-C-LoopBack2]
loopback 2
ip binding vpn-instance BLUE
ip address 33.33.33.33 32
pim sm
quit
# Configure Loopback 2 as the C-BSR and C-RP for VPN-BLUE of the private network.
[PE-C] pim vpn-instance BLUE
[PE-C-pim-BLUE] c-bsr Loopback2
[PE-C-pim-BLUE] c-rp Loopback2
[PE-C-pim-BLUE] quit
# Configure unicast routing information of BGP, OSPF, and RIP.
[PE-C] bgp 100
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
306
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
[PE-C-bgp] group VPN-G internal
[PE-C-bgp] peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1
[PE-C-bgp] peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G
[PE-C-bgp] peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G
[PE-C-bgp] ipv4-family vpn-instance RED
[PE-C-bgp-RED] import-route rip 2
[PE-C-bgp-RED] import-route direct
[PE-C-bgp-RED] quit
[PE-C-bgp] ipv4-family vpn-instance BLUE
[PE-C-bgp-BLUE] import-route rip 3
[PE-C-bgp-BLUE] import-route direct
[PE-C-bgp-BLUE] quit
[PE-C-bgp] ipv4-family vpnv4
[PE-C-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer VPN-G enable
[PE-C-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G
[PE-C-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G
[PE-C-bgp-af-vpnv4] quit
[PE-C-bgp] quit
[PE-C] ospf 1
[PE-C-ospf-1] area 0.0.0.0
[PE-C-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 1.1.1.3 0.0.0.0
[PE-C-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255
[PE-C-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] quit
[PE-C-ospf-1] quit
[PE-C] rip 2 vpn-instance RED
[PE-C-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0
[PE-C-rip-2] import-route bgp cost 3
[PE-C-rip-2] quit
[PE-C] rip 3 vpn-instance BLUE
[PE-C-rip-3] network 10.0.0.0
[PE-C-rip-3] import-route bgp cost 3
Step 4 Configure the P.
# Enable IP multicast routing of the public network, configure the ID of the MPLS LSR, and
then enable LDP.
[P] multicast routing-enable
[P] mpls lsr-id 2.2.2.2
[P] mpls
[P-mpls] quit
[P] mpls ldp
[P-mpls-ldp] quit
# Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0 and start PIM-SM.
[P] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
[P-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 10
[P-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 10
[P-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[P] interface vlanif 10
[P-Vlanif10] ip address 192.168.6.2 24
[P-Vlanif10] pim sm
[P-Vlanif10] mpls
[P-Vlanif10] mpls ldp
# Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0 and start PIM-SM.
[P] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
[P-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 20
[P-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 20
[P-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit
[P] interface vlanif 20
[P-Vlanif20] ip address 192.168.7.2 24
[P-Vlanif20] pim sm
[P-Vlanif20] mpls
[P-Vlanif20] mpls ldp
# Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 3/0/0 and start PIM-SM.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
307
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
[P] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0
[P-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 30
[P-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 30
[P-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit
[P] interface vlanif 30
[P-Vlanif30] ip address 192.168.8.2 24
[P-Vlanif30] pim sm
[P-Vlanif30] mpls
[P-Vlanif30] mpls ldp
# Assign an IP address to Loopback 1 and start PIM-SM.
[P] interface
[P-LoopBack1]
[P-LoopBack1]
[P-LoopBack1]
loopback 1
ip address 2.2.2.2 32
pim sm
quit
# Configure Loopback 1 as the C-BSR and C-RP for the public network.
[P] pim
[P-pim] c-bsr Loopback1
[P-pim] c-rp Loopback1
# Configure OSPF unicast routing information.
[P] ospf 1
[P-ospf-1] area 0.0.0.0
[P-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 2.2.2.2 0.0.0.0
[P-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255
[P-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] quit
Step 5 Configure CE-Ra.
# Enable IP multicast routing.
[CE-Ra] multicast routing-enable
# Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0.
[CE-Ra] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
[CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 130
[CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 130
[CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[CE-Ra] interface vlanif 130
[CE-Ra-Vlanif130] ip address 10.110.7.1 24
[CE-Ra-Vlanif130] pim sm
# Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0.
[CE-Ra] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
[CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 140
[CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 140
[CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit
[CE-Ra] interface vlanif 140
[CE-Ra-Vlanif140] ip address 10.110.2.2 24
[CE-Ra-Vlanif140] pim sm
# Configure RIP unicast routing information.
[CE-Ra] rip 2
[CE-Ra-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0
[CE-Ra-rip-2] import-route direct
Step 6 Configure CE-Bb.
# Enable IP multicast routing.
[CE-Bb] multicast routing-enable
# Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
308
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
[CE-Bb] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
[CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 150
[CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 150
[CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[CE-Bb] interface vlanif 150
[CE-Bb-Vlanif150] ip address 10.110.8.1 24
[CE-Bb-Vlanif150] pim sm
# Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0.
[CE-Bb] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
[CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 160
[CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 160
[CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit
[CE-Bb] interface vlanif 160
[CE-Bb-Vlanif160] ip address 10.110.3.2 24
[CE-Bb-Vlanif160] pim sm
# Configure RIP unicast routing information.
[CE-Bb] rip 3
[CE-Bb-rip-3] network 10.0.0.0
[CE-Bb-rip-3] import-route direct
Step 7 Configure CE-Rb.
# Enable IP multicast routing.
[CE-Rb] multicast routing-enable
# Enable PIM-SM and IGMP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0.
[CE-Rb] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
[CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 170
[CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 170
[CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[CE-Rb] interface vlanif 170
[CE-Rb-Vlanif170] ip address 10.110.9.1 24
[CE-Rb-Vlanif170] pim sm
[CE-Rb-Vlanif170] igmp enable
# Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0.
[CE-Rb] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
[CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 180
[CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 180
[CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit
[CE-Rb] interface vlanif 180
[CE-Rb-Vlanif180] ip address 10.110.4.2 24
[CE-Rb-Vlanif180] pim sm
# Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 3/0/0.
[CE-Rb] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0
[CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 190
[CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 190
[CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit
[CE-Rb] interface vlanif 190
[CE-Rb-Vlanif190] ip address 10.110.12.1 24
[CE-Rb-Vlanif190] pim sm
# Assign an IP address to Loopback 1 and start PIM-SM.
[CE-Rb] interface
[CE-Rb-LoopBack1]
[CE-Rb-LoopBack1]
[CE-Rb-LoopBack1]
loopback 1
ip address 22.22.22.22 32
pim sm
quit
# Configure Loopback 1 as the BSR and RP for the private network VPN-RED.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
309
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
[CE-Rb] pim
[CE-Rb-pim] c-bsr Loopback1
[CE-Rb-pim] c-rp Loopback1
[CE-Rb-pim] quit
# Configure RIP unicast routing information.
[CE-Rb] rip 2
[CE-Rb-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0
[CE-Rb-rip-2] network 22.0.0.0
[CE-Rb-rip-2] import-route direct
Step 8 Configure CE-Rc.
# Enable IP multicast routing.
[CE-Rc] multicast routing-enable
# Enable PIM-SM and IGMP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0.
[CE-Rc] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
[CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 200
[CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 200
[CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[CE-Rc] interface vlanif 200
[CE-Rc-Vlanif200] ip address 10.110.10.1 24
[CE-Rc-Vlanif200] pim sm
[CE-Rc-Vlanif200] igmp enable
# Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0.
[CE-Rc] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
[CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 210
[CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 210
[CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit
[CE-Rc] interface vlanif 210
[CE-Rc-Vlanif210] ip address 10.110.5.2 24
[CE-Rc-Vlanif210] pim sm
# Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 3/0/0.
[CE-Rc] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0
[CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 220
[CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 220
[CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit
[CE-Rc] interface vlanif 220
[CE-Rc-Vlanif220] ip address 10.110.12.2 24
[CE-Rc-Vlanif220] pim sm
# Configure RIP unicast routing information.
[CE-Rc] rip 2
[CE-Rc-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0
[CE-Rc-rip-2] import-route direct
Step 9 Configure CE-Bc.
# Enable IP multicast routing.
[CE-Bc] multicast routing-enable
# Enable PIM-SM and IGMP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0.
[CE-Bc] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0
[CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 230
[CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 230
[CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit
[CE-Bc] interface vlanif 230
[CE-Bc-Vlanif230] ip address 10.110.11.1 24
[CE-Bc-Vlanif230] pim sm
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
310
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
[CE-Bc-Vlanif230] igmp enable
# Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0.
[CE-Bc] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0
[CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 240
[CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 240
[CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit
[CE-Bc] interface vlanif 240
[CE-Bc-Vlanif240] ip address 10.110.6.2 24
[CE-Bc-Vlanif240] pim sm
# Configure RIP unicast routing information.
[CE-Bc] rip 3
[CE-Bc-rip-3] network 10.0.0.0
[CE-Bc-rip-3] import-route direct
Step 10 Verify the configuration.
After the preceding configurations, PC1, PC2, and PC3 can receive multicast information from
Source 1; PC4 can receive multicast information from Source 2.
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of PE-A
#
sysname PE-A
#
vlan batch 40 50 60
#
router id 1.1.1.1
#
multicast routing-enable
#
mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.1
mpls
#
mpls ldp
#
ip vpn-instance RED
route-distinguisher 100:1
vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity
vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity
#
multicast routing-enable
multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding MTunnel 0
multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.0 255.255.255.240
#
interface Vlanif40
ip address 192.168.6.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
mpls
mpls ldp
#
interface Vlanif50
ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
ip binding vpn-instance RED
#
interface Vlanif60
ip binding vpn-instance RED
ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
311
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
interface Eth-Trunk10
service type multicast-tunnel
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 40
port hybrid untagged vlan 40
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 50
port hybrid untagged vlan 50
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 60
port hybrid untagged vlan 60
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/5
eth-trunk 10
#
interface LoopBack1
ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
interface MTunnel0
ip binding vpn-instance RED
ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
bgp 100
group VPN-G internal
peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1
peer 1.1.1.2 as-number 100
peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G
peer 1.1.1.3 as-number 100
peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G
#
ipv4-family unicast
undo synchronization
peer VPN-G enable
peer 1.1.1.2 enable
peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G
peer 1.1.1.3 enable
peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G
#
ipv4-family vpnv4
policy vpn-target
peer VPN-G enable
peer 1.1.1.2 enable
peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G
peer 1.1.1.3 enable
peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G
#
ipv4-family vpn-instance RED
import-route rip 2
import-route direct
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255
#
rip 2 vpn-instance RED
network 10.0.0.0
import-route bgp cost 3
#
return
l
Configuration file of PE-B
#
sysname PE-B
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
312
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
vlan batch 70 80 90
#
router id 1.1.1.2
#
multicast routing-enable
#
mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.2
mpls
#
mpls ldp
#
ip vpn-instance BLUE
route-distinguisher 200:1
vpn-target 200:1 export-extcommunity
vpn-target 200:1 import-extcommunity
multicast routing-enable
multicast-domain share-group 239.2.2.2 binding MTunnel 1
multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.4.4.0 255.255.255.240
#
ip vpn-instance RED
route-distinguisher 100:1
vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity
vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity
multicast routing-enable
multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding MTunnel 0
multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.0 255.255.255.240
#
interface Vlanif70
ip address 192.168.7.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
mpls
mpls ldp
#
interface Vlanif80
ip binding vpn-instance BLUE
ip address 10.110.3.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Eth-Trunk10
service type multicast-tunnel
#
interface Vlanif90
ip binding vpn-instance RED
ip address 10.110.4.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 70
port hybrid untagged vlan 70
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 80
port hybrid untagged vlan 80
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 90
port hybrid untagged vlan 90
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/5
eth-trunk 10
#
interface LoopBack1
ip address 1.1.1.2 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
interface MTunnel0
ip binding vpn-instance RED
ip address 1.1.1.2 255.255.255.255
pim sm
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
313
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
#
interface MTunnel1
ip binding vpn-instance BLUE
ip address 1.1.1.2 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
bgp 100
group VPN-G internal
peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1
peer 1.1.1.1 as-number 100
peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G
peer 1.1.1.3 as-number 100
peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G
#
ipv4-family unicast
undo synchronization
peer VPN-G enable
peer 1.1.1.1 enable
peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G
peer 1.1.1.3 enable
peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G
#
ipv4-family vpnv4
policy vpn-target
peer VPN-G enable
peer 1.1.1.1 enable
peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G
peer 1.1.1.3 enable
peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G
#
ipv4-family vpn-instance RED
import-route rip 2
import-route direct
#
ipv4-family vpn-instance BLUE
import-route rip 3
import-route direct
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 1.1.1.2 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255
#
rip 2 vpn-instance RED
network 10.0.0.0
import-route bgp cost 3
#
rip 3 vpn-instance BLUE
network 10.0.0.0
import-route bgp cost 3
#
return
l
Configuration file of PE-C
#
sysname PE-C
#
vlan batch 100 110 120
#
router id 1.1.1.3
#
multicast routing-enable
#
mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.3
mpls
#
mpls ldp
#
ip vpn-instance RED
route-distinguisher 100:1
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
314
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity
vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity
multicast routing-enable
multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding MTunnel 0
multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.0 255.255.255.240
#
ip vpn-instance BLUE
route-distinguisher 200:1
vpn-target 200:1 export-extcommunity
vpn-target 200:1 import-extcommunity
multicast routing-enable
multicast-domain share-group 239.2.2.2 binding MTunnel 1
multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.4.4.0 255.255.255.240
#
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.7.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
mpls
mpls ldp
#
interface Vlanif110
ip binding vpn-instance RED
ip address 10.110.5.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif120
ip binding vpn-instance BLUE
ip address 10.110.6.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Eth-Trunk10
service type multicast-tunnel
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 110
port hybrid untagged vlan 110
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 120
port hybrid untagged vlan 120
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/5
eth-trunk 10
#
interface LoopBack1
ip address 1.1.1.3 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
interface LoopBack2
ip binding vpn-instance BLUE
ip address 33.33.33.33 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
pim vpn-instance BLUE
c-bsr LoopBack2
c-rp LoopBack2
#
interface MTunnel0
ip binding vpn-instance RED
ip address 1.1.1.3 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
interface MTunnel1
ip binding vpn-instance BLUE
ip address 1.1.1.3 255.255.255.255
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
315
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
pim sm
#
bgp 100
group VPN-G internal
peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1
peer 1.1.1.1 as-number 100
peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G
peer 1.1.1.2 as-number 100
peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G
#
ipv4-family unicast
undo synchronization
peer VPN-G enable
peer 1.1.1.1 enable
peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G
peer 1.1.1.2 enable
peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G
#
ipv4-family vpnv4
policy vpn-target
peer VPN-G enable
peer 1.1.1.1 enable
peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G
peer 1.1.1.2 enable
peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G
#
ipv4-family vpn-instance RED
import-route rip 2
import-route direct
#
ipv4-family vpn-instance BLUE
import-route rip 3
import-route direct
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 1.1.1.3 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255
#
rip 2 vpn-instance RED
network 10.0.0.0
import-route bgp cost 3
#
rip 3 vpn-instance BLUE
network 10.0.0.0
import-route bgp cost 3
#
return
l
Configuration file of P
#
sysname P
#
vlan batch 10 20 30
#
multicast routing-enable
#
mpls lsr-id 2.2.2.2
mpls
#
mpls ldp
#
interface Vlanif10
ip address 192.168.6.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
mpls
mpls ldp
#
interface Vlanif20
ip address 192.168.7.2 255.255.255.0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
316
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
pim sm
mpls
mpls ldp
#
interface Vlanif30
ip address 192.168.8.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
mpls
mpls ldp
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 20
port hybrid untagged vlan 20
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 30
port hybrid untagged vlan 30
#
interface LoopBack1
ip address 2.2.2.2 255.255.255.255
pim sm
#
pim
c-bsr Loopback1
c-rp Loopback1
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 2.2.2.2 0.0.0.0
network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of CE-Ra
#
sysname CE-Ra
#
vlan batch 130 140
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif130
ip address 10.110.7.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif140
ip address 10.110.2.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 130
port hybrid untagged vlan 130
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 140
port hybrid untagged vlan 140
#
rip 2
network 10.0.0.0
import-route direct
#
return
l
Configuration file of CE-Bb
#
sysname CE-Bb
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
317
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
#
vlan batch 150 160
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif150
ip address 10.110.8.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif160
ip address 10.110.3.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 150
port hybrid untagged vlan 150
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 160
port hybrid untagged vlan 160
#
rip 3
network 10.0.0.0
import-route direct
#
return
l
Configuration file of CE-Rb
#
sysname CE-Rb
#
vlan batch 170 180 190
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif170
ip address 10.110.9.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
#
interface Vlanif180
ip address 10.110.4.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif190
ip address 10.110.12.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 170
port hybrid untagged vlan 170
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 180
port hybrid untagged vlan 180
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 190
port hybrid untagged vlan 190
#
interface loopback 1
ip address 22.22.22.22 32
pim sm
#
pim
c-bsr Loopback1
c-rp Loopback1
#
rip 2
network 10.0.0.0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
318
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
network 22.0.0.0
import-route direct
#
return
l
Configuration file of CE-Rc
#
sysname CE-Rc
#
vlan batch 200 210 220
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif200
ip address 10.110.10.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
#
interface Vlanif210
ip address 10.110.5.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface Vlanif220
ip address 10.110.12.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 210
port hybrid untagged vlan 210
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 220
port hybrid untagged vlan 220
#
rip 2
network 10.0.0.0
import-route direct
#
return
l
Configuration file of CE-Bc
#
sysname CE-Bc
#
vlan batch 230 240
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif230
ip address 10.110.11.1 255.255.255.0
pim sm
igmp enable
#
interface Vlanif240
ip address 10.110.6.2 255.255.255.0
pim sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 230
port hybrid untagged vlan 230
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 240
port hybrid untagged vlan 240
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
319
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration
rip 3
network 10.0.0.0
import-route direct
#
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
320
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
About This Chapter
The system synchronously maintains multiple multicast routing protocols, and controls multicast
routing and forwarding through the information exchanged between the control plane and the
forwarding plane.
9.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Multicast routing and forwarding maintains a protocol routing table, multicast routing table, and
multicast forwarding table. A multicast routing protocol creates multicast routing entries through
RPF.
9.2 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Features Supported by the S9700
The IPv4 multicast routing management features supported by the system are: static multicast
route, GRE tunnel, multicast routing policy, controlling the multicast forwarding range,
controlling the capacity of a multicast forwarding table, testing multicast routes, and multicast
splitting.
9.3 Configuring a Static Multicast Route
Static multicast routes have the functions of changing RPF routes and connecting RPF routes.
9.4 Configuring the Multicast Routing Policy
Configuring a multicast routing policy involves optimizing storage resources for multicast
forwarding entries,configuring the multicast Hash algorithm, configuring the longest match of
the multicast route, configuring multicast load splitting, and setting a multicast load splitting
weight.
9.5 Configuring the Multicast Forwarding Scope
Multicast information of each multicast group in a network should be transmitted within a certain
range. Therefore, configuring a multicast forwarding boundary are necessary for restricting the
multicast data forwarding scope.
9.6 Configuring Control Parameters of the Multicast Forwarding Table
During network planning, you can restrict the capacity of the forwarding table on a multicast
device, such as the maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table and the
maximum number of downstream interfaces of multicast forwarding entries. In this manner,
traffic load on the multicast device is released and the fault risk resulted from excessive entries
can be avoided.
9.7 Maintaining the Multicast Policy
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
321
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Maintaining IPv4 multicast routing management involves testing multicast routing, checking
the RPF path and multicast path, clearing multicast forwarding and routing entries, and
monitoring multicast routing and forwarding.
9.8 Configuration Examples
Examples for configuring static multicast routes and multicast load splitting are provided.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
322
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
9.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Multicast routing and forwarding maintains a protocol routing table, multicast routing table, and
multicast forwarding table. A multicast routing protocol creates multicast routing entries through
RPF.
In the S9700, multicast routing and forwarding consist of the following three aspects:
l
Each multicast routing protocol has its routing table, such as PIM routing table.
l
The multicast routing information of each multicast routing protocol forms a general
multicast routing table.
The multicast routing table resides in the multicast route management module. It is
composed of (S, G) entries. (S, G) indicates that S sends multicast data to G. If the multicast
route management module supports multiple multicast protocols, the routing table contains
multicast routes that are generated by the protocols. The routing entries are copied to the
forwarding table.
l
The multicast forwarding table controls the forwarding of multicast data packets.
The multicast forwarding table guides the forwarding of multicast data packets. It remains
consistent with the multicast routing table.
To ensure that multicast data is transmitted along the correct path, multicast routing protocols
use the Reverse Path Forwarding (RPF) to create multicast routing entries.
The system performs RPF check based on the following types of routes:
l
Unicast routes
The unicast routing table collects the shortest paths to each destination.
l
MBGP routes
The MBGP routing table provides multicast routing information.
l
MIGP routes
The MIGP routing table provides the routing information calculated based on physical
interfaces of the TE tunnel to guide the forwarding of multicast packets.
l
Static multicast routes
The static multicast routing table provides RPF routing information that is specified through
static configuration.
9.2 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Features
Supported by the S9700
The IPv4 multicast routing management features supported by the system are: static multicast
route, GRE tunnel, multicast routing policy, controlling the multicast forwarding range,
controlling the capacity of a multicast forwarding table, testing multicast routes, and multicast
splitting.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
323
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Static Multicast Route
The static multicast route is an important factor of RPF check. By configuring the static multicast
route, users can specify the RPF interface and RPF neighbor for a specific source of packets on
the current switch.
The static multicast route cannot be used to forward data. It only affects RPF check, and is also
called static RPF route.
The static multicast route is valid only on the configured multicast switchs, and cannot be
advertised or imported to other switchs.
Multicast Routing Policy
If multiple unicast routes with the same cost exist when a multicast switch selects an upstream
interface, users can use one of following methods to configure the switch to select the RPF route:
l
By default, the switch chooses the route with the largest next-hop address.
l
According to the longest match, the switch selects the route longest matching the address
of the source of the packet.
l
Load splitting is configured among equal-cost routes. Performing load splitting of multicast
traffic according to different policies can optimize network traffic transmission in the
scenario where multiple multicast data flows exist.
There are five multicast load splitting policies: stable-preferred, balance-preferred, source
address-based, group address-based, and source and group addresses-based. The five load
splitting policies are mutually exclusive. In stable-preferred mode and balance-preferred
mode, you can configure load splitting weights on the interfaces to achieve unbalanced
multicast load splitting.
Controlling the Multicast Forwarding Range
In a network, the multicast information to which each multicast group corresponds is transmitted
in a certain range. Users can define the multicast forwarding range by using the following
method:
l
Configuring a multicast forwarding boundary on an interface to form a closed multicast
forwarding area.
Controlling the Capacity of a Multicast Forwarding Table
When planning a specific network according to network services, the Internet Service Provider
(ISP) can perform the following configurations:
l
Limiting the number of entries in the multicast forwarding table
Each switch maintains a forwarding entry for each received multicast packet. Too many
multicast forwarding entries, however, use up the memory of a switch. Users can define
the maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table of a switch. Limiting the
number of entries according to the actual networking and service performance can avoid
switch faults caused by excessive entries.
l
Limiting the number of downstream nodes of each forwarding entry
Switch replicate a multicast packet for each downstream node, and then send it out. Each
downstream node forms a branch of an MDT. The number of downstream nodes determines
the maximum scale of the MDT and the multicast service range. Users can define the
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
324
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
number of downstream nodes of a single forwarding entry. Limiting the number of
downstream nodes according to the actual networking and service performance can reduce
the processing pressure of a switch and control the multicast service range.
Testing Multicast Routing
When a fault occurs on a multicast network, you can run the ping multicast and mtrace
commands to test the connectivity of the network.
NOTE
The mtrace command can be used to trace multicast path on a specified multicast VPN network to maintain
multicast VPN services and locate faults on the network.
The ping multicast command is used to check whether a group is reachable and to implement
the following functions:
l
Pinging a reserved group address
This is used to check whether a member of a group exists in the directly connected network
segment, and is not exclusive for multicast networks. You can ping devices that use
multicast addresses.
l
Pinging a common group address
This function is applied as follows:
– To generate multicast traffic and trigger the creation of multicast routing entries: Based
on multicast routing information, you can check whether a protocol runs normally,
determine whether the network can carry multicast services, or test the forwarding
performance.
– To check the members of related groups in the network: Based on the ICMP-EchoReply messages received from destination hosts, the switch on which the command is
used checks the members of the groups in the network, and calculates response time
and the TTL from the switch to members. You can run the command repeatedly in a
certain interval to calculate the network delay and route flapping.
The mtrace command can be used to trace the following paths and output the hop information:
l
RPF path from a source to a querier
l
Multicast path from a source to a querier
l
RPF path from a source to a destination host
l
Multicast path from a source to a destination host
NOTE
You can ping multicast addresses by using the Network Quality Analysis (NQA) test instances or related
commands. For detailed configurations of NQA test instances, refer to the chapter " NQA Configuration
" in S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Network Management.
9.3 Configuring a Static Multicast Route
Static multicast routes have the functions of changing RPF routes and connecting RPF routes.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
325
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
9.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring static multicast routes, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment,
pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task
quickly and accurately.
Applicable Environment
Static multicast route has the following functions:
l
Changing RPF route
If the topology of multicast is the same as that of unicast, the transmission path of multicast
data is the same as that of unicast data. Users can change the RPF route by configuring a
static multicast route. Thus a transmission path of the multicast data, which is different
from the transmission path of unicast data, is established.
l
Connecting RPF route
In the network segment where unicast routes are blocked, when multicast static routes are
not configured, packets cannot be forwarded because there is no RPF route. You can
configure multicast static routes. Therefore, the system can generate RPF routes, complete
RPF check, create routing entries, and guide the forwarding of packets.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring a static multicast route, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring basic multicast functions
Data Preparation
To configure a static multicast route, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Multicast source address, mask or mask length
2
Unicast routing protocol
3
Filtering policy and its preference
9.3.2 Configuring a Static Multicast Route Function
When configuring a static multicast route, you can specify an RPF interface and an RPF neighbor
on the current multicast device.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
326
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Context
CAUTION
When configuring a static multicast route, configure the outgoing interface through the command
if the next hop is in the point-to-point format. If the next hop is not in the point-to-point format,
you must use the next hop.
Do as follows on the multicast switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
ip rpf-route-static [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] source-address { mask | masklength } [ isis process-id | ospf process-id | rip process-id | bgp | static ]
[ route-policy route-policy-name ] { gateway-address | interface-type interfacenumber } [ preference preference ] [ order order-number ]
A static multicast route is configured.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l source-address { mask |mask-length }: specifies a source address and mask.
l isis process-id, ospf process-id, rip process-id, bgp, static: specifies that the matching route
must be present in the specified unicast routing protocol. protocol specifies a unicast routing
protocol. process-id specifies the ID of a process.
l route-policy policy-name: specifies the matching rule of the static multicast route.
l interface-type interface-number: specifies the type and the number of the outgoing interface.
The outgoing interface acts as the RPF interface.
l preference preference: specifies the preference of the route. The greater the preference value
is, the lower the preference is.
l order order-num: specifies the configuration order of routes on the same network segment.
----End
9.3.3 Checking the Configuration
After static multicast routes are configured, you can check the static multicast routing table and
RPF routing information to ensure the normal running of the multicast network.
Procedure
l
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Run the display multicast routing-table [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] static
[ config ] [ source-address { mask | mask-length } ] command to check the static multicast
routing table.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
327
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Run the display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rpf-info
source-address [ group-address ] [ rpt | spt ] command to check RPF routing information
of a specified multicast source.
----End
9.4 Configuring the Multicast Routing Policy
Configuring a multicast routing policy involves optimizing storage resources for multicast
forwarding entries,configuring the multicast Hash algorithm, configuring the longest match of
the multicast route, configuring multicast load splitting, and setting a multicast load splitting
weight.
9.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring multicast routing policies, familiarize yourself with the applicable
environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the
configuration task quickly and accurately.
Applicable Environment
If multiple equal-cost unicast routes exist when a multicast switch select an upstream interface,
you can configure the switch to choose the RPF switch by using one of the following methods:
l
By default, the switch chooses the route with the largest next-hop address.
l
According to the longest match rules, you can configure the switch to select the route with
the destination address that longest matches the address of the source of the packet.
l
You can configure load splitting among these routes. Performing load splitting of multicast
traffic according to different policies can optimize network traffic when multiple multicast
data flows exist.
To optimize storage for multicast entries, set the storage mode of the interface board to multicast
optimization mode.
When many multicast hash collisions occur, the switch may fail to learn some multicast
addresses. When this situation occurs, you can change the multicast hash algorithm to reduce
hash collisions.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring the multicast routing policy, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring basic multicast functions
Data Preparation
To configure the multicast routing policy, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
No.
Data
1
Multicast load splitting policy
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
328
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
No.
Data
2
Multicast load splitting weight on the interface
3
(Optional) Slot ID of the LPU requires the multicast optimization mode configured
for storing Layer 3 forwarding entries.
9.4.2 Configuring Longest Match of Multicast Route
If the longest match principle is configured for route selection, a multicast device prefers the
route with the longest matched mask. If the mask lengths of multiple routes are the same, the
device selects a route as the multicast data forwarding path in the order of the static multicast
route, inter-domain unicast route, and intra-domain unicast route.
Context
CAUTION
Configurations related to VPN instances are applicable only to the PE switch. When configuring
the longest match of multicast routes for a VPN instance on a PE, perform the configuration in
the VPN instance. In other cases, the longest match is configured in the public network instance.
By default, routes are selected in the order of routing entries.
Do as follows on the multicast switch:
Procedure
l
Public network instance
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
multicast longest-match
Routes are selected according to the longest match.
l
VPN instance
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name
The VPN instance view is displayed.
3.
Run:
ipv4-family
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
329
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4
address family view is displayed.
4.
Run:
multicast longest-match
Devices are selected according to the longest match.
----End
9.4.3 Configuring Multicast Load Splitting
Performing load splitting of multicast traffic according to different policies can optimize network
traffic transmission in the scenario where multiple multicast data flows exist. You can choose
to configure a balance-preferred or stable-preferred load splitting policy.
Context
CAUTION
Configurations related to VPN instances are applicable only to the PE switch. When configuring
load splitting among multicast routes for a VPN instance on a PE, perform the configuration in
the VPN instance. In other cases, load balancing among multicast routes is configured in the
public network instance.
The multicast load splitting function extends multicast routing rules, which does not fully depend
on the RPF check. If multiple equal-cost optimal routes exist over the network, they all can be
used for multicast data forwarding and multicast traffic is load split among multiple equal-cost
routes.
By default, load splitting is not performed.
Do as follows on the multicast switch:
Procedure
l
Public network instance
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
multicast load-splitting { balance-preferred | stable-preferred | source
| group | source-group }
Multicast load balancing is configured. The parameters of the command are explained
as follows:
– balance-preferred: indicates balance-preferred load splitting. This policy is
applicable to the scenario where hosts frequently join or leave the groups, which
requires automatic load adjustment.
If balance-preferred is specified, the switch automatically adjusts and balances
the entries on the equal-cost routes when equal-cost routes are added or deleted,
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
330
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
IPv4 multicast routing entries are deleted, or IPv4 load splitting weights on the
interfaces are changed.
– stable-preferred: indicates stable-preferred load splitting. This policy is
applicable to the stable multicast networking.
If stable-preferred is specified, the switch automatically adjusts and balances the
entries when equal-cost routes are added or deleted; however, when IPv4 multicast
routing entries are deleted or load splitting weights on the interfaces are changed,
the switch does not automatically adjust the entries on the equal-cost routes.
– group: indicates group address-based load splitting. This policy is applicable to
the scenario of one source to multiple groups.
– source: indicates source address-based load splitting. This policy is applicable to
the scenario of one group to multiple sources.
– source-group: indicates source and group addresses-based load splitting. This
policy is applicable to the scenario of multiple sources to multiple groups.
NOTE
It is recommended to adopt a fixed IPv4 multicast load splitting policy based on the actual
networking. It is recommended to use the balance-preferred or stable-preferred policy.
balance-preferred or stable-preferred cannot be configured on the interface enabled with
PIM-DM.
You can configure a multicast load balancing timer or a multicast load splitting weight only in
a stable-preferred load splitting or balance-preferred load splitting scenario.
3.
(Optional) Run:
multicast load-splitting-timer interval
A load balancing timer is set.
l
VPN instance
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name
The VPN instance view is displayed.
3.
Run:
ipv4-family
The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4
address family view is displayed.
4.
Run:
multicast load-splitting { balance-preferred | stable-preferred | source
| group | source-group }
Multicast load splitting is configured.
NOTE
You can configure a multicast load balancing timer or a multicast load splitting weight only in
a stable-preferred load splitting or balance-preferred load splitting scenario.
5.
(Optional) Run:
multicast load-splitting-timer interval
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
331
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
A load balancing timer is set for the VPN IPv4 address family.
----End
9.4.4 Configuring a Multicast Load Splitting Weight
When a load splitting policy is configured, because the forwarding capabilities of equal-cost
routes are different from the actual load bearing situation on the equal-cost routes, balanced load
splitting cannot meet network requirements in some scenarios. In such a case, you can configure
a load splitting weight on an interface to achieve unbalanced multicast load splitting.
Context
When stable-preferred or balance-preferred load splitting is configured, because the forwarding
capabilities of equal-cost routes are different from the actual load bearing situation on the equalcost routes, balanced load splitting cannot meet network requirements in some scenarios. In such
a case, you can configure a load splitting weight on an interface to achieve unbalanced multicast
load splitting.
Do as follows on the switch enabled with multicast:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
By default, the multicast load splitting weight of an interface is 1.
The greater the multicast load splitting weight of an interface, the more multicast routing entries
with this interface being the upstream interface. When the multicast load splitting weight on an
interface is 0, it indicates that the routes with this interface being the upstream interface do not
take part in load splitting.
Step 3 Run:
multicast load-splitting weight weight-value
The multicast load splitting weight is set on the interface.
----End
9.4.5 (Optional) Optimizing Storage for Multicast Forwarding
Entries
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
332
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Context
In most cases, the system allocates hardware resources preferentially to the routing table by
default. The ND cache table and multicast forwarding table share hardware resources.
If a large number of ND prefix entries and multicast forwarding entries are sharing hardware
resources, configure optimization mode as the storage mode for Layer 3 multicast forwarding
entries. The system allocates hardware resources preferentially to the multicast forwarding table.
The ND cache table and routing table share hardware resources.
CAUTION
When you configure this mode or restore the default mode, the system will prompt you to restart
the device or a specified LPU. If the system receives no response, the configuration times out,
and the system view is displayed. The system does not restart. The restart can lead to the network
crash for a short period. In most cases, you are advised not to perform this configuration.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
set multicast forwarding-table optimization-mode [ slot slot-id ]
The optimization mode is configured for storing the multicast forwarding entries.
----End
9.4.6 (Optional) Configuring the Multicast Hash Algorithm
Context
To improve multicast forwarding performance, the switch uses a hash algorithm to learn
multicast addresses. When many multicast hash collisions occur, the switch may fail to learn
some multicast addresses. When this occurs, you can change the multicast hash algorithm to
reduce hash collisions.
CAUTION
MAC addresses are distributed on a network randomly, so the system cannot determine the best
hash algorithm. The default hash algorithm is the best algorithm in most cases, so changing the
hash algorithm is not recommended.
After changing the hash algorithm, restart the switch for the configuration to take effect.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
333
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
set multicast-hash-mode{ crc-32-upper| crc-32-lower| lsb| crc-16-upper| crc-16lower }
The multicast hash algorithm is specified.
----End
9.4.7 Checking the Configuration
After multicast routing policies are configured, you can check the configuration of the multicast
optimization mode, the multicast routing table and RPF routing information to ensure normal
running of the multicast network.
Procedure
l
Run the following commands to check the multicast routing table.
– display multicast { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match }
{ interface-type interface-number | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interfacenumber [ number ] ]
– display multicast routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-masklength } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
l
Run the following command to check the source-specific RPF route.
display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rpf-info sourceaddress [ group-address ]
l
Run the following command to check the multicast optimization mode
display multicast forwarding-table optimization-mode configuration [ slot slot-id ]
----End
9.5 Configuring the Multicast Forwarding Scope
Multicast information of each multicast group in a network should be transmitted within a certain
range. Therefore, configuring a multicast forwarding boundary are necessary for restricting the
multicast data forwarding scope.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
334
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
9.5.1 Establish the Configuration Task
Before configuring the multicast data forwarding scope, familiarize yourself with the applicable
environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the
configuration task quickly and accurately.
Applicable Environment
Multicast information to which each multicast group corresponds is forwarded in a certain scope
in network. Uers can define the multicast forwarding scope by using the following methods:
l
Configuring the multicast forwarding boundary to form a close multicast forwarding area.
The interface configured with a forwarding boundary of a multicast group cannot send or
receive packets of the multicast group.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring the multicast forwarding scope, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring basic multicast functions
Data Preparation
To configure the multicast forwarding scope, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Group address, mask, and mask length of the multicast forwarding boundary
9.5.2 Configuring the Multicast Forwarding Boundary
When an interface of a multicast device is configured with a forwarding boundary for a specified
group, the forwarding scope of multicast packets is restricted.
Context
By default, no multicast forwarding boundary is configured on the interface.
Do as follows on the multicast switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
335
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
multicast boundary group-address { mask | mask-length }
The multicast forwarding boundary is configured.
----End
9.5.3 Checking the Configuration
After the multicast forwarding scope is configured, you can check information about the
multicast routing table and multicast boundary of an interfaceto ensure normal running of the
multicast network.
Procedure
l
Run the following commands to check the multicast routing table.
– display multicast { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match }
{ interface-type interface-number | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interfacenumber [ number ] ]
– display multicast routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-masklength } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
l
Run the display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] boundary
[ group-address [ mask | mask-length ] ] [ interface interface-type interface-number ]
command to check information about the multicast boundary of an interface.
----End
9.6 Configuring Control Parameters of the Multicast
Forwarding Table
During network planning, you can restrict the capacity of the forwarding table on a multicast
device, such as the maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table and the
maximum number of downstream interfaces of multicast forwarding entries. In this manner,
traffic load on the multicast device is released and the fault risk resulted from excessive entries
can be avoided.
9.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring control parameters for the multicast forwarding table, familiarize yourself
with the applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you
complete the configuration task quickly and accurately.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
336
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Applicable Environment
To plan a network according to the services, the ISP needs to perform the following configuration
policies:
l
Limiting the number of entries in the multicast forwarding table
Each switch maintains a routing entry for each received multicast packet. Too many entries,
however, may exhaust the memory of the switch. In this case, you can define the maximum
number of multicast routing entries. Limiting the number of the entries can avoid faults in
the switch.
l
Limiting the number of downstream nodes of a single entry
Switchs copy a multicast packet for each downstream node, and the downstream node sends
the copy out. Each downstream node forms a branch of the multicast distribution tree. The
number of the downstream nodes determines the maximum scale of the multicast
distribution tree and the multicast service scope. Users can define the number of the
downstream nodes of a single forwarding entry. Limiting the number of downstream nodes
according to the actual networking and the services can reduce the pressure of switchs and
control the multicast service scope.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring control parameters of the multicast forwarding table, complete the following
tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring basic multicast functions
Data Preparation
To configure control parameters of the multicast forwarding table, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table
42
Maximum number of downstream nodes of each entry in the multicast forwarding
table
9.6.2 Setting the Maximum Number of Entries in Multicast
Forwarding Table
You can adjust the number of entries according to the actual networking and service performance
to avoid the fault risk resulted from excessive entries.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
337
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Context
CAUTION
Configurations related to VPN instances are applicable only to the PE switch. When configuring
the maximum number of entries in the forwarding table for a VPN instance on a PE, perform
the configuration in the VPN instance. In other cases, the maximum number of entries in the
forwarding table is configured in the public network instance.
Too many multicast forwarding entries may use up the memory of a multicast device. You can
set the maximum number of entries in a multicast forwarding table of a multicast device. By
default, the maximum number supported by the system is used.
Do as follows on the multicast switch:
Procedure
l
Public network instance
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
multicast forwarding-table route-limit limit
The maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table is configured.
l
VPN instance
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name
The VPN instance view is displayed.
3.
Run:
ipv4-family
The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4
address family view is displayed.
4.
Run:
multicast forwarding-table route-limit limit
The maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table is configured.
----End
9.6.3 Setting the Maximum Number of Downstream Nodes of
Multicast Forwarding Entry
A multicast device replicates a copy of multicast packets for each downstream interface. Then,
you can set the number of downstream interfaces of a single forwarding entry and adjust the
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
338
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
number of downstream interfaces according to the actual networking and service performance
to release the burden on the multicast device.
Context
CAUTION
This configuration becomes valid only after the reset multicast forwarding-table command is
used. Multicast services are interrupted after you run the reset multicast forwarding-table
command. So, confirm the action before you use the command.
Configurations related to the VPN instance are applicable only to the PE switch. When
configuring the maximum number of downstream nodes for a forwarding entry in a VPN instance
on a PE, perform the configuration in the VPN instance. In other cases, the maximum number
of entries in the forwarding table is configured in the public network instance.
Do as follows on the multicast switch:
Procedure
l
Public network instance
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
multicast forwarding-table downstream-limit limit
The maximum number of downstream nodes of a forwarding entry in the multicast
forwarding table is configured.
The maximum number is valid when it is smaller than the default value.
l
VPN instance
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name
The VPN instance view is displayed.
3.
Run:
ipv4-family
The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4
address family view is displayed.
4.
Run:
multicast forwarding-table downstream-limit limit
The maximum number of downstream nodes of a forwarding entry in the multicast
forwarding table is configured.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
339
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
9.6.4 Checking the Configuration
After control parameters for the multicast forwarding table are configured, you can check
information about the multicast routing table to ensure normal running of the multicast network.
Procedure
l
Run the display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] forwardingtable [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interfacetype interface-number | register | none } | statistics [ outgoing-interface-number
[ number ] ] ] * command to check the multicast forwarding table.
----End
9.7 Maintaining the Multicast Policy
Maintaining IPv4 multicast routing management involves testing multicast routing, checking
the RPF path and multicast path, clearing multicast forwarding and routing entries, and
monitoring multicast routing and forwarding.
9.7.1 Testing Multicast Routing
When a fault occurs during multicast data transmission, you can run the ping command to check
the RPF path and multicast path.
Context
When data transmission is abnormal, you can ping related multicast addresses to check the RPF
path and multicast path.
Procedure
l
Run the ping multicast [ -i interface-type interface-number | -c count | -h ttl-value | -m
time | -p pattern | -q | -s packet(s)ize | -t timeout | -tos tos-value | -v ] * host command in
any view to ping a reserved group address.
l
Run the ping multicast [ -c count | -h ttl-value | -m time | -p pattern | -q | -s packet(s)ize |
-t timeout | -tos tos-value | -v ] * host command in any view to ping a common group address.
----End
9.7.2 Check RPF Paths and Multicast Paths
When a fault occurs during multicast data transmission, you can run the mtrace command to
check the RPF path and multicast path.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
340
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Context
NOTE
When checking the RPF path or multicast path from a source to a destination host, run the mtrace querypolicy [ acl-number ] command on the switch connected to hosts to configure the filtering policy for
queriers. The ACL defines the address scope of reliable queriers. Based on the ACL, the last-hop switch
refuses the IGMP-Tracert-Query messages sent by illegal queriers. Note the following when using this
command:
l This command is valid only for the last-hop switch, and the querier is not the last-hop switch.
l This command is used to filter only the IGMP-Tracert-Query message encapsulated in a unicast IP
packet.
l This command is not applicable to the trace that is initiated by the local querier.
When a fault occurs during data transmission, you can run the following commands in any view
to check RPF paths and multicast paths.
Procedure
l
Run the mtrace [ -ur resp-dest | -l [ stat-times ] [ -st stat-int ] | -m max-ttl | -q nqueries | ts ttl | -tr ttl | -v | -w timeout | -vpn-instance vpn-name ] * source source-address command
in any view to check the RPF path from a source to a querier.
l
Run the mtrace -g group [ { -mr | -ur resp-dest } | -l [ stat-times ] [ -st stat-int ] | -m maxttl | -q nqueries | -ts ttl | -tr ttl | -v | -w timeout | -vpn-instance vpn-name ] * source sourceaddress command in any view to check the multicast path from a source to a querier.
l
Run the mtrace { -gw last-hop-router | -d } -r receiver [ -ur resp-dest | -a source-ipaddress | -l [ stat-times ] [ -st stat-int ] | -m max-ttl | -q nqueries | -ts ttl | -tr ttl | -v | -w
timeout | -vpn-instance vpn-name ] * source source-address command in any view to
check the RPF path from a source to a destination host.
l
Run the mtrace { -gw last-hop-router | -b | -d } -r receiver -g group [ { -mr | -ur respdest } | -a source-ip-address | -l [ stat-times ] [ -st stat-int ] | -m max-ttl | -q nqueries | -ts
ttl | -tr ttl | -v | -w timeout | -vpn-instance vpn-name ] * source source-address command
in any view to check the multicast path from a source to a destination host.
----End
9.7.3 Clearing Multicast Routing and Forwarding Entries
After you confirm to clear multicast forwarding and routing entries, use the reset command in
the user view.
Context
CAUTION
The reset command clears the entries in the multicast forwarding table or the multicast routing
table. It may result in abnormal multicast information forwarding. After the routing entries in
the multicast routing table are cleared, the corresponding forwarding entries corresponding to
the public network instance or VPN instance are also cleared. So, confirm the action before you
use the command.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
341
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Procedure
l
Run the following commands to clear the forwarding entries in the multicast forwarding
table.
– reset multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] forwarding-table
all
– reset multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] forwarding-table
{ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } } *
l
Run the following commands to clear the routing entries in the multicast routing table.
– reset multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table all
– reset multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table
{ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } } *
----End
9.7.4 Monitoring the Status of Multicast Routing and Forwarding
During the routine maintenance of IPv4 multicast routing management, you can run the display
commands in any view to know the running of the multicast forwarding table and routing table.
Context
In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the status of
multicast routing and forwarding.
Procedure
l
Run the display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] boundary
[ group-address [ mask | mask-length ] ] [ interface interface-type interface-number ]
command in any view to check the multicast boundary configured on an interface.
l
Run thedisplay multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] forwardingtable [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interfacetype interface-number | register | none } | statistics ] * command in any view to check the
multicast forwarding table.
l
Run the following commands in any view to check the multicast routing table.
– display multicast { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table
[ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address
[ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match }
{ interface-type interface-number | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interfacenumber [ number ] ]
– display multicast routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-masklength } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
342
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
{ include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
l
Run the display multicast routing-table [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] static
[ config ] [ source-address { mask-length | mask } ] command in any view to check the
static multicast routing table.
l
Run the display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rpf-info
source-address [ group-address ] [ rpt | spt ] command in any view to check the RPF
routing information.
----End
9.7.5 Debugging Multicast Routing and Forwarding
When a fault occurs during IPv4 multicast routing management, run the debugging commands
in the user view and locate the fault based on the debugging information. Debugging affects the
performance of the system. So, after debugging, disable it immediately.
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. After debugging, run the undo debugging
all command to disable it immediately.
When a fault occurs when multicast is enabled, run the following debugging commands in the
user view to debug multicast routes and to locate the fault.
Procedure
l
Run the following commands in the user view to enable the debugging of multicast
forwarding.
– debugging mfib [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] all
– debugging mfib [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] { no-cache |
module | packet | register | route | sync | upcall | wrong-iif } [ advanced-aclnumber ]
l
Run the debugging mrm [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] { all | event |
packet [ advanced-acl-number ] | route [ advanced-acl-number ] } command in the user
view to enable the debugging of multicast routing management.
----End
9.8 Configuration Examples
Examples for configuring static multicast routes and multicast load splitting are provided.
9.8.1 Example for Changing Static Multicast Routes to RPF Routes
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
343
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 9-1, PIM-DM runs on the network and all the Switches support multicast.
The receiver can receive information from the multicast source. Switch A, Switch B, and Switch
C run OSPF. You need to configure a static multicast route to make the multicast path from the
source to the receiver different from the unicast path from the source to the receiver.
Figure 9-1 Networking diagram for changing static multicast routes to RPF routes
SwitchC
GE3/0/0
GE3/0/0
GE2/0/0
PIM-DM
GE2/0/0
SwitchB
SwitchA
GE2/0/0
GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0
8.1.1.2/24
GE3/0/0
7.1.1.2/24
Receiver
Source
Multicast static route
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
Switch A
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 10
9.1.1.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 20
8.1.1.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 30
12.1.1.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 10
9.1.1.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 40
13.1.1.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 50
7.1.1.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 40
13.1.1.2/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 30
12.1.1.2/24
Switch B
Switch C
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch.
2.
Enable the multicast function on all Switches, PIM-SM on all interfaces, and IGMP on the
interfaces at the host side.
3.
Configure static multicast RPF routes on Switch B, and configure Switch C as the RPF
neighbor.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
344
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
IP address of the source
l
Outgoing interface of the route from Switch B to Switch C: VLANIF 40
NOTE
This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure static multicast routes.
Procedure
Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch.
# Configure the IP addresses and masks on the interfaces on each Switch according to Figure
9-1. IP addresses must be configured on the VLANIF interfaces. OSPF runs between Switch A,
Switch B and Switch C, and the Switches can update routes among them through the unicast
routing protocol. The configuration procedure is not provided here.
Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-DM on all interfaces.
# Enable multicast on all Switches, and PIM-SM on all interfaces. Enable the IGMP function
on the interfaces at the host side. The configurations of other Switches are similar to
configuration of Switch B, and are not provided here.
[SwitchB] multicast routing-enable
[SwitchB] interface vlanif 10
[SwitchB-Vlanif10] pim dm
[SwitchB-Vlanif10] quit
[SwitchB] interface vlanif 40
[SwitchB-Vlanif40] pim dm
[SwitchB-Vlanif40] quit
[SwitchB] interface vlanif 50
[SwitchB-Vlanif50] pim dm
[SwitchB-Vlanif50] igmp enable
[SwitchB-Vlanif50] quit
# Run the display multicast rpf-info command on Switch B to view the RPF information of
the source. The RPF routes are unicast routes, and the RPF neighbor is Switch A. The following
information is displayed:
[SwitchB] display multicast rpf-info 8.1.1.2
VPN-Instance: public net
RPF information about source 8.1.1.2:
RPF interface: vlanif10, RPF neighbor: 9.1.1.1
Referenced route/mask: 8.1.1.0/24
Referenced route type: unicast
Route selection rule: preference-preferred
Load splitting rule: disable
Step 3 Configure the static multicast route.
# Configure a static multicast RPF route on Switch B, and configure Switch C as the RPF
neighbor.
[SwitchB] ip rpf-route-static 8.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 13.1.1.2
Step 4 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display multicast rpf-info command on Switch B to view the RPF information of
the source. The RPF information is as follows. The RPF routes and the RPF neighbor are updated
according to the static multicast route.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
345
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
[SwitchB] display multicast rpf-info 8.1.1.2
VPN-Instance: public net
RPF information about source 8.1.1.2:
RPF interface: vlanif40, RPF neighbor: 13.1.1.2
Referenced route/mask: 8.1.1.0/24
Referenced route type: mstatic
Route selection rule: preference-preferred
Load splitting rule: disable
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of Switch A
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 10 20 30
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif10
ip address 9.1.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif20
ip address 8.1.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif30
ip address 12.1.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 20
port hybrid untagged vlan 20
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 30
port hybrid untagged vlan 30
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 8.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 9.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 12.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of Switch B
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 10 40 50
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif10
ip address 9.1.1.2 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif40
ip address 13.1.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
346
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
#
interface Vlanif50
ip address 7.1.1.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
igmp enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 10
port hybrid untagged vlan 10
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 40
port hybrid untagged vlan 40
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 50
port hybrid untagged vlan 50
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 7.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 9.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 13.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
ip rpf-route-static 8.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 13.1.1.2
#
return
l
Configuration file of Switch C
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 30 40
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif30
ip address 12.1.1.2 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif40
ip address 13.1.1.2 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 40
port hybrid untagged vlan 40
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 30
port hybrid untagged vlan 30
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 12.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 13.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
9.8.2 Example for Connecting RPF Routes Through Static Multicast
Routes
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 9-2, PIM-DM runs on the network and all Switch support multicast. The
receiver can receive information from the multicast source Source1. Switch B and Switch C run
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
347
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
OSPF. No unicast route is available between Switch A and Switch B. You need to use a multicast
static route to enable the receiver to receive information sent by Source2.
Figure 9-2 Networking diagram for connecting the RPF route through static multicast routes
PIM-DM
OSPF
Source1
10.1.3.2/24
GE2/0/0
GE3/0/0
GE3/0/0
SwitchA
SwitchB
GE1/0/0
GE1/0/0
GE1/0/0
SwitchC
GE2/0/0
Source2
10.1.5.2/24
Receiver
Multicast static route
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
Switch A
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 11
10.1.5.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 40
10.1.4.2/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 20
10.1.2.2/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 13
10.1.3.1/24
GE 3/0/0
VLANIF 40
10.1.4.1/24
GE 1/0/0
VLANIF 20
10.1.2.1/24
GE 2/0/0
VLANIF 12
10.1.1.1/24
Switch B
Switch C
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch.
2.
Enable the multicast function on all routers, PIM-SM on all interfaces, and IGMP on the
interfaces connected to hosts.
3.
Configure static multicast RPF routes on Switch B and Switch C.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
348
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
IP address of Source2
l
RPF interface, VLANIF 40, through which Switch B connects to Source 2 and the RPF
neighbor, namely, Switch A
l
RPF interface, VLANIF 20, through which Switch C connects to Source 2 and the RPF
neighbor, namely, Switch C
NOTE
This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure static multicast routes.
Procedure
Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch.
# Configure the IP addresses and masks on the interfaces on each Switch according to Figure
9-2. Switch B and Switch C belong to the same OSPF area, and they can update routes between
them through the unicast routing protocol. The configuration procedure is not provided here.
Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-DM on all interfaces.
# Enable multicast on all Switches, and PIM-DM on all interfaces. Enable the IGMP function
on the interfaces connected to hosts.
[SwitchA] multicast routing-enable
[SwitchA] interface vlanif11
[SwitchA-Vlanif11] pim dm
[SwitchA-Vlanif11] quit
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 40
[SwitchA-Vlanif40] pim dm
[SwitchA-Vlanif40] quit
[SwitchB] multicast routing-enable
[SwitchB] interface vlanif 20
[SwitchB-Vlanif20] pim dm
[SwitchB-Vlanif20] quit
[SwitchB] interface vlanif 13
[SwitchB-Vlanif13] pim dm
[SwitchB-Vlanif13] quit
[SwitchB] interface vlanif 40
[SwitchB-Vlanif40] pim dm
[SwitchB-Vlanif40] quit
[SwitchC] multicast routing-enable
[SwitchC] interface vlanif 20
[SwitchC-Vlanif20] pim dm
[SwitchC-Vlanif20] quit
[SwitchC] interface vlanif 12
[SwitchC-Vlanif12] pim dm
[SwitchC-Vlanif12] igmp enable
[SwitchC-Vlanif12] quit
# Source 1 (10.1.3.2/24) and Source 2 (10.1.5.2/24) send multicast data to the multicast group
G (225.1.1.1). The receiver joins multicast group G. Therefore, the receiver can receive the
multicast data sent by Source1, but cannot receive the multicast data sent by Source2.
# Run the display multicast rpf-info 10.1.5.2 command on Switch B and Switch C. If no
information is displayed, it indicates that Switch B and Switch C have no RPF route to Source2.
Step 3 Configure the static multicast route.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
349
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
# Configure a static multicast RPF route on Switch B, and configure Switch A as the RPF
neighbor.
[SwitchB] ip rpf-route-static 10.1.5.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.4.2
# Configure a static multicast RPF route on Switch C, and configure Switch B as the RPF
neighbor.
[SwitchC] ip rpf-route-static 10.1.5.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.2.2
Step 4 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display multicast rpf-info 10.1.5.2 command on Switch B and Switch C to view the
RPF information of Source2. The RPF information is as follows:
[SwitchB] display multicast rpf-info 10.1.5.2
VPN-Instance: public net
RPF information about source: 10.1.5.2
RPF interface: vlanif40, RPF neighbor: 10.1.4.2
Referenced route/mask: 10.1.5.0/24
Referenced route type: mstatic
Route selecting rule: preference-preferred
Load splitting rule: disable
[SwitchC] display multicast rpf-info 10.1.5.2
VPN-Instance: public net
RPF information about source 10.1.5.2:
RPF interface: vlanif20, RPF neighbor: 10.1.2.2
Referenced route/mask: 10.1.5.0/24
Referenced route type: mstatic
Route selection rule: preference-preferred
Load splitting rule: disable
# Run the display pim routing-table command on Switch C to view the routing table. Switch
C has the multicast entries of Source2. The receiver can receive the multicast data from Source2.
[SwitchC] display pim routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 2 (S, G) entry
(*, 225.1.1.1)
Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 03:54:19
Upstream interface: NULL
Upstream neighbor: NULL
RPF prime neighbor: NULL
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif12
Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 01:38:19, Expires: never
(10.1.3.2, 225.1.1.1)
Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: ACT
UpTime: 00:00:44
Upstream interface: vlanif20
Upstream neighbor: 10.1.2.2
RPF prime neighbor: 10.1.2.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif12
Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:00:44, Expires: never
(10.1.5.2, 225.1.1.1)
Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: ACT
UpTime: 00:00:44
Upstream interface: vlanif20
Upstream neighbor: 10.1.2.2
RPF prime neighbor: 10.1.2.2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
350
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: vlanif12
Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:00:44, Expires: never
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of Switch A
#
sysname SwitchA
#
multicast routing-enable
#
vlan batch 11 40
#
interface Vlanif11
ip address 10.1.5.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif40
ip address 10.1.4.2 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 11
port hybrid untagged vlan 11
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 40
port hybrid untagged vlan 40
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.1.5.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.1.4.0 0.0.0.255
#
return
l
Configuration file of Switch B
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 13 20 40
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif13
ip address 10.1.3.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif20
ip address 10.1.2.2 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif40
ip address 10.1.4.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 20
port hybrid untagged vlan 20
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 13
port hybrid untagged vlan 13
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
351
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
port hybrid pvid vlan 40
port hybrid untagged vlan 40
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.1.2.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.1.3.0 0.0.0.255
#
ip rpf-route-static 10.1.5.0 24 10.1.4.2
#
return
l
Configuration file of Switch C
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 12 20
#
multicast routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif12
ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0
igmp enable
pim dm
#
interface Vlanif20
ip address 10.1.2.1 255.255.255.0
pim dm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 20
port hybrid untagged vlan 20
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 12
port hybrid untagged vlan 12
#
ospf 1
area 0.0.0.0
network 10.1.1.0 0.0.0.255
network 10.1.2.0 0.0.0.255
#
ip rpf-route-static 10.1.5.0 24 10.1.2.2
#
return
9.8.3 Example for Configuring Multicast Load Splitting
Networking Requirements
RPF check is the basis of route selection and unicast routes are used to forward multicast traffic.
According to RPF check, a unique route is selected to forward multicast data. If multicast traffic
is heavy, network congestion may occur and multicast services are affected. Multicast load
splitting is an extension of the multicast route selection rule and is independent of RPF check.
If there are multiple optimal equal-cost routes on a network, they may be used to forward
multicast data. Multicast traffic can be load balanced amount multiple equal-cost routes.
Currently, multicast load splitting can be performed based on the source address, group address,
and source group address, without meeting requirements of load splitting in all the scenarios. If
multicast routing entries and network configurations are stable, RPF interfaces and RPF
neighbors in the entries remain unchanged. If a few multicast routing entries are used, traffic
among equal-cost routes may be distributed unevenly.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
352
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
The stable-preferred multicast load splitting policy offsets the disadvantages of the preceding
load splitting policies. As shown in Figure 9-3, three equal-cost routes are available from Switch
E connected to HostA to the multicast source. The stable-preferred multicast load splitting policy
is configured on Switch E so that entries are evenly distributed to the three equal-cost routes.
Load splitting among equal-cost routes is implemented.
If forwarding capabilities or traffic congestion degrees of the three equal-cost routes of Switch
E are different, multicast entries cannot be load balanced. You need to configure uneven load
splitting on Switch E, set different load splitting routes for upstream interfaces, and change the
number of multicast entries on the equal-cost routes. In this manner, multicast entries on the
equal-cost routes can be controlled flexibly.
Figure 9-3 Networking diagram for configuring multicast load splitting
PIM-SM
Source
GE1/0/0
SwitchA
GE
/0
0/1 GE1/0 SwitchB 2/0/0 GE1/0
/
2
/1
GE
GE1/0/2
GE2/0/2
GE2
GE2/0/0
/0/3 GE1/0/0
/0/3
GE1
SwitchC
Loopback0
GE1
/0/0
GE2/0/0
SwitchE
/0/0
GE2
HostA
SwitchD
Device
Interface
IP Address
Device
Interface
IP Address
Switch A
GE1/0/0
10.110.1.2/24
Switch C
GE1/0/0
192.168.2.2/24
VLANIF10
GE2/0/1
VLANIF30
192.168.1.1/24
GE2/0/0
VLANIF20
GE2/0/2
VLANIF80
192.168.2.1/24
Switch D
VLANIF30
GE2/0/3
GE1/0/0
192.168.3.2/24
VLANIF40
192.168.3.1/24
GE2/0/0
VLANIF40
LoopBack0
192.168.5.1/24
192.168.6.1/24
VLANIF100
1.1.1.1/32
Switch E
GE1/0/1
192.168.4.2/24
VLANIF60
SwitchB
GE1/0/0
192.168.1.2/24
VLANIF20
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
GE1/0/2
192.168.5.2/24
VLANIF80
353
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
GE2/0/0
192.168.4.1/24
VLANIF60
GE1/0/3
192.168.6.2/24
VLANIF100
GE2/0/0
10.110.2.2/24
VLANIF140
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
l
Assign IP addresses to interfaces on switches.
l
Configure IS-IS to implement interworking among all the switches and ensure that route
costs are the same.
l
Enable multicast on all the switches, enable PIM-SM on all the interfaces, and set the
loopback interface on Switch A as an RP.
l
Configure stable-preferred multicast load splitting on Switch E to ensure the stability of
multicast services.
l
HostA needs to receive data from some multicast groups for a long period. Add the hostside interfaces of Switch E to multicast groups in batches.
l
HostA needs to receive data from a new multicast group. According to networking
requirements, set different multicast load splitting weights for upstream interfaces on
Switch E to ensure that multicast traffic is distributed unevenly.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
IP address of the multicast source
l
IP addresses of interfaces on the switches
l
Addresses of the multicast groups to which the host-side interfaces of Switch E are added
in batches
l
Multicast load splitting weights of upstream interfaces on Switch E
Procedure
Step 1 Assign IP addresses to interfaces on the switches according to Figure 9-3. The configuration
details are not provided here.
Step 2 Configure IS-IS to implement interworking among switches and ensure that route costs are the
same. The configuration details are not provided here.
Step 3 Enable multicast on all the switches and enable PIM-SM on each interface.
# Configure Switch A. The configurations on Switch B, Switch C, Switch D, and Switch E are
similar to the configuration on Switch A, and are not provided here.
[SwitchA] multicast routing-enable
[SwitchA] interface Vlanif10
[SwitchA-Vlanif10] pim sm
[SwitchA-Vlanif20] quit
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
354
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
[SwitchA] interface Vlanif20
[SwitchA-Vlanif20] pim sm
[SwitchA-Vlanif20] quit
[SwitchA] interface Vlanif30
[SwitchA-Vlanif30] pim sm
[SwitchA-Vlanif30] quit
[SwitchA] interface Vlanif40
[SwitchA-Vlanif40] pim sm
[SwitchA-Vlanif40] quit
[SwitchA] interface loopback 0
[SwitchA-LoopBack0] pim sm
[SwitchA-LoopBack0] quit
Step 4 Configure an RP on Switch A.
# Configure Loopback0 on Switch A as an RP.
[SwitchA] pim
[SwitchA-pim] c-bsr loopback 0
[SwitchA-pim] c-rp loopback 0
[SwitchA-pim] quit
Step 5 Configure stable-preferred multicast load splitting on Switch E.
[SwitchE] multicast load-splitting stable-preferred
Step 6 Add the host-side interfaces of Switch E to multicast groups in batches.
# Add VLANIF140 to multicast groups from 225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.3.
[SwitchE] interface Vlanif140
[SwitchE-Vlanif140] igmp static-group 225.1.1.1 inc-step-mask 32 number 3
[SwitchE-Vlanif140] quit
Step 7 Verify the configuration of stable-preferred multicast load splitting.
# The multicast source (10.110.1.1/24) sends multicast data to multicast groups 225.1.1.1 to
225.1.1.3. HostA can receive the multicast data from the multicast source. On Switch E, check
brief information about the PIM routing table.
<SwitchE> display pim routing-table brief
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 3 (*, G) entry; 3 (S, G) entries
00001.(*, 225.1.1.1)
Upstream interface:Vlanif100
Number of downstream:1
00002.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.1)
Upstream interface:Vlanif100
Number of downstream:1
00003.(*, 225.1.1.2)
Upstream interface:Vlanif80
Number of downstream:1
00004.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.2)
Upstream interface:Vlanif80
Number of downstream:1
00005.(*, 225.1.1.3)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
00006.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.3)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
(*, G) and (S, G) entries are evenly distributed to the three equal-cost routes, with the upstream
interfaces being VLANIF100, VLANIF80, and VLANIF60.
NOTE
The load splitting algorithm processes (*, G) and (S, G) entries separately with the same processing rule.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
355
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Step 8 Set different multicast load splitting weights for upstream interfaces of Switch E to ensure that
multicast traffic is distributed unevenly.
# Set the multicast load splitting weight on VLANIF60 to 2.
[SwitchE] interface Vlanif60
[SwitchE-Vlanif60] multicast load-splitting weight 2
[SwitchE-Vlanif60] quit
# Set the multicast load splitting weight on VLANIF100 to 0.
[SwitchE] interface Vlanif100
[SwitchE-Vlanif100] multicast load-splitting weight 0
[SwitchE-Vlanif100] quit
Step 9 Add the host-side interfaces of SwitchE to multicast groups in batches.
# Add VLANIF140 to multicast groups from 225.1.1.4 to 225.1.1.9.
[SwitchE] interface Vlanif140
[SwitchE-Vlanif140] igmp static-group 225.1.1.4 inc-step-mask 32 number 6
[SwitchE-Vlanif140] quit
Step 10 Verify the configuration of uneven multicast load splitting.
# The multicast source (10.110.1.1/24) sends multicast data to multicast groups 225.1.1.1 to
225.1.1.9. HostA can receive the multicast data from the multicast source. On Switch E, check
brief information about the PIM routing table.
<SwitchE> display pim routing-table brief
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 9 (*, G) entry; 9 (S, G) entries
00001.(*, 225.1.1.1)
Upstream interface:Vlanif100
Number of downstream:1
00002.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.1)
Upstream interface:Vlanif100
Number of downstream:1
00003.(*, 225.1.1.2)
Upstream interface:Vlanif80
Number of downstream:1
00004.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.2)
Upstream interface:Vlanif80
Number of downstream:1
00005.(*, 225.1.1.3)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
00006.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.3)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
00007.(*, 225.1.1.4)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
00008.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.4)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
00009.(*, 225.1.1.5)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
00010.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.5)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
00011.(*, 225.1.1.6)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
00012.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.6)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
00011.(*, 225.1.1.6)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
356
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
Number of downstream:1
00012.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.6)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
00013.(*, 225.1.1.7)
Upstream interface:Vlanif80
Number of downstream:1
00014.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.7)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
00015.(*, 225.1.1.8)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
00016.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.8)
Upstream interface:Vlanif80
Number of downstream:1
00017.(*, 225.1.1.9)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
00018.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.9)
Upstream interface:Vlanif60
Number of downstream:1
The upstream interfaces of existing (*, G) and (S, G) entries remain unchanged. The multicast
load splitting weight of VLANIF60 is greater than that of VLANIF80; The default multicast
load splitting weight is 1. therefore, the newly generated entries with the upstream interface
being VLANIF60 are more than those with the upstream interface being VLANIF80. The
multicast load splitting weight of VLANIF100 is 0, indicating that VLANIF100 does not load
balance new entries.
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of Switch A.
#
sysname SwitchA
#
multicast routing-enable
#
isis 1
network-entity 10.0000.0000.0001.00
#
interface Vlanif10
ip address 10.110.1.2 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
interface Vlanif20
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
interface Vlanif30
ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
interface Vlanif40
ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 10
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
357
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/1
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 20
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/2
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 30
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/3
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 40
#
interface LoopBack0
ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
isis enable 1
pim sm
#
pim
c-bsr LoopBack0
c-rp LoopBack0
#
return
l
Configuration file of Switch B.
#
sysname SwitchB
#
multicast routing-enable
#
isis 1
network-entity 10.0000.0000.0002.00
#
interface Vlanif20
ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
interface Vlanif60
ip address 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 20
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 60
#
return
l
Configuration file of Switch C.
#
sysname SwitchC
#
multicast routing-enable
#
isis 1
network-entity 10.0000.0000.0003.00
#
interface Vlanif30
ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
interface Vlanif80
ip address 192.168.5.1 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
358
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 30
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 80
#
return
l
Configuration file of Switch D.
#
sysname SwitchD
#
multicast routing-enable
#
isis 1
network-entity 10.0000.0000.0004.00
#
interface Vlanif40
ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.6.1 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 40
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 100
#
return
l
Configuration file of Switch E.
#
sysname SwitchE
#
multicast routing-enable
multicast load-splitting stable-preferred
#
isis 1
network-entity 10.0000.0000.0005.00
#
interface Vlanif60
ip address 192.168.4.2 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
multicast load-splitting weight 2
interface Vlanif80
ip address 192.168.5.2 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
interface Vlanif100
ip address 192.168.6.2 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
pim sm
multicast load-splitting weight 0
interface Vlanif140
ip address 10.110.2.2 255.255.255.0
isis enable 1
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
359
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management
pim sm
igmp static-group 225.1.1.1 inc-step-mask 0.0.0.1 number 3
igmp static-group 225.1.1.4 inc-step-mask 0.0.0.1 number 6
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 60
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 80
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port link-type hybrid
port hybrid tagged vlan 140
#
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
360
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
10
MLD Configuration
About This Chapter
On an IPv6 network, by configuring MLD on an interface of a multicast device connected with
the user network segment, you can manage group members on the local network.
10.1 MLD Overview
MLD is short for Multicast Listener Discovery. It has two versions: MLDv1 and MLDv2.
MLDv1 supports the ASM model and MLDv2 can directly support the SSM model.
10.2 MLD Features Supported by the S9700
The MLD features supported by the system include: basic MLD functions, static MLD groups,
configuring the range of groups that an interface can join, controlling the Router-Alert option
in an MLD packet, configuring parameters of an MLD Query message, SSM mapping, and
limiting the number of MLD group memberships.
10.3 Configuring Basic MLD Functions
By configuring basic MLD functions on an interface of a multicast device connected with the
user network segment, you can enable a user host to access the multicast network and receive
multicast data packets.
10.4 Configuring Options of an MLD Packet
You can enable a multicast device to filter MLD Report messages and receive only the MLD
messages with Router-Alert options by configuring options of MLD messages.
10.5 Configuring MLD Query Control
An MLD querier periodically sends MLD Query messages on a shared network segment to
refresh information about IGMP group members. MLD parameters configured on all the
interfaces of the multicast devices on the same network segment with the user host should be
consistent; otherwise, a fault occurs on the network.
10.6 Configuring SSM Mapping
In the network segment where multicast services are provided in the SSM mode, the interface
of the multicast device runs MLDv2 while certain hosts can run only MLDv1 due to various
limitations. To ensure that the multicast device running a later MLD version is compatible with
the hosts running an earlier MLD version and provides SSM services for these hosts, you need
to configure static SSM mapping on the multicast device.
10.7 Configuration MLD Limit Function
If you want to restrict the servable IPTV ICPs and the number of access users on an IP core
network, the MLD limit function is required. Configuring the MLD limit function involves
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
361
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
setting the maximum number of global MLD group memberships, maximum number of global
MLD group memberships in a single instance, and maximum number of MLD group
memberships on an interface.
10.8 Maintaining MLD
Maintaining MLD involves resetting MLD group information, and monitoring MLD running
status.
10.9 Configuration Example
Examples for configuring basic MLD functions and the MLD limit function in the multicast
network are provided.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
362
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
10.1 MLD Overview
MLD is short for Multicast Listener Discovery. It has two versions: MLDv1 and MLDv2.
MLDv1 supports the ASM model and MLDv2 can directly support the SSM model.
The Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) is a sub-protocol of the Internet Control Message
Protocol version 6 (ICMPv6). MLD is used to set up and maintain the membership of groups
between hosts and their directly connected multicast switchs. The functions and principles of
MLD are the same as those of the Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP).MLD has the
following versions:
l
MLDv1
MLDv1 is defined in RFC 2710, and is derived from IGMPv2. MLDv1 supports the AnySource Multicast (ASM) model. With the help of SSM mapping, MLDv1 can support the
Source-Specific Multicast (SSM) model.
l
MLDv2
MLDv2 is defined in RFC 3810, and is derived from IGMPv3. MLDv2 supports the ASM
and SSM models.
10.2 MLD Features Supported by the S9700
The MLD features supported by the system include: basic MLD functions, static MLD groups,
configuring the range of groups that an interface can join, controlling the Router-Alert option
in an MLD packet, configuring parameters of an MLD Query message, SSM mapping, and
limiting the number of MLD group memberships.
Basic MLD Function
You can enable MLD and configure the MLD version.
Static MLD Group
You can configure an interface to statically join a multicast group. After the interface statically
joins a group, the system considers that the network segment where the interface resides has a
member of the group.
Configuring the Range of Groups that an Interface Can Join
You can set the range of groups that an interface can join as required.
Controlling the Router-Alert Option in an MLD Packet
You can determine whether to set the Router-Alert option in the MLD packets to be sent, and
whether to require that the received MLD packets contain the Router-Alert option.
Configuring Parameters of an MLD Query Message
You can set the interval for sending general query messages, MLD robustness variable, the
maximum response time of MLD Query messages, Keepalive period of other MLD queriers,
the interval for sending MLD group-specific query messages, and MLD fast leave.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
363
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
SSM Mapping
For MLDv1 hosts, you can configure SSM mapping to build a multicast network of the SSM
model.
Limiting the Number of MLD Group Memberships
l
Limiting the total number of MLD group memberships on a switch: The total number of
MLD group memberships created by a switch cannot exceed the limit value. When the total
number of MLD group memberships created by a switch exceeds the limit value, no MLD
entry can be created.
l
Limiting the total number of MLD group memberships in a single instance: The total
number of MLD group memberships related to an instance cannot exceed the limit value.
When the total number of MLD group memberships related to an instance reaches the limit
value, no MLD entry can be created.
l
Limiting the total number of MLD group memberships on an interface: The total number
of MLD group memberships created on an interface cannot exceed the limit value. When
the total number of MLD group memberships created on an interface reaches the limit
value, no MLD entry can be created.
10.3 Configuring Basic MLD Functions
By configuring basic MLD functions on an interface of a multicast device connected with the
user network segment, you can enable a user host to access the multicast network and receive
multicast data packets.
10.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring basic MLD functions, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment,
pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task
quickly and accurately.
Applicable Environment
MLD is applicable to the switch and the hosts directly connected to the switch. The switch and
hosts need to run MLD. This section only describes how to configure MLD on a switch.
You must enable IPv6 multicast routing before configuring MLD. IPv6 multicast routing is the
prerequisite for configuring IPv6 multicast functions. If the IPv6 multicast routing is disabled,
all IPv6 multicast configurations are deleted.
Enable MLD on the interface connected to hosts. For different MLD versions, MLD packets are
different; therefore, you need to configure matching MLD versions for switchs and hosts. Other
MLD configurations can be done only after the preceding operations are complete.
To enable hosts in the network segment to which the interface is connected to join the specified
groups and receive packets to the groups, you can set a group policy on the related interface to
limit the range of groups that the interface serves.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring basic MLD functions, configure a unicast routing protocol to interconnect
the entire multicast domain.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
364
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
Data Preparation
To configure basic MLD functions, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
MLD version
2
Group address and source address
3
ACL6 rules for filtering multicast groups
10.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing
Before configuring basic MLD functions, enable IPv6 multicast routing.
Context
Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
IPv6 multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance.
----End
10.3.3 Enabling MLD
After MLD is enabled on an interface of a multicast device connected with the user network
segment, user hosts can dynamically join multicast groups.
Context
Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
365
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
interface-type interface-number specifies the interface connected to hosts.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, or an Loopback interface.
Step 3 Run:
mld enable
MLD is enabled on the interface.
By default, MLD is not enabled on the interface.
NOTE
If PIM-SM (IPv6) or PIM-DM (IPv6) is also required on this interface, PIM-SM (IPv6) or PIM-DM (IPv6)
must be enabled before MLD is enabled.
----End
10.3.4 (Optional) Configuring the MLD Version
You need to configure the version of MLD enabled on the interface of a multicast device
connected with the user network segment. Note that the versions of MLD enabled on the
multicast devices on the same network segment should be the same; otherwise, a network
abnormality occurs.
Context
CAUTION
Ensure that all MLD switch interfaces in the same network segment are configured with the
same MLD version. Otherwise, faults may occur.
This configuration is optional. By default, MLDv2 is adopted.
Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be a VLANIF interface, or an Loopback interface.
Step 3 Run:
mld version { 1 | 2 }
The MLD version of the interface level is configured.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
366
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
By default, MLDv2 is adopted.
----End
10.3.5 (Optional) Configuring an Interface to Statically Join a Group
After a static MLD group is configured on the interface that connects a multicast device to the
user network segment, the multicast device considers that the interface has multicast group
members and keeps on forwarding matched multicast packets to the network segment where this
interface resides.
Context
Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts:
NOTE
This configuration is optional. By default, the interface does not statically join any group.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
mld static-group ipv6-group-address [ inc-step-mask ipv6-group-mask-length number
group-number ] [ source ipv6-source-address ]
The interface is configured to statically join a single multicast group or multiple multicast groups
in batches. After the interface statically joins the multicast groups, the switch considers that the
members of the multicast groups exist on the network segment where the interface resides.
----End
10.3.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Groups an Interface Can
Join
You can configure the range of groups on the interface of a multicast device connected with the
user network segment so that user hosts can join only a specified range of multicast groups.
Context
Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts:
NOTE
This configuration is optional. By default, the interface can join any group.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
367
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
mld group-policy { acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } [ 1 | 2 ]
The range of groups that the interface can join is configured.
----End
10.3.7 Checking the Configuration
After configuring basic MLD functions, check the configuration and running information about
MLD on the interface and memberships of MLD multicast groups to ensure that MLD runs
normally.
Procedure
l
Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command
to check the MLD configuration and running information on an interface.
l
Run the display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * [ static ] [ verbose ] command to check information on members of an MLD
multicast group.
----End
10.4 Configuring Options of an MLD Packet
You can enable a multicast device to filter MLD Report messages and receive only the MLD
messages with Router-Alert options by configuring options of MLD messages.
10.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring options of an MLD message, familiarize yourself with the applicable
environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the
configuration task quickly and accurately.
Applicable Environment
MLD has the group-specific and source/group-specific query messages. The groups are varied.
Switchs cannot join all groups. The Router-Alert option is used to send the MLD packets of
which the multicast group is not specified by the upper-layer protocol of the IP layer to the upperlayer protocol for processing.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
368
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring options of an MLD packet, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to interconnect the entire multicast domain
l
Configuring Basic MLD Functions
Data Preparation
To configure options of an MLD packet, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Whether the Router-Alert option is set in the packet
10.4.2 Configuring the Router-Alert Option of an MLD Packet
To make the multicast device connected with the user network segment or other MLD interfaces
on the same network segment receive only the MLD messages with Router-Alert options, you
can configure a Router-Alert option for MLD messages on the multicast device connected with
the user network segment.
Context
Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts:
This configuration is optional. By default, MLD packets sent by switchs carry the Router-Alert
option, but the switchs do not check the Router-Alert option. That is, the switchs process all the
received MLD packets, including those without the Router-Alert option.
NOTE
The configuration involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all interfaces.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
mld
The MLD view is displayed.
3.
Run:
require-router-alert
The Router-Alert option is required in the received MLD packet.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
369
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
If the received the MLD packet does not carry the Router-Alert option, the packet is
discarded.
4.
Run:
send-router-alert
The Router-Alert option is set in the header of the MLD packet to be sent.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
mld require-router-alert
The Router-Alert option is required in the received MLD packet.
If the received the MLD packet does not carry the Router-Alert option, the packet is
discarded.
4.
Run:
mld send-router-alert
The Router-Alert option is set in the header of the MLD packet to be sent.
----End
10.4.3 Checking the Configuration
After options of MLD messages are configured, you can check MLD configurations and running
information on the interface to ensure normal running of MLD.
Procedure
l
Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check the MLD configuration and running information on an
interface.
----End
10.5 Configuring MLD Query Control
An MLD querier periodically sends MLD Query messages on a shared network segment to
refresh information about IGMP group members. MLD parameters configured on all the
interfaces of the multicast devices on the same network segment with the user host should be
consistent; otherwise, a fault occurs on the network.
10.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring MLD query control, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment,
pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task
quickly and accurately.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
370
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
Applicable Environment
CAUTION
A great many of MLD interfaces exist in the network and these MLD interfaces are mutually
restricted. Ensure that all MLD parameters of all MLD switch interfaces on the same network
segment are identical. Otherwise, the network may be faulty.
The MLD querier periodically sends MLD Query messages on the share network connected to
receivers. When receiving a Report message from a member, the switchs on the shared network
refresh information about the member relationship.
If non-queriers do not receive any query message within the Keepalive period of the MLD
querier, the querier is considered faulty, and a new round of the querier election is triggered
automatically.
In the application of ADSL dial-up access, one host corresponds to a port. A querier, therefore,
corresponds to only one receiver host. When a receiver host switches among multiple groups
such as TV channels, you can enable the fast leave mechanism on the querier.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring MLD query control, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to interconnect the entire multicast domain
l
Configuring Basic MLD Functions
Data Preparation
To configure MLD query control, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
The interval for sending MLD general Query messages
2
Robustness variable
3
The maximum response time of the MLD Query message
4
Keepalive period of the other MLD queriers
5
The interval for sending MLD group-specific Query messages and group/sourcespecific Query messages
6
ACL6 that limits the application range of prompt leave
10.5.2 (Optional) Configuring MLD Query and Response
Configuring an MLD querier involves setting the interval for sending general query messages,
MLD robustness variable, maximum response time of the MLD Query message, Keepalive
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
371
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
period of other MLD queriers, and interval for sending last listener query messages, and enabling
the MLD fast leave function.
Context
CAUTION
In the actual configuration, ensure that the interval for sending general Query messages is greater
than the maximum response time and is smaller than the Keepalive time of the other MLD
queriers.
Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts:
NOTE
The configuration involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all interfaces.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
mld
The MLD view is displayed.
3.
Run:
timer query interval
The interval for sending Query messages is set.
By default, the interval for sending Query messages is 125 seconds.
4.
Run:
robust-count robust-value
The MLD robustness variable is set.
By default, the MLD robustness variable is 2.
– When a switch starts, the switch sends general query messages for the number of
robust-value times. The sending interval is 1/4 of the interval for sending MLD
general query messages.
– When a switch receives a Leave message, the switch sends MLD last listener query
messages for the number of robust-value times.
The greater the robustness variable is, the longer the timeout period of the group is.
5.
Run:
max-response-time interval
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
372
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
The maximum response time of the MLD Query message is set.
By default, the maximum MLD response time is 10 seconds.
6.
Run:
timer other-querier-present interval
The interval for the Keepalive period of the other MLD queriers is set.
By default, the formula used to calculate the Keepalive period of the other queriers
is: the Keepalive period of the other MLD queriers = robustness variable x the interval
for sending MLD general query messages + 1/2 x the MLD maximum response time.
When default values of robustness variable, the interval for sending MLD general
query messages, and maximum response time are used, the Keepalive period of the
other MLD queriers is 255 seconds.
7.
Run:
lastlistener-queryinterval interval
The interval for sending last listener query messages is set.
The shorter the interval, the more sensitive the querier. By default, the interval is 1
second.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
mld timer query interval
The interval for sending MLD general query messages is set.
4.
Run:
mld max-response-time interval
The maximum response time of the MLD Query message is set.
5.
Run:
mld timer other-querier-present interval
The Keepalive period of the other MLD queriers is set.
6.
Run:
mld robust-count robust-value
The MLD robustness variable is set.
7.
Run:
mld lastlistener-queryinterval interval
The interval for sending MLD last listener query messages is set.
8.
Run:
mld prompt-leave [ group-policy { basic-acl6-number | advanced-acl6-number
| acl6-name acl6-name } ]
MLD fast leave is configured.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
373
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
When an interface receives a Leave message for a certain group, the interface
immediately deletes the downstream interface of the entry to which the group
corresponds, without sending the last listener query message.
By default, when a switch receives a Leave message for a group, the switch sends last
listener query messages.
----End
10.5.3 Checking the Configuration
After MLD query control is configured, you can check MLD configurations and running
information on the interface to ensure normal running of MLD.
Procedure
l
Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check the MLD configuration and running information on an
interface.
----End
10.6 Configuring SSM Mapping
In the network segment where multicast services are provided in the SSM mode, the interface
of the multicast device runs MLDv2 while certain hosts can run only MLDv1 due to various
limitations. To ensure that the multicast device running a later MLD version is compatible with
the hosts running an earlier MLD version and provides SSM services for these hosts, you need
to configure static SSM mapping on the multicast device.
10.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring SSM mapping, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, preconfiguration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly
and accurately.
Applicable Environment
In the SSM host network segment, the switch can know the specific source when a host joins a
group. The SSM solutions are as follows:
l
Hosts and switchs run MLDv2. When a host joins a group, the host specifies the source
from which the host wants to receive data.
l
If some hosts in the network segment can run only MLDv1, the hosts cannot specify the
sources from which they want to receive data when joining related groups. In this case, you
need to configure SSM mapping and static mapping rules on the switch. As a result, the (*,
G) information carried in the Report message is mapped to the (G, INCLUDE, (S1, S2, ...))
information.
SSM mapping can be configured in the following situations:
l
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Interfaces in the same VPN sharing one SSM mapping: Configure a mapping in a VPN,
and all SSM mapping-enabled interfaces will share the mapping.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
374
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
10 MLD Configuration
Each interface using an SSM mapping policy: Configure an SSM mapping policy globally
and specify the required SSM mapping policy on the interface. Different SSM mapping
policies can be configured on different interfaces.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring SSM mapping, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to interconnect the entire multicast domain
l
Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing
Data Preparation
To configure SSM mapping, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Interface that needs to be enabled with SSM mapping
2
Name of the IPv6 SSM mapping policy
3
Group address/mask and source address/mask
10.6.2 Enabling SSM Mapping
Prior to configuring SSM mapping, enable SSM mapping on the interface that connects the
multicast device to the user network segment.
Context
SSM mapping must have been enabled before static SSM mapping policies are configured. The
configured SSM source/group address mapping entries take effect only after SSM mapping is
enabled on interfaces.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
mld enable
MLD is enabled.
Step 4 Run:
mld version 2
The MLD version is set to 2.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
375
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
By default, the MLD version is 1.
To ensure that the hosts that run any MLD version on the network segment can obtain the SSM
services, it is recommended to configure MLDv2 on the switch interface.
Step 5 Run:
mld ssm-mapping enable [ policy policy-name ]
SSM mapping and an SSM mapping policy are enabled.
If policy policy-name is specified, SSM mapping is enabled, and the SSM mapping policy is
specified. If policy policy-name is not specified, only SSM mapping is enabled.
----End
10.6.3 Configuring a Static SSM Mapping Policy
You can configure SSM mapping on the interface that connects the multicast device to the user
network segment to enable the user hosts that support only MLDv1 but not MLDv2 to join a
specific source/group. In this manner, the multicast device running a later MLD version is
compatible with the hosts running an earlier MLD version and can provide the SSM service for
these hosts.
Context
After a static SSM mapping policy is configured, SSM mapping-enabled interfaces use the SSM
source/group address mapping based on the policy, and the multicast device running a later
IGMP version is compatible with the hosts running an earlier IGMP version and can provide the
SSM service for these hosts.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
mld
The MLD view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
ssm-mapping ipv6-group-address ipv6-group-mask-length ipv6-source-address
The mapping from the source to the group is set.
You can run the command repeatedly to configure the mapping from a group to multiple sources.
l ipv6-group-address ipv6-group-mask-length: specifies the group address and mask. The
group address must be in the SSM group address range.
l ipv6-source-address: specifies the address of the source that sets up the mapping relationship
with the group.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
376
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
10.6.4 Checking the Configuration
After SSM mapping is configured, you can check MLD configurations and running information,
SSM mapping information of a source-specific group, information about the interface enabled
with SSM mapping, and SSM mapping rules of a specified group to ensure that SSM mapping
runs normally.
Procedure
l
Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check the MLD configuration and running information on an
interface.
l
Run the display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * ssm-mapping [ verbose ] to check information about a source/group-specific
address.
l
Run the display mld ssm-mapping interface [ interface-type interface-number [ group
ipv6-group-address ] ] command to check information about an interface enabled with SSM
mapping.
l
Run the display mld ssm-mapping group [ ipv6-group-address ] command to check SSM
mapping rules of a specified group address.
----End
10.7 Configuration MLD Limit Function
If you want to restrict the servable IPTV ICPs and the number of access users on an IP core
network, the MLD limit function is required. Configuring the MLD limit function involves
setting the maximum number of global MLD group memberships, maximum number of global
MLD group memberships in a single instance, and maximum number of MLD group
memberships on an interface.
10.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring the MLD limit function, familiarize yourself with the applicable
environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the
configuration task quickly and accurately.
Applicable Environment
To limit IPTV ICPs and the number of users accessing IP core networks, you can configure the
MLD limit function.
The MLD limit function is configured on the last-hop switch connected to users. You can perform
the following configurations as required:
l
Configure the maximum number of global MLD group memberships on a switch.
l
Configure the maximum number of MLD entries in a single instance.
l
Configure the maximum number of MLD group memberships on an interface.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
377
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
NOTE
If the MLD limit function is required to be configured globally, for a single instance, and for an interface
on the same switch, it is recommended that the limits on the number of global MLD group memberships,
the number of MLD group memberships in the single instance, and the number of MLD group memberships
on the interface should be in descending order.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring the MLD limit function, complete the following task:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic MLD Functions
Data Preparation
To configure the MLD limit function, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Maximum number of global MLD group memberships
2
Maximum number of MLD group memberships in a single instance
3
Maximum number of MLD group memberships on an interface
10.7.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global MLD Group
Memberships
Configure the maximum number of MLD entries that can be created on the multicast device
connected with the user network segment. When the number of MLD entries reaches the limit,
the system does not create any new MLD entry. If the host wants to join a new multicast group,
you need to delete certain useless entries, modify the limit, or configure the host to statically
join a multicast group or source/group.
Context
Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
mld global limit number
The maximum number of global MLD entries of all instances is set.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
378
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
10.7.3 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global MLD Entries
in a Single Instance
Configure the maximum number of MLD entries that can be created in a single instance on the
multicast device connected with the user network segment. When the number of MLD entries
reaches the limit, the system does not create any new MLD entry. If the host wants to join a new
multicast group, you need to delete certain useless entries, modify the limit, or configure the
host to statically join a multicast group or source/group.
Context
Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
mld
The MLD view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
limit number
The maximum number of global MLD entries in a single instance is set.
----End
10.7.4 Configuring the Maximum Number of MLD Group
Memberships on an Interface
Configure the maximum number of MLD entries that can be created on the interface of the
multicast device connected with the user network segment. When the number of MLD entries
reaches the limit, the system does not create any new MLD entry. If the host wants to join a new
multicast group, you need to delete certain useless entries, modify the limit, or configure the
host to statically join a multicast group or source/group.
Context
Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
379
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
The MLD interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
mld limit number [ except { acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } ]
The maximum number of MLD group memberships is set on the interface.
NOTE
If except is not specified in the command, the router is limited by the maximum number of MLD entries
when creating the entries for all the groups or source/groups.
Before specifying except, you need to configure the corresponding ACl. Then, the interface filters the
received MLD Join messages according to the ACL. The number of entries that are filtered according to
the ACL is not limited by the maximum number of MLD entries.
----End
10.7.5 Checking the Configuration
After configuring MLD limit, check the configuration and running information about MLD on
the interface and memberships of MLD multicast groups to ensure that MLD runs normally.
Procedure
l
Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check the configuration and running of MLD on an interface.
l
Run the following commands to check information about the members of an MLD multicast
group.
– display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interface-number ]
* [ verbose ]
– display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interface-number ]
* ssm-mapping [ verbose ]
# Run the display mld interface command to view the configuration and running status
of MLD on the switch interface. The display information is as follows:
<SwitchA> display mld interface vlanif 10
Interface information
Vlanif10(FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100):
MLD is enabled
Current MLD version is 1
MLD state: up
MLD group policy: none
MLD limit: 30
Value of query interval for MLD (negotiated): 125 s
Value of query interval for MLD (configured): 125 s
Value of other querier timeout for MLD: 0 s
Value of maximum query response time for MLD: 10 s
Querier for MLD: FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100 (this switch)
From the display, you can see the maximum number of MLD group members on VLANIF
10 of Switch A.
----End
10.8 Maintaining MLD
Maintaining MLD involves resetting MLD group information, and monitoring MLD running
status.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
380
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
10.8.1 Clearing Information about MLD Groups
After you confirm to clear the statistics on MLD groups, use the reset commands in the user
view. The receiver cannot receive multicast information normally if the MLD group that the
interface dynamically joins is deleted. Therefore, confirm the action before you use the reset
commands.
Context
CAUTION
The MLD groups that an interface dynamically joins are deleted after you run the reset mld
group or the reset mld group ssm-mapping command. Receivers may not receive multicast
information normally. So, confirm the action before you use the command.
Procedure
l
Run the reset mld explicit-tracking { all | interface interface-type interface-number
[ host ipv6-host-address [ group ipv6-group-address [ source ipv6-source-address ] ] ] }
command in the user view to clear the hosts that join a multicast group through MLD on
an interface.
l
Run the following commands in the user view to clear the MLD groups that the interface
dynamically joins (not including the MLDv1 group in the SSM range).
– reset mld group all
– reset mld group interface interface-type interface-number { all | ipv6-groupaddress [ ipv6-group-mask-length ] [ ipv6-source-address [ ipv6-source-masklength ] ] }
l
Run the following commands in the user view to clear MLDv1 groups in the SSM range.
– reset mld group ssm-mapping all
– reset mld group ssm-mapping interface interface-type interface-number { all | ipv6group-address [ ipv6-group-mask-length ] }
l
Run the reset mld control-message counters [ interface interface-type interfacenumber ] [ message-type { query | report } ] command in the user view to delete statistics
of MLD messages.
----End
10.8.2 Monitoring the Running Status of MLD
During MLD routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know the
running of MLD.
Context
In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running
status of MLD.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
381
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the display mld explicit-tracking [ interface interface-type interface-number [ hostaddress ipv6-host-address | group ipv6-group-address source ipv6-source-address ] ]
command in any view to check information about the MLD hosts on an interface.
l
Run the display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * [ static ] [ verbose ] command in any view to check information about groups
on each interface.
l
Run the display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * ssm-mapping [ verbose ] command in any view to check information about a
group configured with SSM mapping.
l
Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command
in any view to check the MLD configuration and running information on an interface.
l
Run the display mld routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ ipv6-source-mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ ipv6-group-mask-length ] ] * [ static ] [ outgoing-interfacenumber [ number ] ] command in any view to check the MLD routing table.
l
Run the display mld ssm-mapping interface [ interface-type interface-number [ group
ipv6-group-address ] ] command in any view to check information about an interface
enabled with SSM mapping.
l
Run the display mld ssm-mapping group [ ipv6-group-address ] command in any view
to check SSM mapping rules of a specified group address.
l
Run the display mld control-message counters [ interface interface-type interfacenumber ] [ message-type { query | report } ] command in any view to check the statistics
of MLD messages received by interfaces.
l
Run the display mld invalid-packet [ interface interface-type interface-number |
message-type { done | query | report } ] * command in any view to check the statistics
about invalid MLD messages received by a device.
----End
10.8.3 Debugging MLD
When an MLD running fault occurs, run the debugging commands in the user view and locate
the fault based on the debugging information. Debugging affects the performance of the system.
So, after debugging, disable it immediately.
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. After debugging, you need to run the undo
debugging all command to disable the debugging immediately.
Procedure
l
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Run the debugging mld { all | done [ interface-based-acl6-number | basic-acl6number ] * | event [ advanced-acl6-number ] | query [ interface-based-acl6-number | basicHuawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
382
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
acl6-number ] * [ receive | send ] | report [ interface-based-acl6-number | advanced-acl6number ] * | timer } command in the user view to enable the debugging of MLD.
l
Run the debugging mld ssm-mapping [ advanced-acl6-number ] command in the user
view to enable the debugging of SSM mapping.
----End
10.9 Configuration Example
Examples for configuring basic MLD functions and the MLD limit function in the multicast
network are provided.
10.9.1 Example for Configuring Basic MLD Functions
Networking Requirements
On the IPv6 network shown in Figure 10-1, unicast routes are normal. It is required to implement
multicast on the network to enable hosts to receive the Video on Demand (VoD) information.
Figure 10-1 Networking diagram for configuring basic MLD functions
Ethernet
HostA
Receiver
SwitchA
GE2/0/0
GE2/0/0
PIM network
N1
GE1/0/0
3000::12/64
SwitchB
HostB
Leaf network
GE1/0/0
3001::10/64
SwitchC
GE2/0/0
HostC
Receiver
N2
GE1/0/0
3001::12/64
HostD
Ethernet
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE1/0/0
VLANIF100
3000::12/64
GE2/0/0
VLANIF101
2002::1/64
GE1/0/0
VLANIF200
3001::10/64
GE2/0/0
VLANIF201
2003::1/64
GE1/0/0
VLANIF300
3001::12/64
GE2/0/0
VLANIF301
2004::1/64
SwitchB
SwitchC
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
383
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Enable IPv6 Multicast on the S9700s.
2.
Enable IPv6 PIM-SM on all the interfaces on S9700.
3.
Enable MLD on the interface at the host side.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
MLD version running between the S9700s and the user hosts
Procedure
Step 1 Create VLANs and VLAN interfaces on the S9700s and assign IPv6 addresses to the VLAN
interfaces. The configuration procedure is not provided here.
Step 2 Enable multicast on the S9700s and enable MLD and IPv6 PIM-DM on the interfaces connected
to user hosts.
# Enable multicast on SwitchA, enable MLD and IPv6 PIM-DM on VLANIF 100, and set the
MLD version to 2.
<SwitchA> system-view
[SwitchA] multicast ipv6 routing-enable
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 100
[SwitchA-Vlanif100] pim ipv6 sm
[SwitchA-Vlanif100] mld enable
[SwitchA-Vlanif100] mld version 2
[SwitchA-Vlanif100] quit
The configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and
are not provided here.
Step 3 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display mld interface command, and you can check the configuration and running
status of MLD on each interface. MLD information on VLANIF 200 of SwitchB is as follows:
<SwitchB> display mld interface vlanif 200 verbose
Interface information
Vlanif200(FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100):
MLD is enabled
Current MLD version is 2
MLD state: up
MLD group policy: none
MLD limit: Value of query interval for MLD (negotiated): 125 s
Value of query interval for MLD (configured): 125 s
Value of other querier timeout for MLD: 0 s
Value of maximum query response time for MLD: 10 s
Value of last listener query time: 2 s
Value of last listener query interval: 1 s
Value of startup query interval: 31 s
Value of startup query count: 2
General query timer expiry (hours:minutes:seconds): 00:00:28
Querier for MLD: FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100 (this router)
MLD activity: 0 joins, 0 dones
Robustness (negotiated): 2
Robustness (configured): 2
Require-router-alert: disabled
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
384
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
Send-router-alert: enabled
Prompt-leave: disabled
SSM-Mapping: disabled
Startup-query-timer-expiry: on
Other-querier-present-timer-expiry: off
From the display, you can see that SwitchB is a querier. This is because the IPv6 address of
VLANIF 200 on S9700B is the smallest on the network segment.
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 100 101
#
ipv6
#
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif101
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 2002::1/64
pim ipv6 sm
#
interface Vlanif100
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 3000::12/64
pim ipv6 sm
mld enable
mld version 2
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 101
port hybrid untagged vlan 101
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchB
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 200 201
#
ipv6
#
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif201
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 2003::1/64
pim ipv6 sm
#
interface Vlanif200
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 3001::10/64
pim ipv6 sm
mld enable
mld version 2
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
385
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 201
port hybrid untagged vlan 201
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 300 301
#
ipv6
#
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif301
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 2004::1/64
pim ipv6 sm
#
interface Vlanif300
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 3001::12/64
pim ipv6 sm
mld enable
mld version 2
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 301
port hybrid untagged vlan 301
#
return
10.9.2 Example for Configuring MLD Limit
Networking Requirements
When a large number of users watch multiple programs simultaneously, great bandwidth of
devices is consumed, which degrades the performance of the devices and lowers the stability of
receiving multicast data.
The existing multicast technologies control multicast networks by limiting the number of
multicast forwarding entries or the number of outgoing interfaces of an entry, which cannot meet
the requirements of operators for real-time video services on IPTV networks and flexible
management of network resources.
Configuring MLD limit can enable operators to properly plan network resources and flexibly
control the number of multicast groups that hosts can join. In the network shown in Figure
10-2, multicast services are deployed. The global MLD limit, instance-based MLD limit, and
interface-based MLD limit are configured on Switch A, Switch B, and Switch C connected to
hosts to limit the number of multicast groups that the hosts can join. When the number of
multicast groups that hosts can join reaches the limit, the devices are not allowed to create new
MLD entries. This ensures that the users that join related multicast groups more clearly and
stably watch related programs.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
386
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
Figure 10-2 Networking diagram of configuring MLD Limit
Ethernet
HostA
SwitchA
Receiver
N1
GE2/0/0
GE1/0/0
HostB
SwitchB
Leaf network
GE2/0/0
PIM network
GE1/0/0
HostC
Receiver
SwitchC
N2
GE2/0/0
GE1/0/0
HostD
Ethernet
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE1/0/0
VLANIF100
3000::12/64
GE2/0/0
VLANIF101
2001::1/64
GE1/0/0
VLANIF200
3001::10/64
GE2/0/0
VLANIF201
2002::1/64
GE1/0/0
VLANIF300
3001::12/64
GE2/0/0
VLANIF301
2003::1/64
SwitchB
SwitchC
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Enable IPv6 multicast.
2.
Enable PIM-IPv6-SM on all switch interfaces.
3.
Enable MLD on the interface at the host side.
4.
Limit the number of MLD group memberships on Switch A, Switch B, and Switch C.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
the version number of MLD of switches and user hosts.
l
The maximum number of MLD group memberships.
Procedure
Step 1 Assign IPv6 addresses to interfaces on the switches according to Figure 10-2. The configuration
details are not provided here.
Step 2 Enable multicast on switches and MLD and PIM-IPv6-SM on the interface at the host side.
# Enable multicast on Switch A, enable MLD and PIM-IPv6-SM on VLANIF 100.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
387
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
<SwitchA> system-view
[SwitchA] multicast ipv6 routing-enable
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 100
[SwitchA-Vlanif100] pim ipv6 sm
[SwitchA-Vlanif100] mld enable
[SwitchA-Vlanif100] quit
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 101
[SwitchA-Vlanif101] pim ipv6 sm
[SwitchA-Vlanif101] quit
# The configurations of Switch B and Switch C are the same as the configuration of Switch A,
and are not mentioned here.
Step 3 Limit the number of MLD group memberships on the last-hop switch connected to users.
# Configure the maximum number of MLD group memberships to 50 on Switch A.
[SwitchA] mld global limit 50
# Configure the maximum number of MLD group memberships to 40 in the public network
instance.
[SwitchA] mld
[SwitchA-mld] limit 40
[SwitchA-mld] quit
# Configure the maximum number of MLD group relationships to 30 on VLANIF 100.
[SwitchA] interface vlanif 100
[SwitchA-Vlanif100] mld limit 30
[SwitchA-Vlanif100] quit
# Configurations of Switch B and Switch C are similar to those of Switch A, and are not
mentioned here.
Step 4 Verify the configuration.
# Run the display mld interface command to view the configuration and running status of MLD
on the switch interface. MLD information on VLANIF 100 of Switch B is as follows:
[SwitchB] display mld interface vlanif 100
Interface information
Vlanif100(FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100):
MLD is enabled
Current MLD version is 1
MLD state: up
MLD group policy: none
MLD limit: 30
Value of query interval for MLD (negotiated): Value of query interval for MLD (configured): 125 s
Value of other querier timeout for MLD: 0 s
Value of maximum query response time for MLD: 10 s
Querier for MLD: FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100 (this router)
Querier for MLD: FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100 (this router)
From the display, you can see that the maximum number of MLD group members that the
VLANIF 100 of Switch B can creat is 30.
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of Switch A
#
sysname SwitchA
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
388
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
10 MLD Configuration
vlan batch 100 101
#
ipv6
#
mld global limit 50
#
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif100
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 3000::12/64
pim ipv6 sm
mld enable
mld limit 30
#
interface Vlanif101
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 2001::1/64
pim ipv6 sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
pport hybrid pvid vlan 101
port hybrid untagged vlan 101
#
mld
limit 40
#
return
l
Configuration file of Switch B
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 200 201
#
ipv6
#
mld global limit 50
#
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif200
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 3001::10/64
pim ipv6 sm
mld enable
mld limit 30
#
interface Vlanif201
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 2002::1/64
pim ipv6 sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
pport hybrid pvid vlan 201
port hybrid untagged vlan 201
#
mld
limit 40
#
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
389
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
10 MLD Configuration
Configuration file of Switch C
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 300 101
#
ipv6
#
mld global limit 50
#
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif300
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 3001::12/64
pim ipv6 sm
mld enable
mld limit 30
#
interface Vlanif301
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 2003::1/64
pim ipv6 sm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
pport hybrid pvid vlan 301
port hybrid untagged vlan 301
#
mld
limit 40
#
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
390
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
11
MLD Snooping Configuration
About This Chapter
This chapter describes the implementation and configuration procedures of Multicast Listener
Discovery (MLD) snooping on the S9700.
11.1 Overview of MLD Snooping
When MLD snooping is enabled, the S9700 creates a Layer 2 forwarding table for multicast
data packets by listening to MLD messages. In this manner, the S9700 manages and controls
the forwarding of multicast data packets to ensure that these packets are sent only to the hosts
that need the multicast data.
11.2 MLD Snooping Features Supported by the S9700
This section describes MLD snooping features supported by the S9700.
11.3 Configuring Basic Functions of MLD Snooping
This section describes how to enable MLD snooping, add an interface to a multicast group
statically, and configure an interface as a static router interface.
11.4 Configuring MLD Snooping Proxy
This section describes how to configure MLD snooping proxy in a VLAN.
11.5 Configuring an IPv6 Layer 2 Multicast Policy
This section describes how to configure an IPv6 Layer 2 multicast policy.
11.6 (Optional) Modifying Parameters of MLD Snooping
This section describes how to optimize the performance of MLD snooping by modifying MLD
snooping parameters, including the aging time of the router interface, interval for sending Last
Member Query messages, interval for sending the General Query messages, maximum response
time for MLD messages, MLD robustness variable, source IP address of the MLD message sent
to respond to changes of Layer 2 network topology, MLD version, duration for suppressing the
same Report messages, maximum number of MLD snooping entries, and whether the Router
Alert option is contained in MLD messages.
11.7 Maintaining MLD Snooping
This section describes how to maintain MLD snooping.
11.8 Configuration Examples
This section provides several configuration examples of MLD snooping.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
391
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
11.1 Overview of MLD Snooping
When MLD snooping is enabled, the S9700 creates a Layer 2 forwarding table for multicast
data packets by listening to MLD messages. In this manner, the S9700 manages and controls
the forwarding of multicast data packets to ensure that these packets are sent only to the hosts
that need the multicast data.
If MLD snooping is disabled, IPv6 multicast packets are broadcast in the VLAN, which wastes
network bandwidth. MLD snooping has the following advantages:
l
Reducing broadcast packets on the Layer 2 network to save network bandwidth
l
Improving information security
l
Implementing separate accounting of each host
11.2 MLD Snooping Features Supported by the S9700
This section describes MLD snooping features supported by the S9700.
Basic Features of MLD Snooping
The S9700 supports VLAN-based MLD snooping.
MLD snooping implements Layer 2 multicast of IPv6 and controls multicast data forwarding
by listening to multicast protocol packets sent between an upstream router and a downstream
host and maintaining downstream interface information.
The S9700 supports the following basic features of MLD snooping:
l
Configuring an interface in a VLAN as a static router interface to enable users to receive
multicast data steadily for a long time, because the static router interface never ages
l
Adding interfaces in a VLAN to a multicast group statically
l
Configuring an MLD snooping querier
l
Suppressing MLD messages
MLD Snooping Proxy
Configuring MLD snooping proxy on an edge device can reduce the number of MLD Report
and Done messages received by an upstream Layer 3 device and improve performance of the
upstream Layer 3 device. The device configured with MLD snooping proxy functions as a host
for its upstream device and a querier for its downstream host.
Layer 2 Multicast Policy
The S9700 uses Layer 2 multicast policies according to networking requirements:
l
Configures an IPv6 multicast group policy to control the multicast groups that users can
join.
l
Enables interfaces to quickly leave multicast groups.
l
Sets the maximum number of multicast groups that an interface can dynamically join to
limit the multicast forwarding entries dynamically learned on the interface.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
392
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
11.3 Configuring Basic Functions of MLD Snooping
This section describes how to enable MLD snooping, add an interface to a multicast group
statically, and configure an interface as a static router interface.
11.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
If MLD snooping is configured on the Layer 2 device on an IPv6 network, multicast data of a
known group is forwarded to specified receivers (paid subscribers) but not broadcast at the data
link layer.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before enabling MLD snooping, complete the following tasks:
l
Creating a VLAN
l
Adding interfaces to the VLAN
Data Preparation
To enable MLD snooping, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
ID of the VLAN
2
(Optional) Version of IGMP messages
3
(Optional) Types and numbers of interfaces
4
(Optional) Parameters of a querier: interval
for sending MLD General Query messages,
robustness variable, maximum response time,
and interval for sending Last Member Query
messages
5
(Optional) Suppression duration of MLD
messages
6
(Optional) Aging time of the router interface
11.3.2 Enabling MLD snooping on the S9700
Context
To enable MLD snooping globally, do as follows on the S9700.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
393
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 (Optional) Run:
assign multicast-resource-mode optimize
The multicast forwarding table is optimized.
If a multicast forwarding table needs to contain more than 4096 entries, run this command to
optimize the multicast forwarding table before enabling MLD snooping.
Step 3 Run:
mld-snooping enable
MLD snooping is enabled globally.
By default, MLD snooping is disabled on the S9700.
Step 4 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 5 Run:
mld-snooping enable
MLD snooping is enabled in a VLAN.
Step 6 (Optional) Run:
mld-snooping version version
The version of MLD messages that MLD snooping can process is specified.
By default, the S9700 can process MLDv1 messages.
----End
11.3.3 (Optional) Configuring an Interface as a Static Router
Interface
Context
To configure an interface as a static router interface, do as follows on the S9700.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
394
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk
interface.
Step 3 Run:
mld-snooping static-router-port vlan vlan-id
The interface is configured as a static router interface.
NOTE
Before using the mld-snooping static-router-port vlan vlan-id command, ensure that the interface is
added to the VLAN specified by vlan-id; otherwise, the configuration fails.
----End
11.3.4 (Optional) Adding an Interface to a Multicast Group
Statically
Context
To add an interface to a multicast group statically, do as follows on the S9700.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run the following commands as required:
l Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk
interface.
Step 3 Run:
mld-snooping static-group
vlan vlan-id }
{ group-ipv6-address [ source source-ipv6-address ]
The interface is added to a multicast group statically.
NOTE
l Before using the mld-snooping static-group command, ensure that the interface is added to the VLAN
specified by vlan-id; otherwise, the configuration fails.
l If the source-address parameter is specified in the mld-snooping static-group command, the MLD
version must be V2; otherwise, the configuration does not take effect even though the command can
be run.
----End
11.3.5 Enabling the MLD Snooping Querier
Context
Do as follows on the S9700.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
395
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
mld-snooping querier enable
The MLD snooping querier is enabled.
By default, the MLD snooping querier is disabled.
NOTE
MLD snooping querier cannot be enabled in a VLAN if the corresponding VLANIF interface has MLD
enabled.
MLD snooping querier and MLD snooping proxy cannot be enabled in the same VLAN.
The MLD snooping querier does not participate in the election of the MLD querier; however, the MLD
snooping querier on an IPv6 multicast network running MLD may affect the election result because the
source IPv6 address of the Query message sent by the MLD snooping querier is small.
Step 4 (Optional) Run:
mld-snooping query-interval query-interval
The interval at which a querier sends General Query messages is set.
By default, the interval for sending General Query messages is 60 seconds.
Step 5 (Optional) Run:
mld-snooping robust-count robust-count
The MLD robustness variable is set.
By default, the MLD robustness variable is 2.
Step 6 (Optional) Run:
mld-snooping max-response-time max-response-time
The maximum response time for General Query messages is set.
By default, the maximum response time for an MLD Query message is 10 seconds.
NOTE
The maximum response time must be shorter than the interval at which General Query messages are sent.
When receiving MLD Report messages from hosts, the S9700 sets the aging time of member interfaces
using the following formula: Aging time = MLD robustness variable x Interval at which General Query
messages are sent + Maximum response time.
Step 7 (Optional) Run:
mld-snooping last-listener-query-interval time-value
The interval at which a querier sends Group-Specific Query messages is set.
By default, the interval for sending Group-Specific Query messages is 1 second.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
396
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
NOTE
When receiving MLD Leave messages from hosts, the S9700 sets the aging time of member interfaces
using the following formula: Aging time = Interval for sending Group-Specific Query messages x MLD
robustness variable.
When the S9700 runs MLDv1, hosts do not send MLD Done messages when leaving a multicast group.
Therefore, this command is valid only when MLDv2 messages can be processed in a VLAN.
----End
11.3.6 (Optional) Configuring MLD Message Suppression
Context
Hosts running MLD in a VLAN use a snooping mechanism to suppress Report messages that
member hosts send to join the same multicast group. However, many duplicate Report messages
may be sent when the suppression time expires. In addition, hosts running MLDv2 send duplicate
Done messages when they leave a multicast group.
After a Layer 2 device is enabled to suppress Report and Done messages, it sends Membership
Report messages only when the first member joins a multicast group or the last member of a
multicast group leaves the group.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
mld-snooping report-suppress
MLD message suppression is enabled.
NOTE
l MLD message suppression cannot be configured in a VLAN if the corresponding VLANIF interface
has MLD enabled.
l MLD message suppression and MLD snooping proxy cannot be enabled in the same VLAN.
----End
11.3.7 Checking the Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run the display mld-snooping configuration command to check the configuration information
of MLD snooping.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
397
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
Step 2 Run the display mld-snooping [ vlan vlan-id ] command to check the status of MLD snooping
in a VLAN.
Step 3 Run the display mld-snooping port-info [ vlan vlan-id [ group group-ipv6-address [ sourceaddress source-ipv6-address ] | verbose ] ] command to check information about member
interfaces of a multicast group and the router interface in a VLAN.
Step 4 Run the display mld-snooping router-port [ vlan vlan-id ] command to check information
about the router interface in a VLAN.
NOTE
The display mld-snooping port-info command displays only the information about the static member
interface or static router interface in Up state.
----End
11.4 Configuring MLD Snooping Proxy
This section describes how to configure MLD snooping proxy in a VLAN.
Applicable Environment
After the MLD snooping proxy function is configured on the S9700, the S9700 replaces the
upstream router to send MLD Query messages to the downstream devices, and receives the MLD
Report and MLD Done messages from the downstream devices. This function reduces the
bandwidth used between the upstream router and the S9700 and the workload on the upstream
router.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring the MLD snooping proxy, enable MLD snooping globally and in a specified
VLAN.
Data Preparation
None
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
mld-snooping proxy
MLD snooping proxy is enabled.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
398
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
NOTE
l After MLD snooping proxy is enabled in a VLAN, the S9700 periodically broadcasts MLD Query
messages to all the interfaces in the VLAN, including router interfaces. This may result in MLD
snooping querier reelection. If an MLD snooping querier already exists on a multicast network, you
are advised to enable the functions of MLD snooping querier and MLD message suppression to
implement the MLD snooping proxy function. For detailed configurations of MLD snooping querier
and MLD message suppression, see 11.3.5 Enabling the MLD Snooping Querier and 11.3.6
(Optional) Configuring MLD Message Suppression.
l MLD snooping proxy cannot be enabled in a VLAN if the corresponding VLANIF interface has MLD
enabled.
l In a VLAN, the MLD snooping proxy function cannot be enabled together with the MLD snooping
querier or MLD message suppression function.
----End
Checking the Configuration
Run the display mld-snooping configuration command to check the non-default MLD
snooping configuration.
If the command output shows that the MLD snooping proxy function has been enabled, the
configuration succeeds.
# View the non-default MLD snooping configuration in VLAN 10.
<Quidway> display mld-snooping vlan 10 configuration
MLD Snooping Configuration for VLAN 10
mld-snooping enable
mld-snooping proxy
11.5 Configuring an IPv6 Layer 2 Multicast Policy
This section describes how to configure an IPv6 Layer 2 multicast policy.
11.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
A Layer 2 multicast policy controls the multicast programs that users can order on a switch with
MLD snooping enabled. This policy improves multicast network controllability and security.
S9700 supports the following Layer 2 multicast policies:
l
Configures multicast group policy, prohibiting multicast member interfaces from joining
the specified multicast group.
l
Enables interfaces to quickly leave multicast groups.
l
Sets the maximum number of multicast groups that an interface can dynamically join.
You can use Layer 2 multicast policies according to network requirements.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring a Layer 2 multicast policy, complete the following tasks:
l
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Enabling MLD snooping globally and in a VLAN
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
399
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
Creating VLANs and adding interfaces to these VLANs
Data Preparation
To configure a Layer 2 multicast policy, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Types and numbers of interfaces
2
ACL rules applied to a multicast group policy
3
ACL rules applied to prompt leave of
multicast member interfaces
11.5.2 Configuring a Multicast Group Policy
Context
To configure a multicast group policy, perform the following operations on the S9700.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Use either of the following methods to configure a multicast group policy.
l Configure a multicast group policy in a VLAN.
1.
Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
2.
Run:
mld-snooping group-policy acl-number [ mld-version ]
A multicast group policy is configured to prohibit the hosts in the specified VLANs
from joining the specified multicast group.
l Configure a multicast group policy on an interface.
1.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface type can be Ethernet, GE, XGE, or Eth-Trunk interface.
2.
Run:
mld-snooping group-policy acl-number vlan vlan-id
A multicast group policy is configured to prohibit the hosts in the specified VLANs
from joining the specified multicast group.
If you configure multicast group policies for the same VLAN in the interface view and VLAN
view, only the policy configured in the interface view takes effect.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
400
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
NOTE
A multicast group policy does not apply to static multicast entries.
----End
11.5.3 Configuring Prompt Leave of Interfaces
Context
To configure the prompt leave function in a VLAN, do as follows on the S9700.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
mld-snooping prompt-leave [ group-policy acl-number ]
Prompt leave is enabled for interfaces in the VLAN.
NOTE
By default, no interface is allowed to promptly leave a multicast group.
If group-policy acl-number is not specified in step 3, the S9700 deletes the forwarding entry of a member
interface immediately when receiving a Done message from the interface.
----End
11.5.4 Setting the Maximum Number of Multicast Groups That an
Interface Can Dynamically Join
Context
To restrict the number of multicast programs that a user can request, set the maximum number
of multicast groups that an interface can dynamically join. This configuration limits the multicast
data traffic volume on the interface.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
401
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
The interface can be Ethernet, GE, or XGE or Eth-Trunk interface.
Step 3 Run:
mld-snooping table limit [ limit-num ] vlan vlan-id
The maximum number of multicast groups that an interface can dynamically join is set.
NOTE
This command limits only the number of multicast groups that an interface can dynamically join. The
number of static multicast groups is not limited on an interface.
If the number of multicast groups that an interface has joined is larger than the configured limit, the current
number of multicast groups on the interface does not change but the interface cannot join new multicast
groups.
----End
11.5.5 Enabling IGMP Snooping
Context
To reject certain types of multicast data, a network administrator can filter UDP packets from a
certain VLAN on an interface of the S9700.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk
interface.
Step 3 Run:
multicast-source-deny vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10>
The Layer 2 multicast data from a certain VLAN on the interface is rejected.
----End
11.5.6 Checking the Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the display mld-snooping configuration command to check the non-default MLD
snooping configuration.
You can view the configuration of a Layer 2 multicast policy in a VLAN by viewing the
non-default MLD snooping configuration in the VLAN.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
402
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
Example
# View the non-default MLD snooping configuration in all VLANs.
[Quidway] display mld-snooping configuration
MLD Snooping Configuration for VLAN 11
mld-snooping enable
mld-snooping group-policy 2000 2
MLD Snooping Configuration for VLAN 12
mld-snooping enable
mld-snooping prompt-leave
11.6 (Optional) Modifying Parameters of MLD Snooping
This section describes how to optimize the performance of MLD snooping by modifying MLD
snooping parameters, including the aging time of the router interface, interval for sending Last
Member Query messages, interval for sending the General Query messages, maximum response
time for MLD messages, MLD robustness variable, source IP address of the MLD message sent
to respond to changes of Layer 2 network topology, MLD version, duration for suppressing the
same Report messages, maximum number of MLD snooping entries, and whether the Router
Alert option is contained in MLD messages.
11.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Applicable Environment
You can modify parameters of MLD snooping to optimize the multicast performance on the
S9700 according to the actual situation of the network.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before modifying parameters of MLD snooping, complete the following task:
l
11.3 Configuring Basic Functions of MLD Snooping
Data Preparation
To modify parameters of MLD snooping, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
No.
Procedure
1
ID of the VLAN where you need to optimize
the performance of MLD snooping
2
(Optional) Aging time of the router interface
3
Duration for suppressing the same MLD
messages
4
(Optional) Source IPv6 address of the MLD
General Query message that the MLD
snooping module sends to respond to the
change of the Layer 2 network topology
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
403
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
11.6.2 (Optional) Setting the Aging Time of the Router Interface
Context
To set the aging time of the router interface, do as follows on the S9700.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
mld-snooping router-aging-time router-aging-time
The aging time of the router interface is set.
l By default, the S9700 sets the remaining aging time of router interface as follows:
l If the router interface receives an MLD Query message, the S9700 sets the remaining aging
time of the interface to 180 seconds.
l If the router interface receives a PIM Hello message and the holdtime value of the Hello
message is greater than the remaining aging time of the interface, the S9700 sets the remaining
aging time of the interface to the holdtime value.
----End
11.6.3 Setting the Duration for Suppressing the Same MLD
Messages
Context
To set the duration for suppressing the MLD Report messages with the same content, do as
follows on the S9700.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
mld-snooping suppression-time time-value
The duration for suppressing the same MLD Report messages is set.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
404
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
NOTE
l By default, the duration for suppressing the same MLD Report messages is 10 seconds.
l The MLD snooping function is applicable to only the MLDv1 packets, but is invalid for the MLDv2
packets.
----End
11.6.4 (Optional) Configuring the Router Alert Option in MLD
Messages
Context
To configure whether MLD messages contain the Router Alert option, do as follows on the
S9700.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
vlan vlan-id
The VLAN view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
mld-snooping require-router-alert
The S9700 is configured to process only the MLD messages that contain the Router Alert option
in the IP header.
Step 4 Run:
mld-snooping send-router-alert
The S9700 is configured to send only the MLD messages that contain the Router Alert option
in the IP header.
By default, the S9700 processes all MLD messages and sends the MLD messages with the Router
Alert to the VLAN.
Step 3 and Step 4 can be performed in a random order.
----End
11.6.5 Enabling the MLD Snooping Module to Respond to Changes
of the Layer 2 Network Topology
Context
To enable the MLD snooping module to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network topology,
do as follows on the S9700.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
405
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
mld-snooping send-query enable
The MLD snooping module of the S9700 is enabled to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network
topology.
Step 3 Run:
mld-snooping send-query source-address ipv6-address
The source IPv6 address of the MLD General Query messages that the MLD snooping module
sends to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network topology is set.
By default, the source IPv6 address of the MLD General Query message sent by the S9700 is
FE80::.
After the S9700 is enabled to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network topology, it sends an
MLD General Query message to the downstream S9700 when receiving a Topology Change
message. Then the downstream S9700 can learn the new router interface. When a member
interface receives the MLD General Query message, the member interface responds with an
MLD Report message. Then the S9700 and its downstream S9700 can learn the new multicast
forwarding entry. This function enables the S9700 to forward multicast data correctly after the
Layer 2 topology changes.
----End
11.6.6 Checking the Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run the display mld-snooping [ vlan vlan-id ] command to check information about MLD
snooping in a VLAN.
----End
Example
If the preceding configurations are successful, the following information is displayed:
<Quidway> display mld-snooping vlan 10
MLD Snooping Vlan Information for VLAN 10
MLD Snooping is Enable
MLD Version is Set to default 1
MLD Query Interval is Set to default 60
MLD Max Response Interval is Set to default 10
MLD Robustness is Set to default 2
MLD Last Member Query Interval is Set to default 1
MLD Router Port Aging Interval is Set to 180s or holdtime in hello
MLD Filter Group-Policy is Set to default : Permit All
MLD Prompt Leave Disable
MLD Router Alert is Not Required
MLD Send Router Alert Enable
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
406
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
11.7 Maintaining MLD Snooping
This section describes how to maintain MLD snooping.
11.7.1 Clearing MLD Snooping Entries
Context
CAUTION
Use this command with caution. After the MLD snooping entries, that is, the dynamic forwarding
entries, of a VLAN are deleted from the multicast forwarding table, the multicast flows sent to
hosts in the VLAN are interrupted. The hosts can receive multicast flows again only after the
S9700 receives the MLD Membership Report messages from the hosts and generates new
forwarding entries.
To clear the dynamic forwarding entries from the multicast forwarding table, run the following
command in the user view.
Procedure
Step 1 Run the reset mld-snooping group { vlan { vlan-id | all } | all } command to clear the dynamic
forwarding entries from the multicast forwarding table.
----End
11.7.2 Clearing the Statistics on MLD Snooping
Context
CAUTION
The statistics on MLD snooping cannot be restored after you clear them. So, confirm the action
before you use the command. To clear the statistics on MLD snooping, run the following
command in the user view.
Procedure
Step 1 Run the reset mld-snooping statistics [ vlan vlan-id ] command to clear the statistics on MLD
snooping in a VLAN.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
407
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
11.7.3 Debugging MLD Snooping
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging
mld-snooping all command to disable it immediately.
When a fault occurs in MLD Snooping, you can run the following debugging command in the
user view to debug MLD snooping and locate the fault.
Procedure
Step 1 Run the debugging mld-snooping [ all | event | done [ basic-acl-number ] | packet [advanceacl-number ] | query [ advance-acl-number ] | report [ advance-acl-number ] | timer |
general ] command in the user view to enable debugging of MLD snooping.
----End
11.8 Configuration Examples
This section provides several configuration examples of MLD snooping.
11.8.1 Example for Configuring a Multicast Group Policy
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 11-1, three hosts are all in VLAN 3. All these three hosts need to receive
data from multicast groups FF32::1 to FF32::10.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
408
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
Figure 11-1 Networking diagram for configuring a multicast group policy on the Ethernet
multicast source
DHCP server
IP/MPLS core
GE1/0/6
SwitchA
VLAN 3
Host 3
GE1/0/5
Host 4
Host 5
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Create VLAN 3 and add GE 1/0/5 and GE 1/0/6 to VLAN 3.
2.
Enable MLD snooping globally on SwitchA.
3.
Configure a multicast group policy in VLAN 3 on SwitchA.
4.
Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3 on SwitchA.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
VLAN that Host 3, Host 4, and Host 5 belong to: VLAN 3
l
Multicast groups that Host 3, Host 4, and Host 5 can join: FF32::1 to FF32::10
Procedure
Step 1 Create VLAN 3 on SwitchA and add GE 1/0/5 and GE 1/0/6 to VLAN 3. The configuration
procedure is not provided here.
Step 2 Enable MLD snooping globally on SwitchA.
[SwitchA]mld-snooping enable
Step 3 Create an IPv6 ACL.
[SwitchA]acl ipv6 3000
[SwitchA-acl6-adv-3000] rule permit ipv6 source FF32::3 128
[SwitchA-acl6-adv-3000] rule permit ipv6 source FF32::4 128
[SwitchA-acl6-adv-3000] rule permit ipv6 source FF32::5 128
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
409
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
[SwitchA-acl6-adv-3000] rule permit ipv6 source FF32::6 128
[SwitchA-acl6-adv-3000] quit
Step 4 Configure a multicast group policy in VLAN 3.
[SwitchA] vlan 3
[SwitchA-vlan3] mld-snooping group-policy 3000
Step 5 Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3.
[SwitchA-vlan3] mld-snooping enable
Step 6 Verify the configuration.
# Verify that host 3, host 4 and host 5 can join multicast groups FF32::1 to FF32::10. Send
Membership Report messages from Host 3, Host 4, or Host 5 to multicast group FF32::3, and
then run the display mld-snooping port-info on SwitchA. You can view information about the
outgoing interface of the multicast group.
[Switch-vlan3] display mld-snooping port-info
----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port
Flag
Flag: S:Static
D:Dynamic
M: Ssm-mapping
----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 33, 1 Entry(s)
(
*, ff32:0:0:0:0:0:0:3)GE1/0/5
D-1 port(s)
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
The preceding output shows that GE 1/0/5 has joined multicast group FF32::3.
# Verify that host 3, host 4 and host 5 cannot join multicast groups out of the range of FF32::1
to FF32::10.
Send Membership Report messages from Host 15, Host 4, or Host 5 to multicast group FF32::15,
and then run the display mld-snooping port-info on SwitchA. You can view information about
the outgoing interface of the multicast group.
[Switch-vlan3] display mld-snooping port-info
----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port
Flag
Flag: S:Static
D:Dynamic
M: Ssm-mapping
----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 33, 1 Entry(s)
(
*, ff32:0:0:0:0:0:0:3)GE1/0/5
D-1 port(s)
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
No information about the outgoing interface of multicast group FF32::15 is displayed. It
indicates that GE 0/0/5 does not join the multicast group FF32::15.
----End
Configuration Files
#
sysname SwitchA
#
mld-snooping enable
#
vlan batch 3
#
vlan 3
mld-snooping enable
mld-snooping group-policy 3000
#
acl ipv6 number 3000
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
410
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
rule 5 permit ipv6 source FF32::3/128
rule 10 permit ipv6 source FF32::4/128
rule 15 permit ipv6 source FF32::5/128
rule 20 permit ipv6 source FF32::6/128
#
interface GigabitEthernet 1/0/5
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 3
#
interface GigabitEthernet 1/0/6
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 3
#
return
11.8.2 Example for Configuring Prompt Leave of Interfaces in a
VLAN
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 11-2, GE 1/0/3 and GE 1/0/4 on of Switch A are connected to only one
receiver respectively. Other hosts connected to GE 1/0/3 and GE 1/0/4 do not need to receive
multicast packets. Therefore, when receiving MLD Leave messages from the two interfaces,
Switch A deletes the forwarding entries of the multicast groups that the hosts leave without
waiting for the timeout of the aging timer. This saves the bandwidth and system resources.
Figure 11-2 Networking diagram for configuring prompt leave of interfaces in a VLAN
multicast source
DHCP server
IP/MPLS
core
SwitchA
GE1/0/3
VLAN 3
Host1
Host2
GE1/0/5
GE1/0/4
Host 3 Host 4 Host 5
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Create VLAN 3 on Switch A and add GE 1/0/3, GE 1/0/4, and GE 1/0/5 to VLAN 3.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
411
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
2.
Enable MLD snooping globally on Switch A.
3.
Enable prompt leave of interfaces in VLAN 3 on Switch A.
4.
Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3 on Switch A.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
ID of the VLAN where prompt leave is enabled: 3
Procedure
Step 1 Create VLAN 3 on Switch A and add GE 1/0/3, GE 1/0/4, and GE 1/0/5 to VLAN 3. The
configuration procedure is not provided here.
Step 2 Enable MLD snooping globally on Switch A.
[SwitchA] mld-snooping enable
Step 3 Enable prompt leave of interfaces in VLAN 3.
[SwitchA] vlan 3
[SwitchA-vlan3] mld-snooping prompt-leave
Step 4 Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3.
[SwitchA-vlan3] mld-snooping enable
Step 5 Verify the configuration. Run the display mld-snooping command on Switch A.
[SwitchA] display mld-snooping vlan 3
MLD Snooping Vlan Information for VLAN 3
MLD Snooping is Enable
MLD Version is Set to default 1
MLD Query Interval is Set to default 60
MLD Max Response Interval is Set to default 10
MLD Robustness is Set to default 2
MLD Last Listener Query Interval is Set to default 1
MLD Router Port Aging Interval is Set to 180s or holdtime in hello
MLD Filter Group-Policy is Set to default : Permit All
MLD Prompt Leave Enable
MLD Router Alert is Not Required
MLD Send Router Alert Enable
As shown in the preceding output, "MLD Prompt Leave Enable" indicates that the configuration
of prompt leave for interfaces in VLAN 3 is successful.
----End
Configuration Files
#
sysname SwitchA
#
mld-snooping enable
#
vlan batch 3
#
vlan 3
mld-snooping enable
mld-snooping prompt-leave
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3
port link-type access
port default vlan 3
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
412
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/4
port link-type access
port default vlan 3
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/5
port link-type access
port default vlan 3
#
return
11.8.3 Example for Configuring a Static Router Interface
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 11-3, Switch A is connected to a router and several hosts. The router runs
the MLD protocol. The Switch A needs to forward multicast data to the hosts.
Figure 11-3 Networking diagram for configuring a static router interface
DHCP server
multicast source
IP/MPLS core
VLAN 2
GE1/0/2
Host 1
GE1/0/5
SwitchA GE1/0/3
Host 2
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Create VLAN 2 on Switch A and add GE 1/0/2, GE 1/0/3, and GE 1/0/5 to VLAN 2.
2.
Enable MLD snooping globally on Switch A.
3.
Configure GE 1/0/5 as a static router interface.
4.
Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 2 on Switch A.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
413
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
l
Interface to be configured as a static router interface: GE 1/0/5
l
VLAN that Host 1 and Host 2 belongs to: VLAN 2
Procedure
Step 1 Create VLAN 2 on Switch A and add GE 1/0/2, GE 1/0/3, and GE 1/0/5 to VLAN 2. The
configuration procedure is not provided here.
Step 2 Enable MLD snooping globally on Switch A.
[SwitchA] mld-snooping enable
Step 3 Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 2.
[SwitchA] vlan 2
[SwitchA-vlan2] mld-snooping enable
[SwitchA-vlan2] quit
Step 4 Configure GE 1/0/5 as a static router interface.
[SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/5
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/5] mld-snooping static-router-port vlan 2
[SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/5] quit
Step 5 Verify the configuration. Run the display mld-snooping router-port command on Switch A.
[SwitchA] display mld-snooping router-port vlan 2
Total Number of Router Port on Vlan 2 is 1
Port Name
UpTime
Expires
GE1/0/5
00:00:32
--
Flags
STATIC
The preceding output shows that GE 1/0/5 is configured as a static router interface.
----End
Configuration Files
#
sysname SwitchA
#
mld-snooping enable
#
vlan batch 2
#
vlan 2
mld-snooping enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2
port link-type access
port default vlan 2
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3
port link-type access
port default vlan 2
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/5
port link-type access
port default vlan 2
mld-snooping static-router-port vlan 2
#
return
11.8.4 Example for Enabling the MLD Snooping Module to
Respond to Changes of the Layer 2 Network Topology
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
414
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 11-4, four S9700s form a ring network to improve the network reliability.
To prevent loops on the network, the S9700s run the Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol (MSTP).
Host 1 and Host 2 need to receive multicast data from the multicast source. The IPv6 addresses
of Host 1 and Host 2 are 2::3/112 and 3::1/64 respectively.
Figure 11-4 Networking diagram for enabling the MLD snooping module to respond to changes
of the Layer 2 network topology
DHCP server
multicast source
IP/MPLS
core
SwitchA
GE1/0/3
GE1/0/2
GE1/0/1
SwitchC
MSTP
GE1/0/5 GE1/0/7
GE1/0/6
GE1/0/8
SwitchB
GE1/0/3
SwitchD
GE1/0/2
GE1/0/4
GE1/0/1
3::1/64
Host2
VLAN 3
2::3/112
Host1
Configuration Roadmap
The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Enable MSTP on all the S9700s.
2.
Create VLAN 3 and add interfaces to VLAN 3 on all the S9700s.
3.
Enable MLD snooping globally on all the S9700s.
4.
Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3 on all the S9700s.
5.
Enable the MLD snooping module of SwitchA to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network
topology.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
415
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Source IP address contained in the MLD General Query message that the MLD snooping
module sends to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network: FE80::1
Procedure
Step 1 Enable MSTP on all the S9700s. The configuration procedure is not provided here. For the
method of configuring MSTP, see the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide Ethernet.
Step 2 Create VLAN 3 and add interfaces to VLAN 3 on all the S9700s. The configuration procedure
is not provided here.
Step 3 Run the mld-snooping enable command to enable MLD snooping globally on all the S9700s.
Step 4 Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3 on all the S9700s.
[SwitchA] vlan 3
[SwitchA-vlan3] mld-snooping enable
[SwitchA-vlan3] quit
The configurations of other S9700s are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not
provided here.
Step 5 Enable the MLD snooping module of SwitchA to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network
topology.
[SwitchA]mld-snooping send-query enable
[SwitchA] mld-snooping send-query source-address FE80::1
Step 6 Verify the configuration.
l Verify that Host 1 and Host 2 can receive multicast data.
l Run the display stp command on the S9700s to find the interfaces that are blocked and the
transmission path of multicast data.
l Assume that GE 1/0/1 is blocked and multicast data is transmitted to Host 1 through the path
SwitchA -> SwitchC -> SwitchB and to Host 2 through the path SwitchA -> SwitchD. Run
the shutdown command on GE 1/0/1 of SwitchC to shut down the interface so that the
topology of the MSTP network changes.
l Verify that Host 1 and Host 2 can still receive multicast data after the network topology
changes.
----End
Configuration Files
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
mld-snooping enable
mld-snooping send-query enable
mld-snooping send-query source-address FE80::1
#
vlan batch 3
#
stp enable
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
416
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
vlan 3
mld-snooping enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 3
bpdu enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 3
bpdu enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 3
bpdu enable
#
return
Configuration file of SwitchB
#
sysname SwitchB
#
mld-snooping enable
#
vlan batch 3
#
stp enable
#
vlan 3
mld-snooping enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1
port link-type access
port default vlan 3
bpdu enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 3
bpdu enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/4
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 3
bpdu enable
#
return
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
mld-snooping enable
#
vlan batch 3
#
stp enable
#
vlan 3
mld-snooping enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/5
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 3
bpdu enable
#
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
417
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
11 MLD Snooping Configuration
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/6
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 3
bpdu enable
#
return
Configuration file of SwitchD
#
sysname SwitchD
#
mld-snooping enable
#
vlan batch 3
#
stp enable
#
vlan 3
mld-snooping enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2
port link-type access
port default vlan 3
bpdu enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/7
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 3
bpdu enable
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/8
port link-type trunk
port trunk allow-pass vlan 3
bpdu enable
#
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
418
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
12
PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
About This Chapter
The PIM protocol can be used in an IPv6 network to implement multicast routing and data
forwarding inside an AS. The PIM-DM protocol is a multicast routing protocol of dense node.
It is applicable to a small-scale network with densely-distributed members.
12.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview
In the IPv6 network where multicast group members are densely distributed and each network
segment may have multicast group members, PIM-DM builds a unidirectional and loop-free
SPT from the multicast source to the group member through periodical flooding and pruning.
12.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700
The system can work normally with default PIM-DM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust
parameters related to neighbor discovery, prune, state refresh, graft, and assert according to
specific scenarios. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent
function to enhance the IPv6 PIM-DM security.
12.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions
Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv6 multicast routing and enable
IPv6 PIM-DM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the IPv6 PIM-DM
network can work normally.
12.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source
A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This
helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream
receivers to enhance security.
12.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors
Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters
by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as
required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values.
12.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune
When the last member leaves a group, the multicast device sends a Prune message upstream,
requesting the upstream device to execute the prune operation. If other downstream devices on
the same network segment need the multicast data for this group, they need to send Join messages
to override the prune operation. You can adjust control parameters of Join/Prune messages as
required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
419
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
12.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh
In a PIM-DM network, the periodic flooding-pruning wastes lots of network resources. To
prevent the pruned interface from forwarding messages because the prune timer times out, you
can enable the State-Refresh function to enable the multicast device to send State-Refresh
messages periodically, refresh the prune state of the interface, and maintain SPT.
12.8 Adjusting Control Messages for Graft
To enable new members in a network to quickly receive multicast data, a multicast device
actively sends a Graft message through an upstream interface, requesting the upstream device
to forward multicast data to this network segment.
12.9 Adjusting Control Messages for Assert
If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates
that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert
message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream
device.
12.10 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent Function
The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM.
In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send
the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To
avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state.
12.11 Maintaining PIM-DM
Maintaining IPv6 PIM-DM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status.
12.12 Configuration Example
Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic IPv6 PIM-DM network.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
420
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
12.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview
In the IPv6 network where multicast group members are densely distributed and each network
segment may have multicast group members, PIM-DM builds a unidirectional and loop-free
SPT from the multicast source to the group member through periodical flooding and pruning.
In IPv4 multicast applications, the Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) is used to establish
multicast routes between switchs to replicate and forward multicast packets.
In IPv6 multicast applications, switchs run PIM-IPv6. The functions and principles of PIM-IPv6
are similar to those of PIM-IPv4.
PIM-IPv6 consists of the following separate protocols:
l
PIM-DM: indicates the Protocol Independent Multicast-Dense Mode. PIM-DM is
applicable to a small-scale network with densely-distributed members. The network adopts
the Any-Source Multicast (ASM) model to implement multicast services.
l
PIM-SM: indicates the Protocol Independent Multicast-Sparse Mode. PIM-SM is
applicable to a large-scale network with sparsely-distributed members. The network adopts
the ASM and Source-Specific Multicast (SSM) models to implement multicast services.
NOTE
l This chapter is concerned only about the PIM-DM configuration in the IPv6 network. PIM-DM in this
chapter refers to IPv6 PIM-DM, unless otherwise specified.
l For details of PIM-SM (IPv6), refer to the chapter PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration.
l For details of ASM and SSM models, refer to the chapter "IP Multicast Overview" in the S9700 Core
Routing Switch Feature Description - IP Multicast.
12.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700
The system can work normally with default PIM-DM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust
parameters related to neighbor discovery, prune, state refresh, graft, and assert according to
specific scenarios. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent
function to enhance the IPv6 PIM-DM security.
Controlling the Forwarding of a Multicast Source
You can configure the Keepalive period of a multicast source and the filtering rules of the
multicast source.
Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors
You can set the following control parameters by using the related commands:
l
Interval for sending Hello messages
l
Period for keeping neighbors reachable
l
Whether the Hello messages without the Generation ID option are accepted
l
Maximum delay for triggering Hello messages
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
421
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Neighbor filtering function: An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the
addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering
rules
Adjusting Control Parameters for Pruning
You can adjust the following control parameters for pruning:
l
The interval for keeping the Prune state of the downstream interface
l
The delay from the time when the current switch receives a Prune message from a
downstream switch to the time when the current switch performs the prune action in the
LAN
l
The period for overriding the prune action
Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh
You can enable or disable State-Refresh, set the interval for sending PIM State-Refresh
messages, set the time for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message, and set the TTL
values of State-Refresh messages.
Adjusting Control Parameters for Graft
You can set the interval for retransmitting Graft messages.
Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert
You can set the period for switchs to keep the Assert state. The switchs that fail in the election
forbid downstream interfaces to forward multicast data during this period. After the period
expires, the downstream interfaces continue to forward multicast data.
Configuring PIM Silent
Some hosts may send a large number of malicious PIM Hello messages, which results in the
suspension of the switch. By configuring the PIM Silent function on the interfaces of the
switch connected with the host, you can protect the switch from being attacked.
12.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions
Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv6 multicast routing and enable
IPv6 PIM-DM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the IPv6 PIM-DM
network can work normally.
12.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring basic IPv6 PIM-DM functions, configure a unicast IPv6 routing protocol.
Applicable Environment
PIM-DM is applicable to a small-scale network. Most of network segments have receivers.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
422
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configure basic PIM-DM functions, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
Data Preparation
To configure basic PIM-DM functions, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Type and number of the interface to be enabled with PIM-DM (IPv6)
12.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing
Prior to configuring all IPv6 multicast features, enable IPv6 multicast routing.
Context
Do as follows on the switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 (Optional) Run:
assign multicast-resource-mode optimize
The multicast replication capability of LPUs is improved. If each multicast packet needs to be
replicated into more than 8192 copies, run this command to improve the multicast replication
capability before enabling IP multicast routing.
Step 3 Run:
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
The IPv6 multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance.
----End
12.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions
An interface can set up IPv6 PIM neighbor relationship with other devices after IPv6 PIM-DM
is enabled on it.
Context
Do as follows on the switch:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
423
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The VLANIF interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
pim ipv6 dm
Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) functions are enabled.
After PIM-DM (IPv6) is enabled on interfaces, switchs set up the PIM-IPv6 neighbor
relationship with each other. The switchs can then process protocol packets received from PIMIPv6 neighbors.
You can run the undo pim ipv6 dm command to disable PIM-DM (IPv6) on an interface.
NOTE
PIM-DM (IPv6) and PIM-SM (IPv6) cannot be enabled on an interface simultaneously. The PIM-IPv6
modes on all interfaces that belong to the same instance must be the same. When a switch is deployed in
a PIM-DM (IPv6) domain, enable PIM-DM (IPv6) on all non-boundary interfaces.
----End
12.3.4 Checking the Configuration
After IPv6 PIM-DM is configured successfully, you can check information about the PIM
interface, PIM neighbor, and PIM routing table through commands..
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type
interface-number | verbose ] * command to check information about PIM-IPv6 neighbors.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
424
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
12.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source
A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This
helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream
receivers to enhance security.
12.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can configure the lifetime of a
multicast source and source address-based filtering rules as required.
Applicable Environment
This configuration is applicable to all PIM-DM networks.
PIM-IPv6 switchs check the passing multicast data packets. By checking whether the data
packets match the filtering rule, the switchs determine whether to forward the packets. That is,
the switchs in the PIM-IPv6 domain act as filters. The filters help to control data flows and limit
information obtained by downstream receivers.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters of a source, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters of a source, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Keepalive period of a source
2
Filtering rules of multicast source addresses
12.4.2 Configuring the Keepalive Period of a Source
A multicast device starts a timer for each (S, G) entry. If the multicast device does not receive
any multicast packets from a multicast source within the set lifetime of the multicast source, it
considers that the (S, G) entry becomes invalid and the multicast source stops sending multicast
data to the multicast group.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch:
NOTE
If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
425
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
source-lifetime interval
The Keepalive period of a source is configured.
If a switch does not receive any (S, G) packet in the Keepalive period of the source, the
switch considers that the source stops sending multicast data to G, and the (S, G) entry becomes
invalid.
----End
12.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses
After ACL6 rules are configured, a multicast device can filter the received multicast packets
based on source addresses or source/group addresses.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
source-policy { acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name }
A filter is configured.
The nearer the filter to the source, the more obvious the effect of the filtering.
If the basic ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses that pass the filtering
are forwarded.
If the advanced ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses and group
addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
426
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
NOTE
l If acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name is specified in the source-policy command and ACL rules are
created, only the multicast packets whose source addresses match the ACL rules are permitted.
l If acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name is specified in the source-policy command and no ACL rule is
created, the multicast packets with any source addresses are not forwarded.
l The source-policy command does not filter the static (S, G) entries.
----End
12.4.4 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters of a multicast source are adjusted, you can run commands to check
entries in the PIM routing table.
Procedure
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
12.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining
Neighbors
Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters
by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as
required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values.
12.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can adjust related parameters of the
Hello message for controlling the neighbor relationships and configure the neighbor filtering
function to enhance security as required.
Applicable Environment
PIM-IPv6 switchs establish the neighbor relationship by exchanging Hello messages to negotiate
various control parameters.
Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust
related parameters according to the specific network environment.
NOTE
If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
427
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for maintaining neighbors, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for maintaining neighbors, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Timeout period for waiting to receive Hello message from neighbors
2
Interval for sending Hello messages
3
Maximum delay for triggering Hello messages
4
Number or name of the ACL used to filter PIM neighbors
12.5.2 Configuring the Interval for Sending Hello Messages
The interval for sending Hello messages can be set either globally or on an interface. The
configuration in the interface view is prior to the configuration in the PIM view. When the
interval is not configured in the interface view, the configuration in the PIM view takes effect.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch:
NOTE
The configuration of the control parameters for maintaining PIM-IPv6 neighbors involves the following
cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not set, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
3.
Run:
timer hello interval
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
428
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
The interval for sending Hello messages is configured.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
pim ipv6 timer hello interval
The interval for sending Hello messages is set.
4.
Run:
pim ipv6 triggered-hello-delay interval
The maximum delay for triggering Hello messages is set.
After the maximum delay is set, the conflict caused by multiple PIM-IPv6 switchs
simultaneously sending Hello message is avoided.
----End
12.5.3 Configuring the Timeout Period of a Neighbor
The timeout period of a neighbor can be set either globally or on an interface. If the multicast
device does not receive any Hello message from a neighbor when the timeout period is expired,
the device considers that the neighbor is unreachable. The timeout period of the neighbor must
be longer than the interval for sending Hello messages.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch:
NOTE
The configuration of the control parameters for maintaining PIM-IPv6 neighbors involves the following
cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not set, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
429
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3.
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Run:
hello-option holdtime interval
The timeout period for keeping a neighbor reachable is set.
Each switch maintains a timer for each neighbor. When receiving a Hello message, a
switch resets the timer. If the local switch does not receive any Hello message from
a neighbor after the timer times out, the local switch considers that the neighbor is
unreachable.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
pim ipv6 hello-option holdtime interval
The timeout period for keeping the neighbor reachable is set.
If the local switch does not receive any Hello message from a neighbor after the timer
times out, the local switch considers that the neighbor is unreachable.
----End
12.5.4 Refusing to Receive the Hello Message Without the
Generation ID Option
When the Generation ID option in the Hello message received from an upstream neighbor
changes, it indicates that the status of the upstream neighbor changes. Therefore, you can
configure a PIM interface to deny the Hello messages without Generation ID options to obtain
the upstream neighbor status in real time.
Context
A switch assigns a random Generation ID to an interface enabled with PIM. The Hello messages
sent by the interface carry the random Generation ID. If the status of the interface changes, the
random Generation ID is updated.
When the Generation ID option in the Hello message received from an upstream neighbor
changes, it indicates that the status of the upstream neighbor changes. If a switch does not want
to receive data from an upstream neighbor, the switch sends a Prune message after receiving a
data packet from the upstream neighbor.
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
430
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
pim ipv6 require-genid
The Generation ID option is set in a Hello message.
The Hello message without the Generation ID option is rejected.
----End
12.5.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering
To prevent some unknown devices from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is
required. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the
filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering rules.
Context
To prevent some switch from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is required.
Do as follows on the switch running IPv6 PIM-DM:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
pim ipv6 neighbor-policy { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name }
PIM neighbor filtering is configured.
An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules
and deletes the neighbors unmatching the filtering rules.
NOTE
When configuring the neighbor filtering function on the interface, you must also configure the neighbor
filtering function correspondingly on the switch that sets up the neighbor relationship with the interface.
----End
12.5.6 Checking the Configuration
After the neighbor control parameters are adjusted, you can run commands to check information
about the PIM interface and the PIM neighbor.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
431
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type
interface-number | verbose ] * command to check information about PIM-IPv6 neighbors.
----End
12.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune
When the last member leaves a group, the multicast device sends a Prune message upstream,
requesting the upstream device to execute the prune operation. If other downstream devices on
the same network segment need the multicast data for this group, they need to send Join messages
to override the prune operation. You can adjust control parameters of Join/Prune messages as
required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values.
12.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic IPv6 PIM-DM functions are configured, you can set the period for an interface to
keep the prune state, delay for transmitting Prune messages in a LAN, and interval for overriding
the prune action as required.
Applicable Environment
When the last member of a group on a switch leaves its group, the switch sends a Prune message
through an upstream interface to request the upstream switch to perform the prune action. After
receiving the Prune message, the upstream interface stops forwarding packets to this network
segment. If other downstream switchs exist in this network segment, they must send the Join
message to override the prune action.
Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust
related parameters according to the specific network environment.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for prune, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for prune, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
No.
Data
1
Timeout period of the Prune state
2
Delay for transmitting Prune messages
3
Period for overriding the prune action
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
432
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
12.6.2 Configuring the Period for an Interface to Keep the Prune
State
The period for an interface to keep the prune state can be set either globally or on an interface.
After the period expires, the pruned interface starts to forward messages again. If the multicast
device receives a State-Refresh message before the period expires, it resets the timer, that is, it
refreshes the prune state.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
NOTE
The configuration of the control parameters of prune involves the following cases:
l Global Configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on the interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not set, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
3.
Run:
holdtime join-prune interval
The period during which the downstream interface is in the Prune state is set.
After the period expires, the pruned interface continues to forward packets. Before
the period expires, the switch resets the Holdtime timer after receiving a State-Refresh
message.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
pim ipv6 holdtime join-prune interval
The period during which the downstream interface is in the Prune state is set.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
433
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
After the period expires, the pruned interface continues to forward packets. Before
the period expires, the switch resets the Holdtime timer after receiving a State-Refresh
message.
----End
12.6.3 Configuring the Delay for Transmitting Prune Messages in a
LAN
The delay for transmitting Prune messages in a LAN can be set either globally or on an interface.
When the values of lan-delay on all devices along the same link are different, the maximum
value of these values is preferred.
Context
The Hello message carries lan-delay and the override-interval. The relationship between landelay, override-interval, and Prune-Pending Timer (PPT) is that lan-delay + override-interval =
PPT. PPT indicates the delay from the time when a switch receives the Prune message from a
downstream interface to the time when the switch performs the prune action to suppress the
forwarding on the downstream interface. If the switch receives a Join message from a
downstream switch within the PPT, the switch does not perform the prune action.
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
NOTE
The configuration of control parameters for Prune involves the following two cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
3.
Run:
hello-option lan-delay interval
The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
434
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
pim ipv6 hello-option lan-delay interval
The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set.
----End
12.6.4 Configuring the Interval for Overriding the Prune Action
If a device receives a Prune message from the upstream interface, it indicates that other
downstream devices still exist in the LAN. If these devices still needs to receive the multicast
data, the device must send a Join message upstream within the override-interval.
Context
When a switch receives a Prune message from an upstream interface, it indicates that switch in
the LAN. When a switch receives a Prune message from an upstream interface, it indicates that
the switch still needs to receive multicast data. If the switch still requests the multicast data, it
needs to send a Join message in the override-interval period to the upstream switch.
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
NOTE
The configuration of control parameters for Prune involves the following two cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
3.
Run:
hello-option override-interval interval
The interval for overriding the prune action is set.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
435
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
3.
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Run:
pim ipv6 hello-option override-interval interval
The interval for overriding the prune action is set.
----End
12.6.5 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for prune are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM
interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through
commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft |
graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
12.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh
In a PIM-DM network, the periodic flooding-pruning wastes lots of network resources. To
prevent the pruned interface from forwarding messages because the prune timer times out, you
can enable the State-Refresh function to enable the multicast device to send State-Refresh
messages periodically, refresh the prune state of the interface, and maintain SPT.
12.7.1 Estalishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can set the interval for sending StateRefresh messages, period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message, and TTL value
carried in the State-Refresh message as required.
Applicable Environment
By default, a PIM-DM interface is in the forwarding state. The pruned interface continues to
forward packets after the prune timer times out. In the PIM-DM network, periodically flooding
State-Refresh messages can update the prune timer and maintain the suppressed state of the
prune interface.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
436
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust
related parameters according to the specific network environment.
NOTE
If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for State-Refresh, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for State-Refresh, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages
2
Period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message
3
TTL value used to forward State-Refresh messages
12.7.2 Disabling State-Refresh
After this function is disabled on the interface, the interface cannot forward any State-Refresh
messages.
Context
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-DM domain:
NOTE
By default, PIM-DM State-Refresh is enabled on an interface.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
undo pim ipv6 state-refresh-capable
State-Refresh is disabled.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
437
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
The interface on which PIM-DM State-Refresh is disabled cannot forward any State-Refresh
message.
NOTE
You can run the pim ipv6 state-refresh-capable command to re-enable the PIM-DM State-Refresh on the
interface.
----End
12.7.3 Configuring the Interval for Sending State-Refresh Messages
To prevent pruned interfaces from forwarding messages after the prune state timer times out,
you need to set the interval for sending State-Refresh messages to be shorter than the period for
keeping the Prune state.
Context
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-DM domain:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
state-refresh-interval interval
The interval for sending PIM-IPv6 State-Refresh messages is set.
NOTE
The interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages should be shorter than the timeout period for keeping
the Prune state. You can run the holdtime join-prune command to set the timeout period for keeping the
Prune state.
----End
12.7.4 Configuring the Period for Receiving the Next State-Refresh
Message
A multicast device may receive PIM State-Refresh messages from multiple routers in a short
period and some PIM State-Refresh messages are repeated. Before the state-refresh timer times
out, the device discards the received repeated State-Refresh messages. The device is allowed to
receive the next State-Refresh message only after the timer times out.
Context
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-DM domain:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
438
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
state-refresh-rate-limit interval
The period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message is set.
----End
12.7.5 Configuring the TTL Value of a State-Refresh Message
After receiving the PIM State-Refresh message, a multicast device decrements the TTL value
by 1 and then forwards the message downstream until the TTL value becomes 0. In a smallsized network, the PIM State-Refresh message is transmitted circularly on the network. You can
adjust the TTL value according to the network scale.
Context
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-DM domain:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
state-refresh-ttl ttl-value
The TTL value in the State-Refresh message is set.
----End
12.7.6 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for state-refresh are adjusted, you can check information about the
PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through
commands.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
439
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft |
graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
12.8 Adjusting Control Messages for Graft
To enable new members in a network to quickly receive multicast data, a multicast device
actively sends a Graft message through an upstream interface, requesting the upstream device
to forward multicast data to this network segment.
12.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can set the interval for retransmitting
Graft messages as required.
Applicable Environment
In the PIM-DM network, if State-Refresh is not enabled, the pruned interface can forward
packets only after the Prune timer times out. If State-Refresh is enabled, the pruned interface
may not continue to forward packets forever.
To enable new members in the network to quickly receive multicast data, the PIM-DM switch
sends a Graft message through an upstream interface. After receiving the Graft message, the
upstream switch immediately replies a Graft-Ack message and restores the forwarding of the
interface that receives the Graft message.
switchs in the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related
parameters according to the specific network environment.
NOTE
If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for graft, complete the following tasks:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
440
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for graft, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Interval for retransmitting Graft messages
12.8.2 Setting the Interval for Retransmitting Graft Messages
In PIM-DM mode, when a member joins a pruned group, the multicast device sends a Graft
message and waits for an ACK message from the upstream device. If the downstream device
does not receive any ACK message within a certain period, the device resends the Graft message
until it receives an ACK message from the upstream device.
Context
If the local switch does not receive any Graft-Ack message from the upstream switch in the
specified time, the local switch resends the Graft message.
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
pim ipv6 timer graft-retry interval
The interval for retransmitting Graft messages is set.
----End
12.8.3 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for graft are adjusted, you can check information about the
unacknowledged PIM-DM graft, PIM interface, and PIM routing table and statistics about PIM
control messages through commands.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
441
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 grafts command to check the unacknowledged PIM-DM Graft
messages.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft |
graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
12.9 Adjusting Control Messages for Assert
If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates
that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert
message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream
device.
12.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can set the period for holding the
Assert state as required.
Applicable Environment
When a PIM-DM switch receives multicast data through a downstream interface, this indicates
that other upstream switchs exist in this network segment. The switch sends an Assert message
through the downstream interface to take part in the assert election.
Switchs in the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related
parameters according to the specific network environment.
NOTE
If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for Assert, complete the following tasks:
l
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
442
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for asset, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
The period for keeping the Assert state
12.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State
The device that fails in the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding multicast
data. After the holdtime of the Assert state expires, the downstream interface can forward
multicast data.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch:
NOTE
The configuration involves the following two cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
3.
Run:
holdtime assert interval
The period for keeping the Assert state is set.
The switch that fails in the election prohibits its downstream interface from forwarding
multicast data.
After the Holdtime timer times out, the downstream interface continues to forward
packets.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
443
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
pim ipv6 holdtime assert interval
The period for keeping the Assert state is set.
The switch that fails in the election prohibits its downstream interface from forwarding
multicast data.
After the Holdtime timer times out, the downstream interface continues to forward
packets.
----End
12.9.3 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for assert are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM
interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through
commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft |
graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
12.10 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent Function
The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM.
In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send
the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To
avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
444
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
12.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM and MLD are configured, you can configure the PIM
silent function on the interface connected with the user host. This interface should be enabled
with IPv6 PIM-DM and MLD first.
Applicable Environment
At the access layer, the switch interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with
PIM-IPv6. You can establish a PIM-IPv6 neighbor on the switch interface to process various
PIM packets. The configuration, however, has the security vulnerability. When a host
maliciously generates PIM-IPv6 Hello packets and sends the packets in a large quantity, the
switch may break down.
To avoid the preceding case, you can set the status of the switch interface to PIM silent. When
the interface is in the PIM-IPv6 silent state, the interface is prohibited from receiving and
forwarding any PIM-IPv6 packet. All PIM-IPv6 neighbors and PIM-IPv6 state machines on the
interface are deleted. The interface then acts as the static DR, which takes effect immediately.
At the same time, MLD on the interface is not affected.
PIM silent is applicable only to the switch interface directly connected to the host network
segment that is connected only to this switch.
CAUTION
If PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled on the interface connected to a switch, the PIM-IPv6 neighbor
cannot be established and a multicast fault may occur.
If the host network segment is connected to multiple switchs and PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled on
multiple switch interfaces, the interfaces become static DRs. Therefore, multiple DRs exist in
this network segment, and a multicast fault occurs.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring PIM-IPv6 silent, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to make the network layer reachable
l
Configuring PIM-DM
l
Configuring MLD
Data Preparation
To configure PIM-IPv6 silent, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
No.
Data
1
Number of the switch interface connected to hosts
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
445
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
12.10.2 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent
After the interface is configured with PIM silent, it is forbidden to receive or forward any PIM
protocol packet. All PIM neighbors and PIM state machines on this interface are deleted. Then,
this interface automatically becomes the DR. MLD on the interface is not affected.
Context
CAUTION
PIM silent is applicable only to the switch interface directly connected to the host network
segment that can be connected to only one PIM switch.
Do as follows on the switch interface connected to the host network segment:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
pim ipv6 silent
PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled.
After this function is enabled, the attacks from malicious hosts by sending Hello messages are
effectively prevented and the switch is protected.
----End
12.10.3 Checking the Configuration
After PIM silent is configured, you can run the command to check information about the PIM
interface.
Prerequisites
All the configurations of PIM silent are complete.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
446
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
12.11 Maintaining PIM-DM
Maintaining IPv6 PIM-DM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status.
12.11.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages
If you need to re-collect the statistics about IPv6 PIM control messages, you can reset the existent
statistics. Note that the statistics cannot be restored after you reset them. This operation does not
affect normal running of PIM.
Context
CAUTION
The statistics of PIM-IPv6 control messages on an interface cannot be restored after you clear
them. So, confirm the action before you use the command.
Procedure
l
Run the reset pim ipv6 control-message counters [ interface interface-type interfacenumber ] command in the user view to clear statistics of PIM-IPv6 control messages on an
interface.
----End
12.11.2 Monitoring Running Status of PIM-DM
During IPv6 PIM routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know
the running of PIM.
Context
In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running
status of PIM-DM.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft |
graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command in any view to check the statistics of sent and received PIM-IPv6
control messages.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 grafts command in any view to check the unacknowledged PIMDM Graft messages.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command in any view to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type
interface-number | verbose ] * command in any view to check information about PIM-IPv6
neighbors.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
447
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
l
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Run the following commands in any view to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
12.11.3 Debugging PIM-IPv6
When a fault occurs during the running of IPv6 PIM, run the debugging commands in the user
view and check the contents of sent and received packets for fault location.
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, you need to run the undo
debugging all command to disable the debugging immediately.
Procedure
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 all command in the user view to enable all the debugging of
PIM-IPv6.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 event [ advanced-acl6-number ] command in the user view
to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 event.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 routing-table [ advanced-acl6-number ] command in the
user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 routing table.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 neighbor [ interface-based-acl6-number | basic-acl6number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIMIPv6 neighbors.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 assert [ advanced-acl6-number | [ receive | send ] ] *
command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 Assert.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 join-prune [ interface-based-acl6-number | advanced-acl6number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIMIPv6 Join/Prune.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 state-refresh [ advanced-acl6-number | [ receive | send ] ]
command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 State-Refresh.
*
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
448
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
12.12 Configuration Example
Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic IPv6 PIM-DM network.
12.12.1 Example for Configuring the IPv6 PIM-DM Network
Networking Requirements
On the experiment network shown in Figure 12-1, multicast is deployed. IGP is also deployed
on the network, and unicast routes work normally. The S9700s on the network need to be
configured properly so that user hosts can receive the VoD information in multicast mode.
Figure 12-1 Networking diagram for configuring basic IPv6 PIM-DM functions
Host A
GE1/0/0
2002::2
Source
GE2/0/0
2002::1
GE1/0/0
2001::1
2001::5
Host B
GE2/0/0
3001::1
SwitchB
SwitchA
GE3/0/0
2003::1
GE1/0/0
2003::2
SwitchC
GE2/0/0
4001::1
Host C
Host D
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE1/0/0
VLANIF100
2001::1
GE2/0/0
VLANIF101
2002::1
GE3/0/0
VLANIF102
2003::1
GE1/0/0
VLANIF200
2002::2
GE2/0/0
VLANIF201
3001::1
GE1/0/0
VLANIF300
2003::2
GE2/0/0
VLANIF301
4001::1
SwitchB
SwitchC
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
449
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Configuration Roadmap
On a small-scale experiment network, PIM-DM is adopted to configure multicast. In this
example, each host network segment is connected to only one S9700, so PIM silent can be used
to prevent the Hello message attack. The configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Enable multicast on the S9700s.
2.
Enable an IPv6 unicast routing protocol on the three switches.
3.
Enable IPv6 PIM-DM on each interface.
4.
Enable PIM IPv6 silent and MLD on the router interfaces connected to hosts.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
Create VLANs and VLANIF interfaces on the S9700s and assign IP addresses to the
VLANIF interfaces.
l
Address of the multicast group G: FF0E::1
l
Address of the multicast source S: 2001::5
l
Version of the MLD protocol running between S9700s and user hosts: MLDv1
Procedure
Step 1 Create VLANs and VLANIF interfaces on the S9700s and assign IP addresses to the VLANIF
interfaces. The configuration procedure is not provided here.
Step 2 Enable an IPv6 unicast routing protocol on the three switches. The configuration procedure is
not provided here.
Step 3 Enable IPv6 multicast on all S9700s and enable PIM-DM on all interfaces.
# Enable IPv6 multicast on SwitchA and enable PIM-DM on all its interfaces. The configurations
of SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not
provided here.
[SwitchA] multicast
[SwitchA] interface
[SwitchA-Vlanif100]
[SwitchA-Vlanif100]
[SwitchA] interface
[SwitchA-Vlanif101]
[SwitchA-Vlanif101]
[SwitchA] interface
[SwitchA-Vlanif102]
[SwitchA-Vlanif102]
ipv6 routing-enable
Vlanif 100
pim ipv6 dm
quit
Vlanif 101
pim ipv6 dm
quit
Vlanif 102
pim ipv6 dm
quit
Step 4 On SwitchB, enable PIM silent and MLD on the interface connected to the user host.
[SwitchB] multicast
[SwitchB] interface
[SwitchB-Vlanif201]
[SwitchB-Vlanif201]
[SwitchB-Vlanif201]
[SwitchB-Vlanif201]
ipv6 routing-enable
Vlanif 201
pim ipv6 silent
mld enable
mld version 1
quit
The configuration of SwitchC is similar to the configuration of SwitchB, and is not provided
here.
Step 5 Verify the configuration.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
450
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
# Run the display pim ipv6 interface command, and you can view the configuration and running
status of PIM-IPv6 on interfaces of each S9700. The display of the PIM-IPv6 configuration on
SwitchA is as follows:
<SwitchA> display pim ipv6 interface
VPN-Instance: public net
Interface
State NbrCnt HelloInt
Vlanif100
up
0
30
(local)
Vlanif101
up
1
30
Vlanif102
up
1
30
DR-Pri
1
1
1
DR-Address
FE80::200:AFF:FE01:109
FE80::A01:109:1(local)
FE80::A01:109:2(local)
# Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor command to check the PIM neighbor relationship between
the S9700s. The display of the PIM-IPv6 neighbor relationship on SwitchA is as follows:
<SwitchA> display pim ipv6 neighbor
VPN-Instance: public net
Total Number of Neighbors = 2
Neighbor
Interface
Uptime
Expires
FE80::A01:104:1 Vlanif101
00:04:16 00: 01:29
FE80::A01:105:1 Vlanif102
00:03:54 00 :01:17
Dr-Priority
1
1
BFD-Session
N
N
# Run the display pim ipv6 routing-table command to view the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing
table on an S9700. Assume that Host A joins multicast group G (FF0E::1). SwitchB generates
a (*, G) entry. When multicast source S (2001::5) sends multicast packets to G, a Shortest Path
Tree (SPT) is generated through flooding-prune. The (S, G) entry exists on each S9700 on the
network, and the display is as follows:
<SwitchA> display pim ipv6 routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 0 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(2001::5, FF0E::1)
Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: LOC ACT
UpTime: 00:01:20
Upstream interface: Vlanif100
Upstream neighbor: NULL
RPF prime neighbor: NULL
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif101
Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:01:20, Expires: <SwitchB> display pim ipv6 routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(*, FF0E::1)
Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: WC
UpTime: 01:46:23
Upstream interface: Vlanif200
Upstream neighbor: FE80::A01:109:1
RPF prime neighbor: FE80::A01:109:1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif201
Protocol: mld, UpTime: 01:46:23, Expires: never
(2001::5, FF0E::1)
Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: ACT
UpTime: 00:02:19
Upstream interface: Vlanif200
Upstream neighbor: FE80::A01:109:1
RPF prime neighbor: FE80::A01:109:1
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 1
1: Vlanif201
Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:02:19, Expires: <SwitchC> display pim ipv6 routing-table
VPN-Instance: public net
Total 0 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry
(2001::5, FF0E::1)
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
451
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: ACT
UpTime: 00:02:19
Upstream interface: Vlanif300
Upstream neighbor: FE80::A01:109:2
RPF prime neighbor: FE80::A01:109:2
Downstream interface(s) information:
Total number of downstreams: 0
----End
Configuration Files
l
Configuration file of SwitchA
#
sysname SwitchA
#
vlan batch 100 to 102
#
ipv6
#
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif100
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 2001::1/64
pim ipv6 dm
#
interface Vlanif101
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 2002::1/64
pim ipv6 dm
#
interface Vlanif102
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 2003::1/64
pim ipv6 dm
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 100
port hybrid untagged vlan 100
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 101
port hybrid untagged vlan 101
#
interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 102
port hybrid untagged vlan 102
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchB
#
sysname SwitchB
#
vlan batch 200 201
#
ipv6
#
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif200
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 2002::2/64
pim ipv6 dm
#
interface Vlanif201
ipv6 enable
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
452
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration
ipv6 address 3001::1/64
pim ipv6 dm
pim ipv6 silent
mld enable
mld version 1
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 200
port hybrid untagged vlan 200
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 201
port hybrid untagged vlan 201
#
return
l
Configuration file of SwitchC
#
sysname SwitchC
#
vlan batch 300 301
#
ipv6
#
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
#
interface Vlanif300
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 2003::2/64
pim ipv6 dm
#
interface Vlanif301
ipv6 enable
ipv6 address 4001::1/64
pim ipv6 dm
pim ipv6 silent
mld enable
mld version 1
#
interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 300
port hybrid untagged vlan 300
#
interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0
port hybrid pvid vlan 301
port hybrid untagged vlan 301
#
return
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
453
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
13
PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
About This Chapter
The PIM protocol can be used in an IPv6 network to implement multicast routing and data
forwarding inside an AS. The PIM-SM protocol is a multicast routing protocol of sparse mode.
It is applicable to a large-scale network with sparsely-distributed members.
13.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview
In an IPv6 PIM-SM network, group members are sparsely distributed and almost all the network
segments do not have group members resided. Therefore, an RP is a forwarding core of the PIMSM network. All PIM devices in the PIM-SM network must know the location of the RP and
the RP collects information about both group members and multicast sources.
13.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700
You are allowed to adjust parameters related to neighbor discovery, forwarding, DR, RP, join,
register, and assert. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent
function to enhance the PIM-SM security. IPv6 PIM-SM supports SSM, PIM GR, and SPT
switchover.
13.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions
Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv6 multicast routing and enable
IPv6 PIM-SM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the IPv6 PIM-SM
network can work normally.
13.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source
A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This
helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream
receivers to enhance security.
13.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-RP and a C-BSR
If a dynamic RP is used, you can adjust parameters of C-RPs and C-BSR as required.
13.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors
Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters
by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as
required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values.
13.7 Adjusting Control Parameters of Source Registering
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
454
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the multicast source encapsulates multicast
data in a Register message and sends the message to the RP in unicast mode. The RP then
decapsulates the message, and forwards the multicast data to receivers along the RPT.
13.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding
A multicast device sends Join messages upstream to require forwarding multicast data and Prune
messages to require stopping the forwarding of multicast data. You can adjust control parameters
for multicast data forwarding as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values.
13.9 Configuring Control Parameters for Assert
If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates
that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert
message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream
device.
13.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for the SPT Switchover
A high volume of multicast data traffic increases the load of an RP, and may result in a fault.
To solve this problem, IPv6 PIM-SM allows the RP or the DR at the group member side to
trigger the SPT switchover when the rate of multicast packets is high.
13.11 Configuring PIM GR (IPv6)
In an IPv6 PIM-SM network, PIM GR can be applied to a device with dual main control boards
to ensure normal multicast data forwarding during master-slave switchover.
13.12 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent
The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM.
In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send
the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To
avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state.
13.13 Maintaining PIM-SM
Maintaining IPv6 PIM-SM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status.
13.14 Configuration Example
Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic IPv6 PIM-SM network.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
455
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
13.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview
In an IPv6 PIM-SM network, group members are sparsely distributed and almost all the network
segments do not have group members resided. Therefore, an RP is a forwarding core of the PIMSM network. All PIM devices in the PIM-SM network must know the location of the RP and
the RP collects information about both group members and multicast sources.
In the IPv4 multicast applications, the Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) is used to set
multicast routes between switchs to replicate and forward multicast packets.
In IPv6 multicast applications, switchs run PIM-IPv6. The functions and principles of PIM-IPv6
are similar to the functions of PIM-IPv4.
PIM-IPv6 consists of the following separate protocols:
l
PIM-DM: indicates the Protocol Independent Multicast-Dense Mode. PIM-DM is
applicable to a small-scale network with densely-distributed members. The network adopts
the Any-Source Multicast (ASM) model to implement multicast services.
l
PIM-SM: indicates the Protocol Independent Multicast-Sparse Mode. PIM-SM is
applicable to a large-scale network with sparsely-distributed members. The network adopts
the ASM and Source-Specific Multicast (SSM) models to implement multicast services.
NOTE
l This chapter describes only the PIM-SM configuration in the IPv6 network. PIM-SM in this chapter
refers to the IPv6 PIM-SM, unless otherwise specified.
l For the configuration of PIM-DM, refer to the chapter PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration.
l For details of ASM and SSM models, refer to the chapter "IP Multicast Overview" in the S9700 Core
Routing Switch Feature Description - IP Multicast.
13.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700
You are allowed to adjust parameters related to neighbor discovery, forwarding, DR, RP, join,
register, and assert. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent
function to enhance the PIM-SM security. IPv6 PIM-SM supports SSM, PIM GR, and SPT
switchover.
Embedded-RP
Based on PIM-SM (IPv4), embedded-Rendezvous Point (Embedded-RP) is added in PIM-SM
(IPv6). The embedded-RP is a method of obtaining an RP(Rendezvous Point). The function of
the embedded-RP is the same as that of the static RP and the dynamic RP.
Static RP
You can specify the static RP on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain. When a dynamic RP exists
in the domain, the dynamic RP is preferred by default, but you can configure the static RP to be
preferred.
Dynamic RP
You can specify a C-RP in a BSR domain, adjust the priority for C-RP election, adjust the lifetime
of the advertisement message on the BSR received from the C-RP, adjust the interval for the CIssue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
456
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
RP to advertise advertisement messages, and specify an Access Control List (ACL) to limit the
range of the multicast groups served by the C-RP.
BSR
You can specify a Candidate-BSR (C-BSR) in a BSR domain, adjust the hash mask length used
by the C-RP for C-RP election, adjust the priority for BSR election, and adjust the legal address
range of BSRs.
Controlling a Multicast Source
You can configure the filtering rules based on multicast source addresses to control a multicast
source.
BSR Administrative Domain
To provide precise management, a PIM-SM network is divided into multiple BSR administrative
domains and a Global domain. This can reduce the workload of a single BSR and designate a
group address for users in a specific domain.
Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining PIM-SM Neighbors
You can adjust such control parameters of a PIM-SM neighbor relationship as:
l
Interval for sending Hello messages
l
Time period for the neighbor to hold the reachable state
l
Whether to accept the Hello messages with Generation IDs
l
Maximum delay in triggering the sending of the Hello messages
l
Priority for DR election
l
DR switching delay
l
Neighbor filtering function: An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the
addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering
rules.
Adjusting Control Parameters for Source Registering
You can configure the policy to filter Register messages, and set the timeout period for being in
the register suppression state and interval for sending null Register messages by running related
commands.
Adjusting Control Parameters for Multicast Forwarding
You can adjust the control parameters for multicast forwarding, including:
l
Interval for sending Join messages
l
Time period for the downstream interface to keep the forwarding state
l
Time for overriding the prune action
l
Filtering Join information in the Join/Prune messages
l
Neighbor check function: checks whether the sent or received Join/Prune and Assert
messages are to or from a PIM neighbor. If not, stop sending these messages.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
457
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert
You can configure the period for keeping the Assert state of a switch interface.
Adjusting Control Parameters for SPT Switchover
You can adjust the conditions of the SPT switchover and the interval for checking the forwarding
rate of multicast data.
IPv6 BFD for PIM
The S9700 supports IPv6 BFD for PIM for detecting the status of the link on the shared network
segment within milliseconds and fast responding to the fault on the PIM neighbor.
IPv6 BFD for PIM detects the current DR or Assert winner status on the shared network segment.
When a fault occurs on the interface, BFD immediately instructs the PIM module to trigger a
new DR election or Assert election rather than waits until the neighbor relationship or the Assert
timer times out. This reduces the discontinue period of multicast data transmission and thus
improves the reliability of multicast data transmission.
Configuring PIM Silent
On the access layer, the switch interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with
PIM. You can establish a PIM neighbor on the switch interface to process various PIM packets.
The configuration, however, has the security vulnerability. When a host maliciously generates
PIM Hello packets and sends the packets in large quantity, the switch may break down.
To prevent the preceding case, you can set the status of the switch interface to PIM Silent (that
is, PIM pasive state). When the interface is in the PIM silent state, the interface is prohibited
from receiving and forwarding any PIM packet. Then all PIM neighbors and PIM state machines
on the interface are deleted. The interface acts as the static DR and immediately takes effect. At
the same time, MLD on the interface are not affected.
PIM for Anycast RP
Through PIM for Anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain, IP routing will automatically select the
topologically closest RP for each source and receiver. This releases burdens on a single RP,
implements RP backup, and optimizes multicast forwarding paths.
IPv6 PIM IPSec
IPv6 PIM IPSec provides a complete set of IPSec mechanisms to authenticate the sent and
received IPv6 PIM protocol packets, thus protecting devices are protected against pseudo IPv6
PIM protocol packets.
13.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions
Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv6 multicast routing and enable
IPv6 PIM-SM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the IPv6 PIM-SM
network can work normally.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
458
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
13.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Before configuring basic IPv6 PIM-SM functions, configure a unicast IPv6 routing protocol.
Applicable Environment
A PIM-SM network can adopt the ASM and SSM models to provide multicast services for hosts.
The integrated components (including the RP) of the ASM model must be configured in the
network first. The SSM group address range is then adjusted as required.
NOTE
The SSM model needs to be supported by the Multicast Listener Discovery version 2 (MLDv2). If a host
must run MLDv1, configure MLD SSM mapping on the switch interface.
Through MLD, a switch knows the multicast group G that a user wants to join.
l
If G is in the SSM group address range and the source S is specified when the user joins G
through MLDv2, the SSM model is used to provide multicast services.
l
If G is in the SSM group address range and the switch is configured with the (S, G) SSM
mapping rules, the SSM model is used to provide multicast services.
l
If G is not in the SSM group address range, the ASM model is used to provide multicast
services.
In the PIM-SM network, the ASM model supports the following methods used to obtain an RP.
You can select at least one method to obtain an RP.
l
Embedded-RP: By default, the embedded-RP is started. The range of groups served by the
embedded-RP is limited.
l
Dynamic RP: To obtain a dynamic RP, select several switchs in the PIM-SM domain and
configure them as C-RPs and C-BSRs, and then configure the BSR boundary on the
switch interface on the boundary of the domain. Each switch in the PIM-SM domain can
then automatically obtain the RP.
l
Static RP: To obtain a static RP, manually configure the RP on each switch in the PIM-SM
domain. For the large-scale PIM-IPv6 network, configuring a static RP is complicated. To
enhance the robustness and the operation management of the multicast network, the static
RP is usually used as the backup of the BSR-RP.
A multicast group may be in the service range of the embedded-RP, dynamic -RP and static RP
simultaneously. By default, the sequence used by switchs to select an RP is embedded-RP>
dynamic RP > the static RP. If the static RP precedence is configured, the static RP is preferred.
Compared with all groups corresponding to an RP, different multicast groups correspond to
different RPs can reduce the load of a single RP and enhance the robustness of the network.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configure basic PIM-SM functions, complete the following task:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Enable IPv6 function globally
Data Preparation
To configure basic PIM-SM functions, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
459
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
No.
Data
1
(Optional) The range of groups served by the embedded-RP
2
(Optional) The IP address of the static RP
3
(Optional) ACL6 that defines the range of multicast groups served by a static RP
4
(Optional) The priority of a C-RP
5
(Optional) ACL6 that defines the range of multicast groups served by a C-RP
6
(Optional) The interval taken by a C-RP to send advertisement messages
7
(Optional) Timeout period during which a BSR waits to receive the advertisement
message from a C-RP
8
(Optional) Hash mask length of a C-BSR
9
(Optional) The priority of a C-BSR
10
(Optional) SSM group address range
13.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing
Prior to configuring all IPv6 multicast features, enable IPv6 multicast routing.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 (Optional) Run:
assign multicast-resource-mode optimize
The multicast replication capability of LPUs is improved. If each multicast packet needs to be
replicated into more than 8192 copies, run this command to improve the multicast replication
capability before enabling IP multicast routing.
Step 3 Run:
multicast ipv6 routing-enable
IPv6 multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance.
----End
13.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions
An interface can set up PIM neighbor relationship with other devices after IPv6 PIM-SM is
enabled on it.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
460
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Context
Do as follows on the PIM switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The VLANIF interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
pim ipv6 sm
PIM-SM (IPv6) is enabled.
After PIM-SM (IPv6) is enabled on interfaces, switchs set up PIM-IPv6 neighbor relationship
with each other. The switchs can then process protocol packets received from PIM-IPv6
neighbors.
NOTE
PIM-DM (IPv6) and PIM-SM (IPv6) cannot be enabled on an interface simultaneously. The PIM mode on
all interfaces that belong to the same instance must be the same. When a switch is deployed in a PIM-SM
(IPv6) domain, enable PIM-SM (IPv6) on all non-boundary interfaces.
----End
13.3.4 (Optional) Configuring an Embedded-RP
IPv6 PIM-SM supports the embedded-RP and the range of multicast groups that the embeddedRP serves set on all devices must be the same.
Context
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM (IPv6) domain:
NOTE
This configuration is optional. By default, the embedded-RP is enabled. The group address range of the
embedded-RP is FF7x::/12, and the value of x ranges from 0, 3 to F.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
461
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
embedded-rp [ basic-acl6-number | acl6-name
acl6-name ]
The group address range of an embedded-RP is specified.
If the address range defined by ACL6 is wider than the default group address range of an
embedded-RP, the embedded-RP is valid for the intersection part of the two address ranges.
NOTE
The group address scope of the embedded-RP on all switchs in the PIM-SM (IPv6) domain must be the
same.
----End
13.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Static RP
When only one RP exists in the network, you can manually configure a static RP rather than a
dynamic RP. This can save the bandwidth occupied by message exchange between the C-RP
and the BSR. The configurations about the static RP should be the same on all the devices in an
IPv6 PIM-SM domain.
Context
CAUTION
Configuring a static RP and a BSR-RP in the PIM-SM simultaneously may cause a network
fault. Therefore, confirm the action before you perform this configuration.
If the static RP is not required in this PIM-SM network, this configuration is not necessary.
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM(IPv6) domain:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
static-rp rp-address [ basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name ] [preferred ]
A static RP is specified.
The parameters of the command are explained as follows:
l rp-address: specifies the static RP address.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
462
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
l basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name: specifies the number of the ACL. This basic ACL
defines the scope of groups served by the static RP. When the scopes of multicast groups
that multiple static RP serves overlap, the static RP with the highest IP address acts as the
RP.
l preferred: indicates that the static RP takes precedence. The C-RP is configured in the
network at the same time. After preferred is set, switchs prefer the static RP. Otherwise,
switchs prefer the C-RP.
Multiple static RPs can be configured by using this command repeatedly, but the same ACL
cannot correspond to multiple static RPs. If the ACL is not configured, only one static RP can
be configured.
NOTE
The same static-rp command must be used on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain.
----End
13.3.6 (Optional) Configuring a Dynamic RP
In an PIM-SM(IPv6) domain, you can select several PIM devices and configure C-RPs on the
devices. Then, the RP is elected from these C-RPs. The C-BSRs should also be configured and
a BSR is elected from these C-BSRs. The BSR is responsible for collecting and advertising the
C-RP information on the network.
Context
CAUTION
This configuration is applicable only to the dynamic RP. If the dynamic RP is not used in this
network, this configuration is not necessary.
Do as follows on switchs that may become RP in the PIM-SM domain:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
c-rp ipv6-address [ advertisement-interval interval | [ group-policy { basic-acl6number | acl6-name acl6-name } | scope scope-id ] |holdtime interval | priority
priority-value ] *
The C-RP is configured.
The parameters of this command are explained as follows:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
463
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
l ipv6-address: specifies the IPv6 address of the interface where the C-RP resides. PM-SM
must be enabled on that interface.
l group-policy basic-acl6-number: specifies that the C-RP serves only the multicast group
matching ACL6. basic-acl-number: specifies the number of the basic ACL6. By default, the
C-RP serves all multicast groups.
l priority priority: specifies the priority for electing the C-RP. The greater the value, the lower
the priority. By default, the priority is 192.
NOTE
In the RP election, the C-RP with the highest priority (with the lowest priority value) succeeds. In case
of the same priority, the hash function is calculated, and the C-RP with the greatest hash value succeeds.
In case of the same priority and the same hash value, the C-RP with the highest IP address succeeds.
l holdtime hold-interval: specifies the timeout period during which the BSR waits to receive
the advertisement message from the C-RP. By default, the value is 150s.
l advertisement-interval adv-interval: specifies the interval during which the C-RP sends
advertisement messages. By default, the value is 60s.
Step 4 Run:
c-bsr ipv6-address [ hash-length [ priority ] ]
A C-BSR is configured.
The parameters of this command are explained as follows:
l ipv6-address: specifies the IPv6 address of the interface where the C-BSR resides. The
interface must be configured with PIM-SM.
l hash-length: specifies the length of the hash mask. According to the group address G, C-RP
address, and the value of hash-length, switchs calculate the C-RPs that have the same priority
and want to serve G by operating hash functions, and compare the calculation results. The
C-RP with the greatest calculated value acts as the RP that serves G.
You can use the c-bsr hash-length hash-length command to set the global hash length of the
C-BSRs. The set hash length then applies to all the C-BSRs configured on the switch.
Step 5 (Optional) Run:
bsm semantic fragmentation
The BSR message fragmentation is enabled.
It is recommended to enable BSR message fragmentation on all devices on the network because
BSR message fragmentation can solve the problem faced by IP fragmentation that all fragments
become unavailable due to loss of fragment information.
----End
13.3.7 (Optional) Configuring the SSM Group Address Range
The default SSM group address range is FF3x::/32. You can manually configure the SSM group
address range. Ensure that the SSM group address ranges configured on all devices in the network
are identical.
Context
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
464
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
NOTE
This configuration is optional. By default, the SSM group address range is FF3x::/32.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
ssm-policy { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name }
The SSM group address range is configured.
NOTE
Ensure that the SSM group address ranges of all switchs in the network must be identical.
----End
13.3.8 Checking the Configuration
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can check information about the
BSR, RP, PIM interface, PIM neighbor, and PIM routing table through commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 bsr-info command to check information about the BSR in the
PIM-SM (IPv6) domain.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type
interface-number | verbose ] * command to check information about PIM-IPv6 neighbors.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 rp-info [ ipv6-group-address ] command to check information
about RPs in the PIM-SM domain.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
465
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
13.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source
A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This
helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream
receivers to enhance security.
13.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can configure the lifetime of a
multicast source and source address-based filtering rules as required.
Applicable Environment
All the configurations in this section are applicable to the ASM and SSM models.
PIM-IPv6 switchs check the passing multicast data packets. By checking whether the data
packets match the filtering rule, the switchs determine whether to forward the packets. That is,
the switchs in the PIM domain act as filters. The filters help to control data flows, and limit
information obtained by downstream receivers.
NOTE
Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related
parameters according to the actual environment. If there is no special requirement from the actual network,
it is recommended to use default values.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters of a multicast source, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters of a multicast source, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Keepalive period of a multicast source
2
Filtering rules of multicast source addresses
13.4.2 Configuring the Keepalive Period of a Source
A multicast device starts a timer for each (S, G) entry. If the multicast device does not receive
any multicast packets from a multicast source within the set lifetime of the multicast source, it
considers that the (S, G) entry becomes invalid and the multicast source stops sending multicast
data to the multicast group.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
466
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
source-lifetime interval
The Keepalive period of a source is configured.
When the Keepalive period expires, the (S, G) entry becomes invalid.
----End
13.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses
After ACL6 rules are configured, a multicast device can filter the received multicast packets
based on source addresses or source/group addresses.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
source-policy { acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name }
A filter is configured.
If the basic ACL6 is configured, only the packets with the source addresses that pass the filtering
are forwarded.
If the advanced ACL6 is configured, only the packets with the source addresses and group
addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
467
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
NOTE
l If acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name is specified in the source-policy command and ACL rules are
created, only the multicast packets whose source addresses match the ACL rules are permitted.
l If acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name is specified in the source-policy command and no ACL rule is
created, the multicast packets with any source addresses are not forwarded.
l The source-policy command does not filter the static (S, G) entries.
----End
13.4.4 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters of a multicast source are adjusted, you can run commands to check
entries in the PIM routing table.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
13.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-RP and a C-BSR
If a dynamic RP is used, you can adjust parameters of C-RPs and C-BSR as required.
13.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
In case that the dynamic RP is used, after basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you
can adjust parameters of C-RPs and C-BSR, configure a BSR boundary, and set valid address
ranges for BSRs and C-RPs.
Applicable Environment
To enhance the performance of an RP or a BSR, you can adjust control parameters of C-RPs
and C-BSRs by using related commands.
NOTE
Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related
parameters according to the actual environment. If there is no special requirement of the actual network,
it is recommended to use default values.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
468
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters of a C-RP and a C-BSR, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters of a C-RP and C-BSR, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Priority of the C-RP
2
Interval during which the C-RP sending advertisement messages
3
Timeout period during which the BSR waits to receive the advertisement message
from the C-RP
4
Hash mask length of the C-BSR
5
Priority of the C-BSR
6
Interval during which the C-BSR sends Bootstrap messages
7
Period for keeping the Boostrap message received from the BSR
8
ACL6 that defines the legal BSR address range
9
ACL6 that defines the legal C-RP address range
13.5.2 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-RP
C-RPs periodically send Advertisement messages to a BSR. The Advertisement messages carry
C-RP priorities. You can adjust the C-RP priority, the interval for sending Advertisement
messages, and the holdtime of Advertisement messages on a device configured with the C-RP.
Context
Do as follows on the switch on which the C-RP is configured:
NOTE
Do as follows on the switch that has been configured with a C-RP. This configuration is optional. If there
is no special requirement, default values are recommended.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
469
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
c-rp priority priority
The priority of the C-RP is configured.
Step 4 Run:
c-rp advertisement-interval interval
The interval during which the C-RP sends advertisement messages is configured.
Step 5 Run:
c-rp holdtime interval
The period for keeping the advertisement message received from the C-RP is configured.
This period must be longer than the interval during the C-RP sends advertisement messages.
The C-RP periodically sends advertisement messages to the BSR. After receiving the
advertisement messages, the BSR obtains the Holdtime period from the messages. During the
Holdtime period, the advertisement message is valid. When the Holdtime period expires, the CRP ages. No requirement is imposed on the sequence of the preceding steps.
----End
13.5.3 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-BSR
At first, each C-BSR considers itself as a BSR and sends Bootstrap messages to all devices in
the network. You can adjust the hash mask length of the C-BSR carried in a Bootstrap message,
the C-BSR priority, the interval for sending Bootstrap messages, and the holdtime of Bootstrap
messages on a device configured with the C-BSR.
Context
Do as follows on the switch on which the C-BSR is configured:
NOTE
Do as follows on the switch that has been configured with a C-BSR. This configuration is optional. If there
is no special requirement, default values are recommended.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
c-bsr hash-length hash-length
The hash mask length of the C-BSR is configured.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
470
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Step 4 Run:
c-bsr priority priority
The priority of the C-BSR is configured.
Step 5 Run:
c-bsr interval interval
The interval during which the BSR sends Bootstrap messages is configured.
Step 6 Run:
c-bsr holdtime interval
The period for keeping the Bootstrap received from the BSR is configured.
The BSR periodically sends a Bootstrap message to the network. After receiving the Bootstrap
message, the C-BSR keeps the message for a certain period. During the period, the BSR election
stops temporarily. If the Holdtime period expires, a new round of BSR election is triggered
among C-BSRs.
NOTE
Ensure that the period for keeping the Bootstrap message received from the BSR and the interval during
which the BSR sends Bootstrap messages must be the same on all C-BSRs in the PIM-IPv6 domains. The
period for keeping the Bootstrap message received from the BSR must be longer than the interval during
which the BSR sending Bootstrap messages. No requirement is imposed on the sequence of the preceding
steps.
----End
13.5.4 Configuring the BSR Service Boundary
A BSR boundary can be configured on an interface. Bootstrap messages cannot pass the BSR
boundary. Multiple BSR boundary interfaces divide the network into different PIM-SM
domains.
Context
Do as follows the switchs that may become BSR boundaries:
NOTE
The BSR boundary is used to divide a PIM-SM (IPv6) domain. switchs outside the BSR boundary do not
take part in the process of multicast forwarding in the PIM-SM (IPv6) domain. This configuration is
optional. By default, all PIM-SM (IPv6) switchs in the network can receive BSR messages.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
pim ipv6 bsr-boundary
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
471
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
The BSR boundary is configured.
BSR messages cannot pass the BSR boundary.
----End
13.5.5 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Legal BSR addresses
ACL6-based policies can be set on all devices to filter C-BSR addresses. The devices then receive
only the Bootstrap messages with the source addresses being in the valid C-BSR address range.
Thus, BSR spoofing is avoided.
Context
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain:
NOTE
This configuration is optional. By default, source addresses of the received BSR packets are not checked,
and all received BSR packets are received.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
bsr-policy { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name }
The range of legal BSR addresses is limited.
After receiving an IP packet carrying a Bootstrap message, a switch checks the source address
of the IP packet. If the source address is not in the range of legal BSR addresses, the packet is
discarded. The BSR spoofing is thus avoided.
basic-acl6-number specifies the number of the basic ACL. The ACL defines the filtering policy
for the source addresses of BSR messages.
----End
13.5.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Legal C-RP Addresses
ACL6-based policies can be set on all C-BSRs to filter C-RP addresses and addresses of the
groups that the C-RPs serve. The BSR adds C-RP information to the RP-set only when the
addresses are in the set legal address range. Thus, C-RP spoofing is avoided.
Context
Do as follows on all C-BSRs in the PIM-SM domain:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
472
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
NOTE
This configuration is optional. By default, the C-RP address carried in the received advertisement message
and the address of the group that the C-RP serves are not checked, and all received advertisement messages
are received and added to the RP-set.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
crp-policy { advanced-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name }
The range of legal C-RP addresses and the range of groups that C-RPs serve are limited. When
a switch receives an advertisement message, the switch checks the C-RP address and the address
of the group that the C-RP serves in the message. The advertisement message is received and
added to the RP-set only when the C-RP address and the group address are in the legal address
range. The C-RP spoofing is thus avoided.
{ advanced-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name }: specifies the number of the advanced ACL.
The ACL defines the filtering policy to limit the range of legal C-RP and the range of groups
that the C-RP serves.
----End
13.5.7 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters of C-RPs and C-BSRs are adjusted, you can check information
about the BSR and RP and check whether a BSR boundary is configured on the interface through
commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 bsr-info command to check information about BSRs in the PIMSM domain.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 rp-info [ ipv6-group-address ] command to check information
about RPs in the PIM-SM domain.
----End
13.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining
Neighbors
Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters
by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as
required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
473
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
13.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust related parameters of Hello
messages for controlling neighbor relationships and configure the downstream neighbor tracking
function and the neighbor filtering function.
Applicable Environment
The configuration in this section is applicable to both the ASM model and the SSM model.
The PIM switchs send Hello messages to each other to establish the neighbor relationship,
negotiate the control parameters, and elect a DR.
The switch can work normally by default. The S9700 allows the users to adjust the parameters
as required.
NOTE
It is recommended to adopt the default value if there is no special requirement.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for maintaining neighbors, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for maintaining neighbors, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
Priority for DR election
2
Timeout period for waiting to receive Hello message from neighbors
3
Interval for sending Hello messages
4
Maximum delay for triggering Hello messages
5
DR switching delay, that is, the remaining time for the entries to turn invalid after a
DR interface no longer functions as a DR.
6
Number or name of the ACL6 used to filter PIM neighbors
13.6.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Maintaining PIM-IPv6
Neighbors
Control Parameters for Maintaining PIM-IPv6 Neighbors can be set either globally or on an
interface. The configuration in the interface view is prior to the configuration in the PIM view.
When the interval is not configured in the interface view, the configuration in the PIM view
takes effect.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
474
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Context
Perform the following steps on an PIM-SM (IPv6) switchto set the interval at which Hello
packets are sent and the period for keeping the reachable state of a neighbor:
NOTE
The configuration of the control parameters for maintaining PIM neighbors involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
3.
Run:
timer hello interval
The interval for sending Hello messages is configured.
4.
Run:
hello-option holdtime interval
The period for keeping the reachable state of a neighbor is configured.
If the local switch does not receive any Hello message from the neighbor after the
period expires, the local switch considers that the neighbor is unreachable.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
pim ipv6 timer hello interval
The interval for sending Hello messages is set.
4.
Run:
pim ipv6 triggered-hello-delay interval
The maximum delay for triggering Hello messages is set.
After the maximum delay is set, the conflict caused by multiple PIM-IPv6 switchs
simultaneously sending Hello message is avoided.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
475
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
5.
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Run:
pim ipv6 hello-option holdtime interval
The period for keeping the reachable state of a neighbor is configured.
If the local switch does not receive any Hello message from the neighbor after the
period expires, the local switch considers that the neighbor is unreachable.
6.
Run:
pim ipv6 require-genid
The Generation ID option is set in received Hello message.
The Hello message without the Generation ID option is refused.
----End
13.6.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Electing a DR
DR control parameters are used to direct the DR election. The greater the parameter value, the
higher the priority. You can set the DR priority value either globally or on an interface as needed.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-SM (IPv6) switch:
NOTE
The configuration of the control parameters for electing a DR involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
3.
Run:
hello-option dr-priority priority
The priority for the DR election is configured.
On the shared network segment where all PIM-IPv6 switchs support the DR priority,
the switch interface with highest priority acts as the DR. In the case of the same
priority, the switch interface with the highest IP address acts as the DR. If a minimum
of one PIM-IPv6 switch does not support the DR priority, the switch interface with
the highest IP address acts as the DR.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
476
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
pim ipv6 hello-option dr-priority priority-value
The priority for the DR election is configured.
On the shared network segment where all PIM-IPv6 switchs support the DR priority,
the switch interface with highest priority acts as the DR. In the case of the same
priority, the switch interface with the highest IP address acts as the DR. If a minimum
of one PIM-IPv6 switch does not support the DR priority, the switch interface with
the highest IP address acts as the DR.
4.
Run:
pim ipv6 timer dr-switch-delay interval
The DR switching delay is configured and the value of the delay is set.
When an interface changes from a DR to a non-DR, the existing routing entries are
valid until the maximum delay expires.
----End
13.6.4 Enabling the Function of Tracking a Downstream Neighbor
Enabling the function of tracking a downstream neighbor prevents the prune action from being
overridden when Prune messages and Join messages are received from the same network
segment. This reduces bandwidth consumption caused by message exchanges.
Context
Do as follows on the switch running IPv6 PIM-SM:
NOTE
The configuration involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
3.
Run:
hello-option neighbor-tracking
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
477
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
The function of tracking downstream neighbors is enabled.
After this function is enabled, information about the downstream neighbor who has
sent a Join message and whose Join state does not times out is recorded.
NOTE
The function of tracking downstream neighbors cannot be implemented unless all the switchs
running IPv6 PIM-SM in the shared network segment are enabled with this function.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
pim ipv6 hello-option neighbor-tracking
The function of tracking downstream neighbors is enabled.
After this function is enabled, information about the downstream neighbor who has
sent a Join message and whose Join state does not times out is recorded.
NOTE
The function of tracking downstream neighbors cannot be implemented unless all the switchs
running IPv6 PIM-SM in the shared network segment are enabled with this function.
----End
13.6.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering
To prevent some unknown devices from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is
required. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the
filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering rules.
Context
To prevent some switches from establishing unauthorized neighbor relationships through the
PIM protocol, configure the local device to filter PIM neighbors.
Do as follows on the switch enabled with IPv6 PIM-SM:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
478
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Step 3 Run:
pim ipv6 neighbor-policy { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name }
PIM neighbor filtering is configured.
An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules
and deletes the neighbors unmatching the filtering rules.
NOTE
When configuring the PIM neighbor filtering function on the interface, you must also configure the
neighbor filtering function correspondingly on the switch that sets up the neighbor relationship with the
interface.
----End
13.6.6 Checking the Configuration
After the neighbor control parameters are adjusted, you can run commands to check information
about the PIM interface and the PIM neighbor.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type
interface-number | verbose ] * command to check information about PIM-IPv6 neighbors.
----End
13.7 Adjusting Control Parameters of Source Registering
In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the multicast source encapsulates multicast
data in a Register message and sends the message to the RP in unicast mode. The RP then
decapsulates the message, and forwards the multicast data to receivers along the RPT.
13.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can configure filtering policies and
the checksumming mode for Register messages and configure PIM-SM Register suppression as
required.
Applicable Environment
This section describes how to configure the control parameters of the source registering through
commands in the ASM model.
In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the source S encapsulates the received
multicast data in a Register message and unicasts the Register message to the RP. The RP then
decapsulates the message, and forwards the multicast data to receivers along the RPT.
After the SPT switchover on the RP is complete, the multicast data reaches the RP along the
source tree in the multicast mode. The RP sends a Register-Stop message to the DR at the source
side. The DR then stops sending Register messages and enters the suppressed state. In the register
suppression period, the DR periodically sends a Probe message (null Register message) to notify
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
479
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
the RP that the multicast source is still in the active state. After the register suppression expires,
the DR resends the Register message carrying a multicast data packet.
NOTE
Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related
parameters according to the specific network environment. If there is no special requirement, default values
are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters of source registering, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters of source registering, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
ACL6 rules used by the RP to filter Register messages
2
Timeout period for keeping the suppressed state of the source registering
3
Interval for sending null Register messages to the RP
4
IPv6 global unicast address for sending Register messages from the source's DR
13.7.2 Configuring Rules for Filtering PIM-SM (IPv6) Register
Messages
You can configure policies on filtering Register messages on all the routers that may become
RPs. By default, the checksum is calculated based on the entire Register message. You can
configure the device to calculate the checksum based on only the header of a Register message.
Context
Do as follows on switchs that may become RPs:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
480
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
register-policy { advanced-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name }
The rules for filtering Register messages are set.
The RP accepts or rejects to a Register message according to the rules.
----End
13.7.3 Configuring PIM-SM (IPv6) Registering Suppression
You can set the timeout period for keeping the register suppression state and the interval for
sending null Register messages on all the devices that may become DRs at the multicast source
side.
Context
Do as follows on the switch that may become the DR at the source side:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
register-suppression-timeout interval
The timeout period for keeping the suppressed state of the registering is set.
Step 4 Run:
probe-interval interval
The interval for sending null Register messages is set.
----End
13.7.4 Checking the Configuration
After control parameters for source registering are adjusted, you can run the corresponding
command to check information about the PIM interface.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
481
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
13.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding
A multicast device sends Join messages upstream to require forwarding multicast data and Prune
messages to require stopping the forwarding of multicast data. You can adjust control parameters
for multicast data forwarding as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values.
13.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can adjust control parameters used
to maintain the forwarding relationship, and configure the Join information filtering and
neighbor filtering functions to enhance security as required.
Applicable Environment
Unless otherwise specified, the configurations in this section are applicable to both the ASM
model and the SSM model.
When the first member of a group appears on a switch, the switch sends a Join message through
the upstream interface to require the upstream switch to forward packets to this network segment.
When the last member of a group on the switch leaves its group, the switch sends the Prune
message through the upstream interface to request the upstream switch to perform the prune
action. After receiving the Prune message, the upstream interface stops forwarding packets to
this network segment. If other downstream switchs exist in this network segment, they must
send the Join message to override the prune action.
In the ASM model, the switchs periodically send Join messages to the RP in case the RPT branch
is deleted because of timeout.
NOTE
Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related
parameters according to the specific network environment. If there is no special requirement, default values
are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for forwarding, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for forwarding, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
No.
Data
1
Interval for sending Join/Prune messages
2
The value of the Holdtime field in the sent Join/Prune message
3
Delay for transmitting messages
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
482
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
No.
Data
4
Period of overriding the Prune action
5
Number or name of the ACL6 used to filter join information
6
Whether to perform neighbor check on the received or sent Join/Prune messages and
Assert messages
13.8.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Keeping the Forwarding
Relationship
The control parameters of multicast data forwarding can be set either globally or on an interface.
The parameters specify the interval for sending Join/Prune messages and the period for a
downstream interface to keep the Join/Prune state.
Context
Do as follows on the PIM-SM (IPv6) switch:
NOTE
The configuration of the control parameters for maintaining the forwarding relationship involves the
following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
3.
Run:
timer join-prune interval
The interval for sending Join/Prune messages is set.
4.
Run:
holdtime join-prune interval
The value of the Holdtime field in the sent Join/Prune message is set.
The Holdtime period is the period for keeping the Forwarding/Prune state of the
downstream interface.
l
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Configuration on an Interface
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
483
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
1.
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
pim ipv6 timer join-prune interval
The interval for sending Join/Prune messages is set.
4.
Run:
pim ipv6 holdtime join-prune interval
The value of the Holdtime field in the sent Join/Prune message is set.
The Holdtime period is the period for keeping the Forwarding/Prune state of the
downstream interface.
5.
Run:
pim ipv6 require-genid
The Generation ID option is set in received Hello message.
The Hello message without the Generation ID option is refused.
NOTE
The change of the Generation ID in the Hello message received from the upstream neighbor
indicates that the upstream neighbor is lost or the status of the upstream neighbor has changed.
----End
13.8.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Prune
The prune control parameters can be set either globally or on an interface. The parameters specify
the delay for transmitting messages in a LAN and the interval for overriding the Prune action.
Context
The Hello message carries lan-delay ( which indicates the delay for transmitting prune message )
and override-interval ( which indicates the interval for overriding a prune ). The relationship
between lan-delay, override-interval, and PPT is that lan-delay + override-interval = PPT. PrunePending Timer (PPT) indicates the delay from the time when a switch receives the Prune message
from the downstream interface to the time when the switch performs the prune action to suppress
the forwarding of the downstream interface. If the switch receives a Join message from a
downstream switch within the PPT, the switch does not perform the prune action.
Do as follows on the PIM-SM (IPv6) switch:
NOTE
The configuration of the control parameters of prune involves the following cases:
l Global Configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on the interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
484
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
3.
Run:
hello-option lan-delay interval
The delay of transmitting messages in a LAN is set.
4.
Run:
hello-option override-interval interval
The period for overriding the prune action is set.
When a switch receives a Prune message through an upstream interface, it indicates
that another downstream switch exists in the LAN. If the switch still needs to receive
the multicast data, the switch must send a Join message to the upstream within the
override-interval.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
pim ipv6 hello-option lan-delay interval
The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set.
4.
Run:
pim ipv6 hello-option override-interval interval
The period for overriding the prune action is set.
----End
13.8.4 Configuring Join Information Filtering
A Join/Prune message received by an interface may contain both join information and prune
information. You can configure the interface to filter join information based on ACL6 rules.
Context
You can configure the switch to filter join information based on ACL6 rules. The switch then
creates PIM entries for only the join information matching ACL6 rules, which can prevent illegal
users from accessing the group.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
485
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Do as follows on the switch enabled with IPv6 PIM-SM:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
pim ipv6 join-policy { asm { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } | ssm
{ advanced-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } | advanced-acl6-number | acl6-name
acl6-name }
Join information filtering is configured.
----End
13.8.5 (Optional) Configuring Parameters for Join/Prune Messages
The parameters such as the maximum message size and number of (S, G) entries, and the message
package function can be configured for PIM Join/Prune messages.
Context
Perform the following steps on the PIM-SM-enabled switch:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6 [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ]
The IPv6 PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
join-prune max-packet-length packet-length
The maximum size of each PIM-SM Join/Prune message to be sent is configured.
The default size is 8100 bytes.
Step 4 Run:
join-prune periodic-messages queue-size queue-size
The maximum number of entries carried in a PIM-SM Join/Prune message that is sent every
second is configured.
The default value is 1020.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
486
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Step 5 Run:
join-prune triggered-message-pack disable
The function to package Join/Prune messages in real time is disabled.
This function is enabled by default.
----End
13.8.6 Configuring Neighbor Check
If PIM neighbor check is enabled, a device checks whether the Join/Prune and Assert messages
are sent to or received from a PIM neighbor. If not, the device drops the messages.
Context
By default, checking whether the Join/Prune message and Assert messages are sent to or received
from a PIM neighbor is not enabled.
If PIM neighbor checking is required, it is recommended to configure the neighbor checking
function on the devices connected with user devices rather than on the internal devices of the
network. Then, the switch checks whether the Join/Prune and Assert messages are sent to or
received from a PIM neighbor. If not, the switch drops the messages.
Do as follows on the switch enabled with IPv6 PIM-SM:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The IPv6 PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
neighbor-check { receive | send }
The neighbor check function is configured.
You can specify both receive and send to enable the IPv6 PIM neighbor check function for both
the received and sent Join/Prune messages and Assert messages.
----End
13.8.7 Checking the Configuration
After control parameters for multicast data forwarding are adjusted, you can check information
about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages
through commands.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
487
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft |
graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
13.9 Configuring Control Parameters for Assert
If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates
that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert
message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream
device.
13.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can set the period for holding the
Assert state as required.
Applicable Environment
The configurations in this section are applicable to both the ASM model and the SSM model.
When a PIM-SM switch receives multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates
that other upstream switchs exist in this network segment. The switch sends an Assert message
through the downstream interface to take part in the assert election.
NOTE
switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, you can adjust related
parameters according to the specific network environment. If there is no special requirement, default values
are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for assert, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
488
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for asset, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
The period for keeping the Assert state
13.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State
The device that fails the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding multicast
data during the Assert state. After the holdtime of the Assert state expires, the downstream
interface can forward multicast data.
Context
Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM (IPv6) domain:
NOTE
The configuration of control parameters for Assert involves the following cases:
l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces.
l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global
configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used.
Procedure
l
Global Configuration
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
3.
Run:
holdtime assert interval
The period for keeping the Assert state is configured.
The switch that fails in the election prohibits the downstream interface from
forwarding multicast data in this period. After the period expires, the switch restores
the forwarding of the downstream interface. By default, the holdtime period in Assert
messages is 180 seconds.
l
Configuration on an Interface
1.
Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
2.
Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
489
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
The interface view is displayed.
3.
Run:
pim ipv6 holdtime assert interval
The period for keeping the Assert state is set.
The switch that fails in the election prohibits the downstream interface from
forwarding multicast data in this period. After the period expires, the switch restores
the forwarding of the downstream interface. By default, the holdtime period in Assert
messages is 180 seconds.
----End
13.9.3 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for assert are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM
interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through
commands.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft |
graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages.
l
Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
----End
13.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for the SPT Switchover
A high volume of multicast data traffic increases the load of an RP, and may result in a fault.
To solve this problem, IPv6 PIM-SM allows the RP or the DR at the group member side to
trigger the SPT switchover when the rate of multicast packets is high.
13.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust control parameters for
SPT switchover as required.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
490
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Applicable Environment
This section describes how to configure the control parameters of the SPT switchover through
commands in the ASM model.
In PIM-SM forwarding, each multicast group corresponds to an RPT. At first, all multicast
sources encapsulate data in Register messages, and send the messages to the RP in the unicast
mode. The RP decapsulates the messages and forwards the data along the RPT.
Forwarding multicast data by using the RPT has the following disadvantages:
l
The DR at the source side and the RP need to encapsulate and decapsulate packets.
l
The forwarding path may not be the shortest path from the source to receivers.
l
Heavy data traffic increases the load of the RP, and may cause a fault.
The solution to the preceding disadvantages is that:
l
SPT switchover triggered by the RP: The RP sends a Join message to the source, and
establishes a multicast route along the shortest path from the DR at the source side to the
RP. The subsequent packets are forwarded along the path.
l
SPT switchover triggered by the DR at the receiver side: The DR at the receiver side checks
the forwarding rate of multicast data. If the DR finds that the rate exceeds the threshold,
the DR triggers the SPT switchover immediately. The DR sends a Join message to the
source, and establishes a multicast route along the shortest path from the DR at the source
side to the DR at the receiver side. The subsequent packets are forwarded along the path.
NOTE
switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related
parameters according to the specific network environment. If there is no special requirement, default values
are recommended.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before adjusting control parameters for the SPT switchover, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To adjust control parameters for the SPT switchover, you need the following data.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
No.
Data
1
Forwarding rate threshold that the DR at the receiver side switches packets from the
RPT to the SPT
2
Group filtering policy and sequence policy for the RPT-to-SPT switchover
3
Interval for checking the forwarding rate threshold of multicast data before RPT-toSPT switchover
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
491
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
13.10.2 (Optional) Adjusting Conditions of the SPT Switchover
You can configure SPT switchover conditions on the DR at the group member side. The DR
then checks the forwarding rate of multicast data. If finding that the rate exceeds the threshold,
the DR triggers the SPT switchover immediately.
Context
Do as follows on the switch that may become the DR at the receiver side:
NOTE
This configuration is optional. By default, the RP and the DR at the receiver side immediately perform the
SPT switchover after receiving the first multicast data packet.
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
spt-switch-threshold { traffic-rate | infinity } [ group-policy { basic-acl6number | acl6-name acl6-name } [ order order-value ] ]
Conditions of the SPT switchover are adjusted.
The parameters of this command are explained as follows:
l traffic-rate: specifies the rate threshold of SPT switchover.
l infinity: indicates that the SPT switchover is not triggered.
l group-policy { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } [ order order-value ]: specifies
the range of the multicast groups that use the threshold. By default, the threshold is applicable
to all multicast groups.
----End
13.10.3 (Optional) Configuring the Interval for Checking the
Forwarding Rate of Multicast Data
After conditions for the SPT switchover are configured, you can set the interval for checking
the forwarding rate of multicast data.
Context
Do as follows on the switch that may become the DR at the receiver side:
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
492
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
timer spt-switch interval
The interval for checking the forwarding rate of multicast data is set.
By default, the DR at the receiver side performs SPT switchover after receiving the first multicast
data packet.
NOTE
Before configuring the timer spt-switch command, run the spt-switch-threshold command to set the
threshold of the rate that will trigger SPT switchover. Otherwise, timer spt-switch does not take effect.
----End
13.10.4 Checking the Configuration
After the control parameters for SPT switchover are adjusted, you can run commands to check
information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
----End
13.11 Configuring PIM GR (IPv6)
In an IPv6 PIM-SM network, PIM GR can be applied to a device with dual main control boards
to ensure normal multicast data forwarding during master-slave switchover.
13.11.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can configure PIM GR to improve
PIM network reliability.
Applicable Environment
In some multicast applications, the switch may need to perform active/standby switchover. After
active/standby switchover, the new active main control board deletes the forwarding entries on
the interface board and re-learns the PIM routing table and multicast routing table. During this
process, multicast traffic is interrupted.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
493
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
In the PIM-SM/SSM network, PIM Graceful Restart (GR) can be applied to the switch with dual
main control boards to ensure normal multicast traffic forwarding during active/standby
switchover.
The active main control board of the switch backs up PIM routing entries and Join/Prune
information to be sent upstream to the standby main control board. The interface board keeps
forwarding entries. Therefore, after active/standby switchover, the switch can actively and fast
send Join messages upstream to maintain the Join state of the upstream. Then, the PIM protocol
sends Hello messages carrying new Generation ID to all switchs enabled with PIM-SM. When
the downstream switch finds that the Generation ID of its neighbor changes, it sends a Join/
Prune message to the neighbor for re-creating routing entries, thereby ensuring non-stop
forwarding of multicast data on the forwarding plane.
If a dynamic RP is used on the network, after receiving a Hello message with the Generation ID
being changed, the DR or candidate DR unicasts a BSM message to the switch performing active/
standby switchover and the switch learns and restores RP information based on the received
BSM message. If the switch has not leant any RP information from the BSM messages, it obtains
the RP information from the Join/Prune message received from the downstream router and recreates multicast routing table.
NOTE
PIM GR is applicable to PIM-SM/SSM networks.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring PIM GR, complete the following task:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol and enabling unicast GR
l
Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions
Data Preparation
To enable PIM GR, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
PIM-IPv6 GR period
13.11.2 Enabling PIM GR (IPv6)
After PIM GR is enabled on a device, you can set the PIM GR period as required.
Context
Do as follows on the switch enabled with PIM SM (IPv6).
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
494
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Step 2 Run:
pim-ipv6
The IPv6 PIM view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
graceful-restart
PIM GR is enabled.
Step 4 (Optional) Run:
graceful-restart period period
The PIM GR period is set.
By default, the PIM GR period is 120 seconds.
----End
13.11.3 Checking the Configuration
After PIM GR is configured, you can run the command to check whether the PIM routing table
is the same as that before master-slave switchover.
Procedure
Step 1 Run the following commands to check IPv6 PIM routing table.
l display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-groupaddress [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none |
rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude |
include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoinginterface-number [ number ] ]
l display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } ] *
----End
13.12 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent
The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM.
In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send
the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To
avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state.
13.12.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM and MLD are configured, you can configure the PIM
silent function on the interface connected with the user host. This interface should be enabled
with IPv6 PIM-SM and MLD first.
Applicable Environment
At the access layer, the switch interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with
PIM-IPv6. You can establish the PIM-IPv6 neighbor relationship on the switch interface to
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
495
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
process various PIM-IPv6 packets. The configuration, however, has the security vulnerability.
When a host maliciously generates PIM-IPv6 Hello packets and sends the packets in large
quantity, the switch may break down.
To avoid the preceding case, you can set the status of the switch interface to PIM-IPv6 silent.
When the interface is in the PIM-IPv6 silent state, the interface is prohibited from receiving and
forwarding any PIM-IPv6 packet. All PIM-IPv6 neighbors and PIM-IPv6 state machines on the
interface are deleted. The interface acts as the static DR and immediately takes effect. At the
same time, MLD on the interface is not affected.
To enable PIM-IPv6 silent, the network environment must meet the following conditions:
l
The network supports IPv4 and IPv6.
l
The PIM-IPv6 silent is applicable only to the switch interface directly connected to the host
network segment that is connected only to this switch.
CAUTION
If PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled on the interface connected to a switch, the PIM-IPv6 neighbor
cannot be established and a multicast fault may occur.
If the host network segment is connected to multiple switchs and PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled on
multiple switch interfaces, the interface become static DRs. Therefore, multiple DRs exist in
this network segment, and a multicast fault occurs.
Pre-configuration Tasks
Before configuring PIM-IPv6 silent, complete the following tasks:
l
Configuring a unicast routing protocol to make the network layer reachable
l
Configuring PIM-SM
l
Configuring MLD
Data Preparation
To configure PIM-IPv6 silent, you need the following data.
No.
Data
1
The number of the switch interface connected to hosts
13.12.2 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent
After the interface is configured with PIM silent, it is forbidden to receive or forward any PIM
protocol packet. All PIM neighbors and PIM state machines on this interface are deleted. Then,
this interface automatically becomes the DR. MLD on the interface is not affected.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
496
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Context
CAUTION
PIM-IPv6 silent is applicable only to the switch interface connected to the host network segment
that can be connected to only one PIM-IPv6 switch.
Do as follows on the switch interface connected to the host network segment:
Procedure
Step 1 Run:
system-view
The system view is displayed.
Step 2 Run:
interface interface-type interface-number
The interface view is displayed.
Step 3 Run:
pim ipv6 silent
PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled.
After this function is enabled, the Hello packet attack of malicious hosts is effectively prevented
and the connected switchs are protected.
----End
13.12.3 Checking the Configuration
After PIM silent is configured, you can run the command to check information about the PIM
interface.
Prerequisites
All the configurations of PIM silent are complete.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
----End
13.13 Maintaining PIM-SM
Maintaining IPv6 PIM-SM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
497
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
13.13.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM-IPv6 Control Messages
If you need to re-collect the statistics about IPv6 PIM control messages, you can reset the existent
statistics. Note that the statistics cannot be restored after you reset them. This operation does not
affect normal running of PIM.
Context
CAUTION
The statistics of PIM-IPv6 control messages on an interface cannot be restored after you clear
it. Therefore, confirm the action before you use the command.
Procedure
l
Run the reset pim ipv6 control-message counters [ interface interface-type interfacenumber ] command in the user view to clear statistics of PIM-IPv6 control messages on an
interface.
----End
13.13.2 Clearing the PIM Status of the Specified Downstream
Interfaces of PIM Entries
You can clear the PIM Join/Prune state and Assert state on the specified downstream interface
of an IPv6 PIM entry. MLD status and static multicast groups on this interface are not affected.
Context
CAUTION
Clearing PIM status of the downstream interfaces may trigger the sending of corresponding Join/
Prune messages, which affects multicast services.
Using the following command can clear join information about illegal users, and clear the PIM
status of the specified interface in a specified entry, such as PIM Join/Prune status and Assert
status.
The command cannot be used to clear the MLD or static group join status on a specified interface.
Procedure
Step 1 After confirming that PIM status of the specified downstream interfaces of the specified PIM
entry need to be cleared, run the reset pim ipv6 routing-table group ipv6-group-address
mask ipv6-group-mask-length source ipv6-source-address interface interface-type interfacenumber command in the user view.
----End
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
498
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
13.13.3 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM-SM
During IPv6 PIM routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know
the running of PIM.
Context
In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running
status of PIM-SM.
Procedure
l
Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft |
graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command in any view to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6
control messages.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 bsr-info command in any view to check information about the
BSR.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 claimed-route [ ipv6-source-address ] command in any view
to check unicast routing information used by (S, G) and (*, G) entries in the PIM-SM routing
table.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 rp-info [ ipv6-group-address ] command in any view to check
information about the RP to which the multicast group corresponds.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 grafts command in any view to check the unacknowledged PIMIPv6 Graft messages.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ]
[ verbose ] command in any view to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces.
l
Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type
interface-number | verbose ] * command in any view to check information about PIM-IPv6
neighbors.
l
Run the following commands in any view to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table.
– display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif |
nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } |
outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number |
none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ]
– display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] |
ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type
interface-number | register } ] *
l
Run the display pim ipv6 invalid-packet [ interface interface-type interface-number |
message-type { assert | bsr | hello | join-prune | graft | graft-ack | state-refresh } ] *
command in any view to check the statistics about invalid IPv6 PIM messages received by
a device.
----End
13.13.4 Debugging PIM-IPv6
When a fault occurs during the running of IPv6 PIM, run the debugging commands in the user
view and check the contents of sent and received packets for fault location.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
499
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Context
CAUTION
Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging
all command to disable it immediately.
Procedure
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 all command in the user view to enable all the PIM-IPv6
debugging.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 event [ advanced-acl6-number ] in the user view to enable
the debugging of PIM-IPv6 events.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 routing-table [ advanced-acl6-number ] command in the
user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 routing table.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 neighbor [ interface-based-acl6-number | basic-acl6number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIMIPv6 neighbors.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 assert [ advanced-acl6-number | [ receive | send ] ] *
command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 Assert.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 join-prune [ interface-based-acl6-number | advanced-acl6number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIMIPv6 Join/Prune.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 rp [ receive | send ] command in the user view to enable the
debugging of PIM-IPv6 RP.
l
Run the debugging pim ipv6 register [ advanced-acl6-number ] command in the user view
to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 Register.
----End
13.14 Configuration Example
Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic IPv6 PIM-SM network.
13.14.1 Example for Configuring the IPv6 PIM-SM Network
Networking Requirements
As shown in Figure 13-1, multicast is deployed on the network of an Internet service provider
(ISP). The network is deployed with IGP and is connected to the Internet. The unicast routing
routes work normally. The S9700s on the network need to be configured properly so that user
hosts can receive the VoD information in multicast mode.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
500
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
Figure 13-1 Networking diagram for configuring basic IPv6 PIM-DM functions
SwitchB
GE1/0/0
2002::2
GE2/0/0
3001::1
GE3/0/0
2004::1
SwitchA
Source
2001::5
GE1/0/0
2001::1
GE2/0/0
2002::1
GE3/0/0
2003::1
GE1/0/0
GE4/0/0 2003::2
2006::1
Internet
HostA
HostB
GE2/0/0
2004::2
SwitchD
GE3/0/0
2005::1
GE1/0/0
2005::2
SwitchC
GE2/0/0
4001::2
HostC
HostD
Switch
Physical interface
VLANIF interface
IP address
SwitchA
GE1/0/0
VLANIF100
2001::1
GE2/0/0
VLANIF101
2002::1
GE3/0/0
VLANIF102
2003::1
GE4/0/0
VLANIF103
2006::1
GE1/0/0
VLANIF101
2002::2
GE2/0/0
VLANIF201
3001::1
GE3/0/0
VLANIF202
2004::1
GE1/0/0
VLANIF300
2005::2
GE2/0/0
VLANIF301
4001::2
GE1/0/0
VLANIF102
2003::2
GE2/0/0
VLANIF202
2004::2
GE3/0/0
VLANIF300
2005::1
SwitchB
SwitchC
SwitchD
Configuration Roadmap
The ISP network is connected to the Internet. Therefore, to facilitate service expansion, IPv6
PIM-SM protocol is used to configure the multicast function and ASM and SSM models are
adopted to provide multicast services. In this example, each host network segment is connected
to only one S9700, so PIM silent can be used to prevent the Hello message attack. The
configuration roadmap is as follows:
1.
Create VLANs and VLAN interfaces on the S9700s and assign IPv6 addresses to the VLAN
interfaces. The configuration procedure is not provided here.
2.
Enable an IPv6 unicast routing protocol on the four switches.
Issue 01 (2012-03-15)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
501
S9700 Core Routing Switch
Configuration Guide - Multicast
13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration
3.
Enable multicast on the S9700s.
4.
Enable IPv6 PIM-SM on all router interfaces.
5.
Configure the C-BSR and C-RP on SwitchD.
6.
Configure the BSR boundary on the interface connecting SwitchA to the Internet.
7.
Configure the SSM address range on each S9700.
8.
Enable PIM IPv6 silent and MLD on the interfaces connected to hosts.
Data Preparation
To complete the configuration, you need the following data:
l
MLD version running on the interfaces of S9700s connected to user hosts: MLDv2
l
Global unicast IPv6 address of the C-BSR and C-RP: 2004::2
l
SSM group a